PIC18F1230-E/PQTP [MICROCHIP]
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D; 18 /20/ 28引脚,增强型闪存微控制器采用纳瓦技术,高性能PWM和A / D型号: | PIC18F1230-E/PQTP |
厂家: | MICROCHIP |
描述: | 18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D |
文件: | 总312页 (文件大小:5230K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
PIC18F1230/1330
Data Sheet
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash
Microcontrollers with
nanoWatt Technology,
High-Performance PWM and A/D
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B
Note the following details of the code protection feature on Microchip devices:
•
Microchip products meet the specification contained in their particular Microchip Data Sheet.
•
Microchip believes that its family of products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the market today, when used in the
intended manner and under normal conditions.
•
There are dishonest and possibly illegal methods used to breach the code protection feature. All of these methods, to our
knowledge, require using the Microchip products in a manner outside the operating specifications contained in Microchip’s Data
Sheets. Most likely, the person doing so is engaged in theft of intellectual property.
•
•
Microchip is willing to work with the customer who is concerned about the integrity of their code.
Neither Microchip nor any other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of their code. Code protection does not
mean that we are guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Code protection is constantly evolving. We at Microchip are committed to continuously improving the code protection features of our
products. Attempts to break Microchip’s code protection feature may be a violation of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act. If such acts
allow unauthorized access to your software or other copyrighted work, you may have a right to sue for relief under that Act.
Information contained in this publication regarding device
applications and the like is provided only for your convenience
and may be superseded by updates. It is your responsibility to
ensure that your application meets with your specifications.
MICROCHIP MAKES NO REPRESENTATIONS OR WAR-
RANTIES OF ANY KIND WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
WRITTEN OR ORAL, STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE,
RELATED TO THE INFORMATION, INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO ITS CONDITION, QUALITY, PERFORMANCE,
MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR PURPOSE.
Microchip disclaims all liability arising from this information and
its use. Use of Microchip devices in life support and/or safety
applications is entirely at the buyer’s risk, and the buyer agrees
to defend, indemnify and hold harmless Microchip from any and
all damages, claims, suits, or expenses resulting from such
use. No licenses are conveyed, implicitly or otherwise, under
any Microchip intellectual property rights.
Trademarks
The Microchip name and logo, the Microchip logo, Accuron,
dsPIC, KEELOQ, microID, MPLAB, PIC, PICmicro, PICSTART,
PRO MATE, PowerSmart, rfPIC and SmartShunt are
registered trademarks of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A. and other countries.
AmpLab, FilterLab, Migratable Memory, MXDEV, MXLAB,
SEEVAL, SmartSensor and The Embedded Control Solutions
Company are registered trademarks of Microchip Technology
Incorporated in the U.S.A.
Analog-for-the-Digital Age, Application Maestro, dsPICDEM,
dsPICDEM.net, dsPICworks, ECAN, ECONOMONITOR,
FanSense, FlexROM, fuzzyLAB, In-Circuit Serial
Programming, ICSP, ICEPIC, Linear Active Thermistor,
MPASM, MPLIB, MPLINK, MPSIM, PICkit, PICDEM,
PICDEM.net, PICLAB, PICtail, PowerCal, PowerInfo,
PowerMate, PowerTool, REAL ICE, rfLAB, rfPICDEM, Select
Mode, Smart Serial, SmartTel, Total Endurance, UNI/O,
WiperLock and Zena are trademarks of Microchip Technology
Incorporated in the U.S.A. and other countries.
SQTP is a service mark of Microchip Technology Incorporated
in the U.S.A.
All other trademarks mentioned herein are property of their
respective companies.
© 2006, Microchip Technology Incorporated, Printed in the
U.S.A., All Rights Reserved.
Printed on recycled paper.
Microchip received ISO/TS-16949:2002 quality system certification for
its worldwide headquarters, design and wafer fabrication facilities in
Chandler and Tempe, Arizona and Mountain View, California in
October 2003. The Company’s quality system processes and
procedures are for its PICmicro® 8-bit MCUs, KEELOQ® code hopping
devices, Serial EEPROMs, microperipherals, nonvolatile memory and
analog products. In addition, Microchip’s quality system for the design
and manufacture of development systems is ISO 9001:2000 certified.
DS39758B-page ii
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with
nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
14-Bit Power Control PWM Module:
Peripheral Highlights:
• Up to 6 PWM channel outputs
• High-current sink/source 25 mA/25 mA
• Up to 4 programmable external interrupts
• Four input change interrupts
- Complementary or independent outputs
• Edge or center-aligned operation
• Flexible dead-band generator
• Enhanced Addressable USART module:
- Supports RS-485, RS-232 and LIN 1.2
• Hardware Fault protection input
• Simultaneous update of duty cycle and period:
- Flexible Special Event Trigger output
- RS-232 operation using internal oscillator
block (no external crystal required)
- Auto-wake-up on Start bit
- Auto-Baud Detect
Flexible Oscillator Structure:
• 10-bit, up to 4-channel Analog-to-Digital Converter
module (A/D):
• Four Crystal modes, up to 40 MHz
• 4x Phase Lock Loop (PLL) – available for crystal
and internal oscillators
- Auto-acquisition capability
- Conversion available during Sleep
• Up to 3 analog comparators
• Two External RC modes, up to 4 MHz
• Two External Clock modes, up to 40 MHz
• Internal oscillator block:
• Programmable reference voltage for comparators
• Programmable 15-level Low-Voltage Detection
(LVD) module:
- 8 user-selectable frequencies from 31 kHz
to 8 MHz
- Supports interrupt on Low-Voltage Detection
- Provides a complete range of clock speeds from
31 kHz to 32 MHz when used with PLL
Special Microcontroller Features:
• C compiler optimized architecture with optional
extended instruction set
• Flash memory retention: > 40 years
• Self-programmable under software control
• Priority levels for interrupts
- User-tunable to compensate for frequency drift
• Secondary oscillator using Timer1 @ 32 kHz
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor:
- Allows for safe shutdown if peripheral clock stops
• 8 x 8 Single-Cycle Hardware Multiplier
• Extended Watchdog Timer (WDT):
- Programmable period from 4 ms to 131s
• Programmable Code Protection
• Single-Supply In-Circuit Serial Programming™
(ICSP™) via two pins
Power-Managed Modes:
• Run: CPU on, peripherals on
• Idle: CPU off, peripherals on
• Sleep: CPU off, peripherals off
• Idle mode currents down to 5.8 μA, typical
• Sleep mode current down to 0.1 μA, typical
• Timer1 Oscillator: 1.8 μA, typical; 32 kHz; 2V
• Watchdog Timer (WDT): 2.1 μA, typical
• Two-Speed Oscillator Start-up
• In-Circuit Debug (ICD) via two pins
• Wide operating voltage range (2.0V to 5.5V)
Program Memory
Data Memory
10-Bit
Analog
Comparator PWM (ch)
14-Bit
Timers
16-Bit
Device
I/O
ADC
EUSART
Flash # Single-Word SRAM EEPROM
(bytes) Instructions (bytes) (bytes)
Channel
PIC18F1230
PIC18F1330
4096
8192
2048
4096
256
256
128
128
13
13
4
4
Yes
Yes
3
3
6
6
2
2
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 1
PIC18F1230/1330
Pin Diagrams
18-Pin PDIP, SOIC
(1)
RA0/AN0/INT0/KBI0/CMP0
RA1/AN1/INT1/KBI1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
RB3/INT3/KBI3/CMP1/T1OSI
(1)
(1)
RB2/INT2/KBI2CMP2/T1OSO /T1CKI
(1)
(2)
RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+
RA7/OSC1/CLKI/T1OSI /FLTA
(2)
(1)
(1)
MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA
RA6/OSC2/CLKO/T1OSO /T1CKI /AN3
VDD/AVDD
VSS/AVSS
RA2/TX/CK
RA3/RX/DT
RB0/PWM0
RB1/PWM1
RB7/PWM5/PGD
RB6/PWM4/PGC
RB5/PWM3
RB4/PWM2
20-Pin SSOP
(1)
RA0/AN0/INT0/KBI0/CMP0
RA1/AN1/INT1/KBI1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
20
RB3/INT3/KBI3/CMP1/T1OSI
(1)
(1)
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
RB2/INT2/KBI2CMP2/T1OSO /T1CKI
(1)
(2)
RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+
RA7/OSC1/CLKI/T1OSI /FLTA
(2)
(1)
(1)
MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA
RA6/OSC2/CLKO/T1OSO /T1CKI /AN3
VSS
AVSS
VDD
AVDD
RB7/PWM5/PGD
RB6/PWM4/PGC
RB5/PWM3
RA2/TX/CK
RA3/RX/DT
RB0/PWM0
RB1/PWM1
RB4/PWM2
10
Note 1: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of
CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
DS39758B-page 2
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Pin Diagrams (Continued)
28-Pin QFN(3)
28 27 26 25 24 23 22
(2)
(1)
(2)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA
RA7/OSC1/CLKI/T1OSI /FLTA
(1)
(1)
NC
VSS
NC
AVSS
NC
RA6/OSC2/CLKO/T1OSO /T1CKI /AN3
VDD
PIC18F1X30
NC
AVDD
RB7/PWM5/PGD
RB6/PWM4/PGC
RA2/TX/CK
8
9 10 11 12 13 14
Note 1: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of
CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
3: It is recommended that the user connect the center metal pad for this device package to the ground.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 3
PIC18F1230/1330
Table of Contents
1.0 Device Overview .......................................................................................................................................................................... 7
2.0 Oscillator Configurations ............................................................................................................................................................ 15
3.0 Power-Managed Modes ............................................................................................................................................................. 25
4.0 Reset.......................................................................................................................................................................................... 33
5.0 Memory Organization................................................................................................................................................................. 45
6.0 Flash Program Memory.............................................................................................................................................................. 65
7.0 Data EEPROM Memory ............................................................................................................................................................. 75
8.0 8 x 8 Hardware Multiplier............................................................................................................................................................ 79
9.0 I/O Ports ..................................................................................................................................................................................... 81
10.0 Interrupts .................................................................................................................................................................................... 87
11.0 Timer0 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 101
12.0 Timer1 Module ......................................................................................................................................................................... 105
13.0 Power Control PWM Module .................................................................................................................................................... 111
14.0 Enhanced Universal Synchronous Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (EUSART)............................................................... 141
15.0 10-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) Module...................................................................................................................... 163
16.0 Comparator Module.................................................................................................................................................................. 173
17.0 Comparator Voltage Reference Module................................................................................................................................... 177
18.0 Low-Voltage Detect (LVD)........................................................................................................................................................ 179
19.0 Special Features of the CPU.................................................................................................................................................... 183
20.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 203
21.0 Instruction Set Summary.......................................................................................................................................................... 207
22.0 Electrical Characteristics.......................................................................................................................................................... 257
23.0 DC and AC Characteristics Graphs and Tables....................................................................................................................... 287
24.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 289
Appendix A: Revision History............................................................................................................................................................. 295
Appendix B: Device Differences......................................................................................................................................................... 295
Appendix C: Conversion Considerations ........................................................................................................................................... 296
Appendix D: Migration from Baseline to Enhanced Devices.............................................................................................................. 296
Appendix E: Migration from Mid-Range TO Enhanced Devices ........................................................................................................ 297
Appendix F: Migration from High-End to Enhanced Devices............................................................................................................. 297
Index ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 299
The Microchip Web Site..................................................................................................................................................................... 307
Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 307
Customer Support.............................................................................................................................................................................. 307
Reader Response .............................................................................................................................................................................. 308
PIC18F1230/1330 Product Identification System .............................................................................................................................. 309
DS39758B-page 4
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS
It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip
products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and
enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced.
If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via
E-mail at docerrors@microchip.com or fax the Reader Response Form in the back of this data sheet to (480) 792-4150. We
welcome your feedback.
Most Current Data Sheet
To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Web site at:
http://www.microchip.com
You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page.
The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000A is version A of document DS30000).
Errata
An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current
devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision
of silicon and revision of document to which it applies.
To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following:
•
•
Microchip’s Worldwide Web site; http://www.microchip.com
Your local Microchip sales office (see last page)
When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are
using.
Customer Notification System
Register on our web site at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 5
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 6
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
1.1.2
MULTIPLE OSCILLATOR OPTIONS
AND FEATURES
1.0
DEVICE OVERVIEW
This document contains device-specific information for
the following devices:
All of the devices in the PIC18F1230/1330 family offer
ten different oscillator options, allowing users a wide
range of choices in developing application hardware.
These include:
• PIC18F1230
• PIC18F1330
This family offers the advantages of all PIC18 micro-
controllers – namely, high computational performance at
an economical price – with the addition of high-
endurance Enhanced Flash program memory. On top of
these features, the PIC18F1230/1330 family introduces
design enhancements that make these microcontrollers
a logical choice for many high-performance, power
control and motor control applications.
• Four Crystal modes, using crystals or ceramic
resonators.
• Two External Clock modes, offering the option of
using two pins (oscillator input and a divide-by-4
clock output) or one pin (oscillator input, with the
second pin reassigned as general I/O).
• Two External RC Oscillator modes with the same
pin options as the External Clock modes.
Peripheral highlights include:
• An internal oscillator block which provides an 8 MHz
clock and an INTRC source (approximately 31 kHz),
as well as a range of six user-selectable clock
frequencies, between 125 kHz to 4 MHz, for a total of
eight clock frequencies. This option frees the two
oscillator pins for use as additional general
purpose I/Os.
• 14-bit resolution Power Control PWM module
(PCPWM) with programmable dead-time insertion
The PCPWM can generate up to six complementary
PWM outputs with dead-band time insertion. Overdrive
current is detected by off-chip analog comparators or
the digital Fault input (FLTA).
PIC18F1230/1330 devices also feature Flash program
memory and an internal RC oscillator.
• A Phase Lock Loop (PLL) frequency multiplier,
available to both the High-Speed Crystal and Internal
Oscillator modes, which allows clock speeds of up to
40 MHz. Used with the internal oscillator, the PLL
gives users a complete selection of clock speeds,
from 31 kHz to 32 MHz, all without using an external
crystal or clock circuit.
1.1
New Core Features
1.1.1
nanoWatt TECHNOLOGY
All of the devices in the PIC18F1230/1330 family incor-
porate a range of features that can significantly reduce
power consumption during operation. Key items
include:
Besides its availability as a clock source, the internal
oscillator block provides a stable reference source that
gives the family additional features for robust
operation:
• Alternate Run Modes: By clocking the controller
from the Timer1 source or the internal oscillator
block, power consumption during code execution
can be reduced by as much as 90%.
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor: This option constantly
monitors the main clock source against a reference
signal provided by the internal oscillator. If a clock
failure occurs, the controller is switched to the
internal oscillator block, allowing for continued
low-speed operation or a safe application
shutdown.
• Multiple Idle Modes: The controller can also run
with its CPU core disabled but the peripherals still
active. In these states, power consumption can be
reduced even further, to as little as 4% of normal
operation requirements.
• Two-Speed Start-up: This option allows the
internal oscillator to serve as the clock source
from Power-on Reset, or wake-up from Sleep
mode, until the primary clock source is available.
• On-the-Fly Mode Switching: The power-managed
modes are invoked by user code during operation,
allowing the user to incorporate power-saving ideas
into their application’s software design.
• Low Consumption in Key Modules: The power
requirements for both Timer1 and the Watchdog
Timer are minimized. See Section 22.0 “Electrical
Characteristics” for values.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 7
PIC18F1230/1330
1.2
Other Special Features
1.3
Details on Individual Family
Members
• Memory Endurance: The Enhanced Flash cells for
both program memory and data EEPROM are rated
to last for many thousands of erase/write cycles –
up to 100,000 for program memory and 1,000,000
for EEPROM. Data retention without refresh is
conservatively estimated to be greater than
40 years.
Devices in the PIC18F1230/1330 family are available
in 18-pin, 20-pin and 28-pin packages.
The devices are differentiated from each other in one
way:
1. Flash program memory (4 Kbytes for
PIC18F1230, 8 Kbytes for PIC18F1330).
• Self-Programmability: These devices can write to
their own program memory spaces under internal
software control. By using a bootloader routine
located in the protected Boot Block at the top of
program memory, it becomes possible to create an
application that can update itself in the field.
All other features for devices in this family are identical.
These are summarized in Table 1-1.
A block diagram of the PIC18F1220/1320 device archi-
tecture is provided in Figure 1-1. The pinouts for this
device family are listed in Table 1-2.
• Extended Instruction Set: The PIC18F1230/1330
family introduces an optional extension to the PIC18
instruction set, which adds eight new instructions
and an Indexed Addressing mode. This extension,
enabled as a device configuration option, has been
specifically designed to optimize re-entrant
application code originally developed in high-level
languages, such as C.
Like all Microchip PIC18 devices, members of the
PIC18F1230/1330 family are available as both stan-
dard and low-voltage devices. Standard devices with
Enhanced Flash memory, designated with an “F” in the
part number (such as PIC18F1330), accommodate an
operating VDD range of 4.2V to 5.5V. Low-voltage
parts, designated by “LF” (such as PIC18LF1330),
function over an extended VDD range of 2.0V to 5.5V.
• Power Control PWM Module: This module
provides up to six modulated outputs for controlling
half-bridge and full-bridge drivers. Other features
include auto-shutdown on Fault detection and
auto-restart to reactivate outputs once the condition
has cleared.
• Enhanced Addressable USART: This serial
communication module is capable of standard
RS-232 operation and provides support for the LIN
bus protocol. Other enhancements include
automatic baud rate detection and a 16-bit Baud
Rate Generator for improved resolution. When the
microcontroller is using the internal oscillator block,
the EUSART provides stable operation for applica-
tions that talk to the outside world without using an
external crystal (or its accompanying power
requirement).
• 10-Bit A/D Converter: This module incorporates
programmable acquisition time, allowing for a
channel to be selected and a conversion to be
initiated without waiting for a sampling period and
thus, reducing code overhead.
• Extended Watchdog Timer (WDT): This enhanced
version incorporates a 16-bit prescaler, allowing an
extended time-out range that is stable across
operating voltage and temperature. See
Section 22.0 “Electrical Characteristics” for
time-out periods.
DS39758B-page 8
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 1-1:
DEVICE FEATURES
Features
PIC18F1230
PIC18F1330
Operating Frequency
Program Memory (Bytes)
Program Memory (Instructions)
Data Memory (Bytes)
Data EEPROM Memory (Bytes)
Interrupt Sources
DC – 40 MHz
DC – 40 MHz
4096
8192
2048
4096
256
128
256
128
17
17
I/O Ports
Ports A, B
2
Ports A, B
2
Timers
Power Control PWM Module
Serial Communications
10-Bit Analog-to-Digital Module
Resets (and Delays)
6 Channels
Enhanced USART
4 Input Channels
6 Channels
Enhanced USART
4 Input Channels
POR, BOR,
RESETInstruction,
Stack Full,
POR, BOR,
RESETInstruction,
Stack Full,
Stack Underflow (PWRT, OST),
MCLR (optional),
WDT
Stack Underflow (PWRT, OST),
MCLR (optional),
WDT
Programmable Low-Voltage Detect
Programmable Brown-out Reset
Instruction Set
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
75 Instructions;
83 with Extended Instruction Set
enabled
75 Instructions;
83 with Extended Instruction Set
enabled
Packages
18-pin PDIP
18-pin SOIC
20-pin SSOP
28-pin QFN
18-pin PDIP
18-pin SOIC
20-pin SSOP
28-pin QFN
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 9
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 1-1:
PIC18F1230/1330 (18-PIN) BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus<8>
PORTA
Data Latch
Table Pointer <2>
inc/dec logic
21
8
8
8
8
RA0/AN0/INT0/KBI0/CMP0
RA1/AN1/INT1/KBI1
RA2/TX/CK
Data RAM
21
21
Address Latch
20
PCLATU PCLATH
Address Latch
12
Address<12>
RA3/RX/DT
Program Memory
(4 Kbytes)
PIC18F1230
PCU PCH PCL
Program Counter
12
FSR0
4
4
BSR
RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+
MCLR/VPP/RA5(1)/FLTA(4)
Bank0, F
(8 Kbytes)
PIC18F1330
FSR1
FSR2
31 Level Stack
12
RA6/OSC2(2)/CLKO(2)
/
Data Latch
16
T1OSO(3)
/T1CKI(3)/AN3
RA7/OSC1(2)/CLKI(2)
/
inc/dec
logic
Decode
T1OSI(3)/FLTA(4)
Table Latch
8
ROM Latch
PORTB
RB0/PWM0
RB1/PWM1
Instruction
Register
RB2/INT2/KBI2/CMP2/
T1OSO(3)/T1CKI(3)
8
Instruction
Decode &
Control
RB3/INT3/KBI3/CMP1/
T1OSI(3)
PRODH PRODL
8 x 8 Multiply
3
RB4/PWM2
8
RB5/PWM3
WREG
8
BIT OP
8
OSC1(2)
OSC2(2)
T1OSI
Power-up
Timer
8
RB6/PWM4/PGC
RB7/PWM5/PGD
Timing
Generation
Oscillator
Start-up Timer
8
INTRC
Oscillator
ALU<8>
Power-on
Reset
T1OSO
8
Watchdog
Timer
Precision
Voltage
Reference
Brown-out
Reset
Low-Voltage
Programming
MCLR(1)
Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor
In-Circuit
Debugger
VDD, VSS
BOR
LVD
PCPWM
Timer0
Timer1
10-Bit
A/D Converter
Enhanced
USART
Data EEPROM
Note 1: RA5 is available only when the MCLR Reset is disabled.
2: OSC1, OSC2, CLKI and CLKO are only available in select oscillator modes and when these pins are not being
used as digital I/O. Refer to Section 2.0 “Oscillator Configurations” for additional information.
3: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of the Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of CONFIG3H.
4: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of the Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
DS39758B-page 10
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 1-2:
Pin Name
PIC18F1230/1330 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS
Pin Number
Pin Buffer
PDIP,
Description
Type Type
SSOP QFN
SOIC
MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA
MCLR
4
4
1
Master Clear (input), programming voltage (input)
or Fault detect input.
I
ST
Master Clear (Reset) input. This pin is an
active-low Reset to the device.
Programming voltage input.
Digital input.
VPP
I
I
I
Analog
ST
ST
RA5
FLTA(1)
Fault detect input for PWM.
RA7/OSC1/CLKI/
T1OSI/FLTA
RA7
16
15
18
21
Oscillator crystal, external clock input, Timer1
oscillator input or Fault detect input.
Digital I/O.
I/O
I
ST
Analog
OSC1
Oscillator crystal input or external clock source
input.
External clock source input.
Timer1 oscillator input.
CLKI
I
I
I
Analog
Analog
ST
T1OSI(2)
FLTA(1)
Fault detect input for PWM.
RA6/OSC2/CLKO/
T1OSO/T1CKI/AN3
RA6
17
20
Oscillator crystal, clock output, Timer1 oscillator
output or analog input.
Digital I/O.
I/O
O
ST
Analog
OSC2
Oscillator crystal output or external clock
source input.
CLKO
O
O
I
Analog
Analog
ST
External clock source output.
Timer1 oscillator output.
Timer1 clock input.
T1OSO(2)
TICKI(2)
AN3
I
Analog
Analog input 3.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
= Output
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
I
= Input
O
P
= Power
Note 1: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of
CONFIG3H.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 11
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 1-2:
Pin Name
PIC18F1230/1330 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Buffer
Type Type
Description
PDIP,
SSOP QFN
SOIC
PORTA is a bidirectional I/O port.
RA0/AN0/INT0/KBI0/
CMP0
RA0
1
1
2
26
27
I/O
TTL
Analog
ST
TTL
Analog
Digital I/O.
Analog input 0.
External interrupt 0.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
Comparator 0 input.
AN0
I
I
I
I
INT0
KBI0
CMP0
RA1/AN1/INT1/KBI1
2
RA1
AN1
INT1
KBI1
I/O
TTL
Analog
ST
Digital I/O.
Analog input 1.
External interrupt 1.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
I
I
I
TTL
RA2/TX/CK
RA2
6
7
3
7
8
3
7
8
I/O
O
I/O
TTL
—
ST
Digital I/O.
EUSART asynchronous transmit.
EUSART synchronous clock.
TX
CK
RA3/RX/DT
RA3
I/O
I
I/O
TTL
ST
ST
Digital I/O.
EUSART asynchronous receive.
EUSART synchronous data.
RX
DT
RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+
28
RA4
T0CKI
AN2
I/O
TTL
ST
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
Timer0 external clock input.
Analog input 2.
I
I
I
VREF+
A/D reference voltage (high) input.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
= Output
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
I
= Input
O
P
= Power
Note 1: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of
CONFIG3H.
DS39758B-page 12
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 1-2:
Pin Name
PIC18F1230/1330 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Buffer
Type Type
Description
PDIP,
SSOP QFN
SOIC
PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port.
RB0/PWM0
RB0
8
9
9
I/O
O
TTL
—
Digital I/O.
PWM module output PWM0.
PWM0
RB1/PWM1
RB1
9
10
19
10
23
I/O
O
TTL
—
Digital I/O.
PWM module output PWM1.
PWM1
RB2/INT2/KBI2/CMP2/
T1OSO/T1CKI
RB2
17
I/O
I
I
I
O
I
TTL
ST
TTL
Analog
Analog
ST
Digital I/O.
INT2
KBI2
External interrupt 2.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
Comparator 2 input.
Timer1 oscillator output.
Timer1 clock input.
CMP2
T1OSO(2)
T1CKI(2)
RB3/INT3/KBI3/CMP1/
18
20
24
T1OSI
RB3
I/O
TTL
ST
TTL
Analog
Analog
Digital I/O.
INT3
KBI3
I
I
I
I
External interrupt 3.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
Comparator 1 input.
Timer1 oscillator input.
CMP1
T1OSI(2)
RB4/PWM2
RB4
10
11
12
11
12
13
12
13
15
I/O
O
TTL
—
Digital I/O.
PWM module output PWM2.
PWM2
RB5/PWM3
RB5
I/O
O
TTL
—
Digital I/O.
PWM module output PWM3.
PWM3
RB6/PWM4/PGC
RB6
I/O
O
I
TTL
—
ST
Digital I/O.
PWM4
PGC
PWM module output PWM4.
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP™ programming
clock pin.
RB7/PWM5/PGD
RB7
13
14
16
I/O
O
O
TTL
—
—
Digital I/O.
PWM5
PGD
PWM module output PWM5.
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP programming
data pin.
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
= Output
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
I
= Input
O
P
= Power
Note 1: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of
CONFIG3H.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 13
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 1-2:
PIC18F1230/1330 PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)
Pin Number
Pin Buffer
Type Type
Pin Name
Description
PDIP,
SOIC
5
SSOP QFN
VSS
5
3
19
5
P
P
—
—
—
—
—
Ground reference for logic and I/O pins.
Positive supply for logic and I/O pins.
Ground reference for A/D converter module.
Positive supply for A/D converter module.
No Connect.
VDD
AVSS
AVDD
NC
14
5
16
6
P
14
—
15
—
17
P
2, 4, 6,
11, 14,
18, 22,
25
—
Legend: TTL = TTL compatible input
ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels
= Output
CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output
I
= Input
O
P
= Power
Note 1: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of
CONFIG3H.
DS39758B-page 14
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 2-1:
CRYSTAL/CERAMIC
RESONATOROPERATION
(XT, LP, HS OR HSPLL
CONFIGURATION)
2.0
2.1
OSCILLATOR
CONFIGURATIONS
Oscillator Types
(1)
C1
C2
OSC1
PIC18F1230/1330 devices can be operated in ten
different oscillator modes. The user can program the
Configuration bits, FOSC3:FOSC0, in Configuration
Register 1H to select one of these ten modes:
To
Internal
Logic
(3)
RF
XTAL
1. LP
2. XT
3. HS
Low-Power Crystal
Sleep
(2)
RS
Crystal/Resonator
(1)
PIC18FXXXX
OSC2
High-Speed Crystal/Resonator
4. HSPLL High-Speed Crystal/Resonator
with PLL enabled
Note 1: See Table 2-1 and Table 2-2 for initial values of
C1 and C2.
5. RC
External Resistor/Capacitor with
FOSC/4 output on RA6
2: A series resistor (RS) may be required for AT
strip cut crystals.
6. RCIO
External Resistor/Capacitor with I/O
on RA6
3: RF varies with the oscillator mode chosen.
7. INTIO1 Internal Oscillator with FOSC/4 output
on RA6 and I/O on RA7
TABLE 2-1:
CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
CERAMIC RESONATORS
8. INTIO2 Internal Oscillator with I/O on RA6
and RA7
Typical Capacitor Values Used:
9. EC
External Clock with FOSC/4 output
External Clock with I/O on RA6
Mode
Freq
OSC1
OSC2
10. ECIO
XT
3.58 MHz
4.19 MHz
4 MHz
15 pF
15 pF
30 pF
50 pF
15 pF
15 pF
30 pF
50 pF
2.2
Crystal Oscillator/Ceramic
Resonators
4 MHz
In XT, LP, HS or HSPLL Oscillator modes, a crystal or
ceramic resonator is connected to the OSC1 and
OSC2 pins to establish oscillation. Figure 2-1 shows
the pin connections.
Capacitor values are for design guidance only.
Different capacitor values may be required to produce
acceptable oscillator operation. The user should test
the performance of the oscillator over the expected
VDD and temperature range for the application.
The oscillator design requires the use of a parallel cut
crystal.
See the notes following Table 2-2 for additional
information.
Note:
Use of a series cut crystal may give a fre-
quency out of the crystal manufacturer’s
specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 15
PIC18F1230/1330
An external clock source may also be connected to the
OSC1 pin in the HS mode, as shown in Figure 2-2.
TABLE 2-2:
CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR
Typical Capacitor Values
FIGURE 2-2:
EXTERNAL CLOCK
INPUT OPERATION
(HS OSCILLATOR
CONFIGURATION)
Crystal
Freq
Tested:
Osc Type
C1
C2
LP
XT
32 kHz
30 pF
30 pF
1 MHz
4 MHz
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
OSC1
Clock from
Ext. System
HS
4 MHz
10 MHz
20 MHz
25 MHz
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
15 pF
PIC18FXXXX
(HS Mode)
OSC2
Open
Capacitor values are for design guidance only.
2.3
External Clock Input
Different capacitor values may be required to produce
acceptable oscillator operation. The user should test
the performance of the oscillator over the expected
VDD and temperature range for the application.
The EC and ECIO Oscillator modes require an external
clock source to be connected to the OSC1 pin. There is
no oscillator start-up time required after a Power-on
Reset or after an exit from Sleep mode.
See the notes following this table for additional
information.
In the EC Oscillator mode, the oscillator frequency
divided by 4 is available on the OSC2 pin. This signal
may be used for test purposes or to synchronize other
logic. Figure 2-3 shows the pin connections for the EC
Oscillator mode.
Note 1: Higher capacitance increases the stability
of the oscillator but also increases the
start-up time.
FIGURE 2-3:
EXTERNAL CLOCK
INPUT OPERATION
(EC CONFIGURATION)
2: When operating below 3V VDD, or when
using certain ceramic resonators at any
voltage, it may be necessary to use the
HS mode or switch to a crystal oscillator.
OSC1/CLKI
3: Since each resonator/crystal has its own
characteristics, the user should consult
the resonator/crystal manufacturer for
Clock from
Ext. System
PIC18FXXXX
OSC2/CLKO
FOSC/4
appropriate
values
of
external
components.
The ECIO Oscillator mode functions like the EC mode,
except that the OSC2 pin becomes an additional
general purpose I/O pin. The I/O pin becomes bit 6 of
PORTA (RA6). Figure 2-4 shows the pin connections
for the ECIO Oscillator mode.
4: Rs may be required to avoid overdriving
crystals with low drive level specification.
5: Always verify oscillator performance over
the VDD and temperature range that is
expected for the application.
FIGURE 2-4:
EXTERNAL CLOCK
INPUT OPERATION
(ECIO CONFIGURATION)
OSC1/CLKI
PIC18FXXXX
I/O (OSC2)
Clock from
Ext. System
RA6
DS39758B-page 16
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
2.4
RC Oscillator
2.5
PLL Frequency Multiplier
For timing insensitive applications, the “RC” and
“RCIO” device options offer additional cost savings.
The actual oscillator frequency is a function of several
factors:
A Phase Locked Loop (PLL) circuit is provided as an
option for users who wish to use a lower frequency
oscillator circuit or to clock the device up to its highest
rated frequency from a crystal oscillator. This may be
useful for customers who are concerned with EMI due
to high-frequency crystals or users who require higher
clock speeds from an internal oscillator.
• supply voltage
• values of the external resistor (REXT) and
capacitor (CEXT)
• operating temperature
2.5.1
HSPLL OSCILLATOR MODE
Given the same device, operating voltage and
temperature and component values, there will also be
unit-to-unit frequency variations. These are due to
factors such as:
The HSPLL mode makes use of the HS mode oscillator
for frequencies up to 10 MHz. A PLL then multiplies the
oscillator output frequency by 4 to produce an internal
clock frequency up to 40 MHz. The PLLEN bit is not
available in this oscillator mode.
• normal manufacturing variation
• difference in lead frame capacitance between
package types (especially for low CEXT values)
The PLL is only available to the crystal oscillator when
the FOSC3:FOSC0 Configuration bits are programmed
for HSPLL mode (= 0110).
• variations within the tolerance of limits of REXT
and CEXT
FIGURE 2-7:
PLL BLOCK DIAGRAM
(HS MODE)
In the RC Oscillator mode, the oscillator frequency
divided by 4 is available on the OSC2 pin. This signal
may be used for test purposes or to synchronize other
logic. Figure 2-5 shows how the R/C combination is
connected.
HS Oscillator Enable
PLL Enable
(from Configuration Register 1H)
FIGURE 2-5:
RC OSCILLATOR MODE
OSC2
OSC1
Phase
Comparator
VDD
HS Mode
Crystal
Osc
FIN
FOUT
REXT
Internal
OSC1
Clock
Loop
Filter
CEXT
VSS
PIC18FXXXX
OSC2/CLKO
÷4
VCO
FOSC/4
SYSCLK
Recommended values: 3 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ
CEXT > 20 pF
The RCIO Oscillator mode (Figure 2-6) functions like
the RC mode, except that the OSC2 pin becomes an
additional general purpose I/O pin. The I/O pin
becomes bit 6 of PORTA (RA6).
2.5.2
PLL AND INTOSC
The PLL is also available to the internal oscillator block
in selected oscillator modes. In this configuration, the
PLL is enabled in software and generates a clock
output of up to 32 MHz. The operation of INTOSC with
the PLL is described in Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC
Modes”.
FIGURE 2-6:
RCIO OSCILLATOR MODE
VDD
REXT
Internal
OSC1
Clock
CEXT
PIC18FXXXX
VSS
I/O (OSC2)
RA6
Recommended values: 3 kΩ ≤ REXT ≤ 100 kΩ
CEXT > 20 pF
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 17
PIC18F1230/1330
When the OSCTUNE register is modified, the INTOSC
frequency will begin shifting to the new frequency. The
INTRC clock will reach the new frequency within
8 clock cycles (approximately 8 * 32 μs = 256 μs). The
INTOSC clock will stabilize within 1 ms. Code
execution continues during this shift. There is no
indication that the shift has occurred.
2.6
Internal Oscillator Block
The PIC18F1230/1330 devices include an internal
oscillator block which generates two different clock
signals; either can be used as the microcontroller’s clock
source. This may eliminate the need for external
oscillator circuits on the OSC1 and/or OSC2 pins.
The main output (INTOSC) is an 8 MHz clock source,
which can be used to directly drive the device clock. It
also drives a postscaler, which can provide a range of
clock frequencies from 31 kHz to 4 MHz. The INTOSC
output is enabled when a clock frequency from 125 kHz
to 8 MHz is selected.
The OSCTUNE register also implements the INTSRC
and PLLEN bits, which control certain features of the
internal oscillator block. The INTSRC bit allows users
to select which internal oscillator provides the clock
source when the 31 kHz frequency option is selected.
This is covered in greater detail in Section 2.7.1
“Oscillator Control Register”.
The other clock source is the internal RC oscillator
(INTRC), which provides a nominal 31 kHz output.
INTRC is enabled if it is selected as the device clock
source; it is also enabled automatically when any of the
following are enabled:
The PLLEN bit controls the operation of the frequency
multiplier, PLL, in Internal Oscillator modes.
2.6.4
PLL IN INTOSC MODES
• Power-up Timer
The 4x frequency multiplier can be used with the
internal oscillator block to produce faster device clock
speeds than are normally possible with an internal
oscillator. When enabled, the PLL produces a clock
speed of up to 32 MHz.
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
• Watchdog Timer
• Two-Speed Start-up
These features are discussed in greater detail in
Section 19.0 “Special Features of the CPU”.
Unlike HSPLL mode, the PLL is controlled through
software. The control bit, PLLEN (OSCTUNE<6>), is
used to enable or disable its operation.
The clock source frequency (INTOSC direct, INTRC
direct or INTOSC postscaler) is selected by configuring
the IRCF bits of the OSCCON register (page 22).
The PLL is available when the device is configured to
use the internal oscillator block as its primary clock
source (FOSC3:FOSC0 = 1001or 1000). Additionally,
the PLL will only function when the selected output fre-
quency is either 4 MHz or 8 MHz (OSCCON<6:4> = 111
or 110). If both of these conditions are not met, the PLL
is disabled.
2.6.1
INTIO MODES
Using the internal oscillator as the clock source
eliminates the need for up to two external oscillator
pins, which can then be used for digital I/O. Two distinct
configurations are available:
The PLLEN control bit is only functional in those
Internal Oscillator modes where the PLL is available. In
all other modes, it is forced to ‘0’ and is effectively
unavailable.
• In INTIO1 mode, the OSC2 pin outputs FOSC/4,
while OSC1 functions as RA7 for digital input and
output.
• In INTIO2 mode, OSC1 functions as RA7 and
OSC2 functions as RA6, both for digital input and
output.
2.6.5
INTOSC FREQUENCY DRIFT
The factory calibrates the internal oscillator block
output (INTOSC) for 8 MHz. However, this frequency
may drift as VDD or temperature changes, which can
affect the controller operation in a variety of ways. It is
possible to adjust the INTOSC frequency by modifying
the value in the OSCTUNE register. This has no effect
on the INTRC clock source frequency.
2.6.2
INTOSC OUTPUT FREQUENCY
The internal oscillator block is calibrated at the factory
to produce an INTOSC output frequency of 8.0 MHz.
The INTRC oscillator operates independently of the
INTOSC source. Any changes in INTOSC across
voltage and temperature are not necessarily reflected
by changes in INTRC and vice versa.
Tuning the INTOSC source requires knowing when to
make the adjustment, in which direction it should be
made and in some cases, how large a change is
needed. Two compensation techniques are discussed
in Section 2.6.5.1 “Compensating with the
EUSART” and Section 2.6.5.2 “Compensating with
the Timers”, but other techniques may be used.
2.6.3
OSCTUNE REGISTER
The internal oscillator’s output has been calibrated at
the factory but can be adjusted in the user’s
application. This is done by writing to the OSCTUNE
register (Register 2-1). The tuning sensitivity is
constant throughout the tuning range.
DS39758B-page 18
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 2-1:
OSCTUNE: OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER
R/W-0
INTSRC
bit 7
R/W-0(1)
PLLEN(1)
U-0
—
R/W-0
TUN4
R/W-0
TUN3
R/W-0
TUN2
R/W-0
TUN1
R/W-0
TUN0
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
INTSRC: Internal Oscillator Low-Frequency Source Select bit
1= 31.25 kHz device clock derived from 8 MHz INTOSC source (divide-by-256 enabled)
0= 31 kHz device clock derived directly from INTRC internal oscillator
PLLEN: Frequency Multiplier PLL for INTOSC Enable bit(1)
1= PLL enabled for INTOSC (4 MHz and 8 MHz only)
0= PLL disabled
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
TUN4:TUN0: Frequency Tuning bits
01111= Maximum frequency
bit 4-0
•
•
•
•
00001
00000= Center frequency. Oscillator module is running at the calibrated frequency.
11111
•
•
•
•
10000= Minimum frequency
Note 1: Available only in certain oscillator configurations; otherwise, this bit is unavailable and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC Modes” for details.
2.6.5.1
Compensating with the EUSART
2.6.5.2
Compensating with the Timers
An adjustment may be required when the EUSART
begins to generate framing errors or receives data with
errors while in Asynchronous mode. Framing errors
indicate that the device clock frequency is too high; to
adjust for this, decrement the value in OSCTUNE to
reduce the clock frequency. On the other hand, errors
in data may suggest that the clock speed is too low; to
compensate, increment OSCTUNE to increase the
clock frequency.
This technique compares device clock speed to some
reference clock. Two timers may be used; one timer is
clocked by the peripheral clock, while the other is
clocked by a fixed reference source, such as the
Timer1 oscillator.
Both timers are cleared, but the timer clocked by the
reference generates interrupts. When an interrupt
occurs, the internally clocked timer is read and both
timers are cleared. If the internally clocked timer value
is greater than expected, then the internal oscillator
block is running too fast. To adjust for this, decrement
the OSCTUNE register.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 19
PIC18F1230/1330
The secondary oscillators are those external sources
not connected to the OSC1 or OSC2 pins. These
sources may continue to operate even after the
controller is placed in a power-managed mode.
2.7
Clock Sources and Oscillator
Switching
Like previous PIC18 devices, the PIC18F1230/1330
family includes a feature that allows the device clock
source to be switched from the main oscillator to an
alternate low-frequency clock source. PIC18F1230/1330
devices offer two alternate clock sources. When an alter-
nate clock source is enabled, the various power-managed
operating modes are available.
PIC18F1230/1330 devices offer the Timer1 oscillator
as a secondary oscillator. This oscillator, in all power-
managed modes, is often the time base for functions
such as a real-time clock.
Most often, a 32.768 kHz watch crystal is connected
between the T1OSO/T1CKI and T1OSI pins. Like the
LP mode oscillator circuit, loading capacitors are also
connected from each pin to ground. The Timer1 oscil-
lator is discussed in greater detail in Section 12.2
“Timer1 Oscillator”.
Essentially, there are three clock sources for these
devices:
• Primary oscillators
• Secondary oscillators
• Internal oscillator block
In addition to being a primary clock source, the internal
oscillator block is available as a power-managed
mode clock source. The INTRC source is also used as
the clock source for several special features, such as
the WDT and Fail-Safe Clock Monitor.
The primary oscillators include the External Crystal
and Resonator modes, the External RC modes, the
External Clock modes and the internal oscillator block.
The particular mode is defined by the FOSC3:FOSC0
Configuration bits. The details of these modes are
covered earlier in this chapter.
The clock sources for the PIC18F1230/1330 devices
are shown in Figure 2-8. See Section 19.0 “Special
Features of the CPU” for Configuration register details.
FIGURE 2-8:
PIC18F1230/1330 CLOCK DIAGRAM
PIC18F1230/1330
Primary Oscillator
LP, XT, HS, RC, EC
HSPLL, INTOSC/PLL
T1OSC
OSC2
Sleep
4 x PLL
OSC1
OSCTUNE<6>
Peripherals
Secondary Oscillator
T1OSO
T1OSCEN
Enable
Oscillator
T1OSI
OSCCON<6:4>
Internal Oscillator
CPU
8 MHz
OSCCON<6:4>
111
110
101
4 MHz
2 MHz
Internal
Oscillator
Block
8 MHz
Source
IDLEN
Clock
Control
1 MHz
100
011
010
001
500 kHz
250 kHz
125 kHz
8 MHz
(INTOSC)
INTRC
Source
FOSC3:FOSC0 OSCCON<1:0>
Clock Source Option
for other Modules
1
0
31 kHz
000
31 kHz (INTRC)
OSCTUNE<7>
WDT, PWRT, FSCM
and Two-Speed Start-up
DS39758B-page 20
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The IDLEN bit determines if the device goes into Sleep
mode or one of the Idle modes when the SLEEP
instruction is executed.
2.7.1
OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
The OSCCON register (Register 2-2) controls several
aspects of the device clock’s operation, both in full
power operation and in power-managed modes.
The use of the flag and control bits in the OSCCON
register is discussed in more detail in Section 3.0
“Power-Managed Modes”.
The System Clock Select bits, SCS1:SCS0, select the
clock source. The available clock sources are the
primary clock (defined by the FOSC3:FOSC0
Configuration bits), the secondary clock (Timer1
oscillator) and the internal oscillator block. The clock
source changes immediately after one or more of the
bits is written to, following a brief clock transition
interval. The SCS bits are cleared on all forms of Reset.
Note 1: The Timer1 oscillator must be enabled to
select the secondary clock source. The
Timer1 oscillator is enabled by setting the
T1OSCEN bit in the Timer1 Control regis-
ter (T1CON<3>). If the Timer1 oscillator
is not enabled, then any attempt to select
a secondary clock source will be ignored.
The Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits
(IRCF2:IRCF0) select the frequency output of the
internal oscillator block to drive the device clock. The
choices are the INTRC source, the INTOSC source
(8 MHz) or one of the frequencies derived from the
INTOSC postscaler (31.25 kHz to 4 MHz). If the
internal oscillator block is supplying the device clock,
changing the states of these bits will have an immedi-
ate change on the internal oscillator’s output. On
device Resets, the default output frequency of the
internal oscillator block is set at 1 MHz.
2: It is recommended that the Timer1
oscillator be operating and stable before
selecting the secondary clock source or a
very long delay may occur while the
Timer1 oscillator starts.
2.7.2
OSCILLATOR TRANSITIONS
PIC18F1230/1330 devices contain circuitry to prevent
clock “glitches” when switching between clock sources.
A short pause in the device clock occurs during the
clock switch. The length of this pause is the sum of two
cycles of the old clock source and three to four cycles
of the new clock source. This formula assumes that the
new clock source is stable.
When a nominal output frequency of 31 kHz is selected
(IRCF2:IRCF0 = 000), users may choose which
internal oscillator acts as the source. This is done with
the INTSRC bit in the OSCTUNE register
(OSCTUNE<7>). Setting this bit selects INTOSC as a
31.25 kHz clock source by enabling the divide-by-256
output of the INTOSC postscaler. Clearing INTSRC
selects INTRC (nominally 31 kHz) as the clock source.
Clock transitions are discussed in greater detail in
Section 3.1.2 “Entering Power-Managed Modes”.
This option allows users to select the tunable and more
precise INTOSC as a clock source, while maintaining
power savings with a very low clock speed. Regardless
of the setting of INTSRC, INTRC always remains the
clock source for features such as the Watchdog Timer
and the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor.
The OSTS, IOFS and T1RUN bits indicate which clock
source is currently providing the device clock. The
OSTS bit indicates that the Oscillator Start-up Timer
has timed out and the primary clock is providing the
device clock in primary clock modes. The IOFS bit
indicates when the internal oscillator block has
stabilized and is providing the device clock in RC Clock
modes. The T1RUN bit (T1CON<6>) indicates when
the Timer1 oscillator is providing the device clock in
secondary clock modes. In power-managed modes,
only one of these three bits will be set at any time. If
none of these bits are set, the INTRC is providing the
clock or the internal oscillator block has just started and
is not yet stable.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 21
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 2-2:
OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
IDLEN
bit 7
R/W-1
IRCF2
R/W-0
IRCF1
R/W-0
IRCF0
R(1)
R-0
R/W-0
SCS1
R/W-0
SCS0
OSTS
IOFS
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
IDLEN: Idle Enable bit
1= Device enters Idle mode on SLEEPinstruction
0= Device enters Sleep mode on SLEEPinstruction
bit 6-4
IRCF2:IRCF0: Internal Oscillator Frequency Select bits
111= 8 MHz (INTOSC drives clock directly)
110= 4 MHz
101= 2 MHz
100= 1 MHz(3)
011= 500 kHz
010= 250 kHz
001= 125 kHz
000= 31 kHz (from either INTOSC/256 or INTRC directly)(2)
bit 3
OSTS: Oscillator Start-up Time-out Status bit(1)
1= Oscillator Start-up Timer time-out has expired; primary oscillator is running
0= Oscillator Start-up Timer time-out is running; primary oscillator is not ready
bit 2
IOFS: INTOSC Frequency Stable bit
1= INTOSC frequency is stable
0= INTOSC frequency is not stable
bit 1-0
SCS1:SCS0: System Clock Select bits
1x= Internal oscillator block
01= Secondary (Timer1) oscillator
00= Primary oscillator
Note 1: Reset state depends on state of the IESO Configuration bit.
2: Source selected by the INTSRC bit (OSCTUNE<7>), see text.
3: Default output frequency of INTOSC on Reset.
DS39758B-page 22
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
time clock. Other features may be operating that do not
require a device clock source (i.e., INTn pins and
others). Peripherals that may add significant current
consumption are listed in Section 22.0 “Electrical
Characteristics”.
2.8
Effects of Power-Managed Modes
on the Various Clock Sources
When PRI_IDLE mode is selected, the designated
primary oscillator continues to run without interruption.
For all other power-managed modes, the oscillator
using the OSC1 pin is disabled. The OSC1 pin (and
OSC2 pin, if used by the oscillator) will stop oscillating.
2.9
Power-up Delays
Power-up delays are controlled by two timers, so that no
external Reset circuitry is required for most applications.
The delays ensure that the device is kept in Reset until
the device power supply is stable under normal
circumstances and the primary clock is operating and
stable. For additional information on power-up delays,
see Section 4.5 “Device Reset Timers”.
In Secondary Clock modes (SEC_RUN and
SEC_IDLE), the Timer1 oscillator is operating and
providing the device clock. The Timer1 oscillator may
also run in all power-managed modes if required to
clock Timer1 or Timer3.
In Internal Oscillator modes (RC_RUN and RC_IDLE),
the internal oscillator block provides the device clock
source. The 31 kHz INTRC output can be used directly
to provide the clock and may be enabled to support
various special features, regardless of the power-
managed mode (see Section 19.2 “Watchdog Timer
(WDT)”, Section 19.3 “Two-Speed Start-up” and
Section 19.4 “Fail-Safe Clock Monitor” for more
information on WDT, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor and Two-
Speed Start-up). The INTOSC output at 8 MHz may be
used directly to clock the device or may be divided
down by the postscaler. The INTOSC output is disabled
if the clock is provided directly from the INTRC output.
The first timer is the Power-up Timer (PWRT), which
provides a fixed delay on power-up (parameter 33,
Table 22-10). It is enabled by clearing (= 0) the
PWRTEN Configuration bit.
The second timer is the Oscillator Start-up Timer
(OST), intended to keep the chip in Reset until the
crystal oscillator is stable (LP, XT and HS modes). The
OST does this by counting 1024 oscillator cycles
before allowing the oscillator to clock the device.
When the HSPLL Oscillator mode is selected, the
device is kept in Reset for an additional 2 ms, following
the HS mode OST delay, so the PLL can lock to the
incoming clock frequency.
If the Sleep mode is selected, all clock sources are
stopped. Since all the transistor switching currents
have been stopped, Sleep mode achieves the lowest
current consumption of the device (only leakage
currents).
There is a delay of interval TCSD (parameter 38,
Table 22-10), following POR, while the controller
becomes ready to execute instructions. This delay runs
concurrently with any other delays. This may be the
only delay that occurs when any of the EC, RC or INTIO
modes are used as the primary clock source.
Enabling any on-chip feature that will operate during
Sleep will increase the current consumed during Sleep.
The INTRC is required to support WDT operation. The
Timer1 oscillator may be operating to support a real-
TABLE 2-3:
OSC1 AND OSC2 PIN STATES IN SLEEP MODE
OSC1 Pin
Oscillator Mode
OSC2 Pin
RC, INTIO1
RCIO
Floating, external resistor should pull high
Floating, external resistor should pull high
Configured as PORTA, bit 7
At logic low (clock/4 output)
Configured as PORTA, bit 6
Configured as PORTA, bit 6
Configured as PORTA, bit 6
At logic low (clock/4 output)
INTIO2
ECIO
Floating, pulled by external clock
Floating, pulled by external clock
EC
LP, XT and HS
Feedback inverter disabled at quiescent
voltage level
Feedback inverter disabled at quiescent
voltage level
Note:
See Table 4-2 in Section 4.0 “Reset” for time-outs due to Sleep and MCLR Reset.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 23
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 24
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
3.1.1
CLOCK SOURCES
3.0
POWER-MANAGED MODES
The SCS1:SCS0 bits allow the selection of one of three
clock sources for power-managed modes. They are:
PIC18F1230/1330 devices offer a total of seven
operating modes for more efficient power
management. These modes provide a variety of
options for selective power conservation in applications
where resources may be limited (i.e., battery-powered
devices).
• the primary clock, as defined by the
FOSC3:FOSC0 Configuration bits
• the secondary clock (the Timer1 oscillator)
• the internal oscillator block (for RC modes)
There are three categories of power-managed modes:
3.1.2
ENTERING POWER-MANAGED
MODES
• Run modes
• Idle modes
• Sleep mode
Switching from one power-managed mode to another
begins by loading the OSCCON register. The
SCS1:SCS0 bits select the clock source and determine
which Run or Idle mode is to be used. Changing these
bits causes an immediate switch to the new clock
source, assuming that it is running. The switch may
also be subject to clock transition delays. These are
discussed in Section 3.1.3 “Clock Transitions and
Status Indicators” and subsequent sections.
These categories define which portions of the device
are clocked and sometimes, what speed. The Run and
Idle modes may use any of the three available clock
sources (primary, secondary or internal oscillator
block); the Sleep mode does not use a clock source.
The power-managed modes include several power-
saving features offered on previous PICmicro®
devices. One is the clock switching feature, offered in
other PIC18 devices, allowing the controller to use the
Timer1 oscillator in place of the primary oscillator. Also
included is the Sleep mode, offered by all PICmicro
devices, where all device clocks are stopped.
Entry to the power-managed Idle or Sleep modes is
triggered by the execution of a SLEEPinstruction. The
actual mode that results depends on the status of the
IDLEN bit.
Depending on the current mode and the mode being
switched to, a change to a power-managed mode does
not always require setting all of these bits. Many
transitions may be done by changing the oscillator select
bits, or changing the IDLEN bit, prior to issuing a SLEEP
instruction. If the IDLEN bit is already configured
correctly, it may only be necessary to perform a SLEEP
instruction to switch to the desired mode.
3.1
Selecting Power-Managed Modes
Selecting
a power-managed mode requires two
decisions: if the CPU is to be clocked or not and the
selection of clock source. The IDLEN bit
(OSCCON<7>) controls CPU clocking, while the
SCS1:SCS0 bits (OSCCON<1:0>) select the clock
source. The individual modes, bit settings, clock sources
and affected modules are summarized in Table 3-1.
a
TABLE 3-1:
Mode
POWER-MANAGED MODES
OSCCON Bits Module Clocking
Available Clock and Oscillator Source
SCS1:SCS0
IDLEN<7>(1)
CPU
Peripherals
<1:0>
Sleep
0
N/A
Off
Off
None – All clocks are disabled
PRI_RUN
N/A
00
Clocked
Clocked
Primary – LP, XT, HS, HSPLL, RC, EC and
Internal Oscillator Block(2)
.
This is the normal full power execution mode.
Secondary – Timer1 Oscillator
Internal Oscillator Block(2)
SEC_RUN
RC_RUN
PRI_IDLE
SEC_IDLE
RC_IDLE
N/A
N/A
1
01
1x
00
01
1x
Clocked
Clocked
Off
Clocked
Clocked
Clocked
Clocked
Clocked
Primary – LP, XT, HS, HSPLL, RC, EC
Secondary – Timer1 Oscillator
Internal Oscillator Block(2)
1
Off
1
Off
Note 1: IDLEN reflects its value when the SLEEPinstruction is executed.
2: Includes INTOSC and INTOSC postscaler, as well as the INTRC source.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 25
PIC18F1230/1330
3.1.3
CLOCK TRANSITIONS AND STATUS
INDICATORS
3.2
Run Modes
In the Run modes, clocks to both the core and
peripherals are active. The difference between these
modes is the clock source.
The length of the transition between clock sources is
the sum of two cycles of the old clock source and three
to four cycles of the new clock source. This formula
assumes that the new clock source is stable.
3.2.1
PRI_RUN MODE
Three bits indicate the current clock source and its
status. They are:
The PRI_RUN mode is the normal, full power execution
mode of the microcontroller. This is also the default
mode upon a device Reset unless Two-Speed Start-up
is enabled (see Section 19.3 “Two-Speed Start-up”
for details). In this mode, the OSTS bit is set. The IOFS
bit may be set if the internal oscillator block is the
primary clock source (see Section 2.7.1 “Oscillator
Control Register”).
• OSTS (OSCCON<3>)
• IOFS (OSCCON<2>)
• T1RUN (T1CON<6>)
In general, only one of these bits will be set while in a
given power-managed mode. When the OSTS bit is
set, the primary clock is providing the device clock.
When the IOFS bit is set, the INTOSC output is
providing a stable 8 MHz clock source to a divider that
actually drives the device clock. When the T1RUN bit is
set, the Timer1 oscillator is providing the clock. If none
of these bits are set, then either the INTRC clock
source is clocking the device, or the INTOSC source is
not yet stable.
3.2.2
SEC_RUN MODE
The SEC_RUN mode is the compatible mode to the
“clock switching” feature offered in other PIC18
devices. In this mode, the CPU and peripherals are
clocked from the Timer1 oscillator. This gives users the
option of lower power consumption while still using a
high accuracy clock source.
If the internal oscillator block is configured as the primary
clock source by the FOSC3:FOSC0 Configuration bits,
then both the OSTS and IOFS bits may be set when in
PRI_RUN or PRI_IDLE modes. This indicates that the
primary clock (INTOSC output) is generating a stable
8 MHz output. Entering another power-managed RC
mode at the same frequency would clear the OSTS bit.
SEC_RUN mode is entered by setting the SCS1:SCS0
bits to ‘01’. The device clock source is switched to the
Timer1 oscillator (see Figure 3-1), the primary oscillator
is shut down, the T1RUN bit (T1CON<6>) is set and the
OSTS bit is cleared.
Note:
The Timer1 oscillator should already be
running prior to entering SEC_RUN mode.
If the T1OSCEN bit is not set when the
SCS1:SCS0 bits are set to ‘01’, entry to
SEC_RUN mode will not occur. If the
Timer1 oscillator is enabled, but not yet
running, device clocks will be delayed until
the oscillator has started. In such situa-
tions, initial oscillator operation is far from
stable and unpredictable operation may
result.
Note 1: Caution should be used when modifying a
single IRCF bit. If VDD is less than 3V, it is
possible to select a higher clock speed
than is supported by the low VDD.
Improper device operation may result if
the VDD/FOSC specifications are violated.
2: Executing a SLEEP instruction does not
necessarily place the device into Sleep
mode. It acts as the trigger to place the
controller into either the Sleep mode or
one of the Idle modes, depending on the
setting of the IDLEN bit.
On transitions from SEC_RUN to PRI_RUN mode, the
peripherals and CPU continue to be clocked from the
Timer1 oscillator while the primary clock is started.
When the primary clock becomes ready, a clock switch
back to the primary clock occurs (see Figure 3-2).
When the clock switch is complete, the T1RUN bit is
cleared, the OSTS bit is set and the primary clock is
providing the clock. The IDLEN and SCS bits are not
affected by the wake-up; the Timer1 oscillator
continues to run.
3.1.4
MULTIPLE SLEEP COMMANDS
The power-managed mode that is invoked with the
SLEEP instruction is determined by the setting of the
IDLEN bit at the time the instruction is executed. If
another SLEEPinstruction is executed, the device will
enter the power-managed mode specified by IDLEN at
that time. If IDLEN has changed, the device will enter
the new power-managed mode specified by the new
setting.
DS39758B-page 26
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 3-1:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR ENTRY TO SEC_RUN MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
1
2
3
n-1
n
T1OSI
Clock Transition(1)
OSC1
CPU
Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
Note 1: Clock transition typically occurs within 2-4 TOSC.
FIGURE 3-2:
TRANSITION TIMING FROM SEC_RUN MODE TO PRI_RUN MODE (HSPLL)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3
T1OSI
OSC1
(1)
(1)
TPLL
TOST
1
2
n-1
n
PLL Clock
Output
Clock
Transition(2)
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC + 2
PC + 4
PC
SCS1:SCS0 bits Changed
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
2: Clock transition typically occurs within 2-4 TOSC.
This mode is entered by setting the SCS1 bit to ‘1’.
3.2.3
RC_RUN MODE
Although it is ignored, it is recommended that the SCS0
bit also be cleared; this is to maintain software compat-
ibility with future devices. When the clock source is
switched to the INTOSC multiplexer (see Figure 3-3),
the primary oscillator is shut down and the OSTS bit is
cleared. The IRCF bits may be modified at any time to
immediately change the clock speed.
In RC_RUN mode, the CPU and peripherals are
clocked from the internal oscillator block using the
INTOSC multiplexer. In this mode, the primary clock is
shut down. When using the INTRC source, this mode
provides the best power conservation of all the Run
modes, while still executing code. It works well for user
applications which are not highly timing sensitive or do
not require high-speed clocks at all times.
Note:
Caution should be used when modifying a
single IRCF bit. If VDD is less than 3V, it is
possible to select a higher clock speed
than is supported by the low VDD.
Improper device operation may result if
the VDD/FOSC specifications are violated.
If the primary clock source is the internal oscillator block
(either INTRC or INTOSC), there are no distinguishable
differences between PRI_RUN and RC_RUN modes
during execution. However, a clock switch delay will
occur during entry to and exit from RC_RUN mode.
Therefore, if the primary clock source is the internal
oscillator block, the use of RC_RUN mode is not
recommended.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 27
PIC18F1230/1330
If the IRCF bits and the INTSRC bit are all clear, the
INTOSC output is not enabled and the IOFS bit will
remain clear; there will be no indication of the current
clock source. The INTRC source is providing the
device clocks.
On transitions from RC_RUN mode to PRI_RUN mode,
the device continues to be clocked from the INTOSC
multiplexer while the primary clock is started. When the
primary clock becomes ready, a clock switch to the
primary clock occurs (see Figure 3-4). When the clock
switch is complete, the IOFS bit is cleared, the OSTS
bit is set and the primary clock is providing the device
clock. The IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the
switch. The INTRC source will continue to run if either
the WDT or the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled.
If the IRCF bits are changed from all clear (thus,
enabling the INTOSC output), or if INTSRC is set, the
IOFS bit becomes set after the INTOSC output
becomes stable. Clocks to the device continue while
the INTOSC source stabilizes after an interval of
TIOBST.
If the IRCF bits were previously at a non-zero value, or
if INTSRC was set before setting SCS1 and the
INTOSC source was already stable, the IOFS bit will
remain set.
FIGURE 3-3:
TRANSITION TIMING TO RC_RUN MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
1
2
3
n-1
n
INTRC
OSC1
Clock Transition(1)
CPU
Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
Note 1: Clock transition typically occurs within 2-4 TOSC.
FIGURE 3-4:
TRANSITION TIMING FROM RC_RUN MODE TO PRI_RUN MODE
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3
Q1
Q2
INTOSC
Multiplexer
OSC1
(1)
(1)
TPLL
TOST
1
2
n-1
n
PLL Clock
Output
Clock
Transition(2)
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
SCS1:SCS0 bits Changed
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
2: Clock transition typically occurs within 2-4 TOSC.
DS39758B-page 28
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
3.3
Sleep Mode
3.4
Idle Modes
The power-managed Sleep mode in the PIC18F1230/
1330 devices is identical to the legacy Sleep mode
offered in all other PICmicro devices. It is entered by
clearing the IDLEN bit (the default state on device
Reset) and executing the SLEEPinstruction. This shuts
down the selected oscillator (Figure 3-5). All clock
source status bits are cleared.
The Idle modes allow the controller’s CPU to be
selectively shut down while the peripherals continue to
operate. Selecting a particular Idle mode allows users
to further manage power consumption.
If the IDLEN bit is set to a ‘1’ when a SLEEPinstruction is
executed, the peripherals will be clocked from the clock
source selected using the SCS1:SCS0 bits; however, the
CPU will not be clocked. The clock source status bits are
not affected. Setting IDLEN and executing a SLEEP
instruction provides a quick method of switching from a
given Run mode to its corresponding Idle mode.
Entering the Sleep mode from any other mode does not
require a clock switch. This is because no clocks are
needed once the controller has entered Sleep. If the
WDT is selected, the INTRC source will continue to
operate. If the Timer1 oscillator is enabled, it will also
continue to run.
If the WDT is selected, the INTRC source will continue
to operate. If the Timer1 oscillator is enabled, it will also
continue to run.
When a wake event occurs in Sleep mode (by interrupt,
Reset or WDT time-out), the device will not be clocked
until the clock source selected by the SCS1:SCS0 bits
becomes ready (see Figure 3-6), or it will be clocked
from the internal oscillator block if either the Two-
Speed Start-up or the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor are
enabled (see Section 19.0 “Special Features of the
CPU”). In either case, the OSTS bit is set when the
primary clock is providing the device clocks. The
IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the wake-up.
Since the CPU is not executing instructions, the only
exits from any of the Idle modes are by interrupt, WDT
time-out or a Reset. When a wake event occurs, CPU
execution is delayed by an interval of TCSD
(parameter 38, Table 22-10) while it becomes ready to
execute code. When the CPU begins executing code,
it resumes with the same clock source for the current
Idle mode. For example, when waking from RC_IDLE
mode, the internal oscillator block will clock the CPU
and peripherals (in other words, RC_RUN mode). The
IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the wake-up.
While in any Idle mode or the Sleep mode, a WDT
time-out will result in a WDT wake-up to the Run mode
currently specified by the SCS1:SCS0 bits.
FIGURE 3-5:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR ENTRY TO SLEEP MODE
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1
OSC1
CPU
Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Sleep
Program
Counter
PC
PC + 2
FIGURE 3-6:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR WAKE FROM SLEEP (HSPLL)
Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2
Q1
OSC1
(1)
(1)
TPLL
TOST
PLL Clock
Output
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
PC + 6
Wake Event
Note1:TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
OSTS bit Set
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 29
PIC18F1230/1330
setting the IDLEN bit and executing
a SLEEP
3.4.1
PRI_IDLE MODE
instruction. If the device is in another Run mode, set the
IDLEN bit first, then set the SCS1:SCS0 bits to ‘01’ and
execute SLEEP. When the clock source is switched to
the Timer1 oscillator, the primary oscillator is shut down,
the OSTS bit is cleared and the T1RUN bit is set.
This mode is unique among the three low-power Idle
modes, in that it does not disable the primary device
clock. For timing sensitive applications, this allows for
the fastest resumption of device operation with its more
accurate primary clock source, since the clock source
does not have to “warm-up” or transition from another
oscillator.
When a wake event occurs, the peripherals continue to
be clocked from the Timer1 oscillator. After an interval
of TCSD following the wake event, the CPU begins
executing code being clocked by the Timer1 oscillator.
The IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by the
wake-up; the Timer1 oscillator continues to run (see
Figure 3-8).
PRI_IDLE mode is entered from PRI_RUN mode by
setting the IDLEN bit and executing a SLEEPinstruc-
tion. If the device is in another Run mode, set IDLEN
first, then clear the SCS bits and execute SLEEP.
Although the CPU is disabled, the peripherals continue
to be clocked from the primary clock source specified
by the FOSC3:FOSC0 Configuration bits. The OSTS
bit remains set (see Figure 3-7).
Note:
The Timer1 oscillator should already be
running prior to entering SEC_IDLE mode.
If the T1OSCEN bit is not set when the
SLEEPinstruction is executed, the SLEEP
instruction will be ignored and entry to
SEC_IDLE mode will not occur. If the
Timer1 oscillator is enabled but not yet
running, peripheral clocks will be delayed
until the oscillator has started. In such
situations, initial oscillator operation is far
from stable and unpredictable operation
may result.
When a wake event occurs, the CPU is clocked from the
primary clock source. A delay of interval TCSD is
required between the wake event and when code
execution starts. This is required to allow the CPU to
become ready to execute instructions. After the wake-
up, the OSTS bit remains set. The IDLEN and SCS bits
are not affected by the wake-up (see Figure 3-8).
3.4.2
SEC_IDLE MODE
In SEC_IDLE mode, the CPU is disabled but the
peripherals continue to be clocked from the Timer1
oscillator. This mode is entered from SEC_RUN by
FIGURE 3-7:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR ENTRY TO IDLE MODE
Q4
Q1
Q3
Q1
Q2
OSC1
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
PC + 2
FIGURE 3-8:
TRANSITION TIMING FOR WAKE FROM IDLE TO RUN MODE
Q1
Q3
Q4
Q2
OSC1
TCSD
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC
Wake Event
DS39758B-page 30
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
On all exits from Idle or Sleep modes by interrupt, code
execution branches to the interrupt vector if the GIE/
GIEH bit (INTCON<7>) is set. Otherwise, code execution
continues or resumes without branching (see
Section 10.0 “Interrupts”).
3.4.3
RC_IDLE MODE
In RC_IDLE mode, the CPU is disabled but the
peripherals continue to be clocked from the internal
oscillator block using the INTOSC multiplexer. This
mode allows for controllable power conservation during
Idle periods.
A fixed delay of interval TCSD following the wake event
is required when leaving Sleep and Idle modes. This
delay is required for the CPU to prepare for execution.
Instruction execution resumes on the first clock cycle
following this delay.
From RC_RUN, this mode is entered by setting the
IDLEN bit and executing a SLEEP instruction. If the
device is in another Run mode, first set IDLEN, then set
the SCS1 bit and execute SLEEP. Although its value is
ignored, it is recommended that SCS0 also be cleared;
this is to maintain software compatibility with future
devices. The INTOSC multiplexer may be used to
select a higher clock frequency by modifying the IRCF
bits before executing the SLEEPinstruction. When the
clock source is switched to the INTOSC multiplexer, the
primary oscillator is shut down and the OSTS bit is
cleared.
3.5.2
EXIT BY WDT TIME-OUT
A WDT time-out will cause different actions depending
on which power-managed mode the device is in when
the time-out occurs.
If the device is not executing code (all Idle modes and
Sleep mode), the time-out will result in an exit from the
power-managed mode (see Section 3.2 “Run
Modes” and Section 3.3 “Sleep Mode”). If the device
is executing code (all Run modes), the time-out will
result in a WDT Reset (see Section 19.2 “Watchdog
Timer (WDT)”).
If the IRCF bits are set to any non-zero value, or the
INTSRC bit is set, the INTOSC output is enabled. The
IOFS bit becomes set, after the INTOSC output
becomes stable, after an interval of TIOBST
(parameter 39, Table 22-10). Clocks to the peripherals
continue while the INTOSC source stabilizes. If the
IRCF bits were previously at a non-zero value, or
INTSRC was set before the SLEEP instruction was
executed and the INTOSC source was already stable,
the IOFS bit will remain set. If the IRCF bits and
INTSRC are all clear, the INTOSC output will not be
enabled, the IOFS bit will remain clear and there will be
no indication of the current clock source.
The WDT timer and postscaler are cleared by
executing a SLEEPor CLRWDTinstruction, the loss of a
currently selected clock source (if the Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor is enabled) and modifying the IRCF bits in the
OSCCON register if the internal oscillator block is the
device clock source.
3.5.3
EXIT BY RESET
Normally, the device is held in Reset by the Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST) until the primary clock becomes
ready. At that time, the OSTS bit is set and the device
begins executing code. If the internal oscillator block is
the new clock source, the IOFS bit is set instead.
When a wake event occurs, the peripherals continue to
be clocked from the INTOSC multiplexer. After a delay of
TCSD following the wake event, the CPU begins
executing code being clocked by the INTOSC
multiplexer. The IDLEN and SCS bits are not affected by
the wake-up. The INTRC source will continue to run if
either the WDT or the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is
enabled.
The exit delay time from Reset to the start of code
execution depends on both the clock sources before
and after the wake-up and the type of oscillator if the
new clock source is the primary clock. Exit delays are
summarized in Table 3-2.
3.5
Exiting Idle and Sleep Modes
Code execution can begin before the primary clock
becomes ready. If either the Two-Speed Start-up (see
Section 19.3 “Two-Speed Start-up”) or Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor (see Section 19.4 “Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor”) is enabled, the device may begin execution
as soon as the Reset source has cleared. Execution is
clocked by the INTOSC multiplexer driven by the
internal oscillator block. Execution is clocked by the
internal oscillator block until either the primary clock
becomes ready or a power-managed mode is entered
before the primary clock becomes ready; the primary
clock is then shut down.
An exit from Sleep mode or any of the Idle modes is
triggered by an interrupt, a Reset or a WDT time-out.
This section discusses the triggers that cause exits
from power-managed modes. The clocking subsystem
actions are discussed in each of the power-managed
modes (see Section 3.2 “Run Modes”, Section 3.3
“Sleep Mode” and Section 3.4 “Idle Modes”).
3.5.1
EXIT BY INTERRUPT
Any of the available interrupt sources can cause the
device to exit from an Idle mode or the Sleep mode to
a Run mode. To enable this functionality, an interrupt
source must be enabled by setting its enable bit in one
of the INTCON or PIE registers. The exit sequence is
initiated when the corresponding interrupt flag bit is set.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 31
PIC18F1230/1330
In these instances, the primary clock source either
does not require an oscillator start-up delay since it is
already running (PRI_IDLE), or normally does not
require an oscillator start-up delay (RC, EC and INTIO
Oscillator modes). However, a fixed delay of interval
TCSD following the wake event is still required when
leaving Sleep and Idle modes to allow the CPU to
prepare for execution. Instruction execution resumes
on the first clock cycle following this delay.
3.5.4
EXIT WITHOUT AN OSCILLATOR
START-UP DELAY
Certain exits from power-managed modes do not
invoke the OST at all. There are two cases:
• PRI_IDLE mode, where the primary clock source is
not stopped; and
• the primary clock source is not any of the LP, XT, HS
or HSPLL modes.
TABLE 3-2:
EXIT DELAY ON WAKE-UP BY RESET FROM SLEEP MODE OR ANY IDLE MODE
(BY CLOCK SOURCES)
Clock Source
before Wake-up
Clock Source
after Wake-up
Clock Ready Status
Bit (OSCCON)
Exit Delay
LP, XT, HS
HSPLL
OSTS
IOFS
OSTS
IOFS
OSTS
IOFS
OSTS
IOFS
Primary Device Clock
(PRI_IDLE mode)
(1)
TCSD
EC, RC
INTOSC(2)
LP, XT, HS
HSPLL
(3)
TOST
(3)
TOST + trc
T1OSC
(1)
EC, RC
TCSD
INTOSC(1)
LP, XT, HS
HSPLL
TIOBST
(4)
(4)
TOST
(3)
TOST + trc
INTOSC(3)
(1)
EC, RC
TCSD
INTOSC(1)
LP, XT, HS
HSPLL
None
(3)
TOST
(3)
TOST + trc
None
(Sleep mode)
(1)
EC, RC
INTOSC(1)
TCSD
(4)
TIOBST
Note 1: TCSD (parameter 38) is a required delay when waking from Sleep and all Idle modes and runs concurrently
with any other required delays (see Section 3.4 “Idle Modes”). On Reset, INTOSC defaults to 1 MHz.
2: Includes both the INTOSC 8 MHz source and postscaler derived frequencies.
3: TOST is the Oscillator Start-up Timer (parameter 32). trc is the PLL Lock-out Timer (parameter F12); it is
also designated as TPLL.
4: Execution continues during TIOBST (parameter 39), the INTOSC stabilization period.
DS39758B-page 32
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
A simplified block diagram of the On-Chip Reset Circuit
is shown in Figure 4-1.
4.0
RESET
The PIC18F1230/1330 devices differentiate between
various kinds of Reset:
4.1
RCON Register
a) Power-on Reset (POR)
Device Reset events are tracked through the RCON
register (Register 4-1). The lower five bits of the
register indicate that a specific Reset event has
occurred. In most cases, these bits can only be cleared
by the event and must be set by the application after
the event. The state of these flag bits, taken together,
can be read to indicate the type of Reset that just
occurred. This is described in more detail in
Section 4.6 “Reset State of Registers”.
b) MCLR Reset during normal operation
c) MCLR Reset during power-managed modes
d) Watchdog Timer (WDT) Reset (during
execution)
e) Programmable Brown-out Reset (BOR)
f) RESETInstruction
g) Stack Full Reset
h) Stack Underflow Reset
The RCON register also has control bits for setting
interrupt priority (IPEN) and software control of the
BOR (SBOREN). Interrupt priority is discussed in
Section 10.0 “Interrupts”. BOR is covered in
Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
This section discusses Resets generated by MCLR,
POR and BOR and covers the operation of the various
start-up timers. Stack Reset events are covered in
Section 5.1.2.4 “Stack Full and Underflow Resets”.
WDT Resets are covered in Section 19.2 “Watchdog
Timer (WDT)”.
FIGURE 4-1:
SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM OF ON-CHIP RESET CIRCUIT
RESET
Instruction
Stack Full/Underflow Reset
Stack
Pointer
External Reset
MCLRE
MCLR
( )_IDLE
Sleep
WDT
Time-out
VDD Rise
Detect
POR Pulse
BOREN
VDD
Brown-out
Reset
S
OST/PWRT
OST
10-Bit Ripple Counter
1024 Cycles
Chip_Reset
R
Q
OSC1
32 μs
65.5 ms
PWRT
11-Bit Ripple Counter
INTRC(1)
Enable PWRT
(2)
Enable OST
Note 1: This is the INTRC source from the internal oscillator block and is separate from the RC oscillator of the CLKI pin.
2: See Table 4-2 for time-out situations.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 33
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 4-1:
RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
IPEN
R/W-1(1)
U-0
—
R/W-1
RI
R-1
TO
R-1
PD
R/W-0(2)
POR
R/W-0
BOR
SBOREN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
IPEN: Interrupt Priority Enable bit
1= Enable priority levels on interrupts
0= Disable priority levels on interrupts (PIC16CXXX Compatibility mode)
SBOREN: BOR Software Enable bit(1)
If BOREN1:BOREN0 = 01:
1= BOR is enabled
0= BOR is disabled
If BOREN1:BOREN0 = 00, 10or 11:
Bit is disabled and read as ‘0’.
bit 5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
RI: RESETInstruction Flag bit
1= The RESETinstruction was not executed (set by firmware only)
0= The RESET instruction was executed causing a device Reset (must be set in software after a
Brown-out Reset occurs)
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
TO: Watchdog Time-out Flag bit
1= Set by power-up, CLRWDTinstruction or SLEEPinstruction
0= A WDT time-out occurred
PD: Power-Down Detection Flag bit
1= Set by power-up or by the CLRWDTinstruction
0= Set by execution of the SLEEPinstruction
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit(2)
1= A Power-on Reset has not occurred (set by firmware only)
0= A Power-on Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Power-on Reset occurs)
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
1= A Brown-out Reset has not occurred (set by firmware only)
0= A Brown-out Reset occurred (must be set in software after a Brown-out Reset occurs)
Note 1: If SBOREN is enabled, its Reset state is ‘1’; otherwise, it is ‘0’.
2: The actual Reset value of POR is determined by the type of device Reset. See the notes following this
register and Section 4.6 “Reset State of Registers” for additional information.
Note 1: It is recommended that the POR bit be set after a Power-on Reset has been detected so that subsequent
Power-on Resets may be detected.
2: Brown-out Reset is said to have occurred when BOR is ‘0’ and POR is ‘1’ (assuming that POR was set to
‘1’ by software immediately after a Power-on Reset).
DS39758B-page 34
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 4-2:
EXTERNAL POWER-ON
RESET CIRCUIT (FOR
SLOW VDD POWER-UP)
4.2
Master Clear (MCLR)
The MCLR pin provides a method for triggering an
external Reset of the device. A Reset is generated by
holding the pin low. These devices have a noise filter in
the MCLR Reset path which detects and ignores small
pulses.
VDD
VDD
The MCLR pin is not driven low by any internal Resets,
including the WDT.
D
R
R1
MCLR
In PIC18F1230/1330 devices, the MCLR input can be
disabled with the MCLRE Configuration bit. When
MCLR is disabled, the pin becomes a digital input. See
Section 9.1 “PORTA, TRISA and LATA Registers”
for more information.
PIC18FXXXX
C
Note 1: External Power-on Reset circuit is required
only if the VDD power-up slope is too slow.
The diode D helps discharge the capacitor
quickly when VDD powers down.
4.3
Power-on Reset (POR)
A
Power-on Reset pulse is generated on-chip
2: R < 40 kΩ is recommended to make sure that
the voltage drop across R does not violate
the device’s electrical specification.
whenever VDD rises above a certain threshold. This
allows the device to start in the initialized state when
VDD is adequate for operation.
3: R1 ≥ 1 kΩ will limit any current flowing into
MCLR from external capacitor C, in the event
of MCLR/VPP pin breakdown, due to
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) or Electrical
Overstress (EOS).
To take advantage of the POR circuitry, tie the MCLR
pin through a resistor (1 kΩ to 10 kΩ) to VDD. This will
eliminate external RC components usually needed to
create a Power-on Reset delay. A minimum rise rate for
VDD is specified (parameter D004). For a slow rise
time, see Figure 4-2.
When the device starts normal operation (i.e., exits the
Reset condition), device operating parameters
(voltage, frequency, temperature, etc.) must be met to
ensure operation. If these conditions are not met, the
device must be held in Reset until the operating
conditions are met.
POR events are captured by the POR bit (RCON<1>).
The state of the bit is set to ‘0’ whenever a Power-on
Reset occurs; it does not change for any other Reset
event. POR is not reset to ‘1’ by any hardware event.
To capture multiple events, the user manually resets
the bit to ‘1’ in software following any Power-on Reset.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 35
PIC18F1230/1330
change BOR configuration. It also allows the user to
tailor device power consumption in software by
eliminating the incremental current that the BOR
consumes. While the BOR current is typically very
small, it may have some impact in low-power
applications.
4.4
Brown-out Reset (BOR)
PIC18F1230/1330 devices implement a BOR circuit that
provides the user with a number of configuration and
power-saving options. The BOR is controlled by the
BORV1:BORV0 and BOREN1:BOREN0 Configuration
bits. There are a total of four BOR configurations which
are summarized in Table 4-1.
Note:
Even when BOR is under software control,
the BOR Reset voltage level is still set by
the BORV1:BORV0 Configuration bits. It
cannot be changed in software.
The BOR threshold is set by the BORV1:BORV0 bits. If
BOR is enabled (any values of BOREN1:BOREN0
except ‘00’), any drop of VDD below VBOR (parameter
D005) for greater than TBOR (parameter 35) will reset
the device. A Reset may or may not occur if VDD falls
below VBOR for less than TBOR. The chip will remain in
Brown-out Reset until VDD rises above VBOR.
4.4.2
DETECTING BOR
When Brown-out Reset is enabled, the BOR bit always
resets to ‘0’ on any Brown-out Reset or Power-on
Reset event. This makes it difficult to determine if a
Brown-out Reset event has occurred just by reading
the state of BOR alone. A more reliable method is to
simultaneously check the state of both POR and BOR.
This assumes that the POR bit is reset to ‘1’ in software
immediately after any Power-on Reset event. If BOR is
‘0’ while POR is ‘1’, it can be reliably assumed that a
Brown-out Reset event has occurred.
If the Power-up Timer is enabled, it will be invoked after
VDD rises above VBOR; it then will keep the chip in
Reset for an additional time delay, TPWRT
(parameter 33). If VDD drops below VBOR while the
Power-up Timer is running, the chip will go back into a
Brown-out Reset and the Power-up Timer will be
initialized. Once VDD rises above VBOR, the Power-up
Timer will execute the additional time delay.
4.4.3
DISABLING BOR IN SLEEP MODE
BOR and the Power-on Timer (PWRT) are
independently configured. Enabling BOR Reset does
not automatically enable the PWRT.
When BOREN1:BOREN0 = 10, the BOR remains
under hardware control and operates as previously
described. Whenever the device enters Sleep mode,
however, the BOR is automatically disabled. When the
device returns to any other operating mode, BOR is
automatically re-enabled.
4.4.1
SOFTWARE ENABLED BOR
When BOREN1:BOREN0 = 01, the BOR can be
enabled or disabled by the user in software. This is
done with the control bit, SBOREN (RCON<6>).
Setting SBOREN enables the BOR to function as
previously described. Clearing SBOREN disables the
BOR entirely. The SBOREN bit operates only in this
mode; otherwise it is read as ‘0’.
This mode allows for applications to recover from
brown-out situations, while actively executing code,
when the device requires BOR protection the most. At
the same time, it saves additional power in Sleep mode
by eliminating the small incremental BOR current.
Placing the BOR under software control gives the user
the additional flexibility of tailoring the application to its
environment without having to reprogram the device to
TABLE 4-1:
BOREN1
BOR CONFIGURATIONS
BOR Configuration
Status of
SBOREN
BOR Operation
BOREN0
(RCON<6>)
0
0
1
0
1
0
Unavailable BOR disabled; must be enabled by reprogramming the Configuration bits.
Available BOR enabled in software; operation controlled by SBOREN.
Unavailable BOR enabled in hardware in Run and Idle modes, disabled during
Sleep mode.
1
1
Unavailable BOR enabled in hardware; must be disabled by reprogramming the
Configuration bits.
DS39758B-page 36
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
4.5.3
PLL LOCK TIME-OUT
4.5
Device Reset Timers
With the PLL enabled in its PLL mode, the time-out
sequence following a Power-on Reset is slightly
different from other oscillator modes. A separate timer
is used to provide a fixed time-out that is sufficient for
the PLL to lock to the main oscillator frequency. This
PLL lock time-out (TPLL) is typically 2 ms and follows
the oscillator start-up time-out.
PIC18F1230/1330 devices incorporate three separate
on-chip timers that help regulate the Power-on Reset
process. Their main function is to ensure that the device
clock is stable before code is executed. These timers
are:
• Power-up Timer (PWRT)
• Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
• PLL Lock Time-out
4.5.4
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE
On power-up, the time-out sequence is as follows:
4.5.1
POWER-UP TIMER (PWRT)
1. After the POR pulse has cleared, PWRT time-out
is invoked (if enabled).
The Power-up Timer (PWRT) of PIC18F1230/1330
devices is an 11-bit counter which uses the INTRC
source as the clock input. This yields an approximate
time interval of 2048 x 32 μs = 65.6 ms. While the
PWRT is counting, the device is held in Reset.
2. Then, the OST is activated.
The total time-out will vary based on oscillator
configuration and the status of the PWRT. Figure 4-3,
Figure 4-4, Figure 4-5, Figure 4-6 and Figure 4-7 all
depict time-out sequences on power-up, with the
Power-up Timer enabled and the device operating in
HS Oscillator mode. Figures 4-3 through 4-6 also apply
to devices operating in XT or LP modes. For devices in
RC mode and with the PWRT disabled, there will be no
time-out at all.
The power-up time delay depends on the INTRC clock
and will vary from chip to chip due to temperature and
process variation. See DC parameter 33 for details.
The PWRT is enabled by clearing the PWRTEN
Configuration bit.
4.5.2
OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER
(OST)
Since the time-outs occur from the POR pulse, if MCLR
is kept low long enough, all time-outs will expire.
Bringing MCLR high will begin execution immediately
(Figure 4-5). This is useful for testing purposes or to
synchronize more than one PIC18FXXXX device
operating in parallel.
The Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) provides a
1024 oscillator cycle (from OSC1 input) delay after the
PWRT delay is over (parameter 33). This ensures that
the crystal oscillator or resonator has started and
stabilized.
The OST time-out is invoked only for XT, LP, HS and
HSPLL modes and only on Power-on Reset, or on exit
from most power-managed modes.
TABLE 4-2:
Oscillator
TIME-OUT IN VARIOUS SITUATIONS
Power-up(2) and Brown-out Reset
Exit from
Configuration
Power-Managed Mode
PWRTEN = 0
PWRTEN = 1
HSPLL
66 ms(1) + 1024 TOSC + 2 ms(2)
66 ms(1) + 1024 TOSC
66 ms(1)
1024 TOSC + 2 ms(2)
1024 TOSC + 2 ms(2)
HS, XT, LP
EC, ECIO
1024 TOSC
1024 TOSC
—
—
—
—
—
—
RC, RCIO
66 ms(1)
66 ms(1)
INTIO1, INTIO2
Note 1: 66 ms (65.5 ms) is the nominal Power-up Timer (PWRT) delay.
2: 2 ms is the nominal time required for the PLL to lock.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 37
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 4-3:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR TIED TO VDD, VDD RISE < TPWRT)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
OST TIME-OUT
TOST
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 4-4:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 1
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
OST TIME-OUT
TOST
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 4-5:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POWER-UP (MCLR NOT TIED TO VDD): CASE 2
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
OST TIME-OUT
TOST
INTERNAL RESET
DS39758B-page 38
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 4-6:
SLOW RISE TIME (MCLR TIED TO VDD, VDD RISE > TPWRT)
5V
0V
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
TOST
OST TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
FIGURE 4-7:
TIME-OUT SEQUENCE ON POR W/PLL ENABLED (MCLR TIED TO VDD)
VDD
MCLR
INTERNAL POR
TPWRT
PWRT TIME-OUT
OST TIME-OUT
TOST
TPLL
PLL TIME-OUT
INTERNAL RESET
Note:
TOST = 1024 clock cycles.
TPLL ≈ 2 ms max. First three stages of the PWRT timer.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 39
PIC18F1230/1330
Table 4-4 describes the Reset states for all of the
Special Function Registers. These are categorized by
Power-on and Brown-out Resets, Master Clear and
WDT Resets and WDT wake-ups.
4.6
Reset State of Registers
Most registers are unaffected by a Reset. Their status
is unknown on POR and unchanged by all other
Resets. The other registers are forced to a “Reset
state” depending on the type of Reset that occurred.
Most registers are not affected by a WDT wake-up,
since this is viewed as the resumption of normal oper-
ation. Status bits from the RCON register, RI, TO, PD,
POR and BOR, are set or cleared differently in different
Reset situations, as indicated in Table 4-3. These bits
are used in software to determine the nature of the
Reset.
TABLE 4-3:
STATUS BITS, THEIR SIGNIFICANCE AND THE INITIALIZATION CONDITION
FOR RCON REGISTER
RCON Register
STKPTR Register
Program
Counter
Condition
SBOREN
RI
TO
PD POR BOR STKFUL STKUNF
Power-on Reset
RESETInstruction
Brown-out Reset
0000h
0000h
0000h
0000h
1
1
0
1
u
1
u
1
1
1
u
1
u
0
u
u
u
0
u
0
u
0
u
u
u
0
u
u
u
u(2)
u(2)
u(2)
MCLR during Power-Managed
Run Modes
MCLR during Power-Managed
Idle Modes and Sleep Mode
0000h
0000h
0000h
u(2)
u(2)
u(2)
u
u
u
1
0
u
0
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
WDT Time-out during Full Power
or Power-Managed Run Mode
MCLR during Full Power
Execution
Stack Full Reset (STVREN = 1)
0000h
0000h
u(2)
u(2)
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
u
1
Stack Underflow Reset
(STVREN = 1)
Stack Underflow Error (not an
actual Reset, STVREN = 0)
0000h
u(2)
u(2)
u
u
u
0
u
0
u
u
u
u
u
u
1
u
WDT Time-out during
Power-Managed Idle or
Sleep Modes
PC + 2
Interrupt Exit from
PC + 2(1)
u(2)
u
u
0
u
u
u
u
Power-Managed Modes
Legend: u= unchanged
Note 1: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEH or GIEL bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (008h or 0018h).
2: Reset state is ‘1’ for POR and unchanged for all other Resets when software BOR is enabled
(BOREN1:BOREN0 Configuration bits = 01and SBOREN = 1); otherwise, the Reset state is ‘0’.
DS39758B-page 40
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 4-4:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS
MCLR Resets,
WDT Reset,
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
RESET Instruction,
Stack Resets
TOSU
1230
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
---0 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
00-0 0000
---0 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
--00 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
0000 000x
1111 1111
1100 0000
N/A
---0 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uu-0 0000
---0 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
--00 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
0000 000u
1111 1111
1100 0000
N/A
---0 uuuu(3)
uuuu uuuu(3)
uuuu uuuu(3)
uu-u uuuu(3)
---u uuuu
uuuu uuuu
PC + 2(2)
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu(1)
uuuu uuuu(1)
uuuu uuuu(1)
N/A
TOSH
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
TOSL
STKPTR
PCLATU
PCLATH
PCL
TBLPTRU
TBLPTRH
TBLPTRL
TABLAT
PRODH
PRODL
INTCON
INTCON2
INTCON3
INDF0
POSTINC0
POSTDEC0
PREINC0
PLUSW0
FSR0H
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
---- 0000
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
N/A
---- 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
N/A
---- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
N/A
FSR0L
WREG
INDF1
POSTINC1
POSTDEC1
PREINC1
PLUSW1
FSR1H
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
---- 0000
xxxx xxxx
---- 0000
---- 0000
uuuu uuuu
---- 0000
---- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---- uuuu
FSR1L
BSR
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 41
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 4-4:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
MCLR Resets,
WDT Reset,
RESET Instruction,
Stack Resets
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
Register
INDF2
1230
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
N/A
N/A
N/A
POSTINC2
POSTDEC2
PREINC2
PLUSW2
FSR2H
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
---- 0000
xxxx xxxx
---x xxxx
0000 0000
xxxx xxxx
1111 1111
0100 q000
--00 0101
---- ---0
0q-1 11q0
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
0000 0000
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx
0--- 0000
---0 1111
0-00 0000
01-0 0-00
0-00 0000
000- -000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0010
0000 000x
---- 0000
uuuu uuuu
---u uuuu
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
1111 1111
0100 q000
--00 0101
---- ---0
0q-q qquu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
u0uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
0--- 0000
---0 1111
0-00 0000
01-0 0-00
0-00 0000
000- -000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0010
0000 000x
---- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---u uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuqu
--uu uuuu
---- ---u
uq-u qquu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
u--- uuuu
---u uuuu
u-uu uuuu
--uu uuuu
u-uu uuuu
uuu- -uuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
FSR2L
STATUS
TMR0H
TMR0L
T0CON
OSCCON
LVDCON
WDTCON
RCON(4)
TMR1H
TMR1L
T1CON
ADRESH
ADRESL
ADCON0
ADCON1
ADCON2
BAUDCON
CVRCON
CMCON
SPBRGH
SPBRG
RCREG
TXREG
TXSTA
RCSTA
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
DS39758B-page 42
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 4-4:
Register
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
MCLR Resets,
WDT Reset,
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
RESET Instruction,
Stack Resets
EEADR
EEDATA
EECON2
EECON1
IPR3
1230
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
xx-0 x000
---0 ----
---0 ----
---0 ----
1--1 -1--
0--0 -0--
0--0 -0--
-111 1111
-000 0000
-000 0000
00-0 0000
0000 0000
00-- ----
0000 0000
---- 0000
1111 1111
---- 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111(5)
0000 0000
--00 0000
0000 0000
--00 0000
0000 0000
--00 0000
0--- -000
xxxx xxxx
xxxx xxxx(5)
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
0000 0000
uu-0 u000
---0 ----
---0 ----
---0 ----
1--1 -1--
0--0 -0--
0--0 -0--
-111 1111
-000 0000
-000 0000
00-0 0000
uuuu uuuu
00-- ----
0000 0000
---- 0000
1111 1111
---- 1111
1111 1111
1111 1111(5)
0000 0000
--00 0000
0000 0000
--00 0000
0000 0000
--00 0000
0--- -000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu(5)
0000 0000
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
0000 0000
uu-0 u000
---u ----
---u ----
---u ----
u--u -u--
u--u -u--(1)
u--u -u--
-uuu uuuu
-uuu uuuu(1)
-uuu uuuu
uu-u uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uu-- ----
uuuu uuuu
---- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
---- uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu(5)
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
u--- -uuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu(5)
uuuu uuuu
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
PIR3
PIE3
IPIR2
PIR2
PIE2
IPR1
PIR1
PIE1
OSCTUNE
PTCON0
PTCON1
PTMRL
PTMRH
PTPERL
PTPERH
TRISB
TRISA
PDC0L
PDC0H
PDC1L
PDC1H
PDC2L
PDC2H
FLTCONFIG
LATB
LATA
SEVTCMPL
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 43
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 4-4:
INITIALIZATION CONDITIONS FOR ALL REGISTERS (CONTINUED)
MCLR Resets,
WDT Reset,
RESET Instruction,
Stack Resets
Applicable
Devices
Power-on Reset,
Brown-out Reset
Wake-up via WDT
or Interrupt
Register
SEVTCMPH
PWMCON0
1230
1330
1330
---- 0000
-100 -000(6)
-000 -000(6)
0000 0-00
0000 0000
--11 1111
--00 0000
xxxx xxxx
xx0x 0000(5)
---- 0000
-100 -000(6)
-000 -000(6)
0000 0-00
0000 0000
--11 1111
--00 0000
uuuu uuuu
uu0u 0000(5)
---- uuuu
-uuu -uuu(6)
-uuu -uuu(6)
uuuu u-uu
uuuu uuuu
--uu uuuu
--uu uuuu
uuuu uuuu
uuuu uuuu(5)
1230
PWMCON1
DTCON
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1230
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
1330
OVDCOND
OVDCONS
PORTB
PORTA
Legend: u= unchanged, x= unknown, -= unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: One or more bits in the INTCONx or PIRx registers will be affected (to cause wake-up).
2: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the PC is loaded with the
interrupt vector (0008h or 0018h).
3: When the wake-up is due to an interrupt and the GIEL or GIEH bit is set, the TOSU, TOSH and TOSL are
updated with the current value of the PC. The STKPTR is modified to point to the next location in the
hardware stack.
4: See Table 4-3 for Reset value for specific condition.
5: Bits 6 and 7 of PORTA, LATA and TRISA are enabled depending on the oscillator mode selected. When
not enabled as PORTA pins, they are disabled and read ‘0’.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
DS39758B-page 44
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
5.1
Program Memory Organization
5.0
MEMORY ORGANIZATION
PIC18 microcontrollers implement a 21-bit program
counter, which is capable of addressing a 2-Mbyte
program memory space. Accessing a location between
the upper boundary of the physically implemented
memory and the 2-Mbyte address will return all ‘0’s (a
NOPinstruction).
There are three types of memory in PIC18 Enhanced
microcontroller devices:
• Program Memory
• Data RAM
• Data EEPROM
As Harvard architecture devices, the data and program
memories use separate busses; this allows for
concurrent access of the two memory spaces. The data
EEPROM, for practical purposes, can be regarded as
a peripheral device, since it is addressed and accessed
through a set of control registers.
The PIC18F1230 has 4 Kbytes of Flash memory and
can store up to 2,048 single-word instructions. The
PIC18F1330 has 8 Kbytes of Flash memory and can
store up to 4,096 single-word instructions.
PIC18 devices have two interrupt vectors. The Reset
vector address is at 0000h and the interrupt vector
addresses are at 0008h and 0018h.
Additional detailed information on the operation of the
Flash program memory is provided in Section 6.0
“Flash Program Memory”. Data EEPROM is
discussed separately in Section 7.0 “Data EEPROM
Memory”.
The program memory maps for PIC18F1230 and
PIC18F1330 devices are shown in Figure 5-1.
FIGURE 5-1:
PROGRAM MEMORY MAP AND STACK FOR PIC18F1230/1330 DEVICES
PIC18F1230
PIC18F1330
PC<20:0>
PC<20:0>
21
21
CALL,RCALL,RETURN
RETFIE,RETLW
CALL,RCALL,RETURN
RETFIE,RETLW
Stack Level 1
Stack Level 1
•
•
•
•
•
•
Stack Level 31
Reset Vector
Stack Level 31
Reset Vector
0000h
0008h
0000h
High Priority Interrupt Vector
High Priority Interrupt Vector
Low Priority Interrupt Vector
0008h
0018h
Low Priority Interrupt Vector 0018h
On-Chip
Program Memory
On-Chip
Program Memory
0FFFh
1000h
1FFFh
2000h
Read ‘0’
Read ‘0’
1FFFFFh
200000h
1FFFFFh
200000h
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 45
PIC18F1230/1330
The stack operates as a 31-word by 21-bit RAM and a
5-bit Stack Pointer, STKPTR. The stack space is not
part of either program or data space. The Stack Pointer
is readable and writable and the address on the top of
the stack is readable and writable through the Top-of-
Stack Special Function Registers. Data can also be
pushed to, or popped from the stack, using these
registers.
5.1.1
PROGRAM COUNTER
The Program Counter (PC) specifies the address of the
instruction to fetch for execution. The PC is 21 bits wide
and is contained in three separate 8-bit registers. The
low byte, known as the PCL register, is both readable
and writable. The high byte, or PCH register, contains
the PC<15:8> bits; it is not directly readable or writable.
Updates to the PCH register are performed through the
PCLATH register. The upper byte is called PCU. This
register contains the PC<20:16> bits; it is also not
directly readable or writable. Updates to the PCU
register are performed through the PCLATU register.
A CALLtype instruction causes a push onto the stack;
the Stack Pointer is first incremented and the location
pointed to by the Stack Pointer is written with the
contents of the PC (already pointing to the instruction
following the CALL). A RETURNtype instruction causes
a pop from the stack; the contents of the location
pointed to by the STKPTR are transferred to the PC
and then the Stack Pointer is decremented.
The contents of PCLATH and PCLATU are transferred
to the program counter by any operation that writes to
the PCL. Similarly, the upper two bytes of the program
counter are transferred to PCLATH and PCLATU by an
operation that reads the PCL. This is useful for
computed offsets to the PC (see Section 5.1.4.1
“Computed GOTO”).
The Stack Pointer is initialized to ‘00000’ after all
Resets. There is no RAM associated with the location
corresponding to a Stack Pointer value of ‘00000’; this
is only a Reset value. Status bits indicate if the stack is
full, has overflowed or has underflowed.
The PC addresses bytes in the program memory. To
prevent the PC from becoming misaligned with word
instructions, the Least Significant bit of PCL is fixed to
a value of ‘0’. The PC increments by 2 to address
sequential instructions in the program memory.
5.1.2.1
Top-of-Stack Access
Only the top of the return address stack (TOS) is
readable and writable. A set of three registers,
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL, hold the contents of the stack
location pointed to by the STKPTR register (Figure 5-2).
This allows users to implement a software stack if
necessary. After a CALL, RCALL or interrupt, the
software can read the pushed value by reading the
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL registers. These values can be
placed on a user-defined software stack. At return time,
the software can return these values to
TOSU:TOSH:TOSL and do a return.
The CALL, RCALL, GOTO and program branch
instructions write to the program counter directly. For
these instructions, the contents of PCLATH and
PCLATU are not transferred to the program counter.
5.1.2
RETURN ADDRESS STACK
The return address stack allows any combination of up
to 31 program calls and interrupts to occur. The PC is
pushed onto the stack when a CALL or RCALL
instruction is executed or an interrupt is Acknowledged.
The PC value is pulled off the stack on a RETURN,
RETLWor a RETFIEinstruction. PCLATU and PCLATH
are not affected by any of the RETURN or CALL
instructions.
The user must disable the global interrupt enable bits
while accessing the stack to prevent inadvertent stack
corruption.
FIGURE 5-2:
RETURN ADDRESS STACK AND ASSOCIATED REGISTERS
Return Address Stack <20:0>
11111
11110
11101
Top-of-Stack Registers
Stack Pointer
STKPTR<4:0>
TOSU
00h
TOSH
1Ah
TOSL
34h
00010
00011
00010
00001
00000
001A34h
000D58h
Top-of-Stack
DS39758B-page 46
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
When the stack has been popped enough times to
unload the stack, the next pop will return a value of zero
to the PC and sets the STKUNF bit, while the Stack
Pointer remains at zero. The STKUNF bit will remain
set until cleared by software or until a POR occurs.
5.1.2.2
Return Stack Pointer (STKPTR)
The STKPTR register (Register 5-1) contains the Stack
Pointer value, the STKFUL (Stack Full) status bit and
the STKUNF (Stack Underflow) status bits. The value
of the Stack Pointer can be 0 through 31. The Stack
Pointer increments before values are pushed onto the
stack and decrements after values are popped off the
stack. On Reset, the Stack Pointer value will be zero.
The user may read and write the Stack Pointer value.
This feature can be used by a Real-Time Operating
System (RTOS) for return stack maintenance.
Note:
Returning a value of zero to the PC on an
underflow has the effect of vectoring the
program to the Reset vector, where the
stack conditions can be verified and
appropriate actions can be taken. This is
not the same as a Reset, as the contents
of the SFRs are not affected.
After the PC is pushed onto the stack 31 times (without
popping any values off the stack), the STKFUL bit is
set. The STKFUL bit is cleared by software or by a
POR.
5.1.2.3
PUSH and POP Instructions
Since the Top-of-Stack is readable and writable, the
ability to push values onto the stack and pull values off
the stack, without disturbing normal program execu-
tion, is a desirable feature. The PIC18 instruction set
includes two instructions, PUSH and POP, that permit
the TOS to be manipulated under software control.
TOSU, TOSH and TOSL can be modified to place data
or a return address on the stack.
The action that takes place when the stack becomes
full depends on the state of the STVREN (Stack
Overflow Reset Enable) Configuration bit. (Refer to
Section 19.1 “Configuration Bits” for a description of
the device Configuration bits.) If STVREN is set
(default), the 31st push will push the (PC + 2) value
onto the stack, set the STKFUL bit and reset the
device. The STKFUL bit will remain set and the Stack
Pointer will be set to zero.
The PUSHinstruction places the current PC value onto
the stack. This increments the Stack Pointer and loads
the current PC value onto the stack.
If STVREN is cleared, the STKFUL bit will be set on the
31st push and the Stack Pointer will increment to 31.
Any additional pushes will not overwrite the 31st push
and STKPTR will remain at 31.
The POP instruction discards the current TOS by
decrementing the Stack Pointer. The previous value
pushed onto the stack then becomes the TOS value.
REGISTER 5-1:
STKPTR: STACK POINTER REGISTER
R/C-0
STKFUL(1)
bit 7
R/C-0
STKUNF(1)
U-0
—
R/W-0
SP4
R/W-0
SP3
R/W-0
SP2
R/W-0
SP1
R/W-0
SP0
bit 0
Legend:
C = Clearable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
R = Readable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
STKFUL: Stack Full Flag bit(1)
1= Stack became full or overflowed
0= Stack has not become full or overflowed
STKUNF: Stack Underflow Flag bit(1)
1= Stack underflow occurred
0= Stack underflow did not occur
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 4-0
SP4:SP0: Stack Pointer Location bits
Note 1: Bit 7 and bit 6 are cleared by user software or by a POR.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 47
PIC18F1230/1330
5.1.2.4
Stack Full and Underflow Resets
5.1.4
LOOK-UP TABLES IN PROGRAM
MEMORY
Device Resets on stack overflow and stack underflow
conditions are enabled by setting the STVREN bit in
Configuration Register 4L. When STVREN is set, a full
or underflow will set the appropriate STKFUL or
STKUNF bit and then cause a device Reset. When
STVREN is cleared, a full or underflow condition will set
the appropriate STKFUL or STKUNF bit but not cause
a device Reset. The STKFUL or STKUNF bit is cleared
by the user software or a Power-on Reset.
There may be programming situations that require the
creation of data structures, or look-up tables, in
program memory. For PIC18 devices, look-up tables
can be implemented in two ways:
• Computed GOTO
• Table Reads
5.1.4.1
Computed GOTO
5.1.3
FAST REGISTER STACK
A computed GOTOis accomplished by adding an offset
to the program counter. An example is shown in
Example 5-2.
A Fast Register Stack is provided for the STATUS,
WREG and BSR registers, to provide a “fast return”
option for interrupts. The stack for each register is only
one level deep and is neither readable nor writable. It is
loaded with the current value of the corresponding
register when the processor vectors for an interrupt. All
interrupt sources will push values into the Stack
registers. The values in the registers are then loaded
back into their associated registers if the
RETFIE, FASTinstruction is used to return from the
interrupt.
A look-up table can be formed with an ADDWF PCL
instruction and a group of RETLW nninstructions. The
W register is loaded with an offset into the table before
executing a call to that table. The first instruction of the
called routine is the ADDWF PCLinstruction. The next
instruction executed will be one of the RETLW nn
instructions that returns the value ‘nn’ to the calling
function.
The offset value (in WREG) specifies the number of
bytes that the program counter should advance and
should be multiples of 2 (LSb = 0).
If both low and high priority interrupts are enabled, the
Stack registers cannot be used reliably to return from
low priority interrupts. If a high priority interrupt occurs
while servicing a low priority interrupt, the Stack regis-
ter values stored by the low priority interrupt will be
overwritten. In these cases, users must save the key
registers in software during a low priority interrupt.
In this method, only one data byte may be stored in
each instruction location and room on the return
address stack is required.
EXAMPLE 5-2:
COMPUTED GOTO USING
If interrupt priority is not used, all interrupts may use the
Fast Register Stack for returns from interrupt. If no
interrupts are used, the Fast Register Stack can be
used to restore the STATUS, WREG and BSR registers
at the end of a subroutine call. To use the Fast Register
Stack for a subroutine call, a CALL label, FAST
instruction must be executed to save the STATUS,
WREG and BSR registers to the Fast Register Stack. A
RETURN, FASTinstruction is then executed to restore
these registers from the Fast Register Stack.
AN OFFSET VALUE
OFFSET, W
MOVF
CALL
TABLE
ORG
TABLE
nn00h
ADDWF
RETLW
RETLW
RETLW
.
PCL
nnh
nnh
nnh
.
.
Example 5-1 shows a source code example that uses
the Fast Register Stack during a subroutine call and
return.
5.1.4.2
Table Reads and Table Writes
A better method of storing data in program memory
allows two bytes of data to be stored in each instruction
location.
EXAMPLE 5-1:
FAST REGISTER STACK
CODE EXAMPLE
Look-up table data may be stored two bytes per
program word by using table reads and writes. The
Table Pointer (TBLPTR) register specifies the byte
address and the Table Latch (TABLAT) register
contains the data that is read from or written to program
memory. Data is transferred to or from program
memory one byte at a time.
CALL SUB1, FAST
;STATUS, WREG, BSR
;SAVED IN FAST REGISTER
;STACK
•
•
SUB1
•
•
Table read and table write operations are discussed
further in Section 6.1 “Table Reads and Table
Writes”.
RETURN, FAST ;RESTORE VALUES SAVED
;IN FAST REGISTER STACK
DS39758B-page 48
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
5.2.2
INSTRUCTION FLOW/PIPELINING
5.2
PIC18 Instruction Cycle
An “Instruction Cycle” consists of four Q cycles: Q1
through Q4. The instruction fetch and execute are
pipelined in such a manner that a fetch takes one
instruction cycle, while the decode and execute take
another instruction cycle. However, due to the
pipelining, each instruction effectively executes in one
cycle. If an instruction causes the program counter to
change (e.g., GOTO), then two cycles are required to
complete the instruction (Example 5-3).
5.2.1
CLOCKING SCHEME
The microcontroller clock input, whether from an
internal or external source, is internally divided by four
to generate four non-overlapping quadrature clocks
(Q1, Q2, Q3 and Q4). Internally, the program counter is
incremented on every Q1; the instruction is fetched
from the program memory and latched into the Instruc-
tion Register (IR) during Q4. The instruction is decoded
and executed during the following Q1 through Q4. The
clocks and instruction execution flow are shown in
Figure 5-3.
A fetch cycle begins with the Program Counter (PC)
incrementing in Q1.
In the execution cycle, the fetched instruction is latched
into the Instruction Register (IR) in cycle Q1. This
instruction is then decoded and executed during the
Q2, Q3 and Q4 cycles. Data memory is read during Q2
(operand read) and written during Q4 (destination
write).
FIGURE 5-3:
CLOCK/INSTRUCTION CYCLE
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q1
Q1
OSC1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Internal
Phase
Clock
PC
PC
PC + 2
PC + 4
OSC2/CLKO
(RC mode)
Execute INST (PC – 2)
Fetch INST (PC)
Execute INST (PC)
Fetch INST (PC + 2)
Execute INST (PC + 2)
Fetch INST (PC + 4)
EXAMPLE 5-3:
INSTRUCTION PIPELINE FLOW
TCY0
TCY1
TCY2
TCY3
TCY4
TCY5
1. MOVLW 55h
2. MOVWF PORTB
3. BRA SUB_1
Fetch 1
Execute 1
Fetch 2
Execute 2
Fetch 3
Execute 3
Fetch 4
4. BSF
PORTA, BIT3 (Forced NOP)
Flush (NOP)
Fetch SUB_1 Execute SUB_1
5. Instruction @ address SUB_1
All instructions are single cycle, except for any program branches. These take two cycles since the fetch instruction
is “flushed” from the pipeline while the new instruction is being fetched and then executed.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 49
PIC18F1230/1330
The CALL and GOTO instructions have the absolute
program memory address embedded into the
instruction. Since instructions are always stored on word
boundaries, the data contained in the instruction is a
word address. The word address is written to PC<20:1>,
which accesses the desired byte address in program
memory. Instruction #2 in Figure 5-4 shows how the
instruction, GOTO 0006h, is encoded in the program
memory. Program branch instructions, which encode a
relative address offset, operate in the same manner. The
offset value stored in a branch instruction represents the
number of single-word instructions that the PC will be
offset by. Section 21.0 “Instruction Set Summary”
provides further details of the instruction set.
5.2.3
INSTRUCTIONS IN PROGRAM
MEMORY
The program memory is addressed in bytes.
Instructions are stored as two bytes or four bytes in
program memory. The Least Significant Byte of an
instruction word is always stored in a program memory
location with an even address (LSb = 0). To maintain
alignment with instruction boundaries, the PC
increments in steps of 2 and the LSb will always read
‘0’ (see Section 5.1.1 “Program Counter”).
Figure 5-4 shows an example of how instruction words
are stored in the program memory.
FIGURE 5-4:
INSTRUCTIONS IN PROGRAM MEMORY
Word Address
LSB = 1
LSB = 0
↓
Program Memory
Byte Locations →
000000h
000002h
000004h
000006h
000008h
00000Ah
00000Ch
00000Eh
000010h
000012h
000014h
Instruction 1:
Instruction 2:
MOVLW
GOTO
055h
0006h
0Fh
EFh
F0h
C1h
F4h
55h
03h
00h
23h
56h
Instruction 3:
MOVFF
123h, 456h
and used by the instruction sequence. If the first word
is skipped for some reason and the second word is
executed by itself, a NOP is executed instead. This is
necessary for cases when the two-word instruction is
preceded by a conditional instruction that changes the
PC. Example 5-4 shows how this works.
5.2.4
TWO-WORD INSTRUCTIONS
The standard PIC18 instruction set has four two-word
instructions: CALL, MOVFF, GOTO and LSFR. In all
cases, the second word of the instructions always has
‘1111’ as its four Most Significant bits; the other 12 bits
are literal data, usually a data memory address.
Note:
See Section 5.6 “PIC18 Instruction
Execution and the Extended Instruc-
tion Set” for information on two-word
instructions in the extended instruction set.
The use of ‘1111’ in the 4 MSbs of an instruction
specifies a special form of NOP. If the instruction is
executed in proper sequence – immediately after the
first word – the data in the second word is accessed
EXAMPLE 5-4:
CASE 1:
TWO-WORD INSTRUCTIONS
Source Code
Object Code
0110 0110 0000 0000 TSTFSZ
REG1
REG1, REG2 ; No, skip this word
; Execute this word as a NOP
; continue code
; is RAM location 0?
1100 0001 0010 0011
1111 0100 0101 0110
0010 0100 0000 0000
CASE 2:
MOVFF
ADDWF
REG3
Object Code
Source Code
0110 0110 0000 0000
1100 0001 0010 0011
1111 0100 0101 0110
0010 0100 0000 0000
TSTFSZ
MOVFF
REG1
; is RAM location 0?
REG1, REG2 ; Yes, execute this word
; 2nd word of instruction
ADDWF
REG3
; continue code
DS39758B-page 50
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
5.3.1
BANK SELECT REGISTER (BSR)
5.3
Data Memory Organization
Large areas of data memory require an efficient
addressing scheme to make rapid access to any
address possible. Ideally, this means that an entire
address does not need to be provided for each read or
write operation. For PIC18 devices, this is
accomplished with a RAM banking scheme. This
divides the memory space into 16 contiguous banks of
256 bytes. Depending on the instruction, each location
can be addressed directly by its full 12-bit address, or
an 8-bit low-order address and a 4-bit Bank Pointer.
Note:
The operation of some aspects of data
memory are changed when the PIC18
extended instruction set is enabled. See
Section 5.5 “Data Memory and the
Extended Instruction Set” for more
information.
The data memory in PIC18 devices is implemented as
static RAM. Each register in the data memory has a
12-bit address, allowing up to 4096 bytes of data
memory. The memory space is divided into as many as
16 banks that contain 256 bytes each; PIC18F1230/
1330 devices implement 1 bank. Figure 5-5 shows the
data memory organization for the PIC18F1230/1330
devices.
Most instructions in the PIC18 instruction set make use
of the Bank Pointer, known as the Bank Select Register
(BSR). This SFR holds the four Most Significant bits of
a location’s address; the instruction itself includes the
eight Least Significant bits. Only the four lower bits of
the BSR are implemented (BSR3:BSR0). The upper
four bits are unused; they will always read ‘0’ and can-
not be written to. The BSR can be loaded directly by
using the MOVLBinstruction.
The data memory contains Special Function Registers
(SFRs) and General Purpose Registers (GPRs). The
SFRs are used for control and status of the controller
and peripheral functions, while GPRs are used for data
storage and scratchpad operations in the user’s
application. Any read of an unimplemented location will
read as ‘0’s.
The value of the BSR indicates the bank in data
memory. The 8 bits in the instruction show the location
in the bank and can be thought of as an offset from the
bank’s lower boundary. The relationship between the
BSR’s value and the bank division in data memory is
shown in Figure 5-6.
The instruction set and architecture allow operations
across all banks. The entire data memory may be
accessed by Direct, Indirect or Indexed Addressing
modes. Addressing modes are discussed later in this
subsection.
Since up to 16 registers may share the same low-order
address, the user must always be careful to ensure that
the proper bank is selected before performing a data
read or write. For example, writing what should be
program data to an 8-bit address of F9h, while the BSR
is 0Fh, will end up resetting the program counter.
To ensure that commonly used registers (SFRs and
select GPRs) can be accessed in a single cycle, PIC18
devices implement an Access Bank. This is a 256-byte
memory space that provides fast access to SFRs and
the lower portion of GPR Bank 0 without using the
BSR. Section 5.3.2 “Access Bank” provides a
detailed description of the Access RAM.
While any bank can be selected, only those banks that
are actually implemented can be read or written to.
Writes to unimplemented banks are ignored, while
reads from unimplemented banks will return ‘0’s. Even
so, the STATUS register will still be affected as if the
operation was successful. The data memory map in
Figure 5-5 indicates which banks are implemented.
In the core PIC18 instruction set, only the MOVFF
instruction fully specifies the 12-bit address of the
source and target registers. This instruction ignores the
BSR completely when it executes. All other instructions
include only the low-order address as an operand and
must use either the BSR or the Access Bank to locate
their target registers.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 51
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 5-5:
BSR<3:0>
= 0000
DATA MEMORY MAP FOR PIC18F1230/1330 DEVICES
When a = 0:
The BSR is ignored and the
Data Memory Map
Access Bank is used.
000h
07Fh
080h
0FFh
00h
FFh
Access RAM
GPR
The first 128 bytes are
general purpose RAM
(from Bank 0).
Bank 0
The second 128 bytes are
Special Function Registers
(from Bank 15).
When a = 1:
The BSR specifies the Bank
used by the instruction.
Access Bank
00h
Access RAM Low
7Fh
Access RAM High
= 0001
= 1110
Bank 1
Unused
Read ‘00h’
80h
to
(SFRs)
FFh
Bank 14
EFFh
F00h
F7Fh
F80h
FFFh
Unused
00h
FFh
= 1111
Read ‘00h’
Bank 15
SFR
DS39758B-page 52
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 5-6:
USE OF THE BANK SELECT REGISTER (DIRECT ADDRESSING)
(2)
(1)
From Opcode
BSR
7
7
0
0
Memory
Data
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
000h
100h
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
00h
Bank 0
FFh
00h
(2)
Bank Select
Bank 1
through
Bank 13
FFh
00h
E00h
Bank 14
Bank 15
FFh
00h
F00h
FFFh
FFh
Note 1: The Access RAM bit of the instruction can be used to force an override of the selected bank (BSR<3:0>) to
the registers of the Access Bank.
2: The MOVFF instruction embeds the entire 12-bit address in the instruction.
however, the instruction is forced to use the Access
Bank address map; the current value of the BSR is
ignored entirely.
5.3.2
ACCESS BANK
While the use of the BSR with an embedded 8-bit
address allows users to address the entire range of
data memory, it also means that the user must always
ensure that the correct bank is selected. Otherwise,
data may be read from or written to the wrong location.
This can be disastrous if a GPR is the intended target
of an operation, but an SFR is written to instead.
Verifying and/or changing the BSR for each read or
write to data memory can become very inefficient.
Using this “forced” addressing allows the instruction to
operate on a data address in a single cycle without
updating the BSR first. For 8-bit addresses of 80h and
above, this means that users can evaluate and operate
on SFRs more efficiently. The Access RAM below 80h
is a good place for data values that the user might need
to access rapidly, such as immediate computational
results or common program variables. Access RAM
also allows for faster and more code efficient context
saving and switching of variables.
To streamline access for the most commonly used data
memory locations, the data memory is configured with
an Access Bank, which allows users to access a
mapped block of memory without specifying a BSR.
The Access Bank consists of the first 128 bytes of
memory (00h-7Fh) in Bank 0 and the last 128 bytes of
memory (80h-FFh) in Block 15. The lower half is known
as the “Access RAM” and is composed of GPRs. The
upper half is where the device’s SFRs are mapped.
These two areas are mapped contiguously in the
Access Bank and can be addressed in a linear fashion
by an 8-bit address (Figure 5-5).
The mapping of the Access Bank is slightly different
when the extended instruction set is enabled (XINST
Configuration bit = 1). This is discussed in more detail
in Section 5.5.3 “Mapping the Access Bank in
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing Mode”.
5.3.3
GENERAL PURPOSE
REGISTER FILE
PIC18 devices may have banked memory in the GPR
area. This is data RAM which is available for use by all
instructions. GPRs start at the bottom of Bank 0
(address 000h) and grow upwards towards the bottom of
the SFR area. GPRs are not initialized by a Power-on
Reset and are unchanged on all other Resets.
The Access Bank is used by core PIC18 instructions
that include the Access RAM bit (the ‘a’ parameter in
the instruction). When ‘a’ is equal to ‘1’, the instruction
uses the BSR and the 8-bit address included in the
opcode for the data memory address. When ‘a’ is ‘0’,
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 53
PIC18F1230/1330
The SFRs can be classified into two sets: those
associated with the “core” device functionality (ALU,
Resets and interrupts) and those related to the
peripheral functions. The Reset and Interrupt registers
are described in their respective chapters, while the
ALU’s STATUS register is described later in this section.
Registers related to the operation of a peripheral feature
are described in the chapter for that peripheral.
5.3.4
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTERS
The Special Function Registers (SFRs) are registers
used by the CPU and peripheral modules for controlling
the desired operation of the device. These registers are
implemented as static RAM. SFRs start at the top of
data memory (FFFh) and extend downward to occupy
the top half of Bank 15 (F80h to FFFh). A list of these
registers is given in Table 5-1 and Table 5-2.
The SFRs are typically distributed among the
peripherals whose functions they control. Unused SFR
locations are unimplemented and read as ‘0’s.
TABLE 5-1:
Address
SPECIAL FUNCTION REGISTER MAP FOR PIC18F1230/1330 DEVICES
Name
Address
Name
INDF2(1)
Address
FBFh
Name
Address
F9Fh
Name
(2)
FFFh
FFEh
FFDh
FFCh
FFBh
FFAh
FF9h
FF8h
FF7h
FF6h
FF5h
FF4h
FF3h
FF2h
FF1h
FF0h
FEFh
TOSU
TOSH
FDFh
—
IPR1
PIR1
PIE1
FDEh POSTINC2(1)
FDDh POSTDEC2(1)
FDCh PREINC2(1)
FDBh PLUSW2(1)
FBEh
FBDh
FBCh
FBBh
FBAh
FB9h
—
F9Eh
F9Dh
F9Ch
(2)
(2)
TOSL
—
(2)
(2)
STKPTR
PCLATU
PCLATH
PCL
—
—
(2)
—
F9Bh OSCTUNE
(2)
FDAh
FD9h
FD8h
FD7h
FD6h
FD5h
FD4h
FD3h
FD2h
FD1h
FD0h
FCFh
FCEh
FCDh
FCCh
FCBh
FCAh
FC9h
FC8h
FC7h
FC6h
FC5h
FC4h
FC3h
FC2h
FC1h
FC0h
FSR2H
FSR2L
—
F9Ah
F99h
F98h
F97h
F96h
F95h
F94h
F93h
F92h
F91h
F90h
F8Fh
F8Eh
F8Dh
F8Ch
PTCON0
PTCON1
PTMRL
(2)
—
TBLPTRU
TBLPTRH
TBLPTRL
TABLAT
PRODH
PRODL
INTCON
INTCON2
INTCON3
INDF0(1)
STATUS
TMR0H
TMR0L
T0CON
FB8h BAUDCON
(2)
FB7h
FB6h
FB5h
FB4h
FB3h
FB2h
FB1h
FB0h
FAFh
FAEh
FADh
FACh
FABh
FAAh
FA9h
FA8h
—
—
PTMRH
PTPERL
PTPERH
(2)
CVRCON
CMCON
(2)
(2)
—
—
(2)
OSCCON
LVDCON
WDTCON
RCON
—
TRISB
TRISA
PDC0L
PDC0H
PDC1L
PDC1H
PDC2L
PDC2H
(2)
—
(2)
—
SPBRGH
SPBRG
RCREG
TXREG
TXSTA
TMR1H
TMR1L
FEEh POSTINC0(1)
FEDh POSTDEC0(1)
FECh PREINC0(1)
FEBh PLUSW0(1)
T1CON
(2)
—
(2)
—
RCSTA
F8Bh FLTCONFIG
(2)
(2)
FEAh
FE9h
FE8h
FE7h
FE6h POSTINC1(1)
FE5h POSTDEC1(1)
FE4h PREINC1(1)
FE3h PLUSW1(1)
FSR0H
FSR0L
WREG
INDF1(1)
—
—
F8Ah
F89h
LATB
LATA
(2)
—
EEADR
(2)
—
EEDATA
F88h SEVTCMPL
F87h SEVTCMPH
F86h PWMCON0
F85h PWMCON1
(2)
—
FA7h EECON2(1)
(2)
—
FA6h
FA5h
FA4h
FA3h
FA2h
FA1h
FA0h
EECON1
IPR3
(2)
—
ADRESH
ADRESL
ADCON0
ADCON1
ADCON2
PIR3
F84h
DTCON
PIE3
F83h OVDCOND
F82h OVDCONS
FE2h
FE1h
FE0h
FSR1H
FSR1L
BSR
IPR2
PIR2
F81h
F80h
PORTB
PORTA
PIE2
Note 1: This is not a physical register.
2: Unimplemented registers are read as ‘0’.
DS39758B-page 54
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 5-2:
File Name
TOSU
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F1230/1330)
Details
on
page:
Value on
POR, BOR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
—
—
—
Top-of-Stack Upper Byte (TOS<20:16>)
---0 0000 41, 46
0000 0000 41, 46
0000 0000 41, 46
00-0 0000 41, 47
---0 0000 41, 46
0000 0000 41, 46
0000 0000 41, 46
--00 0000 41, 68
0000 0000 41, 68
0000 0000 41, 68
0000 0000 41, 68
xxxx xxxx 41, 79
xxxx xxxx 41, 79
0000 000x 41, 89
TOSH
Top-of-Stack High Byte (TOS<15:8>)
TOSL
Top-of-Stack Low Byte (TOS<7:0>)
STKPTR
PCLATU
PCLATH
PCL
STKFUL(5) STKUNF(5)
—
—
SP4
SP3
SP2
SP1
SP0
—
—
Holding Register for PC<20:16>
Holding Register for PC<15:8>
PC Low Byte (PC<7:0>)
TBLPTRU
TBLPTRH
TBLPTRL
TABLAT
PRODH
PRODL
INTCON
—
—
bit 21
Program Memory Table Pointer Upper Byte (TBLPTR<20:16>)
Program Memory Table Pointer High Byte (TBLPTR<15:8>)
Program Memory Table Pointer Low Byte (TBLPTR<7:0>)
Program Memory Table Latch
Product Register High Byte
Product Register Low Byte
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
INTCON2
INTCON3
INDF0
RBPU
INTEDG0
INT1IP
INTEDG1
INT3IE
INTEDG2
INT2IE
INTEDG3
INT1IE
TMR0IP
INT3IF
INT3IP
INT2IF
RBIP
1111 1111 41, 90
1100 0000 41, 91
INT2IP
INT1IF
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 not changed (not a physical register)
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 post-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
41, 60
41, 60
41, 60
41, 60
41, 60
POSTINC0
POSTDEC0 Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 post-decremented (not a physical register)
PREINC0
PLUSW0
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
Uses contents of FSR0 to address data memory – value of FSR0 pre-incremented (not a physical register) –
value of FSR0 offset by W
FSR0H
FSR0L
—
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 0 High Byte
---- 0000 41, 60
xxxx xxxx 41, 60
xxxx xxxx 41, 48
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 0 Low Byte
Working Register
WREG
INDF1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 not changed (not a physical register)
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 post-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
41, 60
41, 60
41, 60
41, 60
41, 60
POSTINC1
POSTDEC1 Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 post-decremented (not a physical register)
PREINC1
PLUSW1
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
Uses contents of FSR1 to address data memory – value of FSR1 pre-incremented (not a physical register) –
value of FSR1 offset by W
FSR1H
FSR1L
BSR
—
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 1 High Byte
---- 0000 41, 60
xxxx xxxx 41, 60
---- 0000 41, 51
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 1 Low Byte
—
—
—
—
Bank Select Register
INDF2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 not changed (not a physical register)
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 post-incremented (not a physical register)
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
42, 60
42, 60
42, 60
42, 60
42, 60
POSTINC2
POSTDEC2 Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 post-decremented (not a physical register)
PREINC2
PLUSW2
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 pre-incremented (not a physical register)
Uses contents of FSR2 to address data memory – value of FSR2 pre-incremented (not a physical register) –
value of FSR2 offset by W
FSR2H
—
—
—
—
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 2 High Byte
---- 0000 42, 60
xxxx xxxx 42, 60
FSR2L
Indirect Data Memory Address Pointer 2 Low Byte
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 Configuration bits = 01; otherwise, it is disabled and
reads as ‘0’. See Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
2: The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC Modes”.
3: The RA5 bit is only available when Master Clear Reset is disabled (MCLRE Configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RA5 reads
as ‘0’. This bit is read-only.
4: RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary
oscillator modes. When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
5: Bit 7 and bit 6 are cleared by user software or by a POR.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
7: This bit has no effect if the Configuration bit, WDTEN, is enabled.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 55
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 5-2:
File Name
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F1230/1330) (CONTINUED)
Details
on
page:
Value on
POR, BOR
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
STATUS
—
—
—
N
OV
Z
DC
C
---x xxxx 42, 58
0000 0000 42, 103
xxxx xxxx 42, 103
1111 1111 42, 101
0100 q000 42, 22
--00 0101 42, 179
TMR0H
Timer0 Register High Byte
Timer0 Register Low Byte
TMR0L
T0CON
TMR0ON
IDLEN
—
T016BIT
IRCF2
—
T0CS
IRCF1
IRVST
—
T0SE
IRCF0
LVDEN
—
PSA
OSTS
LVDL3
—
T0PS2
IOFS
LVDL2
—
T0PS1
SCS1
LVDL1
—
T0PS0
SCS0
OSCCON
LVDCON
WDTCON
LVDL0
—
—
SWDTEN(7) ---- ---0 42, 195
RCON
IPEN
SBOREN(1)
—
RI
TO
PD
POR
BOR
0q-1 11q0 42, 34
xxxx xxxx 42, 109
xxxx xxxx 42, 109
TMR1H
TMR1L
T1CON
ADRESH
ADRESL
Timer1 Register High Byte
Timer1 Register Low Byte
RD16
T1RUN
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON 0000 0000 42, 105
xxxx xxxx 42, 172
A/D Result Register High Byte
A/D Result Register Low Byte
xxxx xxxx 42, 172
ADCON0
ADCON1
ADCON2
BAUDCON
CVRCON
CMCON
SPBRGH
SPBRG
RCREG
TXREG
TXSTA
RCSTA
EEADR
EEDATA
EECON2
EECON1
IPR3
SEVTEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
CHS1
PCFG3
ACQT0
BRG16
CVR3
—
CHS0
PCFG2
ADCS2
—
GO/DONE
PCFG1
ADCS1
WUE
ADON
PCFG0
ADCS0
ABDEN
CVR0
0--- 0000 42, 163
---0 1111 42, 164
0-00 0000 42, 165
01-0 0-00 42, 144
0-00 0000 42, 177
000- -000 42, 173
0000 0000 42, 146
0000 0000 42, 146
0000 0000 42, 153
0000 0000 42, 151
0000 0010 42, 142
0000 000x 42, 143
0000 0000 43, 75
0000 0000 43, 75
0000 0000 43, 66
xx-0 x000 42, 67
---1 ---- 43, 97
---0 ---- 43, 93
---0 ---- 43, 95
1--1 -1-- 43, 97
0--0 -0-- 43, 93
0--0 -0-- 43, 95
-111 1111 43, 96
-000 0000 43, 92
-000 0000 43, 94
00-0 0000 43, 19
VCFG0
ACQT1
SCKP
CVRSS
—
ADFM
—
ACQT2
—
ABDOVF
CVREN
C2OUT
RCIDL
—
CVRR
C0OUT
CVR2
CMEN2
CVR1
C1OUT
CMEN1
CMEN0
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
EUSART Receive Register
EUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
SPEN
TX9
RX9
TXEN
SREN
SYNC
CREN
SENDB
ADDEN
BRGH
FERR
TRMT
OERR
TX9D
RX9D
EEPROM Address Register
EEPROM Data Register
EEPROM Control Register 2 (not a physical register)
EEPGD
—
CFGS
—
—
—
FREE
PTIP
PTIF
WRERR
—
WREN
—
WR
—
RD
—
PIR3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PIE3
—
—
—
PTIE
EEIP
EEIF
EEIE
TXIP
TXIF
TXIE
TUN4
PTOPS0
—
—
—
—
—
IPR2
OSCFIP
OSCFIF
OSCFIE
—
—
—
—
LVDIP
LVDIF
LVDIE
CMP1IP
CMP1IF
CMP1IE
TUN2
PTCKPS0
—
—
—
PIR2
—
—
—
—
—
PIE2
—
—
—
—
—
IPR1
ADIP
ADIF
ADIE
PLLEN(2)
PTOPS2
PTDIR
RCIP
RCIF
RCIE
—
CMP2IP
CMP2IF
CMP2IE
TUN3
PTCKPS1
—
CMP0IP
CMP0IF
CMP0IE
TUN1
PTMOD1
—
TMR1IP
TMR1IF
TMR1IE
TUN0
PIR1
—
PIE1
—
OSCTUNE
PTCON0
PTCON1
Legend:
INTSRC
PTOPS3
PTEN
PTOPS1
—
PTMOD0 0000 0000 43, 116
00-- ---- 43, 116
—
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 Configuration bits = 01; otherwise, it is disabled and
reads as ‘0’. See Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
2: The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC Modes”.
3: The RA5 bit is only available when Master Clear Reset is disabled (MCLRE Configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RA5 reads
as ‘0’. This bit is read-only.
4: RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary
oscillator modes. When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
5: Bit 7 and bit 6 are cleared by user software or by a POR.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
7: This bit has no effect if the Configuration bit, WDTEN, is enabled.
DS39758B-page 56
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 5-2:
REGISTER FILE SUMMARY (PIC18F1230/1330) (CONTINUED)
Details
on
page:
Value on
POR, BOR
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
PTMRL
PTMRH
PTPERL
PTPERH
TRISB
PWM Time Base Register (lower 8 bits)
0000 0000 43, 119
---- 0000 43, 119
1111 1111 43, 119
---- 1111 43, 119
1111 1111 43, 84
1111 1111 43, 81
0000 0000 43, 125
--00 0000 43, 125
0000 0000 43, 125
--00 0000 43, 125
0000 0000 43, 125
--00 0000 43, 125
0--- -000 43, 137
xxxx xxxx 43, 84
xxxx xxxx 43, 81
0000 0000 43, 138
---- 0000 44, 138
-100 -000 44, 117
-000 -000
—
—
—
—
PWM Time Base Register (upper 4 bits)
PWM Time Base Period Register (lower 8 bits)
—
—
—
—
PWM Time Base Period Register (upper 4 bits)
PORTB Data Direction Control Register
TRISA7(4) TRISA6(4) PORTA Data Direction Control Register
PWM Duty Cycle #0L Register (lower 8 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #0H Register (upper 6 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #1L Register (lower 8 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #1H Register (upper 6 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #2L Register (lower 8 bits)
TRISA
PDC0L
PDC0H
PDC1L
PDC1H
PDC2L
PDC2H
FLTCONFIG
LATB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PWM Duty Cycle #2H Register (upper 6 bits)
BRFEN
—
—
—
FLTAS
FLTAMOD
FLTAEN
PORTB Data Latch Register (Read and Write to Data Latch)
LATA7(4) LATA6(4) PORTA Data Latch Register (Read and Write to Data Latch)
LATA
SEVTCMPL PWM Special Event Compare Register (lower 8 bits)
SEVTCMPH
PWMCON0
—
—
—
—
—
PWM Special Event Compare Register (upper 4 bits)
PWMEN2(6) PWMEN1(6) PWMEN0(6)
—
PMOD2
PMOD1
PMOD0
PWMCON1
DTCON
SEVOPS3
DTPS1
—
SEVOPS2
DTPS0
—
SEVOPS1
DT5
SEVOPS0
DT4
SEVTDIR
DT3
—
UDIS
DT1
OSYNC
DT0
0000 0-00 44, 118
0000 0000 44, 130
--11 1111 44, 134
--00 0000 44, 134
xxxx xxxx 44, 84
xx0x xxxx 44, 81
DT2
OVDCOND
OVDCONS
PORTB
POVD5
POUT5
RB5
POVD4
POUT4
RB4
POVD3
POUT3
RB3
POVD2
POUT2
RB2
POVD1
POUT1
RB1
POVD0
POUT0
RB0
—
—
RB7
RA7(4)
RB6
RA6(4)
PORTA
RA5(3)
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
Legend:
x= unknown, u= unchanged, -= unimplemented, q= value depends on condition
Note 1: The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 Configuration bits = 01; otherwise, it is disabled and
reads as ‘0’. See Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
2: The PLLEN bit is only available in specific oscillator configuration; otherwise, it is disabled and reads as ‘0’. See
Section 2.6.4 “PLL in INTOSC Modes”.
3: The RA5 bit is only available when Master Clear Reset is disabled (MCLRE Configuration bit = 0); otherwise, RA5 reads
as ‘0’. This bit is read-only.
4: RA6/RA7 and their associated latch and direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary
oscillator modes. When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
5: Bit 7 and bit 6 are cleared by user software or by a POR.
6: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit of CONFIG3L.
7: This bit has no effect if the Configuration bit, WDTEN, is enabled.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 57
PIC18F1230/1330
It is recommended that only BCF, BSF, SWAPF, MOVFF
and MOVWFinstructions are used to alter the STATUS
register because these instructions do not affect the Z,
C, DC, OV or N bits in the STATUS register.
5.3.5
STATUS REGISTER
The STATUS register, shown in Register 5-2, contains
the arithmetic status of the ALU. As with any other SFR,
it can be the operand for any instruction.
For other instructions that do not affect Status bits, see
the instruction set summaries in Table 21-2 and
Table 21-3.
If the STATUS register is the destination for an instruc-
tion that affects the Z, DC, C, OV or N bits, the results
of the instruction are not written; instead, the STATUS
register is updated according to the instruction
performed. Therefore, the result of an instruction with
the STATUS register as its destination may be different
than intended. As an example, CLRF STATUSwill set
the Z bit and leave the remaining Status bits
unchanged (‘000u u1uu’).
Note:
The C and DC bits operate as the borrow
and digit borrow bits, respectively, in
subtraction.
REGISTER 5-2:
STATUS REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
U-0
—
R/W-x
N
R/W-x
OV
R/W-x
Z
R/W-x
DC(1)
R/W-x
C(2)
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
N: Negative bit
This bit is used for signed arithmetic (2’s complement). It indicates whether the result was
negative (ALU MSB = 1).
1= Result was negative
0= Result was positive
bit 3
OV: Overflow bit
This bit is used for signed arithmetic (2’s complement). It indicates an overflow of the 7-bit
magnitude which causes the sign bit (bit 7 of the result) to change state.
1= Overflow occurred for signed arithmetic (in this arithmetic operation)
0= No overflow occurred
bit 2
bit 1
Z: Zero bit
1= The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is zero
0= The result of an arithmetic or logic operation is not zero
DC: Digit Carry/borrow bit(1)
For ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLWand SUBWFinstructions:
1= A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result occurred
0= No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit of the result
bit 0
C: Carry/borrow bit(2)
For ADDWF, ADDLW, SUBLWand SUBWFinstructions:
1= A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
0= No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred
Note 1: For borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the 2’s complement of the second
operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either bit 4 or bit 3 of the source register.
2: For borrow, the polarity is reversed. A subtraction is executed by adding the 2’s complement of the second
operand. For rotate (RRF, RLF) instructions, this bit is loaded with either the high or low-order bit of the
source register.
DS39758B-page 58
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The Access RAM bit ‘a’ determines how the address is
interpreted. When ‘a’ is ‘1’, the contents of the BSR
(Section 5.3.1 “Bank Select Register (BSR)”) are
used with the address to determine the complete 12-bit
address of the register. When ‘a’ is ‘0’, the address is
interpreted as being a register in the Access Bank.
Addressing that uses the Access RAM is sometimes
also known as Direct Forced Addressing mode.
5.4
Data Addressing Modes
Note:
The execution of some instructions in the
core PIC18 instruction set are changed
when the PIC18 extended instruction set is
enabled. See Section 5.5 “Data Memory
and the Extended Instruction Set” for
more information.
A few instructions, such as MOVFF, include the entire
12-bit address (either source or destination) in their
opcodes. In these cases, the BSR is ignored entirely.
The data memory space can be addressed in several
ways. For most instructions, the addressing mode is
fixed. Other instructions may use up to three modes,
depending on which operands are used and whether or
not the extended instruction set is enabled.
The destination of the operation’s results is determined
by the destination bit ‘d’. When ‘d’ is ‘1’, the results are
stored back in the source register, overwriting its
original contents. When ‘d’ is ‘0’, the results are stored
in the W register. Instructions without the ‘d’ argument
have a destination that is implicit in the instruction; their
destination is either the target register being operated
on or the W register.
The addressing modes are:
• Inherent
• Literal
• Direct
• Indirect
An additional addressing mode, Indexed Literal Offset,
is available when the extended instruction set is
enabled (XINST Configuration bit = 1). Its operation is
discussed in greater detail in Section 5.5.1 “Indexed
Addressing with Literal Offset”.
5.4.3
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
Indirect Addressing allows the user to access a location
in data memory without giving a fixed address in the
instruction. This is done by using File Select Registers
(FSRs) as pointers to the locations to be read or written
to. Since the FSRs are themselves located in RAM as
Special Function Registers, they can also be directly
manipulated under program control. This makes FSRs
very useful in implementing data structures, such as
tables and arrays in data memory.
5.4.1
INHERENT AND LITERAL
ADDRESSING
Many PIC18 control instructions do not need any
argument at all; they either perform an operation that
globally affects the device or they operate implicitly on
one register. This addressing mode is known as Inherent
Addressing. Examples include SLEEP, RESETand DAW.
The registers for Indirect Addressing are also
implemented with Indirect File Operands (INDFs) that
permit automatic manipulation of the pointer value with
auto-incrementing, auto-decrementing or offsetting
with another value. This allows for efficient code, using
loops, such as the example of clearing an entire RAM
bank in Example 5-5.
Other instructions work in a similar way but require an
additional explicit argument in the opcode. This is
known as Literal Addressing mode because they
require some literal value as an argument. Examples
include ADDLWand MOVLW, which respectively, add or
move a literal value to the W register. Other examples
include CALL and GOTO, which include a 20-bit
program memory address.
EXAMPLE 5-5:
HOW TO CLEAR RAM
(BANK 0) USING
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
5.4.2
DIRECT ADDRESSING
LFSR
CLRF
FSR0, 00h
POSTINC0
;
NEXT
; Clear INDF
; register then
; inc pointer
; All done with
; Bank0?
Direct Addressing specifies all or part of the source
and/or destination address of the operation within the
opcode itself. The options are specified by the
arguments accompanying the instruction.
BTFSS FSR0H, 0
BRA NEXT
; NO, clear next
; YES, continue
In the core PIC18 instruction set, bit-oriented and byte-
oriented instructions use some version of Direct
Addressing by default. All of these instructions include
some 8-bit literal address as their Least Significant
Byte. This address specifies either a register address in
one of the banks of data RAM (Section 5.3.3 “General
Purpose Register File”) or a location in the Access
Bank (Section 5.3.2 “Access Bank”) as the data
source for the instruction.
CONTINUE
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 59
PIC18F1230/1330
5.4.3.1
FSR Registers and the
INDF Operand
5.4.3.2
FSR Registers and POSTINC,
POSTDEC, PREINC and PLUSW
At the core of Indirect Addressing are three sets of
registers: FSR0, FSR1 and FSR2. Each represents a
pair of 8-bit registers, FSRnH and FSRnL. The four
upper bits of the FSRnH register are not used so each
FSR pair holds a 12-bit value. This represents a value
that can address the entire range of the data memory
in a linear fashion. The FSR register pairs, then, serve
as pointers to data memory locations.
In addition to the INDF operand, each FSR register pair
also has four additional indirect operands. Like INDF,
these are “virtual” registers that cannot be indirectly
read or written to. Accessing these registers actually
accesses the associated FSR register pair, but also
performs a specific action on its stored value. They are:
• POSTDEC: accesses the FSR value, then
automatically decrements it by 1 afterwards
Indirect Addressing is accomplished with a set of
Indirect File Operands, INDF0 through INDF2. These
can be thought of as “virtual” registers: they are
mapped in the SFR space but are not physically
implemented. Reading or writing to a particular INDF
register actually accesses its corresponding FSR
register pair. A read from INDF1, for example, reads
the data at the address indicated by FSR1H:FSR1L.
Instructions that use the INDF registers as operands
actually use the contents of their corresponding FSR as
a pointer to the instruction’s target. The INDF operand
is just a convenient way of using the pointer.
• POSTINC: accesses the FSR value, then
automatically increments it by 1 afterwards
• PREINC: increments the FSR value by 1, then
uses it in the operation
• PLUSW: adds the signed value of the W register
(range of -127 to 128) to that of the FSR and uses
the new value in the operation.
In this context, accessing an INDF register uses the
value in the FSR registers without changing them. Sim-
ilarly, accessing a PLUSW register gives the FSR value
offset by that in the W register; neither value is actually
changed in the operation. Accessing the other virtual
registers changes the value of the FSR registers.
Because Indirect Addressing uses a full 12-bit address,
data RAM banking is not necessary. Thus, the current
contents of the BSR and the Access RAM bit have no
effect on determining the target address.
Operations on the FSRs with POSTDEC, POSTINC
and PREINC affect the entire register pair; that is, roll-
overs of the FSRnL register from FFh to 00h carry over
to the FSRnH register. On the other hand, results of
these operations do not change the value of any flags
in the STATUS register (e.g., Z, N, OV, etc.).
FIGURE 5-7:
INDIRECT ADDRESSING
000h
Using an instruction with one of the
indirect addressing registers as the
operand....
Bank 0
Bank 1
ADDWF, INDF1, 1
100h
200h
300h
Bank 2
FSR1H:FSR1L
...uses the 12-bit address stored in
the FSR pair associated with that
register....
7
0
7
0
Bank 3
through
Bank 13
x x x x 1 1 1 0
1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0
...to determine the data memory
location to be used in that operation.
E00h
In this case, the FSR1 pair contains
ECCh. This means the contents of
location ECCh will be added to that
of the W register and stored back in
ECCh.
Bank 14
Bank 15
F00h
FFFh
Data Memory
DS39758B-page 60
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The PLUSW register can be used to implement a form
of Indexed Addressing in the data memory space. By
manipulating the value in the W register, users can
reach addresses that are fixed offsets from pointer
addresses. In some applications, this can be used to
implement some powerful program control structure,
such as software stacks, inside of data memory.
5.5.1
INDEXED ADDRESSING WITH
LITERAL OFFSET
Enabling the PIC18 extended instruction set changes
the behavior of Indirect Addressing using the FSR2
register pair within Access RAM. Under the proper
conditions, instructions that use the Access Bank – that
is, most bit-oriented and byte-oriented instructions – can
invoke a form of Indexed Addressing using an offset
specified in the instruction. This special addressing
mode is known as Indexed Addressing with Literal
Offset, or Indexed Literal Offset mode.
5.4.3.3
Operations by FSRs on FSRs
Indirect Addressing operations that target other FSRs
or virtual registers represent special cases. For
example, using an FSR to point to one of the virtual
registers will not result in successful operations. As a
specific case, assume that FSR0H:FSR0L contains
FE7h, the address of INDF1. Attempts to read the
value of the INDF1 using INDF0 as an operand will
return 00h. Attempts to write to INDF1 using INDF0 as
the operand will result in a NOP.
When using the extended instruction set, this
addressing mode requires the following:
• The use of the Access Bank is forced (‘a’ = 0);
and
• The file address argument is less than or equal to
5Fh.
On the other hand, using the virtual registers to write to
an FSR pair may not occur as planned. In these cases,
the value will be written to the FSR pair but without any
incrementing or decrementing. Thus, writing to INDF2
or POSTDEC2 will write the same value to the
FSR2H:FSR2L.
Under these conditions, the file address of the
instruction is not interpreted as the lower byte of an
address (used with the BSR in Direct Addressing), or
as an 8-bit address in the Access Bank. Instead, the
value is interpreted as an offset value to an Address
Pointer, specified by FSR2. The offset and the contents
of FSR2 are added to obtain the target address of the
operation.
Since the FSRs are physical registers mapped in the
SFR space, they can be manipulated through all direct
operations. Users should proceed cautiously when
working on these registers, particularly if their code
uses Indirect Addressing.
5.5.2
INSTRUCTIONS AFFECTED BY
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
Any of the core PIC18 instructions that can use Direct
Addressing are potentially affected by the Indexed
Literal Offset Addressing mode. This includes all
byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions, or almost
one-half of the standard PIC18 instruction set.
Instructions that only use Inherent or Literal Addressing
modes are unaffected.
Similarly, operations by Indirect Addressing are gener-
ally permitted on all other SFRs. Users should exercise
the appropriate caution that they do not inadvertently
change settings that might affect the operation of the
device.
5.5
Data Memory and the Extended
Instruction Set
Additionally, byte-oriented and bit-oriented instructions
are not affected if they do not use the Access Bank
(Access RAM bit is ‘1’), or include a file address of 60h
or above. Instructions meeting these criteria will
continue to execute as before. A comparison of the
different possible addressing modes when the
extended instruction set is enabled is shown in
Figure 5-8.
Enabling the PIC18 extended instruction set (XINST
Configuration bit = 1) significantly changes certain
aspects of data memory and its addressing. Specifically,
the use of the Access Bank for many of the core PIC18
instructions is different; this is due to the introduction of
a new addressing mode for the data memory space.
What does not change is just as important. The size of
the data memory space is unchanged, as well as its
linear addressing. The SFR map remains the same.
Core PIC18 instructions can still operate in both Direct
and Indirect Addressing mode; inherent and literal
instructions do not change at all. Indirect Addressing
with FSR0 and FSR1 also remains unchanged.
Those who desire to use bit-oriented or byte-oriented
instructions in the Indexed Literal Offset mode should
note the changes to assembler syntax for this mode.
This is described in more detail in Section 21.2.1
“Extended Instruction Syntax”.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 61
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 5-8:
COMPARING ADDRESSING OPTIONS FOR BIT-ORIENTED AND
BYTE-ORIENTED INSTRUCTIONS (EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET ENABLED)
EXAMPLE INSTRUCTION: ADDWF, f, d, a (Opcode: 0010 01da ffff ffff)
000h
When ‘a’ = 0 and f ≥ 60h:
The instruction executes in
060h
080h
Direct Forced mode. ‘f’ is
interpreted as a location in the
Access RAM between 060h
and 0FFh. This is the same as
locations 060h to 07Fh
(Bank 0) and F80h to FFFh
(Bank 15) of data memory.
Bank 0
100h
00h
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
60h
80h
Valid range
for ‘f’
FFh
Access RAM
F00h
Locations below 60h are not
available in this addressing
mode.
Bank 15
SFRs
F80h
FFFh
Data Memory
When ‘a’ = 0 and f ≤ 5Fh:
000h
080h
100h
Bank 0
The instruction executes in
Indexed Literal Offset mode. ‘f’
is interpreted as an offset to the
address value in FSR2. The
two are added together to
obtain the address of the target
register for the instruction. The
address can be anywhere in
the data memory space.
001001da ffffffff
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
FSR2H
FSR2L
F00h
F80h
Note that in this mode, the
correct syntax is now:
ADDWF [k], d
Bank 15
SFRs
where ‘k’ is the same as ‘f’.
FFFh
Data Memory
BSR
000h
080h
100h
00000000
When ‘a’ = 1 (all values of f):
Bank 0
The instruction executes in
Direct mode (also known as
Direct Long mode). ‘f’ is
interpreted as a location in
one of the 16 banks of the data
memory space. The bank is
designated by the Bank Select
Register (BSR). The address
can be in any implemented
bank in the data memory
space.
001001da ffffffff
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
F00h
F80h
Bank 15
SFRs
FFFh
Data Memory
DS39758B-page 62
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Remapping of the Access Bank applies only to
operations using the Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode. Operations that use the BSR (Access RAM bit is
‘1’) will continue to use Direct Addressing as before.
5.5.3
MAPPING THE ACCESS BANK IN
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET
ADDRESSING MODE
The use of Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
effectively changes how the first 96 locations of Access
RAM (00h to 5Fh) are mapped. Rather than containing
just the contents of the bottom half of Bank 0, this mode
maps the contents from Bank 0 and a user-defined
“window” that can be located anywhere in the data
memory space. The value of FSR2 establishes the
lower boundary of the addresses mapped into the
window, while the upper boundary is defined by FSR2
plus 95 (5Fh). Addresses in the Access RAM above
5Fh are mapped as previously described (see
Section 5.3.2 “Access Bank”). An example of Access
Bank remapping in this addressing mode is shown in
Figure 5-9.
5.6
PIC18 Instruction Execution and
the Extended Instruction Set
Enabling the extended instruction set adds eight
additional commands to the existing PIC18 instruction
set. These instructions are executed as described in
Section 21.2 “Extended Instruction Set”.
FIGURE 5-9:
REMAPPING THE ACCESS BANK WITH INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET
ADDRESSING MODE
Example Situation:
ADDWF f, d, a
000h
Bank 0
05Fh
07Fh
090h
FSR2H:FSR2L = 090h
Locations in the region
from the FSR2 Pointer
(090h) to the pointer plus
05Fh (0EFh) are mapped
to the bottom of the
Access RAM (000h-05Fh).
Window
Bank 0
0EFh
100h
00h
Bank 0 “Window”
5Fh
Locations in Bank 0 from
060h to 07Fh are mapped,
as usual, to the middle of
the Access Bank.
Bank 0
7Fh
80h
Bank 1
through
Bank 14
SFRs
Special Function Registers
at F80h through FFFh are
mapped to 80h through
FFh, as usual.
FFh
Access Bank
F00h
Bank 0 addresses below
5Fh can still be addressed
by using the BSR.
Bank 15
SFRs
F80h
FFFh
Data Memory
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 63
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 64
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
6.1
Table Reads and Table Writes
6.0
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
In order to read and write program memory, there are
two operations that allow the processor to move bytes
between the program memory space and the data RAM:
The Flash program memory is readable, writable and
erasable during normal operation over the entire VDD
range.
• Table Read (TBLRD)
• Table Write (TBLWT)
A read from program memory is executed on one byte
at a time. A write to program memory is executed on
blocks of 8 bytes at a time. Program memory is erased
in blocks of 64 bytes at a time. A bulk erase operation
may not be issued from user code.
The program memory space is 16 bits wide, while the
data RAM space is 8 bits wide. Table reads and table
writes move data between these two memory spaces
through an 8-bit register (TABLAT).
Writing or erasing program memory will cease
instruction fetches until the operation is complete. The
program memory cannot be accessed during the write
or erase, therefore, code cannot execute. An internal
programming timer terminates program memory writes
and erases.
Table read operations retrieve data from program
memory and place it into the data RAM space.
Figure 6-1 shows the operation of a table read with
program memory and data RAM.
Table write operations store data from the data memory
space into holding registers in program memory. The
procedure to write the contents of the holding registers
into program memory is detailed in Section 6.5 “Writing
to Flash Program Memory”. Figure 6-2 shows the
operation of a table write with program memory and data
RAM.
A value written to program memory does not need to be
a valid instruction. Executing a program memory
location that forms an invalid instruction results in a
NOP.
Table operations work with byte entities. A table block
containing data, rather than program instructions, is not
required to be word-aligned. Therefore, a table block can
start and end at any byte address. If a table write is being
used to write executable code into program memory,
program instructions will need to be word-aligned.
FIGURE 6-1:
TABLE READ OPERATION
Instruction: TBLRD*
Program Memory
(1)
Table Pointer
Table Latch (8-bit)
TABLAT
TBLPTRU TBLPTRH TBLPTRL
Program Memory
(TBLPTR)
Note 1: Table Pointer register points to a byte in program memory.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 65
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 6-2:
TABLE WRITE OPERATION
Instruction: TBLWT*
Program Memory
Holding Registers
(1)
Table Pointer
TBLPTRU TBLPTRH TBLPTRL
Table Latch (8-bit)
TABLAT
Program Memory
(TBLPTR)
Note 1: Table Pointer actually points to one of 8 holding registers, the address of which is determined by
TBLPTRL<5:0>. The process for physically writing data to the program memory array is discussed in
Section 6.5 “Writing to Flash Program Memory”.
The FREE bit, when set, will allow a program memory
erase operation. When FREE is set, the erase
operation is initiated on the next WR command. When
FREE is clear, only writes are enabled.
6.2
Control Registers
Several control registers are used in conjunction with
the TBLRDand TBLWTinstructions. These include the:
• EECON1 register
• EECON2 register
• TABLAT register
• TBLPTR registers
The WREN bit, when set, will allow a write operation.
On power-up, the WREN bit is clear. The WRERR bit is
set in hardware when the WR bit is set and cleared
when the internal programming timer expires and the
write operation is complete.
6.2.1
EECON1 AND EECON2 REGISTERS
Note:
During normal operation, the WRERR
may read as ‘1’. This can indicate that a
write operation was prematurely termi-
nated by a Reset, or a write operation was
attempted improperly.
The EECON1 register (Register 6-1) is the control
register for memory accesses. The EECON2 register is
not a physical register; it is used exclusively in the
memory write and erase sequences. Reading
EECON2 will read all ‘0’s.
The WR control bit initiates write operations. The bit
cannot be cleared, only set, in software; it is cleared in
hardware at the completion of the write operation.
The EEPGD control bit determines if the access will be
a program or data EEPROM memory access. When
clear, any subsequent operations will operate on the
data EEPROM memory. When set, any subsequent
operations will operate on the program memory.
Note:
The EEIF interrupt flag bit (PIR2<4>) is set
when the write is complete. It must be
cleared in software.
The CFGS control bit determines if the access will be
to the Configuration/Calibration registers or to program
memory/data EEPROM memory. When set,
subsequent operations will operate on Configuration
registers regardless of EEPGD (see Section 19.0
“Special Features of the CPU”). When clear, memory
selection access is determined by EEPGD.
DS39758B-page 66
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 6-1:
EECON1: EEPROM CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-x
EEPGD
bit 7
R/W-x
CFGS
U-0
—
R/W-0
FREE
R/W-x
WRERR(1)
R/W-0
WREN
R/S-0
WR
R/S-0
RD
bit 0
Legend:
S = Settable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
EEPGD: Flash Program or Data EEPROM Memory Select bit
1= Access Flash program memory
0= Access data EEPROM memory
CFGS: Flash Program/Data EEPROM or Configuration Select bit
1= Access Configuration registers
0= Access Flash program or data EEPROM memory
bit 5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
FREE: Flash Row Erase Enable bit
1= Erase the program memory row addressed by TBLPTR on the next WR command
(cleared by completion of erase operation)
0= Perform write-only
bit 3
WRERR: Flash Program/Data EEPROM Error Flag bit(1)
1= A write operation is prematurely terminated (any Reset during self-timed programming in normal
operation, or an improper write attempt)
0= The write operation completed
bit 2
bit 1
WREN: Flash Program/Data EEPROM Write Enable bit
1= Allows write cycles to Flash program/data EEPROM
0= Inhibits write cycles to Flash program/data EEPROM
WR: Write Control bit
1= Initiates a data EEPROM erase/write cycle or a program memory erase cycle or write cycle.
(The operation is self-timed and the bit is cleared by hardware once write is complete.
The WR bit can only be set (not cleared) in software.)
0= Write cycle to the EEPROM is complete
bit 0
RD: Read Control bit
1= Initiates an EEPROM read. (Read takes one cycle. RD is cleared in hardware. The RD bit can only
be set (not cleared) in software. RD bit cannot be set when EEPGD = 1or CFGS = 1.)
0= Does not initiate an EEPROM read
Note 1: When a WRERR occurs, the EEPGD and CFGS bits are not cleared. This allows tracing of the error
condition.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 67
PIC18F1230/1330
6.2.2
TABLAT – TABLE LATCH REGISTER
6.2.4
TABLE POINTER BOUNDARIES
The Table Latch (TABLAT) is an 8-bit register mapped
into the SFR space. The Table Latch register is used to
hold 8-bit data during data transfers between program
memory and data RAM.
TBLPTR is used in reads, writes and erases of the
Flash program memory.
When a TBLRDis executed, all 22 bits of the TBLPTR
determine which byte is read from program memory
into TABLAT.
6.2.3
TBLPTR – TABLE POINTER
REGISTER
When a TBLWTis executed, the three LSbs of the Table
Pointer register (TBLPTR<2:0>) determine which of the
8 program memory holding registers is written to. When
the timed write to program memory begins (via the WR
bit), the 19 MSbs of the TBLPTR (TBLPTR<21:3>)
determine which program memory block of 8 bytes is
written to. For more detail, see Section 6.5 “Writing to
Flash Program Memory”.
The Table Pointer (TBLPTR) register addresses a byte
within the program memory. The TBLPTR is comprised
of three SFR registers: Table Pointer Upper Byte, Table
Pointer High Byte and Table Pointer Low Byte
(TBLPTRU:TBLPTRH:TBLPTRL).
These
three
registers join to form a 22-bit wide pointer. The low-
order 21 bits allow the device to address up to 2 Mbytes
of program memory space. The 22nd bit allows access
to the device ID, the user ID and the Configuration bits.
When an erase of program memory is executed, the
16 MSbs of the Table Pointer register (TBLPTR<21:6>)
point to the 64-byte block that will be erased. The Least
Significant bits (TBLPTR<5:0>) are ignored.
The Table Pointer register, TBLPTR, is used by the
TBLRDand TBLWTinstructions. These instructions can
update the TBLPTR in one of four ways based on the
table operation. These operations are shown in
Table 6-1. These operations on the TBLPTR only affect
the low-order 21 bits.
Figure 6-3 describes the relevant boundaries of
TBLPTR based on Flash program memory operations.
TABLE 6-1:
Example
TABLE POINTER OPERATIONS WITH TBLRD AND TBLWT INSTRUCTIONS
Operation on Table Pointer
TBLRD*
TBLWT*
TBLPTR is not modified
TBLRD*+
TBLWT*+
TBLPTR is incremented after the read/write
TBLPTR is decremented after the read/write
TBLPTR is incremented before the read/write
TBLRD*-
TBLWT*-
TBLRD+*
TBLWT+*
FIGURE 6-3:
TABLE POINTER BOUNDARIES BASED ON OPERATION
21
16 15
TBLPTRH
8
7
TBLPTRL
0
TBLPTRU
TABLE ERASE/WRITE
TBLPTR<21:6>
TABLE WRITE
TBLPTR<5:0>
TABLE READ – TBLPTR<21:0>
DS39758B-page 68
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The internal program memory is typically organized by
words. The Least Significant bit of the address selects
between the high and low bytes of the word. Figure 6-4
shows the interface between the internal program
memory and the TABLAT.
6.3
Reading the Flash Program
Memory
The TBLRD instruction is used to retrieve data from
program memory and places it into data RAM. Table
reads from program memory are performed one byte at
a time.
TBLPTR points to a byte address in program space.
Executing TBLRD places the byte pointed to into
TABLAT. In addition, TBLPTR can be modified
automatically for the next table read operation.
FIGURE 6-4:
READS FROM FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
Program Memory
(Even Byte Address)
(Odd Byte Address)
TBLPTR = xxxxx1
TBLPTR = xxxxx0
Instruction Register
(IR)
TABLAT
Read Register
FETCH
TBLRD
EXAMPLE 6-1:
READING A FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY WORD
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; Load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the word
READ_WORD
TBLRD*+
MOVF
MOVWF
TBLRD*+
MOVF
; read into TABLAT and increment
; get data
TABLAT, W
WORD_EVEN
; read into TABLAT and increment
; get data
TABLAT, W
WORD_ODD
MOVWF
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 69
PIC18F1230/1330
6.4.1
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
ERASE SEQUENCE
6.4
Erasing Flash Program Memory
The minimum erase block is 32 words or 64 bytes. Only
through the use of an external programmer, or through
ICSP control, can larger blocks of program memory be
bulk erased. Word erase in the Flash array is not
supported.
The sequence of events for erasing a block of internal
program memory location is:
1. Load Table Pointer register with address of row
being erased.
When initiating an erase sequence from the micro-
controller itself, a block of 64 bytes of program memory
is erased. The Most Significant 16 bits of the
TBLPTR<21:6> point to the block being erased.
TBLPTR<5:0> are ignored.
2. Set the EECON1 register for the erase operation:
• set EEPGD bit to point to program memory;
• clear the CFGS bit to access program memory;
• set WREN bit to enable writes;
• set FREE bit to enable the erase.
3. Disable interrupts.
The EECON1 register commands the erase operation.
The EEPGD bit must be set to point to the Flash
program memory. The WREN bit must be set to enable
write operations. The FREE bit is set to select an erase
operation.
4. Write 55h to EECON2.
5. Write 0AAh to EECON2.
6. Set the WR bit. This will begin the row erase
cycle.
For protection, the write initiate sequence for EECON2
must be used.
7. The CPU will stall for duration of the erase
(about 2 ms using internal timer).
A long write is necessary for erasing the internal Flash.
Instruction execution is halted while in a long write
cycle. The long write will be terminated by the internal
programming timer.
8. Re-enable interrupts.
EXAMPLE 6-2:
ERASING A FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY ROW
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the memory block
ERASE_ROW
BSF
BCF
BSF
BSF
EECON1, EEPGD
EECON1, CFGS
EECON1, WREN
EECON1, FREE
INTCON, GIE
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1, WR
INTCON, GIE
; point to Flash program memory
; access Flash program memory
; enable write to memory
; enable Row Erase operation
; disable interrupts
BCF
Required
Sequence
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
; write 55h
; write 0AAh
; start erase (CPU stall)
; re-enable interrupts
BSF
DS39758B-page 70
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The long write is necessary for programming the
internal Flash. Instruction execution is halted while in a
long write cycle. The long write will be terminated by
the internal programming timer.
6.5
Writing to Flash Program Memory
The minimum programming block is 4 words or 8 bytes.
Word or byte programming is not supported.
Table writes are used internally to load the holding
registers needed to program the Flash memory. There
are 8 holding registers used by the table writes for
programming.
The EEPROM on-chip timer controls the write time.
The write/erase voltages are generated by an on-chip
charge pump, rated to operate over the voltage range
of the device.
Since the Table Latch (TABLAT) is only a single byte,
the TBLWTinstruction may need to be executed 8 times
for each programming operation. All of the table write
operations will essentially be short writes because only
the holding registers are written. At the end of updating
the 8 holding registers, the EECON1 register must be
written to in order to start the programming operation with
a long write.
Note:
The default value of the holding registers on
device Resets and after write operations is
FFh. A write of FFh to a holding register
does not modify that byte. This means that
individual bytes of program memory may be
modified, provided that the change does not
attempt to change any bit from a ‘0’ to a ‘1’.
When modifying individual bytes, it is not
necessary to load all 8 holding registers
before executing a write operation.
FIGURE 6-5:
TABLE WRITES TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
TABLAT
Write Register
8
8
8
8
TBLPTR = xxxxx0
TBLPTR = xxxxx1
TBLPTR = xxxxx2
TBLPTR = xxxxx7
Holding Register
Holding Register
Holding Register
Holding Register
Program Memory
8. Disable interrupts.
6.5.1
FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
WRITE SEQUENCE
9. Write 55h to EECON2.
10. Write 0AAh to EECON2.
The sequence of events for programming an internal
program memory location should be:
11. Set the WR bit. This will begin the write cycle.
12. The CPU will stall for duration of the write (about
2 ms using internal timer).
1. Read 8 bytes into RAM.
2. Update data values in RAM as necessary.
13. Re-enable interrupts.
3. Load Table Pointer register with address being
erased.
14. Verify the memory (table read).
This procedure will require about 6 ms to update one
row of 8 bytes of memory. An example of the required
code is given in Example 6-3.
4. Execute the row erase procedure.
5. Load Table Pointer register with address of first
byte being written.
6. Write the 8 bytes into the holding registers with
auto-increment.
Note:
Before setting the WR bit, the Table
Pointer address needs to be within the
intended address range of the 8 bytes in
the holding register.
7. Set the EECON1 register for the write operation:
• set EEPGD bit to point to program memory;
• clear the CFGS bit to access program memory;
• set WREN to enable byte writes.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 71
PIC18F1230/1330
EXAMPLE 6-3:
WRITING TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
D'8
COUNTER
BUFFER_ADDR_HIGH
FSR0H
BUFFER_ADDR_LOW
FSR0L
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
; number of bytes in erase block
; point to buffer
; Load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the memory block
READ_BLOCK
TBLRD*+
MOVF
MOVWF
; read into TABLAT, and inc
; get data
; store data
; done?
TABLAT, W
POSTINC0
DECFSZ COUNTER
BRA
READ_BLOCK
; repeat
MODIFY_WORD
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
DATA_ADDR_HIGH
FSR0H
DATA_ADDR_LOW
FSR0L
NEW_DATA_LOW
POSTINC0
NEW_DATA_HIGH
INDF0
; point to buffer
; update buffer word
ERASE_BLOCK
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BCF
BSF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
CODE_ADDR_UPPER
TBLPTRU
CODE_ADDR_HIGH
TBLPTRH
CODE_ADDR_LOW
TBLPTRL
EECON1, EEPGD
EECON1, CFGS
EECON1, WREN
EECON1, FREE
INTCON, GIE
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1, WR
INTCON, GIE
; load TBLPTR with the base
; address of the memory block
; point to Flash program memory
; access Flash program memory
; enable write to memory
; enable Row Erase operation
; disable interrupts
Required
Sequence
; write 55h
; write 0AAh
; start erase (CPU stall)
; re-enable interrupts
; dummy read decrement
; point to buffer
BSF
TBLRD*-
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BUFFER_ADDR_HIGH
FSR0H
BUFFER_ADDR_LOW
FSR0L
WRITE_BUFFER_BACK
MOVLW
D’8
; number of bytes in holding register
MOVWF
WRITE_BYTE_TO_HREGS
MOVFF
COUNTER
POSTINC0, WREG
TABLAT
; get low byte of buffer data
; present data to table latch
; write data, perform a short write
; to internal TBLWT holding register.
; loop until buffers are full
MOVWF
TBLWT+*
DECFSZ COUNTER
BRA WRITE_WORD_TO_HREGS
DS39758B-page 72
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
EXAMPLE 6-3:
WRITING TO FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY (CONTINUED)
PROGRAM_MEMORY
BSF
BCF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
EECON1, EEPGD
EECON1, CFGS
EECON1, WREN
INTCON, GIE
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
; point to Flash program memory
; access Flash program memory
; enable write to memory
; disable interrupts
Required
Sequence
; write 55h
; write 0AAh
EECON1, WR
INTCON, GIE
EECON1, WREN
; start program (CPU stall)
; re-enable interrupts
; disable write to memory
BSF
BCF
6.5.2
WRITE VERIFY
6.5.4
PROTECTION AGAINST
SPURIOUS WRITES
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the
memory should be verified against the original value.
This should be used in applications where excessive
writes can stress bits near the specification limit.
To protect against spurious writes to Flash program
memory, the write initiate sequence must also be
followed. See Section 19.0 “Special Features of the
CPU” for more detail.
6.5.3
UNEXPECTED TERMINATION OF
WRITE OPERATION
6.6
Flash Program Operation During
Code Protection
If a write is terminated by an unplanned event, such as
loss of power or an unexpected Reset, the memory
location just programmed should be verified and
reprogrammed, if needed. If the write operation is
interrupted by a MCLR Reset or a WDT Time-out Reset
during normal operation, the user can check the
WRERR bit and rewrite the location(s) as needed.
See Section 19.5 “Program Verification and Code
Protection” for details on code protection of Flash
program memory.
TABLE 6-2:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PROGRAM FLASH MEMORY
Reset
Valueson
page
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TBLPTRU
—
—
bit 21 Program Memory Table Pointer Upper Byte (TBLPTR<20:16>)
41
41
41
41
41
43
43
43
43
43
TBPLTRH Program Memory Table Pointer High Byte (TBLPTR<15:8>)
TBLPTRL Program Memory Table Pointer Low Byte (TBLPTR<7:0>)
TABLAT
INTCON
Program Memory Table Latch
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
EECON2 EEPROM Control Register 2 (not a physical register)
EECON1
IPR2
EEPGD
OSCFIP
OSCFIF
OSCFIE
CFGS
—
—
—
—
—
FREE
EEIP
EEIF
EEIE
WRERR
WREN
LVDIP
LVDIF
LVDIE
WR
—
RD
—
—
—
—
PIR2
—
—
—
PIE2
—
—
—
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used during Flash/EEPROM access.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 73
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 74
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Control bit, EEPGD, determines if the access will be to
program or data EEPROM memory. When clear,
operations will access the data EEPROM memory.
When set, program memory is accessed.
7.0
DATA EEPROM MEMORY
The data EEPROM is readable and writable during
normal operation over the entire VDD range. The data
memory is not directly mapped in the register file
space. Instead, it is indirectly addressed through the
Special Function Registers (SFR).
Control bit, CFGS, determines if the access will be to
the Configuration registers or to program memory/data
EEPROM memory. When set, subsequent operations
access Configuration registers. When CFGS is clear,
the EEPGD bit selects either program Flash or data
EEPROM memory.
There are four SFRs used to read and write the
program and data EEPROM memory. These registers
are:
• EECON1
• EECON2
• EEDATA
• EEADR
The WREN bit enables and disables erase and write
operations. When set, erase and write operations are
allowed. When clear, erase and write operations are
disabled; the WR bit cannot be set while the WREN bit
is clear. This mechanism helps to prevent accidental
writes to memory due to errant (unexpected) code
execution.
The EEPROM data memory allows byte read and write.
When interfacing to the data memory block, EEDATA
holds the 8-bit data for read/write and EEADR holds the
address of the EEPROM location being accessed.
These devices have 128 bytes of data EEPROM with
an address range from 00h to FFh.
Firmware should keep the WREN bit clear at all times,
except when starting erase or write operations. Once
firmware has set the WR bit, the WREN bit may be
cleared. Clearing the WREN bit will not affect the
operation in progress.
The EEPROM data memory is rated for high erase/
write cycle endurance. A byte write automatically
erases the location and writes the new data (erase-
before-write). The write time is controlled by an on-chip
timer. The write time will vary with voltage and
temperature, as well as from chip-to-chip. Please
refer to parameter D122 (Table 22-1 in Section 22.0
“Electrical Characteristics”) for exact limits.
The WRERR bit is set when a write operation is
interrupted by a Reset. In these situations, the user can
check the WRERR bit and rewrite the location. It is
necessary to reload the data and address registers
(EEDATA and EEADR), as these registers have
cleared as a result of the Reset.
Control bits, RD and WR, start read and erase/write
operations, respectively. These bits are set by firmware
and cleared by hardware at the completion of the
operation.
7.1
EEADR Register
The EEPROM Address register can address 256 bytes
of data EEPROM.
The RD bit cannot be set when accessing program
memory (EEPGD = 1). Program memory is read using
table read instructions. See Section 6.1 “Table Reads
and Table Writes” regarding table reads.
7.2
EECON1 and EECON2 Registers
EECON1 is the control register for memory accesses.
Note:
Interrupt flag bit, EEIF in the PIR2 register,
is set when write is complete. It must be
cleared in software.
EECON2 is not a physical register. Reading EECON2
will read all ‘0’s. The EECON2 register is used
exclusively in the memory write and erase sequences.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 75
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 7-1:
EECON1: EEPROM CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-x
EEPGD
bit 7
R/W-x
CFGS
U-0
—
R/W-0
FREE
R/W-x
WRERR(1)
R/W-0
WREN
R/S-0
WR
R/S-0
RD
bit 0
Legend:
S = Settable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
EEPGD: Flash Program or Data EEPROM Memory Select bit
1= Access Flash program memory
0= Access data EEPROM memory
CFGS: Flash Program/Data EEPROM or Configuration Select bit
1= Access Configuration registers
0= Access Flash program or data EEPROM memory
bit 5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
FREE: Flash Row Erase Enable bit
1= Erase the program memory row addressed by TBLPTR on the next WR command
(cleared by completion of erase operation)
0= Perform write-only
bit 3
WRERR: EEPROM Error Flag bit(1)
1= A write operation is prematurely terminated
(MCLR or WDT Reset during self-timed erase or program operation)
0= The write operation completed
bit 2
bit 1
WREN: Erase/Write Enable bit
1= Allows erase/write cycles
0= Inhibits erase/write cycles
WR: Write Control bit
1= Initiates a data EEPROM erase/write cycle or a program memory erase cycle or write cycle.
(The operation is self-timed and the bit is cleared by hardware once write is complete.
The WR bit can only be set (not cleared) in software.)
0= Write cycle to is completed
bit 0
RD: Read Control bit
1= Initiates a memory read. (Read takes one cycle. RD is cleared in hardware. The RD bit can only be
set (not cleared) in software. RD bit cannot be set when EEPGD = 1.)
0= Read completed
Note 1: When a WRERR occurs, the EEPGD or FREE bit is not cleared. This allows tracing of the error condition.
DS39758B-page 76
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
After a write sequence has been initiated, EECON1,
EEADR and EEDATA cannot be modified. The WR bit
will be inhibited from being set unless the WREN bit is
set. The WREN bit must be set on a previous instruc-
tion. Both WR and WREN cannot be set with the same
instruction.
7.3
Reading the Data EEPROM
Memory
To read a data memory location, the user must write the
address to the EEADR register, clear the EEPGD
control bit (EECON1<7>) and then set control bit RD
(EECON1<0>). The data is available for the very next
instruction cycle; therefore, the EEDATA register can
be read by the next instruction. EEDATA will hold this
value until another read operation, or until it is written to
by the user (during a write operation).
At the completion of the write cycle, the WR bit is
cleared in hardware and the EEPROM Interrupt Flag bit
(EEIF) is set. The user may either enable this interrupt
or poll this bit. EEIF must be cleared by software.
7.5
Write Verify
7.4
Writing to the Data EEPROM
Memory
Depending on the application, good programming
practice may dictate that the value written to the
memory should be verified against the original value.
This should be used in applications where excessive
writes can stress bits near the specification limit.
To write an EEPROM data location, the address must
first be written to the EEADR register and the data
written to the EEDATA register. The sequence in
Example 7-2 must be followed to initiate the write cycle.
The write will not begin if this sequence is not exactly
followed (write 55h to EECON2, write 0AAh to
EECON2, then set WR bit) for each byte. It is strongly
recommended that interrupts be disabled during this
code segment.
7.6
Protection Against Spurious Write
There are conditions when the device may not want to
write to the data EEPROM memory. To protect against
spurious EEPROM writes, various mechanisms have
been built-in. On power-up, the WREN bit is cleared.
Also, the Power-up Timer (72 ms duration) prevents
EEPROM write.
Additionally, the WREN bit in EECON1 must be set to
enable writes. This mechanism prevents accidental
writes to data EEPROM due to unexpected code
execution (i.e., runaway programs). The WREN bit
should be kept clear at all times, except when updating
the EEPROM. The WREN bit is not cleared
by hardware.
The write initiate sequence and the WREN bit together
help prevent an accidental write during brown-out,
power glitch, or software malfunction.
EXAMPLE 7-1:
DATA EEPROM READ
MOVLW
MOVWF
BCF
BSF
MOVF
DATA_EE_ADDR
EEADR
EECON1, EEPGD
EECON1, RD
EEDATA, W
;
; Data Memory Address to read
; Point to DATA memory
; EEPROM Read
; W = EEDATA
EXAMPLE 7-2:
DATA EEPROM WRITE
MOVLW
DATA_EE_ADDR
EEADR
DATA_EE_DATA
EEDATA
EECON1, EEPGD
EECON1, WREN
INTCON, GIE
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1, WR
INTCON, GIE
;
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BCF
BSF
BCF
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
; Data Memory Address to write
;
; Data Memory Value to write
; Point to DATA memory
; Enable writes
; Disable Interrupts
;
; Write 55h
;
; Write 0AAh
; Set WR bit to begin write
; Enable Interrupts
Required
Sequence
BSF
SLEEP
BCF
; Wait for interrupt to signal write complete
; Disable writes
EECON1, WREN
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 77
PIC18F1230/1330
7.7
Operation During Code-Protect
7.8
Using the Data EEPROM
Data EEPROM memory has its own code-protect bits in
Configuration Words. External read and write
operations are disabled if either of these mechanisms
are enabled.
The data EEPROM is a high-endurance, byte
addressable array that has been optimized for the
storage of frequently changing information (e.g.,
program variables or other data that are updated
often). Frequently changing values will typically be
updated more often than specification D124 or D124A.
If this is not the case, an array refresh must be
performed. For this reason, variables that change
infrequently (such as constants, IDs, calibration, etc.)
should be stored in Flash program memory.
The microcontroller itself can both read and write to the
internal data EEPROM, regardless of the state of the
code-protect Configuration bit. Refer to Section 19.0
“Special Features of the CPU” for additional
information.
A simple data EEPROM refresh routine is shown in
Example 7-3.
Note:
If data EEPROM is only used to store
constants and/or data that changes rarely,
an array refresh is likely not required. See
specification D124 or D124A.
EXAMPLE 7-3:
DATA EEPROM REFRESH ROUTINE
CLRF
EEADR
; Start at address 0
BCF
BCF
BCF
BSF
EECON1, CFGS
EECON1, EEPGD
INTCON, GIE
EECON1, WREN
; Set for memory
; Set for Data EEPROM
; Disable interrupts
; Enable writes
LOOP
BSF
; Loop to refresh array
; Read current address
;
; Write 55h
;
; Write 0AAh
; Set WR bit to begin write
; Wait for write to complete
EECON1, RD
55h
EECON2
0AAh
EECON2
EECON1, WR
EECON1, WR
$-2
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
BTFSC
BRA
INCFSZ EEADR, F
; Increment address
BRA
Loop
; Not zero, do it again
BCF
BSF
EECON1, WREN
INTCON, GIE
; Disable writes
; Enable interrupts
TABLE 7-1:
Name
REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH DATA EEPROM MEMORY
Reset
Values on
page
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE INT0IE
EEADR EEPROM Address Register
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
43
43
43
43
EEDATA EEPROM Data Register
EECON2 EEPROM Control Register 2 (not a physical register)
EECON1
IPR2
EEPGD
OSCFIP
OSCFIF
OSCFIE
CFGS
—
—
—
—
—
FREE
EEIP
EEIF
EEIE
WRERR
WREN
LVDIP
LVDIF
LVDIE
WR
—
RD
—
—
—
—
PIR2
—
—
—
PIE2
—
—
—
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged, — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used during Flash/
EEPROM access.
DS39758B-page 78
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
EXAMPLE 8-1:
8 x 8 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
8.0
8.1
8 x 8 HARDWARE MULTIPLIER
Introduction
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1, W
ARG2
;
; ARG1 * ARG2 ->
; PRODH:PRODL
All PIC18 devices include an 8 x 8 hardware multiplier
as part of the ALU. The multiplier performs an unsigned
operation and yields a 16-bit result that is stored in the
Product register pair, PRODH:PRODL. The multiplier’s
operation does not affect any flags in the STATUS
register.
EXAMPLE 8-2:
8 x 8 SIGNED MULTIPLY
ROUTINE
Making multiplication a hardware operation allows it to
be completed in a single instruction cycle. This has the
advantages of higher computational throughput and
reduced code size for multiplication algorithms and
allows the PIC18 devices to be used in many
applications previously reserved for digital signal
processors. A comparison of various hardware and
software multiply operations, along with the savings in
memory and execution time, is shown in Table 8-1.
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1, W
ARG2
; ARG1 * ARG2 ->
; PRODH:PRODL
; Test Sign Bit
; PRODH = PRODH
BTFSC
SUBWF
ARG2, SB
PRODH, F
;
- ARG1
MOVF
BTFSC
SUBWF
ARG2, W
ARG1, SB
PRODH, F
; Test Sign Bit
; PRODH = PRODH
;
- ARG2
8.2
Operation
Example 8-1 shows the instruction sequence for an 8 x 8
unsigned multiplication. Only one instruction is required
when one of the arguments is already loaded in the
WREG register.
Example 8-2 shows the sequence to do an 8 x 8 signed
multiplication. To account for the sign bits of the
arguments, each argument’s Most Significant bit (MSb)
is tested and the appropriate subtractions are done.
TABLE 8-1:
Routine
PERFORMANCE COMPARISON FOR VARIOUS MULTIPLY OPERATIONS
Program
Memory
(Words)
Time
Cycles
(Max)
Multiply Method
@ 40 MHz @ 10 MHz @ 4 MHz
Without hardware multiply
Hardware multiply
13
1
69
1
6.9 μs
100 ns
9.1 μs
600 ns
24.2 μs
2.8 μs
25.4 μs
4.0 μs
27.6 μs
400 ns
36.4 μs
2.4 μs
69 μs
1 μs
8 x 8 unsigned
8 x 8 signed
Without hardware multiply
Hardware multiply
33
6
91
6
91 μs
6 μs
Without hardware multiply
Hardware multiply
21
28
52
35
242
28
254
40
96.8 μs
11.2 μs
102.6 μs
16.0 μs
242 μs
28 μs
254 μs
40 μs
16 x 16 unsigned
16 x 16 signed
Without hardware multiply
Hardware multiply
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 79
PIC18F1230/1330
Example 8-3 shows the sequence to do a 16 x 16
unsigned multiplication. Equation 8-1 shows the
algorithm that is used. The 32-bit result is stored in four
registers (RES3:RES0).
EQUATION 8-2:
16 x 16 SIGNED
MULTIPLICATION
ALGORITHM
RES3:RES0=ARG1H:ARG1L • ARG2H:ARG2L
16
= (ARG1H • ARG2H • 2 ) +
(ARG1H • ARG2L • 2 ) +
(ARG1L • ARG2H • 2 ) +
(ARG1L • ARG2L) +
(-1 • ARG2H<7> • ARG1H:ARG1L • 2 ) +
(-1 • ARG1H<7> • ARG2H:ARG2L • 2
8
EQUATION 8-1:
16 x 16 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLICATION
ALGORITHM
8
16
16
RES3:RES0= ARG1H:ARG1L • ARG2H:ARG2L
)
16
=
(ARG1H • ARG2H • 2 ) +
8
(ARG1H • ARG2L • 2 ) +
8
(ARG1L • ARG2H • 2 ) +
EXAMPLE 8-4:
16 x 16 SIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
(ARG1L • ARG2L)
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2L
; ARG1L * ARG2L ->
; PRODH:PRODL
EXAMPLE 8-3:
16 x 16 UNSIGNED
MULTIPLY ROUTINE
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES1;
PRODL, RES0;
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2L
;
;
; ARG1L * ARG2L->
; PRODH:PRODL
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2H
; ARG1H * ARG2H ->
; PRODH:PRODL
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES1;
PRODL, RES0;
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES3;
PRODL, RES2;
;
;
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2H
; ARG1H * ARG2H->
; PRODH:PRODL
MOVF
ARG1L, W
MULWF
ARG2H
; ARG1L * ARG2H ->
; PRODH:PRODL
;
; Add cross
; products
MOVFF
MOVFF
PRODH, RES3;
PRODL, RES2;
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1L, W
ARG2H
; ARG1L * ARG2H->
ADDWFC RES2, F
CLRF WREG
ADDWFC RES3, F
;
;
;
; PRODH:PRODL
;
; Add cross
; products
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
;
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2L
;
ADDWFC RES2, F
CLRF WREG
ADDWFC RES3, F
;
;
;
; ARG1H * ARG2L ->
; PRODH:PRODL
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
;
;
; Add cross
; products
MOVF
MULWF
ARG1H, W
ARG2L
;
; ARG1H * ARG2L->
ADDWFC RES2, F
CLRF WREG
ADDWFC RES3, F
;
;
;
; PRODH:PRODL
;
; Add cross
; products
;
;
;
MOVF
ADDWF
MOVF
ADDWFC RES2, F
CLRF WREG
ADDWFC RES3, F
PRODL, W
RES1, F
PRODH, W
;
;
BTFSS
BRA
ARG2H, 7
SIGN_ARG1 ; no, check ARG1
; ARG2H:ARG2L neg?
MOVF
SUBWF
MOVF
ARG1L, W
RES2
ARG1H, W
;
;
;
Example 8-4 shows the sequence to do a 16 x 16
signed multiply. Equation 8-2 shows the algorithm
used. The 32-bit result is stored in four registers
(RES3:RES0). To account for the sign bits of the
arguments, the MSb for each argument pair is tested
and the appropriate subtractions are done.
SUBWFB RES3
SIGN_ARG1
BTFSS
BRA
ARG1H, 7
CONT_CODE ; no, done
; ARG1H:ARG1L neg?
MOVF
SUBWF
MOVF
ARG2L, W
RES2
ARG2H, W
;
;
;
SUBWFB RES3
;
CONT_CODE
:
DS39758B-page 80
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Reading the PORTA register reads the status of the
pins, whereas writing to it, will write to the port latch.
9.0
I/O PORTS
Depending on the device selected and features
enabled, there are up to five ports available. Some pins
of the I/O ports are multiplexed with an alternate
function from the peripheral features on the device. In
general, when a peripheral is enabled, that pin may not
be used as a general purpose I/O pin.
The Data Latch (LATA) register is also memory mapped.
Read-modify-write operations on the LATA register read
and write the latched output value for PORTA.
Pins RA6 and RA7 are multiplexed with the main
oscillator pins; they are enabled as oscillator or I/O pins
by the selection of the main oscillator in the Configura-
tion register (see Section 19.1 “Configuration Bits”
for details). When they are not used as port pins, RA6
and RA7 and their associated TRIS and LAT bits are
read as ‘0’.
Each port has three registers for its operation. These
registers are:
• TRIS register (data direction register)
• PORT register (reads the levels on the pins of the
device)
The RA0 pin is multiplexed with one of the analog
inputs, one of the external interrupt inputs, one of the
interrupt-on-change inputs and one of the analog
comparator inputs to become RA0/AN0/INT0/KBI0/
CMP0 pin.
• LAT register (output latch)
The Data Latch (LAT register) is useful for read-modify-
write operations on the value that the I/O pins are
driving.
The RA1 pin is multiplexed with one of the analog
inputs, one of the external interrupt inputs and one of
the interrupt-on-change inputs to become RA1/AN1/
INT1/KBI1 pin.
A simplified model of a generic I/O port, without the
interfaces to other peripherals, is shown in Figure 9-1.
FIGURE 9-1:
GENERIC I/O PORT
OPERATION
Pins RA2 and RA3 are multiplexed with the Enhanced
USART transmission and reception input (see
Section 19.1 “Configuration Bits” for details).
RD LAT
The RA4 pin is multiplexed with the Timer0 module
clock input, one of the analog inputs and the analog
VREF+ input to become the RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+ pin.
Data
Bus
D
Q
WR LAT
I/O pin(1)
or
The Fault detect input for PWM FLTA is multiplexed with
pins RA5 and RA7. Its placement is decided by clearing
or setting the FLTAMX bit of Configuration Register 3H.
Port
CK
Data Latch
D
Q
Note:
On a Power-on Reset, RA0, RA1, RA4
and RA5 are configured as analog inputs
and read as ‘0’. RA2 and RA3 are
configured as digital inputs.
WR TRIS
RD TRIS
CK
TRIS Latch
Input
Buffer
The TRISA register controls the direction of the PORTA
pins, even when they are being used as analog inputs.
The user must ensure the bits in the TRISA register are
maintained set when using them as analog inputs.
Q
D
EN
EXAMPLE 9-1:
INITIALIZING PORTA
CLRF
PORTA
LATA
07h
; Initialize PORTA by
; clearing output
; data latches
; Alternate method
; to clear output
; data latches
RD Port
Note 1: I/O pins have diode protection to VDD and VSS.
CLRF
9.1
PORTA, TRISA and LATA Registers
MOVLW
MOVWF
MOVWF
MOVWF
MOVLW
; Configure A/D
ADCON1 ; for digital inputs
07h
CMCON
0CFh
PORTA is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding data direction register is TRISA. Setting
a TRISA bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTA
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISA bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTA pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
; Configure comparators
; for digital input
; Value used to
; initialize data
; direction
MOVWF
TRISA
; Set RA<7:6,3:0> as inputs
; RA<5:4> as outputs
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 81
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 9-1:
PORTA I/O SUMMARY
TRIS
Setting
I/O
Type
Pin
Function
I/O
Description
RA0/AN0/INT0/
KBI0/CMP0
RA0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
O
I
DIG LATA<0> data output; not affected by analog input.
TTL PORTA<0> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
ANA Analog input 0.
AN0
INT0
KBI0
CMP0
RA1
I
I
ST
External interrupt 0.
I
TTL Interrupt-on-change pin.
I
ANA Comparator 0 input.
RA1/AN1/INT1/
KBI1
O
I
DIG LATA<1> data output; not affected by analog input.
TTL PORTA<1> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
ANA Analog input 1.
AN1
INT1
KBI1
RA2
I
I
ST
External interrupt 1.
I
TTL Interrupt-on-change pin.
RA2/TX/CK
O
DIG LATA<2> data output; not affected by analog input. Disabled when
CVREF output enabled.
1
I
TTL PORTA<2> data input. Disabled when analog functions enabled;
disabled when CVREF output enabled.
TX
CK
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
O
I
DIG EUSART asynchronous transmit.
DIG EUSART synchronous clock.
ST
RA3/RX/DT
RA3
O
I
DIG LATA<3> data output; not affected by analog input.
TTL PORTA<3> data input; disabled when analog input enabled.
ANA EUSART asynchronous receive.
DIG EUSART synchronous data.
TTL
RX
DT
I
O
I
RA4/T0CKI/AN2/
VREF+
RA4
O
I
DIG LATA<4> data output.
ST
ST
PORTA<4> data input; default configuration on POR.
Timer0 external clock input.
T0CKI
AN2
I
I
ANA Analog input 2.
VREF+
MCLR
VPP
I
ANA A/D reference voltage (high) input.
MCLR/VPP/RA5/
FLTA
I
ST
Master Clear (Reset) input. This pin is an active-low Reset to the device.
I
ANA Programming voltage input.
RA5
I
ST
ST
Digital input.
(1)
FLTA
I
Fault detect input for PWM.
RA6/OSC2/CLKO/
T1OSO/T1CKI/AN3
RA6
O
I
DIG LATA<6> data output. Enabled in RCIO, INTIO2 and ECIO modes only.
ST PORTA<6> data input. Enabled in RCIO, INTIO2 and ECIO modes only.
OSC2
CLKO
O
O
O
I
ANA Oscillator crystal output or external clock source output.
ANA Oscillator crystal output.
(2)
T1OSO
ANA Timer1 oscillator output.
(2)
T1CKI
ST
Timer1 clock input.
AN3
RA7
I
ANA Analog input 3.
RA7/OSC1/CLKI/
T1OSI/FLTA
O
I
DIG LATA<7> data output. Disabled in external oscillator modes.
TTL PORTA<7> data input. Disabled in external oscillator modes.
ANA Oscillator crystal input or external clock source input.
ANA External clock source input.
OSC1
CLKI
I
I
(2)
T1OSI
I
ANA Timer1 oscillator input.
(1)
FLTA
I
ST
Fault detect input for PWM.
Legend:
DIG = Digital level output; TTL = TTL input buffer; ST = Schmitt Trigger input buffer; ANA = Analog level input/output;
x= Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
Note 1: Placement of FLTA depends on the value of Configuration bit, FLTAMX, of CONFIG3H.
2: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of CONFIG3H.
DS39758B-page 82
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 9-2:
Name
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTA
Reset
Values
on page
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
PORTA
LATA
RA7(1)
LATA7(1)
RA6(1)
RA5
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
44
43
43
41
41
42
42
42
LATA6(1) PORTA Data Latch Register (Read and Write to Data Latch)
TRISA
TRISA7(1) TRISA6(1) PORTA Data Direction Control Register
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE INT0IE RBIE TMR0IF
INTEDG0 INTEDG1 INTEDG2 INTEDG3 TMR0IP
INTCON
INTCON2
ADCON1
CMCON
CVRCON
INT0IF
INT3IP
PCFG1
RBIF
RBIP
RBPU
—
—
C1OUT
—
—
VCFG0
—
PCFG3
—
PCFG2
PCFG0
C2OUT
CVREN
C0OUT
CVRR
CMEN2 CMEN1 CMEN0
CVR2 CVR1 CVR0
CVRSS
CVR3
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTA.
Note 1: RA7:RA6 and their associated latch and data direction bits are enabled as I/O pins based on oscillator
configuration; otherwise, they are read as ‘0’.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 83
PIC18F1230/1330
Pins RB0, RB1 and RB4:RB7 are multiplexed with the
power control PWM outputs.
9.2
PORTB, TRISB and LATB
Registers
Pins RB2 and RB3 are multiplexed with external interrupt
inputs, interrupt-on-change input, the analog comparator
inputs and the Timer1 oscillator input and output to
become RB2/INT2/KBI2/CMP2/T1OSO/T1CKI and
RB3/INT3/KNBI3/CMP1/T1OSI respectively.
PORTB is an 8-bit wide, bidirectional port. The
corresponding data direction register is TRISB. Setting
a TRISB bit (= 1) will make the corresponding PORTB
pin an input (i.e., put the corresponding output driver in
a high-impedance mode). Clearing a TRISB bit (= 0)
will make the corresponding PORTB pin an output (i.e.,
put the contents of the output latch on the selected pin).
When the interrupt-on-change feature is enabled, only
pins configured as inputs can cause this interrupt to
occur (i.e., any RB2, RB3, RA0 and RA1 pin configured
as an output is excluded from the interrupt-on-change
comparison). The input pins (RB2, RB3, RA0 and RA1)
are compared with the old value latched on the last
read of PORTA and PORTB. The “mismatch” outputs of
these pins are ORed together to generate the RB Port
Change Interrupt with Flag bit, RBIF (INTCON<0>).
The Data Latch register (LATB) is also memory
mapped. Read-modify-write operations on the LATB
register read and write the latched output value for
PORTB.
EXAMPLE 9-2:
INITIALIZING PORTB
CLRF
PORTB
LATB
0Fh
; Initialize PORTB by
; clearing output
; data latches
; Alternate method
; to clear output
; data latches
This interrupt can wake the device from Sleep mode, or
any of the Idle modes. The user, in the Interrupt Service
Routine, can clear the interrupt in the following manner:
CLRF
a) Any read or write of PORTA and/or PORTB
(except with the MOVFF (ANY), PORTA and
MOVFF (ANY), PORTB instructions).
MOVLW
MOVWF
; Set RB<4:0> as
ADCON1 ; digital I/O pins
; (required if config bit
b) Clear flag bit, RBIF.
; PBADEN is set)
; Value used to
; initialize data
; direction
; Set RB<3:0> as inputs
; RB<5:4> as outputs
; RB<7:6> as inputs
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit, RBIF.
Reading PORTA and PORTB will end the mismatch
condition and allow flag bit, RBIF, to be cleared.
MOVLW
MOVWF
0CFh
The interrupt-on-change feature is recommended for
wake-up on key depression operation and operations
where PORTA and PORTB are used for the interrupt-
on-change feature. Polling of PORTA and PORTB is
not recommended while using the interrupt-on-change
feature.
TRISB
Each of the PORTB pins has a weak internal pull-up. A
single control bit can turn on all the pull-ups. This is
performed by clearing bit, RBPU (INTCON2<7>). The
weak pull-up is automatically turned off when the port
pin is configured as an output. The pull-ups are
disabled on a Power-on Reset.
Note:
On
a
Power-on Reset, PORTB is
configured as digital inputs except for RB2
and RB3.
RB2 and RB3 are configured as analog
inputs when the T1OSCMX bit of Configu-
ration Register 3H is cleared. Otherwise,
RB2 and RB3 are also configured as
digital inputs.
DS39758B-page 84
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 9-3:
Pin
PORTB I/O SUMMARY
TRIS
I/O
Type
Function
I/O
Description
Setting
RB0/PWM0
RB0
0
1
O
I
DIG
TTL
LATB<0> data output; not affected by analog input.
PORTB<0> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
(1)
Disabled when analog input enabled.
PWM0
RB1
0
0
1
O
O
I
DIG
DIG
TTL
PWM module output PWM0.
RB1PWM1
LATB<1> data output; not affected by analog input.
PORTB<1> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
Disabled when analog input enabled.
(1)
PWM1
RB2
0
0
1
O
O
I
DIG
DIG
TTL
PWM module output PWM1.
RB2/INT2/KBI2/
CMP2/T1OSO/
T1CKI
LATB<2> data output; not affected by analog input.
PORTB<2> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
Disabled when analog input enabled.
(1)
INT2
KBI2
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
I
I
ST
TTL
ANA
ANA
ST
External interrupt 2 input.
Interrupt-on-change pin.
CMP2
I
Comparator 2 input.
(2)
T1OSO
O
I
Timer1 oscillator output.
(2)
T1CKI
Timer1 clock input.
RB3/INT3/KBI3/
CMP1/T1OSI
RB3
O
I
DIG
TTL
LATB<3> data output; not affected by analog input.
PORTB<3> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
Disabled when analog input enabled.
(1)
INT3
KBI3
1
1
1
1
0
1
I
I
ST
External interrupt 3 input.
TTL
ANA
ANA
DIG
TTL
Interrupt-on-change pin.
CMP1
I
Comparator 1 input.
(2)
T1OSI
I
Timer1 oscillator input.
RB4/PWM2
RB4
O
I
LATB<4> data output; not affected by analog input.
PORTB<4> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
Disabled when analog input enabled.
(1)
PWM2
RB5
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
O
O
I
DIG
DIG
TTL
DIG
DIG
TTL
DIG
ST
PWM module output PWM2.
RB5/PWM3
LATB<5> data output.
PORTB<5> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
PWM module output PWM3.
PWM3
RB6
O
O
I
RB6/PWM4/PGC
LATB<6> data output.
PORTB<6> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
PWM module output PWM4.
PWM4
PGC
RB7
O
I
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP™ programming clock pin.
LATB<7> data output.
RB7/PWM5/PGD
O
I
DIG
TTL
TTL
DIG
PORTB<7> data input; weak pull-up when RBPU bit is cleared.
PWM module output PWM4.
PWM5
PGD
O
O
In-Circuit Debugger and ICSP programming data pin.
Legend:
DIG = Digital level output; TTL = TTL input buffer; ST = Schmitt Trigger input buffer; ANA = Analog level input/output;
x= Don’t care (TRIS bit does not affect port direction or is overridden for this option).
Note 1: Configuration on POR is determined by the PBADEN Configuration bit. Pins are configured as analog inputs by default
when PBADEN is set and digital inputs when PBADEN is cleared.
2: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of CONFIG3H.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 85
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 9-4:
SUMMARY OF REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH PORTB
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
PORTB
LATB
RB7
RB6
RB5
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
RB0
44
43
43
41
41
41
42
PORTB Data Latch Register (Read and Write to Data Latch)
PORTB Data Direction Control Register
TRISB
INTCON
INTCON2
INTCON3
CMCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
INT3IP
INT2IF
RBIF
RBIP
RBPU
INT2IP
C2OUT
INTEDG0 INTEDG1 INTEDG2 INTEDG3 TMR0IP
INT1IP
C1OUT
INT3IE
C0OUT
INT2IE
—
INT1IE
—
INT3IF
INT1IF
CMEN2 CMEN1 CMEN0
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by PORTB.
DS39758B-page 86
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
When the IPEN bit is cleared (default state), the
interrupt priority feature is disabled and interrupts are
compatible with PICmicro® mid-range devices. In
Compatibility mode, the interrupt priority bits for each
source have no effect. INTCON<6> is the PEIE bit,
which enables/disables all peripheral interrupt sources.
INTCON<7> is the GIE bit, which enables/disables all
interrupt sources. All interrupts branch to address
0008h in Compatibility mode.
10.0 INTERRUPTS
The PIC18F1230/1330 devices have multiple interrupt
sources and an interrupt priority feature that allows
most interrupt sources to be assigned a high priority
level or a low priority level. The high priority interrupt
vector is at 0008h and the low priority interrupt vector is
at 0018h. High priority interrupt events will interrupt any
low priority interrupts that may be in progress.
There are thirteen registers which are used to control
interrupt operation. These registers are:
When an interrupt is responded to, the global interrupt
enable bit is cleared to disable further interrupts. If the
IPEN bit is cleared, this is the GIE bit. If interrupt priority
levels are used, this will be either the GIEH or GIEL bit.
High priority interrupt sources can interrupt a low
priority interrupt. Low priority interrupts are not
processed while high priority interrupts are in progress.
• RCON
• INTCON
• INTCON2
• INTCON3
• PIR1, PIR2, PIR3
• PIE1, PIE2, PIE3
• IPR1, IPR2, IPR3
The return address is pushed onto the stack and the
PC is loaded with the interrupt vector address (0008h
or 0018h). Once in the Interrupt Service Routine, the
source(s) of the interrupt can be determined by polling
the interrupt flag bits. The interrupt flag bits must be
cleared in software before re-enabling interrupts to
avoid recursive interrupts.
It is recommended that the Microchip header files
supplied with MPLAB® IDE be used for the symbolic bit
names in these registers. This allows the assembler/
compiler to automatically take care of the placement of
these bits within the specified register.
The “return from interrupt” instruction, RETFIE, exits
the interrupt routine and sets the GIE bit (GIEH or GIEL
if priority levels are used), which re-enables interrupts.
In general, interrupt sources have three bits to control
their operation. They are:
For external interrupt events, such as the INT pins or
the PORTB input change interrupt, the interrupt latency
will be three to four instruction cycles. The exact
latency is the same for one or two-cycle instructions.
Individual interrupt flag bits are set, regardless of the
status of their corresponding enable bit or the GIE bit.
• Flag bit to indicate that an interrupt event
occurred
• Enable bit that allows program execution to
branch to the interrupt vector address when the
flag bit is set
• Priority bit to select high priority or low priority
Note:
Do not use the MOVFFinstruction to modify
any of the interrupt control registers while
any interrupt is enabled. Doing so may
cause erratic microcontroller behavior.
The interrupt priority feature is enabled by setting the
IPEN bit (RCON<7>). When interrupt priority is
enabled, there are two bits which enable interrupts
globally. Setting the GIEH bit (INTCON<7>) enables all
interrupts that have the priority bit set (high priority).
Setting the GIEL bit (INTCON<6>) enables all
interrupts that have the priority bit cleared (low priority).
When the interrupt flag, enable bit and appropriate
global interrupt enable bit are set, the interrupt will
vector immediately to address 0008h or 0018h,
depending on the priority bit setting. Individual
interrupts can be disabled through their corresponding
enable bits.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 87
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 10-1:
PIC18 INTERRUPT LOGIC
TMR0IF
TMR0IE
TMR0IP
Wake-up if in
Idle or Sleep modes
RBIF
RBIE
RBIP
INT0IF
INT0IE
INT1IF
INT1IE
INT1IP
Interrupt to CPU
Vector to Location
0008h
INT2IF
INT2IE
INT2IP
Peripheral Interrupt Flag bit
Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
Peripheral Interrupt Priority bit
GIE/GIEH
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
IPEN
From Power Control PWM
Interrupt Logic
IPEN
PTIF
PTIE
PTIP
PEIE/GIEL
IPEN
Additional Peripheral Interrupts
High Priority Interrupt Generation
Low Priority Interrupt Generation
Peripheral Interrupt Flag bit
Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
Peripheral Interrupt Priority bit
Interrupt to CPU
Vector to Location
0018h
TMR0IF
TMR0IE
TMR0IP
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RBIF
RBIE
RBIP
From Power Control
PWM Interrupt Logic
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
PTIF
PTIE
PTIP
INT1IF
INT1IE
INT1IP
Additional Peripheral Interrupts
INT2IF
INT2IE
INT2IP
DS39758B-page 88
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
10.1 INTCON Registers
Note:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the global
interrupt enable bit. User software should
ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt.
This feature allows for software polling.
The INTCON registers are readable and writable
registers, which contain various enable, priority and
flag bits.
REGISTER 10-1: INTCON: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RBIE
R/W-0
R/W-0
INT0IF
R/W-x
RBIF(1)
GIE/GIEH
PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
TMR0IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
GIE/GIEH: Global Interrupt Enable bit
When IPEN = 0:
1= Enables all unmasked interrupts
0= Disables all interrupts
When IPEN = 1:
1= Enables all high priority interrupts
0= Disables all interrupts
bit 6
PEIE/GIEL: Peripheral Interrupt Enable bit
When IPEN = 0:
1= Enables all unmasked peripheral interrupts
0= Disables all peripheral interrupts
When IPEN = 1:
1= Enables all low priority peripheral interrupts
0= Disables all low priority peripheral interrupts
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
TMR0IE: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the TMR0 overflow interrupt
0= Disables the TMR0 overflow interrupt
INT0IE: INT0 External Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the INT0 external interrupt
0= Disables the INT0 external interrupt
RBIE: RB Port Change Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the RB port change interrupt
0= Disables the RB port change interrupt
TMR0IF: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1= TMR0 register has overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0= TMR0 register did not overflow
INT0IF: INT0 External Interrupt Flag bit
1= The INT0 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0= The INT0 external interrupt did not occur
RBIF: RB Port Change Interrupt Flag bit(1)
1= At least one of the RB7:RB4 pins changed state (must be cleared in software)
0= None of the RB7:RB4 pins have changed state
Note 1: A mismatch condition will continue to set this bit. Reading PORTB will end the mismatch condition and
allow the bit to be cleared.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 89
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 10-2: INTCON2: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-1
RBPU
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
RBIP
INTEDG0
INTEDG1
INTEDG2
INTEDG3
TMR0IP
INT3IP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
RBPU: PORTB Pull-up Enable bit
1= All PORTB pull-ups are disabled
0= PORTB pull-ups are enabled by individual port latch values
INTEDG0: External Interrupt 0 Edge Select bit
1= Interrupt on rising edge
0= Interrupt on falling edge
INTEDG1: External Interrupt 1 Edge Select bit
1= Interrupt on rising edge
0= Interrupt on falling edge
INTEDG2: External Interrupt 2 Edge Select bit
1= Interrupt on rising edge
0= Interrupt on falling edge
INTEDG3: External Interrupt 3 Edge Select bit
1= Interrupt on rising edge
0= Interrupt on falling edge
TMR0IP: TMR0 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
INT3IP: INT3 External Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
RBIP: RB Port Change Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
Note:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding
enable bit or the global interrupt enable bit. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. This feature allows for software polling.
DS39758B-page 90
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 10-3: INTCON3: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 3
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
INT3IF
R/W-0
INT2IF
R/W-0
INT1IF
INT2IP
INT1IP
INT3IE
INT2IE
INT1IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
INT2IP: INT2 External Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
INT1IP: INT1 External Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
INT3IE: INT3 External Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the INT3 external interrupt
0= Disables the INT3 external interrupt
INT2IE: INT2 External Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the INT2 external interrupt
0= Disables the INT2 external interrupt
INT1IE: INT1 External Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the INT1 external interrupt
0= Disables the INT1 external interrupt
INT3IF: INT3 External Interrupt Flag bit
1= The INT3 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0= The INT3 external interrupt did not occur
INT2IF: INT2 External Interrupt Flag bit
1= The INT2 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0= The INT2 external interrupt did not occur
INT1IF: INT1 External Interrupt Flag bit
1= The INT1 external interrupt occurred (must be cleared in software)
0= The INT1 external interrupt did not occur
Note:
Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt condition occurs, regardless of the state of its corresponding
enable bit or the global interrupt enable bit. User software should ensure the appropriate interrupt flag bits
are clear prior to enabling an interrupt. This feature allows for software polling.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 91
PIC18F1230/1330
10.2 PIR Registers
Note 1: Interrupt flag bits are set when an interrupt
condition occurs, regardless of the state of
its corresponding enable bit or the Global
Interrupt Enable bit, GIE (INTCON<7>).
The PIR registers contain the individual flag bits for the
peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of peripheral
interrupt sources, there are three Peripheral Interrupt
Request (Flag) registers (PIR1, PIR2 and PIR3).
2: User software should ensure the
appropriate interrupt flag bits are cleared
prior to enabling an interrupt and after
servicing that interrupt.
REGISTER 10-4: PIR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 1
U-0
—
R/W-0
ADIF
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RCIF
TXIF
CMP2IF
CMP1IF
CMP0IF
TMR1IF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
ADIF: A/D Converter Interrupt Flag bit
1= An A/D conversion completed (must be cleared in software)
0= The A/D conversion is not complete
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
RCIF: EUSART Receive Interrupt Flag bit
1= The EUSART receive buffer, RCREG, is full (cleared when RCREG is read)
0= The EUSART receive buffer is empty
TXIF: EUSART Transmit Interrupt Flag bit
1= The EUSART transmit buffer, TXREG, is empty (cleared when TXREG is written)
0= The EUSART transmit buffer is full
CMP2IF: Analog Comparator 2 Flag bit
1= The output of CMP2 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP2 has not changed since last read
CMP1IF: Analog Comparator 1 Flag bit
1= The output of CMP1 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP1 has not changed since last read
CMP0IF: Analog Comparator 0 Flag bit
1= The output of CMP0 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP0 has not changed since last read
TMR1IF: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Flag bit
1= TMR1 register overflowed (must be cleared in software)
0= TMR1 register did not overflow
DS39758B-page 92
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 10-5: PIR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 2
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
EEIF
U-0
—
R/W-0
LVDIF
U-0
—
U-0
—
OSCFIF
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
OSCFIF: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Flag bit
1= Device oscillator failed, clock input has changed to INTOSC (must be cleared in software)
0= Device clock operating
bit 6-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
EEIF: Data EEPROM/Flash Write Operation Interrupt Flag bit
1= The write operation is complete (must be cleared in software)
0= The write operation is not complete or has not been started
bit 3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
LVDIF: Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Flag bit
1= A low-voltage condition occurred
0= A low-voltage condition has not occurred
bit 1-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
REGISTER 10-6: PIR3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT REQUEST (FLAG) REGISTER 3
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
PTIF
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
PTIF: PWM Time Base Interrupt bit
1= PWM time base matched the value in PTPER register. Interrupt is issued according to the
postscaler settings. PTIF must be cleared in software.
0= PWM time base has not matched the value in PTPER register
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 93
PIC18F1230/1330
10.3 PIE Registers
The PIE registers contain the individual enable bits for
the peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of
peripheral interrupt sources, there are three Peripheral
Interrupt Enable registers (PIE1, PIE2 and PIE3). When
IPEN = 0, the PEIE bit must be set to enable any of
these peripheral interrupts.
REGISTER 10-7: PIE1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 1
U-0
—
R/W-0
ADIE
R-0
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
RCIE
TXIE
CMP2IE
CMP1IE
CMP0IE
TMR1IE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
ADIE: A/D Converter Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the A/D interrupt
0= Disables the A/D interrupt
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
RCIE: EUSART Receive Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the EUSART receive interrupt
0= Disables the EUSART receive interrupt
TXIE: EUSART Transmit Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the EUSART transmit interrupt
0= Disables the EUSART transmit interrupt
CMP2IE: Analog Comparator 2 Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the CMP2 interrupt
0= Disables the CMP2 interrupt
CMP1IE: Analog Comparator 1 Interrupt Enable bit
1= The output of CMP1 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP1 has not changed since last read
CMP0IE: Analog Comparator 0 Interrupt Enable bit
1= The output of CMP0 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP0 has not changed since last read
TMR1IE: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
0= Disables the TMR1 overflow interrupt
DS39758B-page 94
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 10-8: PIE2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 2
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
EEIE
U-0
—
R/W-0
LVDIE
U-0
—
U-0
—
OSCFIE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
OSCFIE: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enabled
0= Disabled
bit 6-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
EEIE: Data EEPROM/Flash Write Operation Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enabled
0= Disabled
bit 3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
LVDIE: Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Enable bit
1= Enabled
0= Disabled
bit 1-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
REGISTER 10-9: PIE3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER 3
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
PTIE
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
PTIE: PWM Time Base Interrupt Enable bit
1= PWM enabled
0= PWM disabled
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 95
PIC18F1230/1330
10.4 IPR Registers
The IPR registers contain the individual priority bits for
the peripheral interrupts. Due to the number of
peripheral interrupt sources, there are three Peripheral
Interrupt Priority registers (IPR1, IPR2 and IPR3). Using
the priority bits requires that the Interrupt Priority Enable
(IPEN) bit be set.
REGISTER 10-10: IPR1: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 1
U-0
—
R/W-1
ADIP
R/W-1
RCIP
R/W-1
TXIP
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
CMP2IP
CMP1IP
CMP0IP
TMR1IP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
ADIP: A/D Converter Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
bit 5
bit 4
RCIP: EUSART Receive Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
TXIP: EUSART Transmit Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
CMP2IP: Analog Comparator 2 Interrupt Priority bit
1= Enables the CMP2 interrupt
0= Disables the CMP2 interrupt
CMP1IP: Analog Comparator 1 Interrupt Priority bit
1= The output of CMP1 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP1 has not changed since last read
CMP0IP: Analog Comparator 0 Interrupt Priority bit
1= The output of CMP0 has changed since last read
0= The output of CMP0 has not changed since last read
TMR1IP: TMR1 Overflow Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
DS39758B-page 96
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 10-11: IPR2: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 2
R/W-1
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-1
EEIP
U-0
—
R/W-1
LVDIP
U-0
—
U-0
—
OSCFIP
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
OSCFIP: Oscillator Fail Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
bit 6-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
EEIP: Data EEPROM/Flash Write Operation Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
bit 3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
LVDIP: Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
bit 1-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
REGISTER 10-12: IPR3: PERIPHERAL INTERRUPT PRIORITY REGISTER 3
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
PTIP
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
PTIP: PWM Time Base Interrupt Priority bit
1= High priority
0= Low priority
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 97
PIC18F1230/1330
The operation of the SBOREN bit and the Reset flag
bits is discussed in more detail in Section 4.1 “RCON
Register”.
10.5 RCON Register
The RCON register contains flag bits which are used to
determine the cause of the last Reset or wake-up from
Idle or Sleep modes. RCON also contains the IPEN bit
which enables interrupt priorities.
REGISTER 10-13: RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
IPEN
R/W-1(1)
U-0
—
R/W-1
RI
R-1
TO
R-1
PD
R/W-0(2)
POR
R/W-0
BOR
SBOREN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
bit 6
IPEN: Interrupt Priority Enable bit
1= Enable priority levels on interrupts
0= Disable priority levels on interrupts (PIC16CXXX Compatibility mode)
SBOREN: BOR Software Enable bit(1)
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5
bit 4
RI: RESETInstruction Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
TO: Watchdog Time-out Flag bit
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
PD: Power-Down Detection Flag bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
POR: Power-on Reset Status bit(2)
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
BOR: Brown-out Reset Status bit
For details of bit operation, see Register 4-1.
Note 1: If SBOREN is enabled, its Reset state is ‘1’; otherwise, it is ‘0’. See Register 4-1 for additional information.
2: The actual Reset value of POR is determined by the type of device Reset. See Register 4-1 for additional
information.
DS39758B-page 98
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
10.6 INTn Pin Interrupts
10.7 TMR0 Interrupt
External interrupts on the RA0/INT0, RA1/INT1, RB2/
INT2 and RB3/INT3 pins are edge-triggered. If the
corresponding INTEDGx bit in the INTCON2 register is
set (= 1), the interrupt is triggered by a rising edge; if
the bit is clear, the trigger is on the falling edge. When
a valid edge appears on the pin, the corresponding flag
bit, INTxIF, is set. This interrupt can be disabled by
clearing the corresponding enable bit, INTxIE. Flag bit,
INTxIF, must be cleared in software in the Interrupt
Service Routine before re-enabling the interrupt.
In 8-bit mode (which is the default), an overflow in the
TMR0 register (FFh → 00h) will set flag bit, TMR0IF. In
16-bit mode, an overflow in the TMR0H:TMR0L
register pair (FFFFh → 0000h) will set TMR0IF. The
interrupt can be enabled/disabled by setting/clearing
enable bit, TMR0IE (INTCON<5>). Interrupt priority for
Timer0 is determined by the value contained in the
interrupt priority bit, TMR0IP (INTCON2<2>). See
Section 11.0 “Timer0 Module” for further details on
the Timer0 module.
All external interrupts (INT0, INT1, INT2 and INT3) can
wake-up the processor from Idle or Sleep modes if bit
INTxIE was set prior to going into those modes. If the
Global Interrupt Enable bit, GIE, is set, the processor
will branch to the interrupt vector following wake-up.
10.8 Interrupt-on-Change
An input change on PORTA<1:0> and/or PORTB<2:3>
sets flag bit, RBIF (INTCON<0>). The interrupt can be
enabled/disabled by setting/clearing enable bit, RBIE
(INTCON<3>). Interrupt priority for interrupt-on-change
is determined by the value contained in the interrupt
priority bit, RBIP (INTCON2<0>).
Interrupt priority for INT1, INT2 and INT3 is determined
by the value contained in the interrupt priority bits,
INT1IP (INTCON3<6>), INT2IP (INTCON3<7>) and
INT3IP (INTCON2<1>). There is no priority bit
associated with INT0. It is always a high priority
interrupt source.
10.9 Context Saving During Interrupts
During interrupts, the return PC address is saved on
the stack. Additionally, the WREG, STATUS and BSR
registers are saved on the fast return stack. If a fast
return from interrupt is not used (see Section 5.3
“Data Memory Organization”), the user may need to
save the WREG, STATUS and BSR registers on entry
to the Interrupt Service Routine. Depending on the
user’s application, other registers may also need to be
saved. Example 10-1 saves and restores the WREG,
STATUS and BSR registers during an Interrupt Service
Routine.
EXAMPLE 10-1:
SAVING STATUS, WREG AND BSR REGISTERS IN RAM
MOVWF
MOVFF
MOVFF
;
W_TEMP
STATUS, STATUS_TEMP
BSR, BSR_TEMP
; W_TEMP is in virtual bank
; STATUS_TEMP located anywhere
; BSR_TMEP located anywhere
; USER ISR CODE
;
MOVFF
MOVF
MOVFF
BSR_TEMP, BSR
W_TEMP, W
STATUS_TEMP, STATUS
; Restore BSR
; Restore WREG
; Restore STATUS
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 99
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 100
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Figure 11-1 shows a simplified block diagram of the
Timer0 module in 8-bit mode and Figure 11-2 shows a
simplified block diagram of the Timer0 module in 16-bit
mode.
11.0 TIMER0 MODULE
The Timer0 module has the following features:
• Software selectable as an 8-bit or
16-bit timer/counter
The T0CON register (Register 11-1) is a readable and
writable register that controls all the aspects of Timer0,
including the prescale selection.
• Readable and writable
• Dedicated 8-bit software programmable prescaler
• Clock source selectable to be external or internal
• Interrupt on overflow from FFh to 00h in 8-bit
mode and FFFFh to 0000h in 16-bit mode
• Edge select for external clock
REGISTER 11-1: T0CON: TIMER0 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
T0CS
R/W-1
T0SE
R/W-1
PSA
R/W-1
T0PS2
R/W-1
T0PS1
R/W-1
T0PS0
TMR0ON
T016BIT
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
bit 2-0
TMR0ON: Timer0 On/Off Control bit
1= Enables Timer0
0= Stops Timer0
T016BIT: Timer0 16-Bit Control bit
1= Timer0 is configured as an 8-bit timer/counter
0= Timer0 is configured as a 16-bit timer/counter
T0CS: Timer0 Clock Source Select bit
1= Transition on T0CKI pin
0= Internal instruction cycle clock (CLKO)
T0SE: Timer0 Source Edge Select bit
1= Increment on high-to-low transition on T0CKI pin
0= Increment on low-to-high transition on T0CKI pin
PSA: Timer0 Prescaler Assignment bit
1= TImer0 prescaler is NOT assigned. Timer0 clock input bypasses prescaler.
0= Timer0 prescaler is assigned. Timer0 clock input comes from prescaler output.
T0PS2:T0PS0: Timer0 Prescaler Select bits
111= 1:256 Prescale value
110= 1:128 Prescale value
101= 1:64 Prescale value
100= 1:32 Prescale value
011= 1:16 Prescale value
010= 1:8 Prescale value
001= 1:4 Prescale value
000= 1:2 Prescale value
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 101
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 11-1:
TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM IN 8-BIT MODE
Data Bus
8
FOSC/4
0
1
T0CKI pin
1
Sync with
Internal
Clocks
TMR0
Programmable
Prescaler
0
(2 TCY Delay)
T0SE
3
PSA
Set Interrupt
Flag bit TMR0IF
on Overflow
T0PS2, T0PS1, T0PS0
T0CS
Note: Upon Reset, Timer0 is enabled in 8-bit mode with clock input from T0CKI maximum prescale.
FIGURE 11-2:
TIMER0 BLOCK DIAGRAM IN 16-BIT MODE
FOSC/4
0
T0CKI pin
1
Sync with
Set Interrupt
Flag bit TMR0IF
on Overflow
TMR0
High Byte
1
Internal
Clocks
TMR0L
Programmable
Prescaler
0
8
(2 TCY Delay)
T0SE
3
Read TMR0L
Write TMR0L
T0PS2, T0PS1, T0PS0
PSA
T0CS
8
8
TMR0H
8
Data Bus<7:0>
Note: Upon Reset, Timer0 is enabled in 8-bit mode with clock input from T0CKI maximum prescale.
DS39758B-page 102
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
11.2.1
SWITCHING PRESCALER
ASSIGNMENT
11.1 Timer0 Operation
Timer0 can operate as a timer or as a counter.
The prescaler assignment is fully under software
control (i.e., it can be changed “on-the-fly” during
program execution).
Timer mode is selected by clearing the T0CS bit. In
Timer mode, the Timer0 module will increment every
instruction cycle (without prescaler). If the TMR0
register is written, the increment is inhibited for the
following two instruction cycles. The user can work
around this by writing an adjusted value to the TMR0
register.
11.3 Timer0 Interrupt
The TMR0 interrupt is generated when the TMR0
register overflows from FFh to 00h in 8-bit mode, or
FFFFh to 0000h in 16-bit mode. This overflow sets the
TMR0IF bit. The interrupt can be masked by clearing
the TMR0IE bit. The TMR0IF bit must be cleared in
software by the Timer0 module Interrupt Service
Routine before re-enabling this interrupt. The TMR0
interrupt cannot awaken the processor from Sleep
mode, since the timer requires clock cycles even when
T0CS is set.
Counter mode is selected by setting the T0CS bit. In
Counter mode, Timer0 will increment, either on every
rising or falling edge of pin RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+.
The incrementing edge is determined by the Timer0
Source Edge Select bit (T0SE). Clearing the T0SE bit
selects the rising edge.
When an external clock input is used for Timer0, it must
meet certain requirements. The requirements ensure
the external clock can be synchronized with the internal
phase clock (TOSC). Also, there is a delay in the actual
incrementing of Timer0 after synchronization.
11.4 16-Bit Mode Timer Reads and
Writes
TMR0H is not the high byte of the timer/counter in
16-bit mode, but is actually a buffered version of the
high byte of Timer0 (refer to Figure 11-2). The high byte
of the Timer0 counter/timer is not directly readable nor
writable. TMR0H is updated with the contents of the
high byte of Timer0 during a read of TMR0L. This
provides the ability to read all 16 bits of Timer0 without
having to verify that the read of the high and low byte
were valid due to a rollover between successive reads
of the high and low byte.
11.2 Prescaler
An 8-bit counter is available as a prescaler for the Timer0
module. The prescaler is not readable or writable.
The PSA and T0PS2:T0PS0 bits determine the
prescaler assignment and prescale ratio.
Clearing bit PSA will assign the prescaler to the Timer0
module. When the prescaler is assigned to the Timer0
module, prescale values of 1:2, 1:4, ..., 1:256 are
selectable.
A write to the high byte of Timer0 must also take place
through the TMR0H Buffer register. Timer0 high byte is
updated with the contents of TMR0H when a write
occurs to TMR0L. This allows all 16 bits of Timer0 to be
updated at once.
When assigned to the Timer0 module, all instructions writ-
ing to the TMR0 register (e.g., CLRF TMR0, MOVWF TMR0,
BSF TMR0, x..., etc.) will clear the prescaler count.
Note:
Writing to TMR0, when the prescaler is
assigned to Timer0, will clear the
prescaler count but will not change the
prescaler assignment.
TABLE 11-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER0
Reset
Values on
page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TMR0L
Timer0 Register Low Byte
Timer0 Register High Byte
42
42
41
42
43
TMR0H
INTCON
T0CON
TRISA
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE INT0IE
RBIE
PSA
TMR0IF INT0IF
RBIF
TMR0ON
RA7(1)
T016BIT
RA6(1)
T0CS
T0SE
T0PS2 T0PS1 T0PS0
PORTA Data Direction Control Register
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged, — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’.
Shaded cells are not used by Timer0.
Note 1: RA6 and RA7 are enabled as I/O pins depending on the oscillator mode selected in CONFIG1H.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 103
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 104
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Register 12-1 details the Timer1 Control register. This
register controls the operating mode of the Timer1
module and contains the Timer1 Oscillator Enable bit
(T1OSCEN). Timer1 can be enabled or disabled by
setting or clearing control bit, TMR1ON (T1CON<0>).
12.0 TIMER1 MODULE
The Timer1 timer/counter module has the following
features:
• 16-bit timer/counter
(two 8-bit registers; TMR1H and TMR1L)
The Timer1 oscillator can be used as a secondary clock
source in power-managed modes. When the T1RUN bit
is set, the Timer1 oscillator provides the system clock. If
the Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled and the Timer1
oscillator fails while providing the system clock, polling
the T1RUN bit will indicate whether the clock is being
provided by the Timer1 oscillator or another source.
• Readable and writable (both registers)
• Internal or external clock select
• Interrupt on overflow from FFFFh to 0000h
• Status of system clock operation
Figure 12-1 is a simplified block diagram of the Timer1
module.
Timer1 can also be used to provide Real-Time Clock
(RTC) functionality to applications with only a minimal
addition of external components and code overhead.
REGISTER 12-1: T1CON: TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
RD16
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
T1RUN
T1CKPS1
T1CKPS0
T1OSCEN
T1SYNC
TMR1CS
TMR1ON
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
RD16: 16-Bit Read/Write Mode Enable bit
1= Enables register read/write of Timer1 in one 16-bit operation
0= Enables register read/write of Timer1 in two 8-bit operations
bit 6
T1RUN: Timer1 System Clock Status bit
1= Device clock is derived from Timer1 oscillator
0= Device clock is derived from another source
bit 5-4
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits
11= 1:8 Prescale value
10= 1:4 Prescale value
01= 1:2 Prescale value
00= 1:1 Prescale value
bit 3
bit 2
T1OSCEN: Timer1 Oscillator Enable bit
1= Timer1 oscillator is enabled
0= Timer1 oscillator is shut off
The oscillator inverter and feedback resistor are turned off to eliminate power drain.
T1SYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Select bit
When TMR1CS = 1:
1= Do not synchronize external clock input
0= Synchronize external clock input
When TMR1CS = 0:
This bit is ignored. Timer1 uses the internal clock when TMR1CS = 0.
bit 1
bit 0
TMR1CS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit
1= External clock from T1OSO/T1CKI (on the rising edge)(1)
0= Internal clock (FOSC/4)
TMR1ON: Timer1 On bit
1= Enables Timer1
0= Stops Timer1
Note 1: Placement of T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI depends on the value of the Configuration bit, T1OSCMX, of CONFIG3H.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 105
PIC18F1230/1330
When TMR1CS
instruction cycle. When TMR1CS
increments on every rising edge of the external clock
input or the Timer1 oscillator, if enabled.
=
0, Timer1 increments every
1, Timer1
12.1 Timer1 Operation
=
Timer1 can operate in one of these modes:
• As a timer
• As a synchronous counter
• As an asynchronous counter
When the Timer1 oscillator is enabled (T1OSCEN is
set), the T1OSI and T1OSO/T1CKI pins become
inputs. That is, the corresponding TRISA bit value is
ignored, and the pins are read as ‘0’.
The operating mode is determined by the Clock Select
bit, TMR1CS (T1CON<1>).
FIGURE 12-1:
TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM
TMR1IF
Synchronized
Clock Input
Overflow
Interrupt
Flag Bit
0
TMR1
TMR1L
TMR1H
1
TMR1ON
On/Off
T1SYNC
T1OSC
1
T1OSO/T1CKI
T1OSI
T1OSCEN
Enable
Synchronize
det
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
(1)
Oscillator
0
2
Peripheral Clocks
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0
TMR1CS
Note 1: When enable bit T1OSCEN is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off. This eliminates power drain.
FIGURE 12-2:
TIMER1 BLOCK DIAGRAM: 16-BIT READ/WRITE MODE
Data Bus<7:0>
8
TMR1H
8
8
Write TMR1L
Read TMR1L
Synchronized
Clock Input
TMR1IF
Overflow
Interrupt
TMR1
0
8
Timer1
High Byte
TMR1L
Flag bit
1
TMR1ON
On/Off
T1SYNC
T1OSC
1
T1OSO/T1CKI
Synchronize
Prescaler
1, 2, 4, 8
T1OSCEN
det
FOSC/4
Internal
Clock
Enable
0
(1)
Oscillator
T1OSI
2
Peripheral Clocks
TMR1CS
T1CKPS1:T1CKPS0
Note 1: When enable bit T1OSCEN is cleared, the inverter and feedback resistor are turned off. This eliminates power drain.
DS39758B-page 106
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
12.2.1
USING TIMER1 AS A CLOCK
SOURCE
12.2 Timer1 Oscillator
A crystal oscillator circuit is built-in between pins T1OSI
(input) and T1OSO/TICKI (amplifier output). The place-
ment of these pins depends on the value of Configuration
bit, T1OSCMX (see Section 19.1 “Configuration
Bits”). It is enabled by setting control bit T1OSCEN
(T1CON<3>). The oscillator is a low-power oscillator
rated for 32 kHz crystals. It will continue to run during all
power-managed modes. The circuit for a typical LP
oscillator is shown in Figure 12-3. Table 12-1 shows the
capacitor selection for the Timer1 oscillator.
The Timer1 oscillator is also available as a clock source
in power-managed modes. By setting the System
Clock Select bits, SCS1:SCS0 (OSCCON<1:0>), to
‘01’, the device switches to SEC_RUN mode; both the
CPU and peripherals are clocked from the Timer1 oscil-
lator. If the IDLEN bit (OSCCON<7>) is cleared and a
SLEEP instruction is executed, the device enters
SEC_IDLE mode. Additional details are available in
Section 3.0 “Power-Managed Modes”.
Whenever the Timer1 oscillator is providing the clock
source, the Timer1 system clock status flag, T1RUN
(T1CON<6>), is set. This can be used to determine the
controller’s current clocking mode. It can also indicate
the clock source being currently used by the Fail-Safe
Clock Monitor. If the Clock Monitor is enabled and the
Timer1 oscillator fails while providing the clock, polling
the T1RUN bit will indicate whether the clock is being
provided by the Timer1 oscillator or another source.
The user must provide a software time delay to ensure
proper start-up of the Timer1 oscillator.
FIGURE 12-3:
EXTERNAL
COMPONENTS FOR THE
TIMER1 LP OSCILLATOR
C1
33 pF
PIC18FXXXX
T1OSI
12.3 Timer1 Oscillator Layout
Considerations
XTAL
32.768 kHz
The oscillator circuit, shown in Figure 12-3, should be
located as close as possible to the microcontroller.
There should be no circuits passing within the oscillator
circuit boundaries other than VSS or VDD.
T1OSO/T1CKI
C2
33 pF
Note:
See the notes with Table 12-1 for addi-
tional information about capacitor selec-
If a high-speed circuit must be located near the
oscillator (such as the PWM pin, or the primary
oscillator using the OSC2 pin), a grounded guard ring
around the oscillator circuit, as shown in Figure 12-4,
may be helpful when used on a single-sided PCB, or in
addition to a ground plane.
TABLE 12-1: CAPACITOR SELECTION FOR
THE TIMER OSCILLATOR
Osc Type
Freq
C1
C2
FIGURE 12-4:
OSCILLATOR CIRCUIT
WITH GROUNDED GUARD
RING
LP
32 kHz
27 pF(1)
27 pF(1)
Note 1: Microchip suggests this value as a starting
point in validating the oscillator circuit.
2: Higher capacitance increases the stability
of the oscillator, but also increases the
start-up time.
RB3
RB2
3: Since each resonator/crystal has its own
characteristics, the user should consult
the resonator/crystal manufacturer for
OSC1
OSC2
appropriate
values
of
external
components.
4: Capacitor values are for design guidance
only.
VDD
Note: Not drawn to scale.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 107
PIC18F1230/1330
12.4 Timer1 Interrupt
12.6 Using Timer1 as a Real-Time Clock
The TMR1 register pair (TMR1H:TMR1L) increments
from 0000h to FFFFh and rolls over to 0000h. The
Timer1 interrupt, if enabled, is generated on overflow
which is latched in interrupt flag bit, TMR1IF
(PIR1<0>). This interrupt can be enabled/disabled by
setting/clearing Timer1 interrupt enable bit, TMR1IE
(PIE1<0>).
Adding an external LP oscillator to Timer1 (such as the
one described in Section 12.2 “Timer1 Oscillator”),
gives users the option to include RTC functionality to
their applications. This is accomplished with an
inexpensive watch crystal to provide an accurate time
base and several lines of application code to calculate
the time. When operating in Sleep mode and using a
battery or super capacitor as a power source, it can
completely eliminate the need for a separate RTC
device and battery backup.
12.5 Timer1 16-Bit Read/Write Mode
Timer1 can be configured for 16-bit reads and writes
(see Figure 12-2). When the RD16 control bit
(T1CON<7>) is set, the address for TMR1H is mapped
to a buffer register for the high byte of Timer1. A read
from TMR1L will load the contents of the high byte of
Timer1 into the Timer1 High Byte Buffer register. This
provides the user with the ability to accurately read all
16 bits of Timer1 without having to determine whether
a read of the high byte, followed by a read of the low
byte, is valid due to a rollover between reads.
The application code routine, RTCisr, shown in
Example 12-1, demonstrates a simple method to
increment a counter at one-second intervals using an
Interrupt Service Routine. Incrementing the TMR1
register pair to overflow triggers the interrupt and calls
the routine, which increments the seconds counter by
one. Additional counters for minutes and hours are
incremented as the previous counter overflow.
Since the register pair is 16 bits wide, counting up to
overflow the register directly from a 32.768 kHz clock
would take 2 seconds. To force the overflow at the
required one-second intervals, it is necessary to pre-
load it. The simplest method is to set the MSb of
TMR1H with a BSF instruction. Note that the TMR1L
register is never preloaded or altered; doing so may
introduce cumulative error over many cycles.
A write to the high byte of Timer1 must also take place
through the TMR1H Buffer register. Timer1 high byte is
updated with the contents of TMR1H when a write
occurs to TMR1L. This allows a user to write all 16 bits
to both the high and low bytes of Timer1 at once.
The high byte of Timer1 is not directly readable or
writable in this mode. All reads and writes must take
place through the Timer1 High Byte Buffer register.
Writes to TMR1H do not clear the Timer1 prescaler.
The prescaler is only cleared on writes to TMR1L.
For this method to be accurate, Timer1 must operate in
Asynchronous mode and the Timer1 overflow interrupt
must be enabled (PIE1<0> = 1), as shown in the
routine, RTCinit. The Timer1 oscillator must also be
enabled and running at all times.
DS39758B-page 108
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
EXAMPLE 12-1:
IMPLEMENTING A REAL-TIME CLOCK USING A TIMER1 INTERRUPT SERVICE
RTCinit
MOVLW
MOVWF
CLRF
0x80
TMR1H
TMR1L
; Preload TMR1 register pair
; for 1 second overflow
MOVLW
MOVWF
CLRF
b’00001111’
T1OSC
secs
; Configure for external clock,
; Asynchronous operation, external oscillator
; Initialize timekeeping registers
;
CLRF
mins
MOVLW
MOVWF
BSF
.12
hours
PIE1, TMR1IE
; Enable Timer1 interrupt
RETURN
RTCisr
BSF
BCF
INCF
MOVLW
CPFSGT
RETURN
CLRF
TMR1H, 7
PIR1, TMR1IF
secs, F
.59
; Preload for 1 sec overflow
; Clear interrupt flag
; Increment seconds
; 60 seconds elapsed?
secs
; No, done
secs
mins, F
.59
; Clear seconds
; Increment minutes
; 60 minutes elapsed?
INCF
MOVLW
CPFSGT
RETURN
CLRF
mins
; No, done
mins
hours, F
.23
; clear minutes
; Increment hours
; 24 hours elapsed?
INCF
MOVLW
CPFSGT
RETURN
MOVLW
MOVWF
RETURN
hours
; No, done
; Reset hours to 1
.01
hours
; Done
TABLE 12-2: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH TIMER1 AS A TIMER/COUNTER
Reset
Values on
page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
—
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
CMP2IF
CMP2IE
CMP2IP
CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
TXIP
IPR1
TMR1L
TMR1H
T1CON
Timer1 Register Low Byte
Timer1 Register High Byte
RD16
T1RUN T1CKPS1 T1CKPS0 T1OSCEN T1SYNC TMR1CS TMR1ON
Legend: x= unknown, u= unchanged, — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Shaded cells are not used by the Timer1 module.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 109
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 110
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The PWM module has the following features:
13.0 POWER CONTROL PWM
MODULE
• Up to six PWM I/O pins with three duty cycle
generators. Pins can be paired to acquire a
complete half-bridge control.
The Power Control PWM module simplifies the task of
generating multiple, synchronized Pulse-Width
Modulated (PWM) outputs for use in the control of
motor controllers and power conversion applications.
In particular, the following power and motion control
applications are supported by the PWM module:
• Up to 14-bit resolution, depending upon the PWM
period.
• “On-the-fly” PWM frequency changes.
• Edge and Center-Aligned Output modes.
• Single-Pulse Generation mode.
• Three-Phase and Single-Phase AC Induction
Motors
• Programmable dead-time control between paired
PWMs.
• Switched Reluctance Motors
• Brushless DC (BLDC) Motors
• Uninterruptible Power Supplies (UPS)
• Multiple DC Brush Motors
• Interrupt support for asymmetrical updates in
Center-Aligned mode.
• Output override for Electrically Commutated Motor
(ECM) operation; for example, BLDC.
• Special Event Trigger comparator for triggering A/D
conversion.
• PWM outputs disable feature sets PWM outputs to
their inactive state when in Debug mode.
The Power Control PWM module supports three PWM
generators and six output channels on PIC18F1230/
1330 devices. A simplified block diagram of the module
is shown in Figure 13-1. Figure 13-2 and Figure 13-3
show how the module hardware is configured for each
PWM output pair for the Complementary and
Independent Output modes.
Each functional unit of the PWM module will be
discussed in subsequent sections.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 111
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-1:
POWER CONTROL PWM MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
Internal Data Bus
8
PWMCON0
PWMCON1
DTCON
PWM Enable and Mode
8
8
8
8
Dead-Time Control
Fault Pin Control
FLTCONFIG
PWM Manual Control
OVDCON<D/S>
(1)
PWM Generator #2
PDC2 Buffer
8
PDC2
Channel 2
PWM5
PWM4
Comparator
Dead-Time Generator
(1)
and Override Logic
8
PWM
Generator 1
Channel 1
Dead-Time Generator
and Override Logic
PWM3
PWM2
PTMR
Comparator
PTPER
Output
Driver
Block
PWM
Generator 0
Channel 0
Dead-Time Generator
and Override Logic
PWM1
PWM0
8
8
PTPER Buffer
FLTA
PTCONx
Special Event
Postscaler
Comparator
Special Event Trigger
SEVTDIR
PTDIR
8
SEVTCMP
Note 1: Only PWM Generator 2 is shown in detail. The other generators are identical; their details are omitted for clarity.
DS39758B-page 112
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-2:
PWM MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM, ONE OUTPUT PAIR, COMPLEMENTARY MODE
VDD
Dead-Band
Generator
PWM1
Duty Cycle Comparator
HPOL
LPOL
PWM Duty Cycle Register
PWM0
Fault Override Values
Channel Override Values
Fault Pin Assignment
Logic
Fault A pin
Note:
In the Complementary mode, the even channel cannot be forced active by a Fault or override event when the odd channel is
active. The even channel is always the complement of the odd channel and is inactive, with dead time inserted, before the odd
channel is driven to its active state.
FIGURE 13-3:
PWM MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM, ONE OUTPUT PAIR, INDEPENDENT MODE
VDD
PWM Duty Cycle Register
PWM1
Duty Cycle Comparator
HPOL
VDD
PWM0
LPOL
Fault Override Values
Channel Override Values
Fault Pin Assignment
Logic
Fault A pin
This module contains three duty cycle generators,
numbered 0 through 2. The module has six PWM
output pins, numbered 0 through 5. The six PWM
outputs are grouped into output pairs of even and odd
numbered outputs. In Complementary modes, the even
PWM pins must always be the complement of the
corresponding odd PWM pins. For example, PWM0 will
be the complement of PWM1 and PWM2 will be the
complement of PWM3. The dead-time generator
inserts an OFF period called “dead time” between the
going OFF of one pin to the going ON of the
complementary pin of the paired pins. This is to prevent
damage to the power switching devices that will be
connected to the PWM output pins.
The time base for the PWM module is provided by its
own 12-bit timer, which also incorporates selectable
prescaler and postscaler options.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 113
PIC18F1230/1330
13.1 Control Registers
13.2 Module Functionality
The operation of the PWM module is controlled by a
total of 20 registers. Eight of these are used to
configure the features of the module:
The PWM module supports several modes of operation
that are beneficial for specific power and motor control
applications. Each mode of operation is described in
subsequent sections.
• PWM Timer Control Register 0 (PTCON0)
• PWM Timer Control Register 1 (PTCON1)
• PWM Control Register 0 (PWMCON0)
• PWM Control Register 1 (PWMCON1)
• Dead-Time Control Register (DTCON)
• Output Override Control Register (OVDCOND)
• Output State Register (OVDCONS)
The PWM module is composed of several functional
blocks. The operation of each is explained separately
in relation to the several modes of operation:
• PWM Time Base
• PWM Time Base Interrupts
• PWM Period
• PWM Duty Cycle
• Fault Configuration Register (FLTCONFIG)
• Dead-Time Generators
• PWM Output Overrides
• PWM Fault Inputs
There are also 12 registers that are configured as six
register pairs of 16 bits. These are used for the
configuration values of specific features. They are:
• PWM Special Event Trigger
• PWM Time Base Registers (PTMRH and PTMRL)
• PWM Time Base Period Registers (PTPERH and
PTPERL)
13.3 PWM Time Base
• PWM Special Event Compare Registers
(SEVTCMPH and SEVTCMPL)
The PWM time base is provided by a 12-bit timer with
prescaler and postscaler functions. A simplified block
diagram of the PWM time base is shown in Figure 13-4.
The PWM time base is configured through the PTCON0
and PTCON1 registers. The time base is enabled or
disabled by respectively setting or clearing the PTEN bit
in the PTCON1 register.
• PWM Duty Cycle #0 Registers
(PDC0H and PDC0L)
• PWM Duty Cycle #1 Registers
(PDC1H and PDC1L)
• PWM Duty Cycle #2 Registers
(PDC2H and PDC2L)
Note:
The PTMR register pair (PTMRL:PTMRH)
is not cleared when the PTEN bit is
cleared in software.
All of these register pairs are double-buffered.
DS39758B-page 114
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-4:
PWM TIME BASE BLOCK DIAGRAM
PTMR Register
PTMR Clock
Timer Reset
Up/Down
Zero Match
Comparator
Timer
Direction
Control
PTDIR
Period Match
PTMOD1
Comparator
PTPER
Duty Cycle Load
Period Load
PTPER Buffer
Update Disable (UDIS)
Zero Match
Period Match
PTMOD1
PTMR Clock
PTEN
Clock
Control
PTMOD0
Prescaler
1:1, 1:4, 1:16, 1:64
FOSC/4
Zero Match
Postscaler
1:1-1:16
Interrupt
Control
PTIF
Period Match
PTMOD1
PTMOD0
The PWM time base can be configured for four different
modes of operation:
These four modes are selected by the
PTMOD1:PTMOD0 bits in the PTCON0 register. The
Free-Running mode produces edge-aligned PWM
generation. The Continuous Up/Down Count modes
produce center-aligned PWM generation. The Single-
Shot mode allows the PWM module to support pulse
control of certain Electronically Commutated Motors
(ECMs) and produces edge-aligned operation.
• Free-Running mode
• Single-Shot mode
• Continuous Up/Down Count mode
• Continuous Up/Down Count mode with interrupts
for double updates
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 115
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 13-1: PTCON0: PWM TIMER CONTROL REGISTER 0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PTOPS3
PTOPS2
PTOPS1
PTOPS0
PTCKPS1
PTCKPS0
PTMOD1
PTMOD0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-4
PTOPS3:PTOPS0: PWM Time Base Output Postscale Select bits
0000= 1:1 Postscale
0001= 1:2 Postscale
.
.
.
1111= 1:16 Postscale
bit 3-2
bit 1-0
PTCKPS1:PTCKPS0: PWM Time Base Input Clock Prescale Select bits
00= PWM time base input clock is FOSC/4 (1:1 prescale)
01= PWM time base input clock is FOSC/16 (1:4 prescale)
10= PWM time base input clock is FOSC/64 (1:16 prescale)
11= PWM time base input clock is FOSC/256 (1:64 prescale)
PTMOD1:PTMOD0: PWM Time Base Mode Select bits
11= PWM time base operates in a Continuous Up/Down Count mode with interrupts for double PWM
updates
10= PWM time base operates in a Continuous Up/Down Count mode
01= PWM time base configured for Single-Shot mode
00= PWM time base operates in a Free-Running mode
REGISTER 13-2: PTCON1: PWM TIMER CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-0
PTEN
R-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
PTDIR
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
PTEN: PWM Time Base Timer Enable bit
1= PWM time base is on
0= PWM time base is off
bit 6
PTDIR: PWM Time Base Count Direction Status bit
1= PWM time base counts down
0= PWM time base counts up
bit 5-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
DS39758B-page 116
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 13-3: PWMCON0: PWM CONTROL REGISTER 0
U-0
—
R/W-1(1)
R/W-1(1)
R/W-1(1)
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
PWMEN2
PWMEN1
PWMEN0
PMOD2
PMOD1
PMOD0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 6-4
PWMEN2:PWMEN0: PWM Module Enable bits(1)
111= All odd PWM I/O pins enabled for PWM output
110= PWM1, PWM3 pins enabled for PWM output
10x= All PWM I/O pins enabled for PWM output
011= PWM0, PWM1, PWM2 and PWM3 I/O pins enabled for PWM output
010= PWM0 and PWM1 pins enabled for PWM output
001= PWM1 pin is enabled for PWM output
000= PWM module disabled; all PWM I/O pins are general purpose I/O
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 2-0
PMOD2:PMOD0: PWM Output Pair Mode bits
For PMOD0:
1= PWM I/O pin pair (PWM0, PWM1) is in the Independent mode
0= PWM I/O pin pair (PWM0, PWM1) is in the Complementary mode
For PMOD1:
1= PWM I/O pin pair (PWM2, PWM3) is in the Independent mode
0= PWM I/O pin pair (PWM2, PWM3) is in the Complementary mode
For PMOD2:
1= PWM I/O pin pair (PWM4, PWM5) is in the Independent mode
0= PWM I/O pin pair (PWM4, PWM5) is in the Complementary mode
Note 1: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 117
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 13-4: PWMCON1: PWM CONTROL REGISTER 1
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
U-0
—
R/W-0
UDIS
R/W-0
SEVOPS3
SEVOPS2
SEVOPS1
SEVOPS0
SEVTDIR
OSYNC
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
-n = Value at POR
bit 7-4
SEVOPS3:SEVOPS0: PWM Special Event Trigger Output Postscale Select bits
0000= 1:1 Postscale
0001= 1:2 Postscale
.
.
.
1111= 1:16 Postscale
bit 3
SEVTDIR: Special Event Trigger Time Base Direction bit
1= A Special Event Trigger will occur when the PWM time base is counting downwards
0= A Special Event Trigger will occur when the PWM time base is counting upwards
bit 2
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
UDIS: PWM Update Disable bit
1= Updates from Duty Cycle and Period Buffer registers are disabled
0= Updates from Duty Cycle and Period Buffer registers are enabled
bit 0
OSYNC: PWM Output Override Synchronization bit
1= Output overrides via the OVDCON register are synchronized to the PWM time base
0= Output overrides via the OVDCON register are asynchronous
DS39758B-page 118
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Table 13-1 shows the minimum PWM frequencies that
can be generated with the PWM time base and the
prescaler. An operating frequency of 40 MHz
(FCYC = 10 MHz) and PTPER = 0xFFF are assumed in
the table. The PWM module must be capable of
generating PWM signals at the line frequency (50 Hz or
60 Hz) for certain power control applications.
13.3.1
FREE-RUNNING MODE
In the Free-Running mode, the PWM time base
(PTMRL and PTMRH) will begin counting upwards until
the value in the PWM Time Base Period register,
PTPER (PTPERL and PTPERH), is matched. The
PTMR registers will be reset on the following input
clock edge and the time base will continue counting
upwards as long as the PTEN bit remains set.
TABLE 13-1: MINIMUM PWM FREQUENCY
13.3.2
SINGLE-SHOT MODE
Minimum PWM Frequencies vs. Prescaler Value
for FCYC = 10 MIPS (PTPER = 0FFFh)
In the Single-Shot mode, the PWM time base will begin
counting upwards when the PTEN bit is set. When the
value in the PTMR register matches the PTPER
register, the PTMR register will be reset on the
following input clock edge and the PTEN bit will be
cleared by the hardware to halt the time base.
PWM
PWM
Prescale
Frequency
Frequency
Edge-Aligned Center-Aligned
1:1
1:4
2441 Hz
610 Hz
153 Hz
38 Hz
1221 Hz
305 Hz
76 Hz
13.3.3
CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT
MODES
1:16
1:64
19 Hz
In Continuous Up/Down Count modes, the PWM time
base counts upwards until the value in the PTPER
register matches the PTMR register. On the following
input clock edge, the timer counts downwards. The
PTDIR bit in the PTCON1 register is read-only and
indicates the counting direction. The PTDIR bit is set
when the timer counts downwards.
13.3.5
PWM TIME BASE POSTSCALER
The match output of PTMR can optionally be
postscaled through a 4-bit postscaler (which gives a
1:1 to 1:16 scaling inclusive) to generate an interrupt.
The postscaler counter is cleared when any of the
following occurs:
Note:
Since the PWM compare outputs are
driven to the active state when the PWM
time-base is counting downwards and
matches the duty cycle value, the PWM
outputs are held inactive during the first
half of the first period of the Continuous
Up/Down Count mode until the PTMR
begins to count down from the PTPER
value.
• Write to the PTMR register
• Write to the PTCONx register
• Any device Reset
The PTMR register is not cleared when PTCONx is
written.
13.4 PWM Time Base Interrupts
The PWM timer can generate interrupts based on the
modes of operation selected by the PTMOD<1:0> bits
and the postscaler bits (PTOPS<3:0>).
13.3.4
PWM TIME BASE PRESCALER
The input clock to PTMR (FOSC/4) has prescaler
options of 1:1, 1:4, 1:16 or 1:64. These are selected by
control bits, PTCKPS<1:0>, in the PTCON0 register.
The prescaler counter is cleared when any of the
following occurs:
13.4.1
INTERRUPTS IN FREE-RUNNING
MODE
When the PWM time base is in the Free-Running mode
(PTMOD<1:0> = 00), an interrupt event is generated
each time a match with the PTPER register occurs. The
PTMR register is reset to zero in the following clock
edge.
• Write to the PTMR register
• Write to the PTCON (PTCON0 or PTCON1) register
• Any device Reset
Note:
The PTMR register is not cleared when
PTCONx is written.
Using a postscaler selection other than 1:1 will reduce
the frequency of interrupt events.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 119
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-5:
PWM TIME BASE INTERRUPT TIMING, FREE-RUNNING MODE
A: PRESCALER = 1:1
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
FOSC/4
1
PTMR
002h
FFEh
FFFh
000h
001h
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
B: PRESCALER = 1:4
Q4
Q4
Qc
Qc Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc
Qc
Qc Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc Qc
Qc
Qc Qc
Qc
Qc
1
PTMR
FFEh
FFFh
000h
001h
002h
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
Note 1: PWM Time Base Period register, PTPER, is loaded with the value FFFh for this example.
13.4.2
INTERRUPTS IN SINGLE-SHOT
MODE
13.4.3
INTERRUPTS IN CONTINUOUS
UP/DOWN COUNT MODE
When the PWM time base is in the Single-Shot mode
(PTMOD<1:0> = 01), an interrupt event is generated
when a match with the PTPER register occurs. The
PWM Time Base register (PTMR) is reset to zero on
the following input clock edge and the PTEN bit is
cleared. The postscaler selection bits have no effect in
this Timer mode.
In the Continuous Up/Down Count mode
(PTMOD<1:0> = 10), an interrupt event is generated
each time the value of the PTMR register becomes
zero and the PWM time base begins to count upwards.
The postscaler selection bits may be used in this Timer
mode to reduce the frequency of the interrupt events.
Figure 13-7 shows the interrupts in Continuous Up/
Down Count mode.
DS39758B-page 120
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-6:
PWM TIME BASE INTERRUPT TIMING, SINGLE-SHOT MODE
A: PRESCALER = 1:1
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
FOSC/4
PTMR
2
FFEh
FFFh
000h
000h
000h
1
1
1
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
B: PRESCALER = 1:4
Q4
Q4
Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc
FFFh
Qc Qc Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc Qc
Qc
Qc Qc Qc
Qc
2
PTMR
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
FFEh
000h
000h
000h
1
1
1
Note 1: Interrupt flag bit, PTIF, is sampled here (every Q1).
2: PWM Time Base Period register, PTPER, is loaded with the value FFFh for this example.
FIGURE 13-7:
PWM TIME BASE INTERRUPTS, CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT MODE
PRESCALER = 1:1
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
FOSC/4
002h
001h
000h
001h
002h
PTMR
PTDIR bit
PTMR_INT_REQ
1
1
1
1
PTIF bit
PRESCALER = 1:4
Q4
Q4
Qc
Qc Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc
001h
Qc
Qc
Qc Qc
002h
Qc
001h
PTMR
002h
000h
PTDIR bit
1
1
1
1
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
Note 1: Interrupt flag bit, PTIF, is sampled here (every Q1).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 121
PIC18F1230/1330
2. Asymmetrical center-aligned PWM waveforms
can be generated, which are useful for
minimizing output waveform distortion in certain
motor control applications.
13.4.4
INTERRUPTS IN DOUBLE UPDATE
MODE
This mode is available in Continuous Up/Down Count
mode. In the Double Update mode (PTMOD<1:0> = 11),
an interrupt event is generated each time the PTMR
register is equal to zero and each time the PTMR
matches the PTPER register. Figure 13-8 shows the
interrupts in Continuous Up/Down Count mode with
double updates.
Note:
Do not change the PTMOD bits while
PTEN is active. It will yield unexpected
results. To change the PWM Timer mode
of operation, first clear the PTEN bit, load
PTMOD bits with required data and then
set PTEN.
The Double Update mode provides two additional
functions to the user in Center-Aligned mode.
1. The control loop bandwidth is doubled because
the PWM duty cycles can be updated twice per
period.
FIGURE 13-8:
PWM TIME BASE INTERRUPTS, CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT MODE WITH
DOUBLE UPDATES
A: PRESCALER = 1:1
Case 1: PTMR Counting Upwards
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
OSC1
2
PTMR
3FEh
3FDh
3FFh
3FEh
3FDh
PTDIR bit
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
1
1
1
1
Case 2: PTMR Counting Downwards
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
Q1 Q2 Q3
Q4
OSC1
PTMR
PTDIR bit
002h
001h
000h
001h
002h
PTMR_INT_REQ
PTIF bit
1
1
1
1
Note 1: Interrupt flag bit, PTIF, is sampled here (every Q1).
2: PWM Time Base Period register, PTPER, is loaded with the value 3FFh for this example.
DS39758B-page 122
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The maximum resolution (in bits) for a given device
oscillator and PWM frequency can be determined from
the following formula:
13.5 PWM Period
The PWM period is defined by the PTPER register pair
(PTPERL and PTPERH). The PWM period has 12-bit
resolution by combining 4 LSBs of PTPERH and 8 bits
of PTPERL. PTPER is a double-buffered register used
to set the counting period for the PWM time base.
EQUATION 13-4: PWM RESOLUTION
FOSC
log
FPWM
The PTPER buffer contents are loaded into the PTPER
register at the following times:
Resolution =
log(2)
• Free-Running and Single-Shot modes: When the
PTMR register is reset to zero after a match with the
PTPER register.
The PWM resolutions and frequencies are shown for a
selection of execution speeds and PTPER values in
Table 13-2. The PWM frequencies in Table 13-2 are
calculated for Edge-Aligned PWM mode. For Center-
Aligned mode, the PWM frequencies will be
approximately one-half the values indicated in this
table.
• Continuous Up/Down Count modes: When the
PTMR register is zero. The value held in the PTPER
buffer is automatically loaded into the PTPER
register when the PWM time base is disabled
(PTEN = 0). Figure 13-9 and Figure 13-10 indicate
the times when the contents of the PTPER buffer
are loaded into the actual PTPER register.
TABLE 13-2: EXAMPLE PWM
FREQUENCIES AND
RESOLUTIONS
The PWM period can be calculated from the following
formulas:
PWM Frequency = 1/TPWM
EQUATION 13-1: PWM PERIOD FOR
FREE-RUNNING MODE
PTPER
PWM
PWM
FOSC
MIPS
Value Resolution Frequency
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
40 MHz
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
0FFFh
07FFh
03FFh
01FFh
FFh
14 bits
13 bits
12 bits
11 bits
10 bits
9 bits
2.4 kHz
4.9 kHz
9.8 kHz
19.5 kHz
39.0 kHz
78.1 kHz
156.2 kHz
312.5 kHz
625 kHz
1.5 kHz
6.1 kHz
24.4 kHz
610 Hz
(PTPER + 1) x PTMRPS
TPWM =
FOSC/4
EQUATION 13-2: PWM PERIOD FOR
CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN
COUNT MODE
7Fh
3Fh
8 bits
(2 x PTPER) x PTMRPS
TPWM =
1Fh
7 bits
FOSC
4
0Fh
6 bits
25 MHz 6.25 0FFFh
25 MHz 6.25 03FFh
14 bits
12 bits
10 bits
14 bits
12 bits
10 bits
14 bits
12 bits
10 bits
14 bits
12 bits
10 bits
The PWM frequency is the inverse of period; or
25 MHz 6.25
FFh
10 MHz
10 MHz
10 MHz
5 MHz
5 MHz
5 MHz
4 MHz
4 MHz
4 MHz
Note:
2.5 0FFFh
EQUATION 13-3: PWM FREQUENCY
2.5
2.5
03FFh
FFh
2.4 kHz
9.8 kHz
305 Hz
1
PWM Frequency =
PWM Period
1.25 0FFFh
1.25 03FFh
1.2 kHz
4.9 kHz
244 Hz
1.25
FFh
0FFFh
03FFh
FFh
1
1
1
976 Hz
3.9 kHz
For center-aligned operation, PWM
frequencies will be approximately 1/2 the
value indicated in the table.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 123
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-9:
PWM PERIOD BUFFER UPDATES IN FREE-RUNNING MODE
Period Value Loaded from PTPER Buffer Register
7
New PTPER Value = 007
6
5
4
Old PTPER Value = 004
4
4
3
3
3
2
2
2
1
1
1
0
0
0
New Value Written to PTPER Buffer
FIGURE 13-10:
PWM PERIOD BUFFER UPDATES IN CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT MODES
Period Value Loaded from
PTPER Buffer Register
7
New PTPER Value = 007
6
6
5
5
4
4
Old PTPER Value = 004
4
3
3
3
3
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
New Value Written to PTPER Buffer
DS39758B-page 124
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
PTMR and the lower 2 bits are equal to Q1, Q2, Q3 or
Q4, depending on the lower two bits of the PDCx (when
the prescaler is 1:1 or PTCKPS<1:0> = 00).
13.6 PWM Duty Cycle
PWM duty cycle is defined by the PDCx (PDCxL and
PDCxH) registers. There are a total of three PWM Duty
Cycle registers for four pairs of PWM channels. The
Duty Cycle registers have 14-bit resolution by combin-
ing the six LSbs of PDCxH with the 8 bits of PDCxL.
PDCx is a double-buffered register used to set the
counting period for the PWM time base.
Note:
When the prescaler is not 1:1
(PTCKPS<1:0> ≠ ~00), the duty cycle
match occurs at the Q1 clock of the
instruction cycle when the PTMR and
PDCx match occurs.
Each compare unit has logic that allows override of the
PWM signals. This logic also ensures that the PWM
signals will complement each other (with dead-time
insertion) in Complementary mode (see Section 13.7
“Dead-Time Generators”).
13.6.1
PWM DUTY CYCLE REGISTERS
There are three 14-bit Special Function Registers used
to specify duty cycle values for the PWM module:
• PDC0 (PDC0L and PDC0H)
• PDC1 (PDC1L and PDC1H)
• PDC2 (PDC2L and PDC2H)
Note:
To get the correct PWM duty cycle, always
multiply the calculated PWM duty cycle
value by four before writing it to the PWM
Duty Cycle registers. This is due to the two
additional LSBs in the PWM Duty Cycle
registers which are compared against the
internal Q clock for the PWM duty cycle
match.
The value in each Duty Cycle register determines the
amount of time that the PWM output is in the active
state. The upper 12 bits of PDCx hold the actual duty
cycle value from PTMRH/L<11:0>, while the lower two
bits control which internal Q clock the duty cycle match
will occur. This 2-bit value is decoded from the Q
clocks, as shown in Figure 13-11, when the prescaler is
1:1 (PTCKPS<1:0> = 00).
In Edge-Aligned mode, the PWM period starts at Q1 and
ends when the Duty Cycle register matches the PTMR
register as follows. The duty cycle match is considered
when the upper 12 bits of the PDCx are equal to the
FIGURE 13-11:
DUTY CYCLE COMPARISON
PTMRH<7:0>
PTMRL<7:0>
PTMR<11:0>
Q Clocks(1)
PTMRH<3:0>
Unused
PTMRL<7:0>
<1:0>
Comparator
Unused
PDCxH<5:0>
PDCxL<7:0>
PDCxL<7:0>
PDCx<13:0>
PDCxH<7:0>
Note 1: This value is decoded from the Q clocks:
00= duty cycle match occurs on Q1
01= duty cycle match occurs on Q2
10= duty cycle match occurs on Q3
11= duty cycle match occurs on Q4
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 125
PIC18F1230/1330
13.6.2
DUTY CYCLE REGISTER BUFFERS
13.6.3
EDGE-ALIGNED PWM
The three PWM Duty Cycle registers are double-
buffered to allow glitchless updates of the PWM
outputs. For each duty cycle block, there is a Duty
Cycle Buffer register that is accessible by the user and
a second Duty Cycle register that holds the actual
compare value used in the present PWM period.
Edge-aligned PWM signals are produced by the module
when the PWM time base is in the Free-Running mode
or the Single-Shot mode. For edge-aligned PWM
outputs, the output for a given PWM channel has a
period specified by the value loaded in PTPER and a
duty cycle specified by the appropriate Duty Cycle
register (see Figure 13-12). The PWM output is driven
active at the beginning of the period (PTMR = 0) and is
driven inactive when the value in the Duty Cycle register
matches PTMR. A new cycle is started when PTMR
matches the PTPER, as explained in the PWM period
section.
In Edge-Aligned PWM Output mode, a new duty cycle
value will be updated whenever a PTMR match with the
PTPER register occurs and PTMR is reset, as shown in
Figure 13-12. Also, the contents of the duty cycle buffers
are automatically loaded into the Duty Cycle registers
when the PWM time base is disabled (PTEN = 0).
If the value in a particular Duty Cycle register is zero,
then the output on the corresponding PWM pin will be
inactive for the entire PWM period. In addition, the out-
put on the PWM pin will be active for the entire PWM
period if the value in the Duty Cycle register is greater
than the value held in the PTPER register.
When the PWM time base is in the Continuous Up/
Down Count mode, new duty cycle values will be
updated when the value of the PTMR register is zero
and the PWM time base begins to count upwards. The
contents of the duty cycle buffers are automatically
loaded into the Duty Cycle registers when the PWM
time base is disabled (PTEN = 0). Figure 13-13 shows
the timings when the duty cycle update occurs for the
Continuous Up/Down Count mode. In this mode, up to
one entire PWM period is available for calculating and
loading the new PWM duty cycle before changes take
effect.
FIGURE 13-12:
EDGE-ALIGNED PWM
New Duty Cycle Latched
PTPER
When the PWM time base is in the Continuous Up/
Down Count mode with double updates, new duty cycle
values will be updated when the value of the PTMR
register is zero and when the value of the PTMR
register matches the value in the PTPER register. The
contents of the duty cycle buffers are automatically
loaded into the Duty Cycle registers during both of the
previously described conditions. Figure 13-14 shows
the duty cycle updates for Continuous Up/Down Count
mode with double updates. In this mode, up to half of a
PWM period is available for calculating and loading the
new PWM duty cycle before changes take effect.
PTMR
Value
PDCx
(old)
PDCx
(new)
0
Duty Cycle
Active at
Beginning
of Period
Period
FIGURE 13-13:
DUTY CYCLE UPDATE TIMES IN CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT MODE
Duty Cycle Value Loaded from Buffer Register
PWM Output
PTMR Value
New Value Written to Duty Cycle Buffer
DS39758B-page 126
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-14:
DUTY CYCLE UPDATE TIMES IN CONTINUOUS UP/DOWN COUNT MODE WITH
DOUBLE UPDATES
Duty Cycle Value Loaded from Buffer Register
PWM Output
PTMR Value
New Values Written to Duty Cycle Buffer
inactive for the entire PWM period. In addition, the
output on the PWM pin will be active for the entire PWM
period if the value in the Duty Cycle register is equal to
or greater than the value in the PTPER register.
13.6.4
CENTER-ALIGNED PWM
Center-aligned PWM signals are produced by the
module when the PWM time base is configured in a
Continuous Up/Down Count mode (see Figure 13-15).
The PWM compare output is driven to the active state
when the value of the Duty Cycle register matches the
value of PTMR and the PWM time base is counting
downwards (PTDIR = 1). The PWM compare output
will be driven to the inactive state when the PWM time
base is counting upwards (PTDIR = 0) and the value in
the PTMR register matches the duty cycle value. If the
value in a particular Duty Cycle register is zero, then
the output on the corresponding PWM pin will be
Note:
When the PWM is started in Center-
Aligned mode, the PWM Time Base
Period register (PTPER) is loaded into the
PWM Time Base register (PTMR) and the
PTMR is configured automatically to start
down counting. This is done to ensure that
all the PWM signals don’t start at the same
time.
FIGURE 13-15:
START OF CENTER-ALIGNED PWM
Period/2
PTPER
PTMR
Value
Duty
Cycle
0
Duty Cycle
Start of
First
PWM
Period
Period
Period
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 127
PIC18F1230/1330
13.6.5
COMPLEMENTARY PWM
OPERATION
FIGURE 13-16:
TYPICAL LOAD FOR
COMPLEMENTARY PWM
OUTPUTS
The Complementary mode of PWM operation is useful
to drive one or more power switches in half-bridge
configuration, as shown in Figure 13-16. This inverter
topology is typical for a 3-phase induction motor,
brushless DC motor or 3-phase Uninterruptible Power
Supply (UPS) control applications.
+V
3-Phase
Load
Each upper/lower power switch pair is fed by a
complementary PWM signal. Dead time may be
optionally inserted during device switching, where both
outputs are inactive for
a
short period (see
Section 13.7 “Dead-Time Generators”).
In Complementary mode, the duty cycle comparison
units are assigned to the PWM outputs as follows:
• PDC0 register controls PWM1/PWM0 outputs
• PDC1 register controls PWM3/PWM2 outputs
• PDC2 register controls PWM5/PWM4 outputs
The Complementary mode is selected for each PWM
I/O pin pair by clearing the appropriate PMODx bit in
the PWMCON0 register. The PWM I/O pins are set to
Complementary mode by default upon all kinds of
device Resets.
PWM1/3/5 are the main PWMs that are controlled by
the PDCx registers and PWM0/2/4 are the
complemented outputs. When using the PWMs to
control the half-bridge, the odd number PWMs can be
used to control the upper power switch and the even
numbered PWMs can be used for the lower switches.
DS39758B-page 128
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
13.7.1
DEAD-TIME INSERTION
13.7 Dead-Time Generators
Each complementary output pair for the PWM module
has a 6-bit down counter used to produce the dead-
time insertion. As shown in Figure 13-17, each dead-
time unit has a rising and falling edge detector
connected to the duty cycle comparison output. The
dead time is loaded into the timer on the detected PWM
edge event. Depending on whether the edge is rising or
falling, one of the transitions on the complementary
outputs is delayed until the timer counts down to zero.
A timing diagram, indicating the dead-time insertion for
one pair of PWM outputs, is shown in Figure 13-18.
In power inverter applications, where the PWMs are
used in Complementary mode to control the upper and
lower switches of a half-bridge, a dead-time insertion is
highly recommended. The dead-time insertion keeps
both outputs in inactive state for a brief time. This
avoids any overlap in the switching during the state
change of the power devices due to TON and TOFF
characteristics.
Because the power output devices cannot switch
instantaneously, some amount of time must be
provided between the turn-off event of one PWM output
in a complementary pair and the turn-on event of the
other transistor. The PWM module allows dead time to
be programmed. The following sections explain the
dead-time block in detail.
FIGURE 13-17:
DEAD-TIME CONTROL UNIT BLOCK DIAGRAM FOR ONE PWM OUTPUT PAIR
Dead Time
Select Bits
Zero Compare
Clock Control
FOSC
6-Bit Down Counter
and Prescaler
Odd PWM Signal to
Output Control Block
Dead Time
Prescale
Even PWM Signal to
Output Control Block
Dead-Time Register
Duty Cycle
Compare Input
FIGURE 13-18:
DEAD-TIME INSERTION FOR COMPLEMENTARY PWM
t
t
d
d
PDC1
Compare
Output
PWM1
PWM0
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 129
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 13-5: DTCON: DEAD-TIME CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
DT5
R/W-0
DT4
R/W-0
DT3
R/W-0
DT2
R/W-0
DT1
R/W-0
DT0
DTPS1
DTPS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
DTPS1:DTPS0: Dead-Time Unit A Prescale Select bits
11= Clock source for dead-time unit is FOSC/16
10= Clock source for dead-time unit is FOSC/8
01= Clock source for dead-time unit is FOSC/4
00= Clock source for dead-time unit is FOSC/2
bit 5-0
DT5:DT0: Unsigned 6-Bit Dead-Time Value for Dead-Time Unit bits
13.7.2
DEAD-TIME RANGES
13.7.3
DECREMENTING THE DEAD-TIME
COUNTER
The amount of dead time provided by the dead-time
unit is selected by specifying the input clock prescaler
value and a 6-bit unsigned value defined in the DTCON
register. Four input clock prescaler selections have
been provided to allow a suitable range of dead times
based on the device operating frequency. FOSC/2,
FOSC/4, FOSC/8 and FOSC/16 are the clock prescaler
options available using the DTPS1:DTPS0 control bits
in the DTCON register.
The dead-time counter is clocked from any of the
Q clocks based on the following conditions.
1. The dead-time counter is clocked on Q1 when:
• The DTPS bits are set to any of the following
dead-time prescaler settings: FOSC/4,
FOSC/8, FOSC/16
• The PWM Time Base Prescale bits
(PTCKPS<1:0>) are set to any of the following
prescale ratios: FOSC/16, FOSC/64, FOSC/256
After selecting an appropriate prescaler value, the
dead time is adjusted by loading a 6-bit unsigned value
into DTCON<5:0>. The dead-time unit prescaler is
cleared on any of the following events:
2. The dead-time counter is clocked by a pair of
Q clocks when the PWM Time Base Prescale
bits are set to 1:1 (PTCKPS<1:0> = 00, FOSC/4)
and the dead-time counter is clocked by the
FOSC/2 (DTPS<1:0> = 00).
• On a load of the down timer due to a duty cycle
comparison edge event;
• On a write to the DTCON register; or
• On any device Reset.
3. The dead-time counter is clocked using every
other Q clock, depending on the two LSbs in the
Duty Cycle registers:
• If the PWM duty cycle match occurs on Q1 or
Q3, then the dead-time counter is clocked
using every Q1 and Q3
• If the PWM duty cycles match occurs on Q2
or Q4, then the dead-time counter is clocked
using every Q2 and Q4
4. When the DTPS<1:0> bits are set to any of the
other dead-time prescaler settings (i.e., FOSC/4,
FOSC/8 or FOSC/16) and the PWM time base pres-
caler is set to 1:1, the dead-time counter is clocked
by the Q clock corresponding to the Q clocks on
which the PWM duty cycle match occurs.
DS39758B-page 130
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The actual dead time is calculated from the DTCON
register as follows:
13.7.4
DEAD-TIME DISTORTION
Note 1: For small PWM duty cycles, the ratio of
dead time to the active PWM time may
become large. In this case, the inserted
dead time will introduce distortion into
waveforms produced by the PWM mod-
ule. The user can ensure that dead-time
distortion is minimized by keeping the
PWM duty cycle at least three times
larger than the dead time. A similar effect
occurs for duty cycles at or near 100%.
The maximum duty cycle used in the
application should be chosen such that
the minimum inactive time of the signal is
at least three times larger than the dead
time. If the dead time is greater or equal
to the duty cycle of one of the PWM
output pairs, then that PWM pair will be
inactive for the whole period.
Dead Time = Dead-Time Value/(FOSC/Prescaler)
Table 13-3 shows example dead-time ranges as a
function of the input clock prescaler selected and the
device operating frequency.
TABLE 13-3: EXAMPLE DEAD-TIME
RANGES
FOSC
(MHz)
Prescaler Dead-Time Dead-Time
MIPS
Selection
Min
Max
40
40
40
40
32
32
32
32
25
25
25
25
20
20
20
20
10
10
10
10
5
10
10
10
10
8
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
FOSC/2
FOSC/4
FOSC/8
FOSC/16
50 ns
100 ns
200 ns
400 ns
62.5 ns
125 ns
250 ns
500 ns
80 ns
3.2 μs
6.4 μs
12.8 μs
25.6 μs
4 μs
8
8 μs
2: Changing the dead-time values in
DTCON when the PWM is enabled may
result in an undesirable situation. Disable
the PWM (PTEN = 0) before changing the
dead-time value.
8
16 μs
32 μs
8
6.25
6.25
6.25
6.25
5
5.12 μs
10.2 μs
20.5 μs
41 μs
160 ns
320 ns
640 ns
100 ns
200 ns
400 ns
800 ns
200 ns
400 ns
800 ns
1.6 μs
400 ns
800 ns
1.6 μs
3.2 μs
0.5 μs
1 μs
13.8 Independent PWM Output
Independent PWM mode is used for driving the loads
(as shown in Figure 13-19) that drive one winding of a
switched reluctance motor. A particular PWM output
pair is configured in the Independent Output mode
when the corresponding PMODx bit in the PWMCON0
register is set. No dead-time control is implemented
between the PWM I/O pins when the module is operat-
ing in the Independent PWM mode and both I/O pins
are allowed to be active simultaneously. This mode can
also be used to drive stepper motors.
6.4 μs
5
12.8 μs
25.6 μs
51.2 μs
12.8 μs
25.6 μs
51.2 μs
102.4 μs
25.6 μs
51.2 μs
102.4 μs
204.8 μs
32 μs
5
5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
1.25
1.25
1.25
1.25
1
13.8.1
DUTY CYCLE ASSIGNMENT IN THE
INDEPENDENT PWM MODE
5
5
In the Independent PWM mode, each duty cycle gener-
ator is connected to both PWM output pins in a given
PWM output pair. The odd and the even PWM output
pins are driven with a single PWM duty cycle generator.
PWM1 and PWM0 are driven by the PWM channel
which uses the PDC0 register to set the duty cycle,
PWM3 and PWM2 with PDC1, and PWM5 and PWM4
with PDC2 (see Figure 13-3 and Register 13-3).
5
4
4
1
64 μs
4
1
2 μs
128 μs
256 μs
4
1
4 μs
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 131
PIC18F1230/1330
OVDCOND and OVDCONS registers are used to
define the PWM override options. The OVDCOND
register contains six bits, POVD5:POVD0, that
determine which PWM I/O pins will be overridden. The
OVDCONS register contains six bits, POUT5:POUT0,
that determine the state of the PWM I/O pins when a
particular output is overridden via the POVD bits.
13.8.2
PWM CHANNEL OVERRIDE
PWM output may be manually overridden for each
PWM channel by using the appropriate bits in the
OVDCOND and OVDCONS registers. The user may
select the following signal output options for each PWM
output pin operating in the Independent PWM mode:
• I/O pin outputs PWM signal
• I/O pin inactive
The POVD bits are active-low control bits. When the
POVD bits are set, the corresponding POUT bit will
have no effect on the PWM output. In other words, the
pins corresponding to POVD bits that are set will have
the duty PWM cycle set by the PDCx registers. When
one of the POVD bits is cleared, the output on the
corresponding PWM I/O pin will be determined by the
state of the POUT bit. When a POUT bit is set, the
PWM pin will be driven to its active state. When the
POUT bit is cleared, the PWM pin will be driven to its
inactive state.
• I/O pin active
Refer to Section 13.10 “PWM Output Override” for
details for all the override functions.
FIGURE 13-19:
CENTER CONNECTED
LOAD
+V
Load
PWM1
13.10.1 COMPLEMENTARY OUTPUT MODE
The even numbered PWM I/O pins have override
restrictions when a pair of PWM I/O pins are operating
in the Complementary mode (PMODx = 0). In
Complementary mode, if the even numbered pin is
driven active by clearing the corresponding POVD bit
and by setting the POUT bits in the OVDCOND and
OVDCONS registers, the output signal is forced to be
the complement of the odd numbered I/O pin in the pair
(see Figure 13-2 for details).
PWM0
13.9 Single-Pulse PWM Operation
The single-pulse PWM operation is available only in
Edge-Aligned mode. In this mode, the PWM module
will produce single-pulse output. Single-pulse
operation is configured when the PTMOD1:PTMOD0
bits are set to ‘01’ in the PTCON0 register. This mode
of operation is useful for driving certain types of ECMs.
13.10.2 OVERRIDE SYNCHRONIZATION
If the OSYNC bit in the PWMCON1 register is set, all
output overrides performed via the OVDCOND and
OVDCONS registers will be synchronized to the PWM
time base. Synchronous output overrides will occur on
the following conditions:
In Single-Pulse mode, the PWM I/O pin(s) are driven to
the active state when the PTEN bit is set. When the
PWM timer match with Duty Cycle register occurs, the
PWM I/O pin is driven to the inactive state. When the
PWM timer match with the PTPER register occurs, the
PTMR register is cleared, all active PWM I/O pins are
driven to the inactive state, the PTEN bit is cleared and
an interrupt is generated if the corresponding interrupt
bit is set.
• When the PWM is in Edge-Aligned mode,
synchronization occurs when PTMR is zero.
• When the PWM is in Center-Aligned mode,
synchronization occurs when PTMR is zero and
when the value of PTMR matches PTPER.
Note 1: In the Complementary mode, the even
channel cannot be forced active by a
Fault or override event when the odd
channel is active. The even channel is
always the complement of the odd
channel, with dead-time inserted, before
the odd channel can be driven to its active
state as shown in Figure 13-20.
Note:
PTPER and PDCx values are held as they
are after the single-pulse output. To have
another cycle of single pulse, only PTEN
has to be enabled.
13.10 PWM Output Override
2: Dead time inserted in the PWM channels
even when they are in Override mode.
The PWM output override bits allow the user to
manually drive the PWM I/O pins to specified logic
states, independent of the duty cycle comparison units.
The PWM override bits are useful when controlling
various types of ECMs, like a BLDC motor.
DS39758B-page 132
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-20:
OVERRIDE BITS IN COMPLEMENTARY MODE
1
POUT0
POUT1
4
3
5
PWM1
PWM0
2
7
6
Assume: POVD0 = 0; POVD1 = 0; PMOD0 = 0
1. Even override bits have no effect in Complementary mode.
2. Odd override bit is activated which causes the even PWM to deactivate.
3. Dead-time insertion.
4. Odd PWM activated after the dead time.
5. Odd override bit is deactivated which causes the odd PWM to deactivate.
6. Dead-time insertion.
7. Even PWM is activated after the dead time.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 133
PIC18F1230/1330
The PWM Duty Cycle registers may be used in
conjunction with the OVDCOND and OVDCONS
registers. The Duty Cycle registers control the average
voltage across the load and the OVDCOND and
OVDCONS registers control the commutation
sequence. Figure 13-22 shows the waveforms, while
Table 13-4 and Table 13-5 show the OVDCOND and
OVDCONS register values used to generate the
signals.
13.10.3 OUTPUT OVERRIDE EXAMPLES
Figure 13-21 shows an example of a waveform that
might be generated using the PWM output override
feature. The figure shows a six-step commutation
sequence for a BLDC motor. The motor is driven
through a 3-phase inverter as shown in Figure 13-16.
When the appropriate rotor position is detected, the
PWM outputs are switched to the next commutation
state in the sequence. In this example, the PWM
outputs are driven to specific logic states. The
OVDCOND and OVDCONS register values used to
generate the signals in Figure 13-21 are given in
Table 13-4.
REGISTER 13-6: OVDCOND: OUTPUT OVERRIDE CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
R/W-1
POVD5
POVD4
POVD3
POVD2
POVD1
POVD0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
POVD5:POVD0: PWM Output Override bits
1= Output on PWM I/O pin is controlled by the value in the Duty Cycle register and the PWM time base
0= Output on PWM I/O pin is controlled by the value in the corresponding POUTx bit
REGISTER 13-7: OVDCONS: OUTPUT STATE REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
POUT5
POUT4
POUT3
POUT2
POUT1
POUT0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
POUT5:POUT0: PWM Manual Output bits
1= Output on PWM I/O pin is active when the corresponding PWM output override bit is cleared
0= Output on PWM I/O pin is inactive when the corresponding PWM output override bit is cleared
DS39758B-page 134
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-21:
PWM OUTPUT OVERRIDE
EXAMPLE #1
13.11 PWM Output and Polarity Control
There are three device Configuration bits associated
with the PWM module that provide PWM output pin
control defined in the CONFIG3L register. They are:
1
2
3
4
5
6
PWM5
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
• HPOL
• LPOL
• PWMPIN
These three Configuration bits work in conjunction with
the three PWM Enable bits (PWMEN2:PWMEN0) in
the PWMCON0 register. The Configuration bits and
PWM enable bits ensure that the PWM pins are in the
correct states after a device Reset occurs.
13.11.1 OUTPUT PIN CONTROL
TABLE 13-4: PWM OUTPUT OVERRIDE
EXAMPLE #1
The PWMEN2:PWMEN0 control bits enable each
PWM output pin as required in the application.
State
OVDCOND (POVD) OVDCONS (POUT)
All PWM I/O pins are general purpose I/O. When a pair
of pins is enabled for PWM output, the PORT and TRIS
registers controlling the pins are disabled. Refer to
Figure 13-23 for details.
1
2
3
4
5
6
00000000b
00000000b
00000000b
00000000b
00000000b
00000000b
00100100b
00100001b
00001001b
00011000b
00010010b
00000110b
13.11.2 OUTPUT POLARITY CONTROL
The polarity of the PWM I/O pins is set during device
programming via the HPOL and LPOL Configuration
bits in the CONFIG3L register. The HPOL Configura-
tion bit sets the output polarity for the high side PWM
outputs: PWM1, PWM3 and PWM5. The polarity is
active-high when HPOL is cleared (= 0) and active-low
when it is set (= 1).
TABLE 13-5: PWM OUTPUT OVERRIDE
EXAMPLE #2
State OVDCOND (POVD) OVDCONS (POUT)
1
2
3
4
00000011b
00110000b
00111100b
00001111b
00000000b
00000000b
00000000b
00000000b
The LPOL Configuration bit sets the output polarity for
the low side PWM outputs: PWM0, PWM2 and PWM4.
As with HPOL, they are active-high when LPOL is
cleared and active-low when set.
All output signals generated by the PWM module are
referenced to the polarity control bits, including those
generated by Fault inputs or manual override (see
Section 13.10 “PWM Output Override”).
FIGURE 13-22:
PWM OUTPUT OVERRIDE
EXAMPLE #2
The default polarity Configuration bits have the PWM
I/O pins in active-high output polarity.
1
2
3
4
PWM5
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
PWM0
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 135
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 13-23:
PWM I/O PIN BLOCK DIAGRAM
PWM Signal from Module
1
0
PWM Pin Enable
Data Bus
D
Q
Q
VDD
P
WR PORT
CK
Data Latch
I/O pin
D
Q
Q
N
WR TRIS
RD TRIS
CK
VSS
TRIS Latch
TTL or
Schmitt
Trigger
Q
D
EN
RD PORT
Note: I/O pin has protection diodes to VDD and VSS. PWM polarity selection logic not shown for clarity.
directly in hardware so that when a Fault occurs, it can
be managed quickly and the PWMs outputs are put into
an inactive state to save the power devices connected
to the PWMs.
13.11.3 PWM OUTPUT PIN RESET STATES
The PWMPIN Configuration bit determines the PWM
output pins to be PWM output pins, or digital I/O pins,
after the device comes out of Reset. If the PWMPIN
Configuration bit is unprogrammed (default), the
PWMEN2:PWMEN0 control bits will be cleared on a
device Reset. Consequently, all PWM outputs will be
tri-stated and controlled by the corresponding PORT
and TRIS registers. If the PWMPIN Configuration bit is
programmed low, the PWMEN2:PWMEN0 control bits
will be set to ‘100’ on a device Reset:
The PWM Fault input is FLTA, which can come from
I/O pins, the CPU or another module. The FLTA pin is
an active-low input so it is easy to “OR” many sources
to the same input.
The FLTCONFIG register (Register 13-8) defines the
settings of the FLTA input.
Note:
The inactive state of the PWM pins is
dependent on the HPOL and LPOL Con-
figuration bit settings, which define the
active and inactive state for PWM outputs.
All PWM pins will be enabled for PWM output and will
have the output polarity defined by the HPOL and
LPOL Configuration bits.
13.12 PWM Fault Input
13.12.1 FAULT PIN ENABLE BIT
There is one Fault input associated with the PWM
module. The main purpose of the input Fault pin is to
disable the PWM output signals and drive them into an
inactive state. The action of the Fault input is performed
By setting the bit FLTAEN in the FLTCONFIG register,
the corresponding Fault input is enabled. If FLTAEN bit
is cleared, then the Fault input has no effect on the
PWM module.
DS39758B-page 136
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
13.12.2 FAULT INPUT MODE
13.12.3 PWM OUTPUTS WHILE IN FAULT
CONDITION
The FLTAMOD bit in the FLTCONFIG register
determines whether the PWM I/O pins are deactivated
when they are overridden by a Fault input.
While in the Fault state (i.e., FLTA input is active), the
PWM output signals are driven into their inactive
states.
FLTAS bit in the FLTCONFIG register gives the status
of the Fault A input.
13.12.4 PWM OUTPUTS IN DEBUG MODE
The Fault input has two modes of operation:
The BRFEN bit in the FLTCONFIG register controls the
simulation of Fault condition when a breakpoint is hit,
while debugging the application using an In-Circuit
Debugger (ICD). Setting the BRFEN bit to high enables
the Fault condition on breakpoint, thus driving the PWM
outputs to inactive state. This is done to avoid any
continuous keeping of status on the PWM pin, which
may result in damage of the power devices connected
to the PWM outputs.
• Inactive Mode (FLTAMOD = 0)
This is a catastrophic Fault Management mode.
When the Fault occurs in this mode, the PWM
outputs are deactivated. The PWM pins will remain in
Inactivated mode until the Fault is cleared (Fault
input is driven high) and the corresponding Fault
status bit has been cleared in software. The PWM
outputs are enabled immediately at the beginning of
the following PWM period, after Fault status bit
(FLTAS) is cleared.
If BRFEN = 0, the Fault condition on breakpoint is
disabled.
• Cycle-by-Cycle Mode (FLTAMOD = 1)
Note:
It is highly recommended to enable the
Fault condition on breakpoint if
When the Fault occurs in this mode, the PWM
outputs are deactivated. The PWM outputs will
remain in the defined Fault states (all PWM outputs
inactive) for as long as the Fault pin is held low. After
the Fault pin is driven high, the PWM outputs will
return to normal operation at the beginning of the
following PWM period and the FLTAS bit is
automatically cleared.
a
debugging tool is used while developing
the firmware and the high-power circuitry
is used. When the device is ready to
program after debugging the firmware, the
BRFEN bit can be disabled.
REGISTER 13-8: FLTCONFIG: FAULT CONFIGURATION REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
FLTAS
R/W-0
R/W-0
BRFEN
FLTAMOD
FLTAEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
BRFEN: Breakpoint Fault Enable bit
1= Enable Fault condition on a breakpoint
0= Disable Fault condition
bit 6-3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
FLTAS: Fault A Status bit
1= FLTA is asserted;
if FLTAMOD = 0, cleared by the user;
if FLTAMOD = 1, cleared automatically at beginning of the new period when FLTA is deasserted
0= No Fault
bit 1
bit 0
FLTAMOD: Fault A Mode bit
1= Cycle-by-Cycle mode: Pins are inactive for the remainder of the current PWM period or until FLTA
is deasserted; FLTAS is cleared automatically
0= Inactive mode: Pins are deactivated (catastrophic failure) until FLTA is deasserted and FLTAS is
cleared by the user only
FLTAEN: Fault A Enable bit
1= Enable Fault A
0= Disable Fault A
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 137
PIC18F1230/1330
The PTMR value for which a Special Event Trigger
should occur is loaded into the SEVTCMP register pair.
SEVTDIR bit in PWMCON1 register specifies the
counting phase when the PWM time base is in a
Continuous Up/Down Count mode.
13.13 PWM Update Lockout
For a complex PWM application, the user may need to
write up to four Duty Cycle registers and the PWM Time
Base Period Register, PTPER, at a given time. In some
applications, it is important that all buffer registers be
written before the new duty cycle and period values are
loaded for use by the module.
If the SEVTDIR bit is cleared, the Special Event Trigger
will occur on the upward counting cycle of the PWM
time base. If SEVTDIR is set, the Special Event Trigger
will occur on the downward count cycle of the PWM
time base. The SEVTDIR bit only effects this operation
when the PWM timer is in the Continuous Up/Down
Count mode.
A PWM update lockout feature may optionally be
enabled so the user may specify when new duty cycle
buffer values are valid. The PWM update lockout
feature is enabled by setting the control bit, UDIS, in
the PWMCON1 register. This bit affects all Duty Cycle
Buffer registers and the PWM Time Base Period
register, PTPER.
Note:
The Special Event Trigger will take place
only for non-zero values in the SEVTCMP
registers.
To perform a PWM update lockout:
1. Set the UDIS bit.
13.14.1 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER ENABLE
2. Write all Duty Cycle registers and PTPER, if
applicable.
The PWM module will always produce Special Event
Trigger pulses. This signal may optionally be used by
the A/D module. Refer to Chapter 15.0 "10-Bit
Analog-to-Digital Converter (A/D) Module" for
details.
3. Clear the UDIS bit to re-enable updates.
4. With this, when UDIS bit is cleared, the buffer
values will be loaded to the actual registers. This
makes a synchronous loading of the registers.
13.14.2 SPECIAL EVENT TRIGGER
POSTSCALER
13.14 PWM Special Event Trigger
The PWM Special Event Trigger has a postscaler that
allows a 1:1 to 1:16 postscale ratio. The postscaler is
configured by writing the SEVOPS3:SEVOPS0 control
bits in the PWMCON1 register.
The PWM module has a Special Event Trigger
capability that allows A/D conversions to be
synchronized to the PWM time base. The A/D sampling
and conversion time may be programmed to occur at
any point within the PWM period. The Special Event
Trigger allows the user to minimize the delay between
the time when A/D conversion results are acquired and
the time when the duty cycle value is updated.
The Special Event Trigger output postscaler is cleared
on any write to the SEVTCMP register pair, or on any
device Reset.
The PWM 16-bit Special Event Trigger register,
SEVTCMP (high and low), and five control bits in the
PWMCON1 register are used to control its operation.
DS39758B-page 138
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 13-6: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH THE POWER CONTROL PWM MODULE
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL
TMR0IE
INT0IE
PTIP
PTIE
PTIF
RBIE
—
TMR0IF
INT0IF
—
RBIF
—
41
43
43
43
43
43
43
43
43
43
IPR3
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
PIE3
—
—
—
PIR3
—
—
—
—
—
—
PTCON0
PTCON1
PTOPS3
PTEN
PTOPS2
PTDIR
PTOPS1
—
PTOPS0 PTCKPS1 PTCKPS0 PTMOD1 PTMOD0
—
—
—
—
—
—
(1)
PTMRL
PTMRH
PWM Time Base Register (lower 8 bits)
(1)
—
—
—
PWM Time Base Register (upper 4 bits)
(1)
(1)
PTPERL
PWM Time Base Period Register (lower 8 bits)
PTPERH
—
—
—
—
PWM Time Base Period Register
(upper 4 bits)
(1)
(1)
SEVTCMPL
PWM Special Event Compare Register (lower 8 bits)
43
44
SEVTCMPH
—
—
—
—
PWM Special Event Compare Register
(upper 4 bits)
(2)
(2)
(2)
PWMCON0
PWMCON1
DTCON
—
PWMEN2
PWMEN1
PWMEN0
—
PMOD2
—
PMOD1
UDIS
DT1
PMOD0
OSYNC
DT0
44
44
44
43
44
44
43
43
43
43
43
43
SEVOPS3 SEVOPS2 SEVOPS1 SEVOPS0 SEVTDIR
DTPS1
BRFEN
—
DTPS0
—
DT5
—
DT4
—
DT3
—
DT2
FLTCONFIG
OVDCOND
OVDCONS
FLTAS FLTAMOD FLTAEN
—
POVD5
POUT5
POVD4
POUT4
POVD3
POUT3
POVD2
POUT2
POVD1
POUT1
POVD0
POUT0
—
—
(1)
PDC0L
PWM Duty Cycle #0L Register (lower 8 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #0H Register (upper 6 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #1L Register (lower 8 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #1H Register (upper 6 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #2L Register (lower 8 bits)
PWM Duty Cycle #2H Register (upper 6 bits)
(1)
PDC0H
—
—
(1)
PDC1L
(1)
PDC1H
—
—
(1)
PDC2L
(1)
PDC2H
—
—
Legend: -= Unimplemented, u= Unchanged. Shaded cells are not used with the power control PWM.
Note 1: Double-buffered register pairs. Refer to text for explanation of how these registers are read and written to.
2: Reset condition of PWMEN bits depends on the PWMPIN Configuration bit.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 139
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 140
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The pins of the Enhanced USART are multiplexed
with PORTA. In order to configure RA2/TX/CK and
RA3/RX/DT as an EUSART:
14.0 ENHANCED UNIVERSAL
SYNCHRONOUS
ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER
TRANSMITTER (EUSART)
• bit SPEN (RCSTA<7>) must be set (= 1)
• bit TRISA<3> must be set (= 1)
• bit TRISA<2> must be set (= 1)
The Enhanced Universal Synchronous Asynchronous
Receiver Transmitter (EUSART) module is one of the
two serial I/O modules. (Generically, the USART is also
known as a Serial Communications Interface or SCI.)
The EUSART can be configured as a full-duplex
asynchronous system that can communicate with
peripheral devices, such as CRT terminals and
personal computers. It can also be configured as a half-
duplex synchronous system that can communicate
with peripheral devices, such as A/D or D/A integrated
circuits, serial EEPROMs, etc.
Note:
The EUSART control will automatically
reconfigure the pin from input to output as
needed.
The operation of the Enhanced USART module is
controlled through three registers:
• Transmit Status and Control (TXSTA)
• Receive Status and Control (RCSTA)
• Baud Rate Control (BAUDCON)
These are detailed on the following pages in
Register 14-1, Register 14-2 and Register 14-3,
respectively.
The Enhanced USART module implements additional
features, including automatic baud rate detection and
calibration, automatic wake-up on Sync Break reception
and 12-bit Break character transmit. These features
make it ideally suited for use in Local Interconnect
Network bus (LIN bus) systems.
The EUSART can be configured in the following
modes:
• Asynchronous (full-duplex) with:
- Auto-Wake-up on Character Reception
- Auto-Baud Calibration
- 12-Bit Break Character Transmission
• Synchronous – Master (half-duplex) with
Selectable Clock Polarity
• Synchronous – Slave (half-duplex) with
Selectable Clock Polarity
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 141
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 14-1: TXSTA: TRANSMIT STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
CSRC
R/W-0
TX9
R/W-0
TXEN(1)
R/W-0
SYNC
R/W-0
R/W-0
BRGH
R-1
R/W-0
TX9D
SENDB
TRMT
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CSRC: Clock Source Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
Don’t care.
Synchronous mode:
1= Master mode (clock generated internally from BRG)
0= Slave mode (clock from external source)
bit 6
bit 5
bit 4
bit 3
TX9: 9-Bit Transmit Enable bit
1= Selects 9-bit transmission
0= Selects 8-bit transmission
TXEN: Transmit Enable bit(1)
1= Transmit enabled
0= Transmit disabled
SYNC: EUSART Mode Select bit
1= Synchronous mode
0= Asynchronous mode
SENDB: Send Break Character bit
Asynchronous mode:
1= Send Sync Break on next transmission (cleared by hardware upon completion)
0= Sync Break transmission completed
Synchronous mode:
Don’t care.
bit 2
BRGH: High Baud Rate Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
1= High speed
0= Low speed
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 1
bit 0
TRMT: Transmit Shift Register Status bit
1= TSR empty
0= TSR full
TX9D: 9th bit of Transmit Data
Can be address/data bit or a parity bit.
Note 1: SREN/CREN overrides TXEN in Sync mode.
DS39758B-page 142
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 14-2: RCSTA: RECEIVE STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
SPEN
R/W-0
RX9
R/W-0
SREN
R/W-0
CREN
R/W-0
R-0
R-0
R-x
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
SPEN: Serial Port Enable bit
1= Serial port enabled (configures RX/DT and TX/CK pins as serial port pins)
0= Serial port disabled (held in Reset)
RX9: 9-Bit Receive Enable bit
1= Selects 9-bit reception
0= Selects 8-bit reception
SREN: Single Receive Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
Don’t care.
Synchronous mode – Master:
1= Enables single receive
0= Disables single receive
This bit is cleared after reception is complete.
Synchronous mode – Slave:
Don’t care.
bit 4
CREN: Continuous Receive Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1= Enables receiver
0= Disables receiver
Synchronous mode:
1= Enables continuous receive until enable bit CREN is cleared (CREN overrides SREN)
0= Disables continuous receive
bit 3
ADDEN: Address Detect Enable bit
Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 1):
1= Enables address detection, enables interrupt and loads the receive buffer when RSR<8> is set
0= Disables address detection, all bytes are received and ninth bit can be used as parity bit
Asynchronous mode 9-bit (RX9 = 0):
Don’t care.
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
FERR: Framing Error bit
1= Framing error (can be updated by reading RCREG register and receiving next valid byte)
0= No framing error
OERR: Overrun Error bit
1= Overrun error (can be cleared by clearing bit CREN)
0= No overrun error
RX9D: 9th bit of Received Data
This can be address/data bit or a parity bit and must be calculated by user firmware.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 143
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 14-3: BAUDCON: BAUD RATE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
R-1
U-0
—
R/W-0
SCKP
R/W-0
U-0
—
R/W-0
WUE
R/W-0
ABDOVF
RCIDL
BRG16
ABDEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
ABDOVF: Auto-Baud Acquisition Rollover Status bit
1= A BRG rollover has occurred during Auto-Baud Rate Detect mode (must be cleared in software)
0= No BRG rollover has occurred
RCIDL: Receive Operation Idle Status bit
1= Receive operation is Idle
0= Receive operation is active
bit 5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
SCKP: Synchronous Clock Polarity Select bit
Asynchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
Synchronous mode:
1= Idle state for clock (CK) is a high level
0= Idle state for clock (CK) is a low level
bit 3
BRG16: 16-Bit Baud Rate Register Enable bit
1= 16-bit Baud Rate Generator – SPBRGH and SPBRG
0= 8-bit Baud Rate Generator – SPBRG only (Compatible mode), SPBRGH value ignored
bit 2
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
WUE: Wake-up Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1= EUSART will continue to sample the RX pin – interrupt generated on falling edge; bit cleared in
hardware on following rising edge
0= RX pin not monitored or rising edge detected
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
bit 0
ABDEN: Auto-Baud Detect Enable bit
Asynchronous mode:
1= Enable baud rate measurement on the next character. Requires reception of a Sync field (55h);
cleared in hardware upon completion
0= Baud rate measurement disabled or completed
Synchronous mode:
Unused in this mode.
DS39758B-page 144
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
to use the high baud rate (BRGH = 1), or the 16-bit BRG
to reduce the baud rate error, or achieve a slow baud
rate for a fast oscillator frequency.
14.1 Baud Rate Generator (BRG)
The BRG is a dedicated 8-bit or 16-bit generator that
supports both the Asynchronous and Synchronous
modes of the EUSART. By default, the BRG operates
in 8-bit mode; setting the BRG16 bit (BAUDCON<3>)
selects 16-bit mode.
Writing a new value to the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers
causes the BRG timer to be reset (or cleared). This
ensures the BRG does not wait for a timer overflow
before outputting the new baud rate.
The SPBRGH:SPBRG register pair controls the period
of a free-running timer. In Asynchronous mode, bits
BRGH (TXSTA<2>) and BRG16 (BAUDCON<3>) also
control the baud rate. In Synchronous mode, BRGH is
ignored. Table 14-1 shows the formula for computation
of the baud rate for different EUSART modes which
only apply in Master mode (internally generated clock).
14.1.1
OPERATION IN POWER-MANAGED
MODES
The device clock is used to generate the desired baud
rate. When one of the power-managed modes is
entered, the new clock source may be operating at a
different frequency. This may require an adjustment to
the value in the SPBRG register pair.
Given the desired baud rate and FOSC, the nearest
integer value for the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers can be
calculated using the formulas in Table 14-1. From this,
the error in baud rate can be determined. An example
calculation is shown in Example 14-1. Typical baud
rates and error values for the various Asynchronous
modes are shown in Table 14-2. It may be advantageous
14.1.2
SAMPLING
The data on the RX pin is sampled three times by a
majority detect circuit to determine if a high or a low
level is present at the RX pin.
TABLE 14-1: BAUD RATE FORMULAS
Configuration Bits
BRG/EUSART Mode
Baud Rate Formula
SYNC
BRG16
BRGH
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
x
x
8-bit/Asynchronous
8-bit/Asynchronous
16-bit/Asynchronous
16-bit/Asynchronous
8-bit/Synchronous
16-bit/Synchronous
FOSC/[64 (n + 1)]
FOSC/[16 (n + 1)]
FOSC/[4 (n + 1)]
Legend: x= Don’t care, n = value of SPBRGH:SPBRG register pair
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 145
PIC18F1230/1330
EXAMPLE 14-1:
CALCULATING BAUD RATE ERROR
For a device with FOSC of 16 MHz, desired baud rate of 9600, Asynchronous mode, 8-bit BRG:
Desired Baud Rate
= FOSC/(64 ([SPBRGH:SPBRG] + 1))
Solving for SPBRGH:SPBRG:
X
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
((FOSC/Desired Baud Rate)/64) – 1
((16000000/9600)/64) – 1
[25.042] = 25
16000000/(64 (25 + 1))
9615
Calculated Baud Rate
Error
(Calculated Baud Rate – Desired Baud Rate)/Desired Baud Rate
(9615 – 9600)/9600 = 0.16%
TABLE 14-2: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH BAUD RATE GENERATOR
Reset Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TXSTA
RCSTA
CSRC
SPEN
TX9
RX9
TXEN
SREN
—
SYNC
CREN
SCKP
SENDB
ADDEN
BRG16
BRGH
FERR
—
TRMT
OERR
WUE
TX9D
RX9D
42
42
42
42
42
BAUDCON ABDOVF RCIDL
ABDEN
SPBRGH EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
SPBRG EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the BRG.
DS39758B-page 146
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 14-3: BAUD RATES FOR ASYNCHRONOUS MODES
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz FOSC = 10.000 MHz
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
value
SPBRG Actual
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
%
Error
%
Error
%
Error
Rate
(K)
value
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Error
(decimal)
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
255
129
31
15
4
—
—
—
129
64
15
7
—
1201
2403
9615
—
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
—
103
51
12
—
—
—
1.221
1.73
0.16
1.73
1.73
8.51
-9.58
1.202
2.404
9.766
19.531
52.083
78.125
0.16
0.16
1.73
1.73
-9.58
-32.18
2.4
2.441
9.615
19.531
56.818
125.000
1.73
0.16
1.73
-1.36
8.51
255
64
31
10
4
2.404
9.6
9.766
19.2
57.6
115.2
19.531
62.500
104.167
2
—
—
—
2
1
—
—
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
value
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
%
Error
%
Error
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Error
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
0.300
1.202
0.16
0.16
207
51
25
6
300
1201
2403
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
103
25
12
—
300
1201
—
-0.16
-0.16
—
51
12
—
—
—
—
—
2.4
2.404
0.16
9.6
8.929
-6.99
8.51
—
—
19.2
57.6
115.2
20.833
62.500
62.500
2
—
—
—
—
—
8.51
0
—
—
—
—
—
-45.75
0
—
—
—
—
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
%
Error
%
Error
%
Error
%
Error
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
2.4
—
—
—
—
—
—
2.441
9.615
19.531
56.818
125.000
1.73
0.16
1.73
-1.36
8.51
255
64
31
10
4
2403
9615
19230
55555
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
3.55
—
207
51
25
8
9.6
9.766
19.231
58.140
113.636
1.73
0.16
0.94
-1.36
255
129
42
9.615
19.231
56.818
113.636
0.16
0.16
-1.36
-1.36
129
64
21
10
19.2
57.6
115.2
21
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 0
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
value
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
%
Error
%
Error
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Error
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
—
—
—
207
103
25
12
3
—
1201
2403
9615
—
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
—
103
51
12
—
300
1201
2403
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
207
51
25
—
1.202
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
8.51
8.51
2.4
2.404
9.6
9.615
19.2
57.6
115.2
19.231
62.500
125.000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 147
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 14-3: BAUD RATES FOR ASYNCHRONOUS MODES (CONTINUED)
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 20.000 MHz
FOSC = 10.000 MHz
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
value
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
%
Error
%
Error
%
Error
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Error
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
0.300
1.200
0.00
0.02
0.06
0.16
0.16
0.94
-1.36
8332
2082
1040
259
129
42
0.300
1.200
0.02
-0.03
-0.03
0.16
4165
1041
520
129
64
0.300
1.200
0.02
-0.03
0.16
0.16
1.73
-1.36
8.51
2082
520
259
64
300
1201
2403
9615
19230
55555
—
-0.04
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
3.55
—
1665
415
207
51
2.4
2.402
2.399
2.404
9.6
9.615
9.615
9.615
19.2
57.6
115.2
19.231
58.140
113.636
19.231
56.818
113.636
0.16
19.531
56.818
125.000
31
25
-1.36
-1.36
21
10
8
21
10
4
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 0, BRG16 = 1
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 4.000 MHz
FOSC = 2.000 MHz
FOSC = 1.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
value
SPBRG Actual
value
(decimal)
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
%
Error
%
Error
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Error
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
0.300
1.202
0.04
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
8.51
8.51
832
207
103
25
12
3
300
1201
2403
9615
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
415
103
51
12
—
300
1201
2403
—
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
207
51
25
—
2.4
2.404
9.6
9.615
19.2
57.6
115.2
19.231
62.500
125.000
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
1
—
—
—
—
—
—
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 1 or SYNC = 1, BRG16 = 1
FOSC = 20.000 MHz FOSC = 10.000 MHz
BAUD
RATE
(K)
FOSC = 40.000 MHz
FOSC = 8.000 MHz
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
SPBRG Actual
SPBRG Actual
value
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
Error
%
%
%
Error
value
(decimal)
Rate
(K)
value
Rate
(K)
Rate
(K)
Error
Error
(decimal)
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
0.300
1.200
0.00
0.00
0.02
0.06
-0.03
0.35
-0.22
33332
8332
4165
1040
520
0.300
1.200
0.00
0.02
0.02
-0.03
0.16
-0.22
0.94
16665
4165
2082
520
259
86
0.300
1.200
0.00
0.02
0.06
0.16
0.16
0.94
-1.36
8332
2082
1040
259
129
42
300
1200
-0.01
-0.04
-0.04
-0.16
-0.16
0.79
6665
1665
832
207
103
34
2.4
2.400
2.400
2.402
2400
9.6
9.606
9.596
9.615
9615
19.2
57.6
115.2
19.193
57.803
114.943
19.231
57.471
116.279
19.231
58.140
113.636
19230
57142
117647
172
86
42
21
-2.12
16
SYNC = 0, BRGH = 1, BRG16 = 1 or SYNC = 1, BRG16 = 1
FOSC = 4.000 MHz FOSC = 2.000 MHz FOSC = 1.000 MHz
BAUD
RATE
(K)
Actual
Rate
(K)
SPBRG Actual
SPBRG Actual
SPBRG
value
(decimal)
%
Error
%
Error
%
Error
value
Rate
(K)
value
Rate
(K)
(decimal)
(decimal)
0.3
1.2
0.300
1.200
0.01
0.04
0.16
0.16
0.16
2.12
-3.55
3332
832
415
103
51
300
1201
2403
9615
19230
55555
—
-0.04
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
3.55
—
1665
415
207
51
300
1201
2403
9615
19230
—
-0.04
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
-0.16
—
832
207
103
25
2.4
2.404
9.6
9.615
19.2
57.6
115.2
19.231
58.824
111.111
25
12
16
8
—
8
—
—
—
—
DS39758B-page 148
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
14.1.3
AUTO-BAUD RATE DETECT
Note 1: If the WUE bit is set with the ABDEN bit,
Auto-Baud Rate Detection will occur on
the byte following the Break character.
The Enhanced USART module supports the automatic
detection and calibration of baud rate. This feature is
active only in Asynchronous mode and while the WUE
bit is clear.
2: It is up to the user to determine that the
incoming character baud rate is within the
range of the selected BRG clock source.
Some combinations of oscillator frequency
and EUSART baud rates are not possible
due to bit error rates. Overall system
timing and communication baud rates
must be taken into consideration when
using the Auto-Baud Rate Detection
feature.
The automatic baud rate measurement sequence
(Figure 14-1) begins whenever a Start bit is received
and the ABDEN bit is set. The calculation is
self-averaging.
In the Auto-Baud Rate Detect (ABD) mode, the clock to
the BRG is reversed. Rather than the BRG clocking the
incoming RX signal, the RX signal is timing the BRG. In
ABD mode, the internal Baud Rate Generator is used
as a counter to time the bit period of the incoming serial
byte stream.
TABLE 14-4: BRG COUNTER
CLOCK RATES
Once the ABDEN bit is set, the state machine will clear
the BRG and look for a Start bit. The Auto-Baud Rate
Detect must receive a byte with the value 55h (ASCII
“U”, which is also the LIN bus Sync character) in order to
calculate the proper bit rate. The measurement is taken
over both a low and a high bit time in order to minimize
any effects caused by asymmetry of the incoming signal.
After a Start bit, the SPBRG begins counting up, using
the preselected clock source on the first rising edge of
RX. After eight bits on the RX pin or the fifth rising edge,
an accumulated value totalling the proper BRG period is
left in the SPBRGH:SPBRG register pair. Once the 5th
edge is seen (this should correspond to the Stop bit), the
ABDEN bit is automatically cleared.
BRG16 BRGH
BRG Counter Clock
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
FOSC/512
FOSC/128
FOSC/128
FOSC/32
Note: During the ABD sequence, SPBRG and
SPBRGH are both used as a 16-bit counter,
independent of the BRG16 setting.
14.1.3.1
ABD and EUSART Transmission
Since the BRG clock is reversed during ABD
acquisition, the EUSART transmitter cannot be used
during ABD. This means that whenever the ABDEN bit
is set, TXREG cannot be written to. Users should also
ensure that ABDEN does not become set during a
transmit sequence. Failing to do this may result in
unpredictable EUSART operation.
If a rollover of the BRG occurs (an overflow from FFFFh
to 0000h), the event is trapped by the ABDOVF status
bit (BAUDCON<7>). It is set in hardware by BRG
rollovers and can be set or cleared by the user in
software. ABD mode remains active after rollover
events and the ABDEN bit remains set (Figure 14-2).
While calibrating the baud rate period, the BRG
registers are clocked at 1/8th the preconfigured clock
rate. Note that the BRG clock will be configured by the
BRG16 and BRGH bits. Independent of the BRG16 bit
setting, both the SPBRG and SPBRGH will be used as
a 16-bit counter. This allows the user to verify that no
carry occurred for 8-bit modes by checking for 00h in
the SPBRGH register. Refer to Table 14-4 for counter
clock rates to the BRG.
While the ABD sequence takes place, the EUSART
state machine is held in Idle. The RCIF interrupt is set
once the fifth rising edge on RX is detected. The value
in the RCREG needs to be read to clear the RCIF
interrupt. ThecontentsofRCREG shouldbediscarded.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 149
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 14-1:
AUTOMATIC BAUD RATE CALCULATION
BRG Value
RX pin
XXXXh
0000h
001Ch
Edge #5
Stop bit
Edge #1
bit 1
Edge #2
bit 3
Edge #3
bit 5
Edge #4
bit 7
bit 6
Start
bit 0
bit 2
bit 4
BRG Clock
Auto-Cleared
Set by User
ABDEN bit
RCIF bit
(interrupt)
Read
RCREG
XXXXh
XXXXh
1Ch
00h
SPBRG
SPBRGH
Note: The ABD sequence requires the EUSART module to be configured in Asynchronous mode and WUE = 0.
FIGURE 14-2:
BRG OVERFLOW SEQUENCE
BRG Clock
ABDEN bit
RX pin
Start
bit 0
ABDOVF bit
BRG Value
FFFFh
XXXXh
0000h
0000h
DS39758B-page 150
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Once the TXREG register transfers the data to the TSR
register (occurs in one TCY), the TXREG register is empty
and the TXIF flag bit (PIR1<4>) is set. This interrupt can
be enabled or disabled by setting or clearing the interrupt
enable bit, TXIE (PIE1<4>). TXIF will be set regardless of
the state of TXIE; it cannot be cleared in software. TXIF
is also not cleared immediately upon loading TXREG but
becomes valid in the second instruction cycle following
the load instruction. Polling TXIF immediately following a
load of TXREG will return invalid results.
14.2 EUSART Asynchronous Mode
The Asynchronous mode of operation is selected by
clearing the SYNC bit (TXSTA<4>). In this mode, the
EUSART uses standard Non-Return-to-Zero (NRZ)
format (one Start bit, eight or nine data bits and one
Stop bit). The most common data format is 8 bits. An
on-chip dedicated 8-bit/16-bit Baud Rate Generator
can be used to derive standard baud rate frequencies
from the oscillator.
The EUSART transmits and receives the LSb first. The
EUSART’s transmitter and receiver are functionally
independent but use the same data format and baud
rate. The Baud Rate Generator produces a clock, either
x16 or x64 of the bit shift rate depending on the BRGH
and BRG16 bits (TXSTA<2> and BAUDCON<3>). Parity
is not supported by the hardware but can be
implemented in software and stored as the 9th data bit.
While TXIF indicates the status of the TXREG register,
another bit, TRMT (TXSTA<1>), shows the status of
the TSR register. TRMT is a read-only bit which is set
when the TSR register is empty. No interrupt logic is
tied to this bit so the user has to poll this bit in order to
determine if the TSR register is empty.
Note 1: The TSR register is not mapped in data
memory so it is not available to the user.
When operating in Asynchronous mode, the EUSART
module consists of the following important elements:
2: Flag bit TXIF is set when enable bit TXEN
is set.
• Baud Rate Generator
• Sampling Circuit
To set up an Asynchronous Transmission:
• Asynchronous Transmitter
• Asynchronous Receiver
• Auto-Wake-up on Sync Break Character
• 12-Bit Break Character Transmit
• Auto-Baud Rate Detection
1. Initialize the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers for the
appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the BRGH
and BRG16 bits, as required, to achieve the
desired baud rate.
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN.
14.2.1
EUSART ASYNCHRONOUS
TRANSMITTER
3. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TXIE.
4. If 9-bit transmission is desired, set transmit bit
TX9. Can be used as address/data bit.
5. Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN
which will also set bit TXIF.
6. If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
7. Load data to the TXREG register (starts
transmission).
8. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
The EUSART transmitter block diagram is shown in
Figure 14-3. The heart of the transmitter is the Transmit
(Serial) Shift Register (TSR). The Shift register obtains
its data from the Read/Write Transmit Buffer register,
TXREG. The TXREG register is loaded with data in
software. The TSR register is not loaded until the Stop
bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As
soon as the Stop bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded
with new data from the TXREG register (if available).
FIGURE 14-3:
EUSART TRANSMIT BLOCK DIAGRAM
Data Bus
TXIF
TXREG Register
TXIE
8
MSb
(8)
LSb
Pin Buffer
and Control
TX pin
0
•
•
•
TSR Register
Interrupt
Baud Rate CLK
SPBRG
TXEN
TRMT
SPEN
BRG16
SPBRGH
TX9
TX9D
Baud Rate Generator
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 151
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 14-4:
ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Write to TXREG
Word 1
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX (pin)
Start bit
bit 0
bit 1
Word 1
bit 7/8
Stop bit
TXIF bit
(Transmit Buffer
Reg. Empty Flag)
1 TCY
Word 1
Transmit Shift Reg
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
FIGURE 14-5:
ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (BACK TO BACK)
Write to TXREG
Word 2
Start bit
Word 1
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
TX (pin)
Start bit
Word 2
bit 0
bit 1
Word 1
bit 7/8
bit 0
Stop bit
1 TCY
TXIF bit
(Interrupt Reg. Flag)
1 TCY
Word 1
Transmit Shift Reg.
Word 2
Transmit Shift Reg.
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
Note: This timing diagram shows two consecutive transmissions.
TABLE 14-5: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ASYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
RBIF
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
42
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RX9
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
SREN
CMP2IF CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
TXIP
RCSTA
TXREG
TXSTA
BAUDCON
SPBRGH
SPBRG
SPEN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
EUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
—
SYNC
SCKP
SENDB
BRG16
BRGH
—
TRMT
WUE
TX9D
ABDOVF
RCIDL
ABDEN
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for asynchronous transmission.
DS39758B-page 152
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
14.2.2
EUSART ASYNCHRONOUS
RECEIVER
14.2.3
SETTING UP 9-BIT MODE WITH
ADDRESS DETECT
The receiver block diagram is shown in Figure 14-6.
The data is received on the RX pin and drives the data
recovery block. The data recovery block is actually a
high-speed shifter operating at x16 times the baud rate,
whereas the main receive serial shifter operates at the
bit rate or at FOSC. This mode would typically be used
in RS-232 systems.
This mode would typically be used in RS-485 systems.
To set up an Asynchronous Reception with Address
Detect Enable:
1. Initialize the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers for the
appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the BRGH
and BRG16 bits, as required, to achieve the
desired baud rate.
To set up an Asynchronous Reception:
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
the SYNC bit and setting the SPEN bit.
1. Initialize the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers for the
appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the BRGH
and BRG16 bits, as required, to achieve the
desired baud rate.
3. If interrupts are required, set the RCEN bit and
select the desired priority level with the RCIP bit.
4. Set the RX9 bit to enable 9-bit reception.
5. Set the ADDEN bit to enable address detect.
6. Enable reception by setting the CREN bit.
2. Enable the asynchronous serial port by clearing
bit SYNC and setting bit SPEN.
3. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RCIE.
4. If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
5. Enable the reception by setting bit CREN.
7. The RCIF bit will be set when reception is
complete. The interrupt will be Acknowledged if
the RCIE and GIE bits are set.
6. Flag bit, RCIF, will be set when reception is
complete and an interrupt will be generated if
enable bit, RCIE, was set.
8. Read the RCSTA register to determine if any
error occurred during reception, as well as read
bit 9 of data (if applicable).
7. Read the RCSTA register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
9. Read RCREG to determine if the device is being
addressed.
10. If any error occurred, clear the CREN bit.
8. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG register.
11. If the device has been addressed, clear the
ADDEN bit to allow all received data into the
receive buffer and interrupt the CPU.
9. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
enable bit CREN.
10. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
FIGURE 14-6:
EUSART RECEIVE BLOCK DIAGRAM
CREN
FERR
OERR
x64 Baud Rate CLK
SPBRGH SPBRG
÷ 64
or
RSR Register
• • •
LSb
MSb
BRG16
÷ 16
or
Stop (8)
7
1
0
Start
÷ 4
Baud Rate Generator
RX9
Pin Buffer
and Control
Data
Recovery
RX9D
RCREG Register
RX
FIFO
SPEN
8
RCIF
RCIE
Interrupt
Data Bus
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 153
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 14-7:
ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION
Start
bit
Start
bit
Start
bit
RX (pin)
Stop
bit
Stop
bit
Stop
bit
bit 0 bit 1
bit 7/8
bit 7/8
bit 0
bit 7/8
Rcv Shift Reg
Rcv Buffer Reg
Word 2
RCREG
Word 1
RCREG
Read Rcv
Buffer Reg
RCREG
RCIF
(Interrupt Flag)
OERR bit
CREN
Note: This timing diagram shows three words appearing on the RX input. The RCREG (Receive Buffer) is read after the third word causing
the OERR (Overrun) bit to be set.
TABLE 14-6: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH ASYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION
Reset
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Values
on page
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
42
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RX9
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
SREN
CMP2IF CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
TXIP
RCSTA
RCREG
TXSTA
SPEN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
EUSART Receive Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
—
SYNC
SCKP
SENDB
BRG16
BRGH
—
TRMT
WUE
TX9D
BAUDCON ABDOVF
RCIDL
ABDEN
SPBRGH
SPBRG
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented locations read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for asynchronous reception.
Following a wake-up event, the module generates an
RCIF interrupt. The interrupt is generated
synchronously to the Q clocks in normal operating
modes (Figure 14-8) and asynchronously if the device
is in Sleep mode (Figure 14-9). The interrupt condition
is cleared by reading the RCREG register.
14.2.4
AUTO-WAKE-UP ON SYNC
BREAK CHARACTER
During Sleep mode, all clocks to the EUSART are
suspended. Because of this, the Baud Rate Generator
is inactive and a proper byte reception cannot be
performed. The auto-wake-up feature allows the
controller to wake-up due to activity on the RX/DT line
while the EUSART is operating in Asynchronous mode.
The WUE bit is automatically cleared once a low-to-
high transition is observed on the RX line following the
wake-up event. At this point, the EUSART module is in
Idle mode and returns to normal operation. This signals
to the user that the Sync Break event is over.
The auto-wake-up feature is enabled by setting the
WUE bit (BAUDCON<1>). Once set, the typical receive
sequence on RX/DT is disabled and the EUSART
remains in an Idle state, monitoring for a wake-up event
independent of the CPU mode. A wake-up event
consists of a high-to-low transition on the RX/DT line.
(This coincides with the start of a Sync Break or a
Wake-up Signal character for the LIN protocol.)
DS39758B-page 154
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
14.2.4.1
Special Considerations Using
Auto-Wake-up
14.2.4.2
Special Considerations Using
the WUE Bit
Since auto-wake-up functions by sensing rising edge
transitions on RX/DT, information with any state
changes before the Stop bit may signal a false End-of-
Character and cause data or framing errors. To work
properly, therefore, the initial characters in the
transmission must be all ‘0’s. This can be 00h (8 bytes)
for standard RS-232 devices or 000h (12 bits) for LIN
bus.
The timing of WUE and RCIF events may cause some
confusion when it comes to determining the validity of
received data. As noted, setting the WUE bit places the
EUSART in an Idle mode. The wake-up event causes a
receive interrupt by setting the RCIF bit. The WUE bit is
cleared after this when a rising edge is seen on RX/DT.
The interrupt condition is then cleared by reading the
RCREG register. Ordinarily, the data in RCREG will be
dummy data and should be discarded.
Oscillator start-up time must also be considered,
especially in applications using oscillators with longer
start-up intervals (i.e., XT or HS mode). The Sync
Break (or Wake-up Signal) character must be of
sufficient length and be followed by a sufficient interval
to allow enough time for the selected oscillator to start
and provide proper initialization of the EUSART.
The fact that the WUE bit has been cleared (or is still
set) and the RCIF flag is set should not be used as an
indicator of the integrity of the data in RCREG. Users
should consider implementing a parallel method in
firmware to verify received data integrity.
To assure that no actual data is lost, check the RCIDL
bit to verify that a receive operation is not in process. If
a receive operation is not occurring, the WUE bit may
then be set just prior to entering the Sleep mode.
FIGURE 14-8:
AUTO-WAKE-UP BIT (WUE) TIMINGS DURING NORMAL OPERATION
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
OSC1
Auto-Cleared
Bit Set by User
WUE bit(1)
RX/DT Line
RCIF
Cleared Due to User Read of RCREG
Note 1:The EUSART remains in Idle while the WUE bit is set.
FIGURE 14-9:
AUTO-WAKE-UP BIT (WUE) TIMINGS DURING SLEEP
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q1
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Auto-Cleared
OSC1
Bit Set by User
WUE bit(2)
RX/DT Line
RCIF
Note 1
Cleared Due to User Read of RCREG
Sleep Ends
Sleep Command Executed
Note 1: If the wake-up event requires long oscillator warm-up time, the auto-clear of the WUE bit can occur before the oscillator is ready. This
sequence should not depend on the presence of Q clocks.
2: The EUSART remains in Idle while the WUE bit is set.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 155
PIC18F1230/1330
3. Load the TXREG with a dummy character to
initiate transmission (the value is ignored).
14.2.5
BREAK CHARACTER SEQUENCE
The EUSART module has the capability of sending the
special Break character sequences that are required by
the LIN bus standard. The Break character transmit
consists of a Start bit, followed by twelve ‘0’ bits and a
Stop bit. The Frame Break character is sent whenever
the SENDB and TXEN bits (TXSTA<3> and
TXSTA<5>) are set while the Transmit Shift register is
loaded with data. Note that the value of data written to
TXREG will be ignored and all ‘0’s will be transmitted.
4. Write ‘55h’ to TXREG to load the Sync character
into the transmit FIFO buffer.
5. After the Break has been sent, the SENDB bit is
reset by hardware. The Sync character now
transmits in the preconfigured mode.
When the TXREG becomes empty, as indicated by the
TXIF, the next data byte can be written to TXREG.
14.2.6
RECEIVING A BREAK CHARACTER
The SENDB bit is automatically reset by hardware after
the corresponding Stop bit is sent. This allows the user
to preload the transmit FIFO with the next transmit byte
following the Break character (typically, the Sync
character in the LIN specification).
The Enhanced USART module can receive a Break
character in two ways.
The first method forces configuration of the baud rate
at a frequency of 9/13 the typical speed. This allows for
the Stop bit transition to be at the correct sampling
location (13 bits for Break versus Start bit and 8 data
bits for typical data).
Note that the data value written to the TXREG for the
Break character is ignored. The write simply serves the
purpose of initiating the proper sequence.
The TRMT bit indicates when the transmit operation is
active or Idle, just as it does during normal
transmission. See Figure 14-10 for the timing of the
Break character sequence.
The second method uses the auto-wake-up feature
described in Section 14.2.4 “Auto-wake-up on Sync
Break Character”. By enabling this feature, the
EUSART will sample the next two transitions on RX/DT,
cause an RCIF interrupt and receive the next data byte
followed by another interrupt.
14.2.5.1
Break and Sync Transmit Sequence
The following sequence will send a message frame
header made up of a Break, followed by an Auto-Baud
Sync byte. This sequence is typical of a LIN bus master.
Note that following a Break character, the user will
typically want to enable the Auto-Baud Rate Detect
feature. For both methods, the user can set the ABDEN
bit once the TXIF interrupt is observed.
1. Configure the EUSART for the desired mode.
2. Set the TXEN and SENDB bits to set up the
Break character.
FIGURE 14-10:
SEND BREAK CHARACTER SEQUENCE
Write to TXREG
Dummy Write
BRG Output
(Shift Clock)
Start bit
TX (pin)
bit 0
bit 1
Break
bit 11
Stop bit
TXIF bit
(Transmit Buffer
Reg. Empty Flag)
TRMT bit
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
SENDB Sampled Here
Auto-Cleared
SENDB
(Transmit Shift
Reg. Empty Flag)
DS39758B-page 156
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Once the TXREG register transfers the data to the TSR
register (occurs in one TCY), the TXREG is empty and
the TXIF flag bit (PIR1<4>) is set. The interrupt can be
enabled or disabled by setting or clearing the interrupt
enable bit, TXIE (PIE1<4>). TXIF is set regardless of
the state of enable bit TXIE; it cannot be cleared in
software. It will reset only when new data is loaded into
the TXREG register.
14.3 EUSART Synchronous
Master Mode
The Synchronous Master mode is entered by setting
the CSRC bit (TXSTA<7>). In this mode, the data is
transmitted in a half-duplex manner (i.e., transmission
and reception do not occur at the same time). When
transmitting data, the reception is inhibited and vice
versa. Synchronous mode is entered by setting bit
SYNC (TXSTA<4>). In addition, enable bit SPEN
(RCSTA<7>) is set in order to configure the TX and RX
pins to CK (clock) and DT (data) lines, respectively.
While flag bit TXIF indicates the status of the TXREG
register, another bit, TRMT (TXSTA<1>), shows the
status of the TSR register. TRMT is a read-only bit which
is set when the TSR is empty. No interrupt logic is tied to
this bit so the user has to poll this bit in order to
determine if the TSR register is empty. The TSR is not
mapped in data memory so it is not available to the user.
The Master mode indicates that the processor
transmits the master clock on the CK line. Clock
polarity is selected with the SCKP bit (BAUDCON<4>).
Setting SCKP sets the Idle state on CK as high, while
clearing the bit sets the Idle state as low. This option is
provided to support Microwire devices with this module.
To set up a Synchronous Master Transmission:
1. Initialize the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers for the
appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the BRG16
bit, as required, to achieve the desired baud rate.
14.3.1
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS MASTER
TRANSMISSION
2. Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC, SPEN and CSRC.
The EUSART transmitter block diagram is shown in
Figure 14-3. The heart of the transmitter is the Transmit
(Serial) Shift Register (TSR). The Shift register obtains
its data from the Read/Write Transmit Buffer register,
TXREG. The TXREG register is loaded with data in
software. The TSR register is not loaded until the last
bit has been transmitted from the previous load. As
soon as the last bit is transmitted, the TSR is loaded
with new data from the TXREG (if available).
3. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TXIE.
4. If 9-bit transmission is desired, set bit TX9.
5. Enable the transmission by setting bit TXEN.
6. If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
7. Start transmission by loading data to the TXREG
register.
8. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
FIGURE 14-11:
SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION
Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
bit 0
bit 1
bit 2
bit 7
bit 0
bit 1
bit 7
RA3/RX/DT
Word 1
Word 2
RA2/TX/CK pin
(SCKP = 0)
RA2/TX/CK pin
(SCKP =
1
)
Write to
TXREG Reg
Write Word 1
Write Word 2
TXIF bit
(Interrupt Flag)
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
‘1’
‘1’
Note: Sync Master mode, SPBRG = 0, continuous transmission of two 8-bit words.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 157
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 14-12:
SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (THROUGH TXEN)
RA3/RX/DT pin
bit 2
bit 0
bit 1
bit 7
bit 6
RA2/TX/CK pin
Write to
TXREG reg
TXIF bit
TRMT bit
TXEN bit
TABLE 14-7: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS MASTER TRANSMISSION
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
42
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RX9
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
SREN
CMP2IF CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
TXIP
RCSTA
TXREG
TXSTA
SPEN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
EUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
—
SYNC
SCKP
SENDB
BRG16
BRGH
—
TRMT
WUE
TX9D
BAUDCON ABDOVF
RCIDL
ABDEN
SPBRGH
SPBRG
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous master transmission.
DS39758B-page 158
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
3. Ensure bits CREN and SREN are clear.
4. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RCIE.
5. If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
6. If a single reception is required, set bit SREN.
For continuous reception, set bit CREN.
7. Interrupt flag bit, RCIF, will be set when reception
is complete and an interrupt will be generated if
the enable bit, RCIE, was set.
8. Read the RCSTA register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
14.3.2
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS
MASTER RECEPTION
Once Synchronous mode is selected, reception is
enabled by setting either the Single Receive Enable bit,
SREN (RCSTA<5>), or the Continuous Receive
Enable bit, CREN (RCSTA<4>). Data is sampled on the
RX pin on the falling edge of the clock.
If enable bit SREN is set, only a single word is received.
If enable bit CREN is set, the reception is continuous
until CREN is cleared. If both bits are set, then CREN
takes precedence.
9. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG register.
10. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
bit CREN.
11. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE bits
in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are set.
To set up a Synchronous Master Reception:
1. Initialize the SPBRGH:SPBRG registers for the
appropriate baud rate. Set or clear the BRG16
bit, as required, to achieve the desired baud rate.
2. Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC, SPEN and CSRC.
FIGURE 14-13:
SYNCHRONOUS RECEPTION (MASTER MODE, SREN)
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4
RA3/RX/DT
bit 5
bit 0
bit 1
bit 4
bit 6
bit 7
bit 2
bit 3
pin
RA2/TX/CK pin
(SCKP = 0)
RA2/TX/CK pin
(SCKP = 1)
Write to
bit SREN
SREN bit
CREN bit
‘0’
‘0’
RCIF bit
(Interrupt)
Read
RXREG
Note: Timing diagram demonstrates Sync Master mode with bit SREN = 1and bit BRGH = 0.
TABLE 14-8: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS MASTER RECEPTION
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
CMP1IF
CMP1IE
CMP1IP
FERR
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
42
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RX9
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
SREN
CMP2IF
CMP2IE
CMP2IP
ADDEN
CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
TXIP
RCSTA
RCREG
TXSTA
SPEN
CREN
OERR
RX9D
EUSART Receive Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
—
SYNC
SCKP
SENDB
BRG16
BRGH
—
TRMT
WUE
TX9D
BAUDCON ABDOVF
RCIDL
ABDEN
SPBRGH EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
SPBRG EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous master reception.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 159
PIC18F1230/1330
To set up a Synchronous Slave Transmission:
14.4 EUSART Synchronous
Slave Mode
1. Enable the synchronous slave serial port by
setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit
CSRC.
Synchronous Slave mode is entered by clearing bit,
CSRC (TXSTA<7>). This mode differs from the
Synchronous Master mode in that the shift clock is
supplied externally at the CK pin (instead of being
supplied internally in Master mode). This allows the
device to transfer or receive data while in any low-power
mode.
2. Clear bits CREN and SREN.
3. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit TXIE.
4. If 9-bit transmission is desired, set bit TX9.
5. Enable the transmission by setting enable bit
TXEN.
6. If 9-bit transmission is selected, the ninth bit
should be loaded in bit TX9D.
14.4.1
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS
SLAVE TRANSMISSION
7. Start transmission by loading data to the TXREG
register.
The operation of the Synchronous Master and Slave
modes are identical, except in the case of the Sleep
mode.
8. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
If two words are written to the TXREG and then the
SLEEPinstruction is executed, the following will occur:
a) The first word will immediately transfer to the
TSR register and transmit.
b) The second word will remain in the TXREG
register.
c) Flag bit, TXIF, will not be set.
d) When the first word has been shifted out of TSR,
the TXREG register will transfer the second
word to the TSR and flag bit, TXIF, will now be
set.
e) If enable bit, TXIE, is set, the interrupt will wake
the chip from Sleep. If the global interrupt is
enabled, the program will branch to the interrupt
vector.
TABLE 14-9: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE TRANSMISSION
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
42
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RX9
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
SREN
CMP2IF CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
TXIP
RCSTA
TXREG
TXSTA
SPEN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
EUSART Transmit Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
—
SYNC
SCKP
SENDB
BRG16
BRGH
—
TRMT
WUE
TX9D
BAUDCON ABDOVF
RCIDL
ABDEN
SPBRGH
SPBRG
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous slave transmission.
DS39758B-page 160
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
To set up a Synchronous Slave Reception:
14.4.2
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE
RECEPTION
1. Enable the synchronous master serial port by
setting bits SYNC and SPEN and clearing bit
CSRC.
The operation of the Synchronous Master and Slave
modes is identical, except in the case of Sleep, or any
Idle mode and bit SREN, which is a “don’t care” in
Slave mode.
2. If interrupts are desired, set enable bit RCIE.
3. If 9-bit reception is desired, set bit RX9.
4. To enable reception, set enable bit CREN.
If receive is enabled by setting the CREN bit prior to
entering Sleep or any Idle mode, then a word may be
received while in this low-power mode. Once the word
is received, the RSR register will transfer the data to the
RCREG register; if the RCIE enable bit is set, the
interrupt generated will wake the chip from the low-
power mode. If the global interrupt is enabled, the
program will branch to the interrupt vector.
5. Flag bit, RCIF, will be set when reception is
complete. An interrupt will be generated if
enable bit, RCIE, was set.
6. Read the RCSTA register to get the 9th bit (if
enabled) and determine if any error occurred
during reception.
7. Read the 8-bit received data by reading the
RCREG register.
8. If any error occurred, clear the error by clearing
bit CREN.
9. If using interrupts, ensure that the GIE and PEIE
bits in the INTCON register (INTCON<7:6>) are
set.
TABLE 14-10: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH SYNCHRONOUS SLAVE RECEPTION
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
42
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RX9
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
SREN
CMP2IF CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
TXIP
RCSTA
RCREG
TXSTA
SPEN
CREN
ADDEN
FERR
OERR
RX9D
EUSART Receive Register
CSRC
TX9
TXEN
—
SYNC
SCKP
SENDB
BRG16
BRGH
—
TRMT
WUE
TX9D
BAUDCON ABDOVF
RCIDL
ABDEN
SPBRGH
SPBRG
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register High Byte
EUSART Baud Rate Generator Register Low Byte
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for synchronous slave reception.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 161
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 162
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The ADCON0 register, shown in Register 15-1,
controls the operation of the A/D module. The
ADCON1 register, shown in Register 15-2, configures
the functions of the port pins. The ADCON2 register,
shown in Register 15-3, configures the A/D clock
source, programmed acquisition time and justification.
15.0 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER (A/D) MODULE
The Analog-to-Digital (A/D) converter module has
4 inputs for the 18/20/28-pin devices. This module
allows conversion of an analog input signal to a
corresponding 10-bit digital number in PIC18F1230/
1330 devices.
The module has five registers:
• A/D Result Register High Byte (ADRESH)
• A/D Result Register Low Byte (ADRESL)
• A/D Control Register 0 (ADCON0)
• A/D Control Register 1 (ADCON1)
• A/D Control Register 2 (ADCON2)
REGISTER 15-1: ADCON0: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 0
R/W-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
CHS1
R/W-0
CHS0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ADON
SEVTEN
GO/DONE
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
SEVTEN: Special Event Trigger Enable bit
1= Special Event Trigger from Power Control PWM module is enabled
0= Special Event Trigger from Power Control PWM module is disabled (default)
bit 6-4
bit 3-2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
CHS1:CHS0: Analog Channel Select bits
00= Channel 0 (AN0)
01= Channel 1 (AN1)
10= Channel 2 (AN2)
11= Channel 3 (AN3)
bit 1
bit 0
GO/DONE: A/D Conversion Status bit
When ADON = 1:
1= A/D conversion in progress
0= A/D Idle
ADON: A/D On bit
1= A/D converter module is enabled
0= A/D converter module is disabled
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 163
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 15-2: ADCON1: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 1
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0(1,2)
PCFG3
R/W(1)
R/W(1)
R/W(1)
VCFG0
PCFG2
PCFG1
PCFG0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-5
bit 4
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
VCFG0: Voltage Reference Configuration bit (VREF+ source)
1= Positive reference for the A/D is VREF+
0= Positive reference for the A/D is AVDD
bit 3
bit 2
bit 1
bit 0
PCFG3: A/D Port Configuration bit for RA6/AN3(1,2)
1= Port is configured as AN3
0= Port is configured as RA6
PCFG2: A/D Port Configuration bit for RA4/AN2(1)
1= Port is configured as AN2
0= Port is configured as RA4
PCFG1: A/D Port Configuration bit for RA1/AN1(1)
1= Port is configured as AN1
0= Port is configured as RA1
PCFG0: A/D Port Configuration bit for RA0/AN0(1)
1= Port is configured as AN0
0= Port is configured as RA0
Note 1: These bits reset to ‘1’ to configure the port as an analog input after Reset.
2: This bit is unused and reads as ‘0’ if pin is not configured for use as RA6
DS39758B-page 164
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 15-3: ADCON2: A/D CONTROL REGISTER 2
R/W-0
ADFM
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
ACQT2
ACQT1
ACQT0
ADCS2
ADCS1
ADCS0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
ADFM: A/D Result Format Select bit
1= Right justified
0= Left justified
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
bit 5-3
ACQT2:ACQT0: A/D Acquisition Time Select bits
111= 20 TAD
110= 16 TAD
101= 12 TAD
100= 8 TAD
011= 6 TAD
010= 4 TAD
001= 2 TAD
(1)
000= 0 TAD
bit 2-0
ADCS2:ADCS0: A/D Conversion Clock Select bits
111= FRC (clock derived from A/D RC oscillator)(1)
110= FOSC/64
101= FOSC/16
100= FOSC/4
011= FRC (clock derived from A/D RC oscillator)(1)
010= FOSC/32
001= FOSC/8
000= FOSC/2
Note 1: If the A/D FRC clock source is selected, a delay of one TCY (instruction cycle) is added before the A/D
clock starts. This allows the SLEEPinstruction to be executed before starting a conversion.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 165
PIC18F1230/1330
The analog reference voltage is software selectable to
the device’s positive supply voltage (VDD), or the
voltage level on the RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+ pin.
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the A/D module to be turned off and any
conversion in progress is aborted.
The A/D converter has a unique feature of being able
to operate while the device is in Sleep mode. To
operate in Sleep, the A/D conversion clock must be
derived from the A/D converter’s internal RC oscillator.
Each port pin associated with the A/D converter can be
configured as an analog input or as a digital I/O. The
ADRESH and ADRESL registers contain the result of
the A/D conversion. When the A/D conversion is
complete,
the
result
is
loaded
into
the
The output of the sample and hold is the input into the
converter, which generates the result via successive
approximation.
ADRESH:ADRESL register pair, the GO/DONE bit
(ADCON0 register) is cleared and A/D Interrupt Flag bit,
ADIF, is set. The block diagram of the A/D module is
shown in Figure 15-1.
FIGURE 15-1:
A/D BLOCK DIAGRAM
CHS1:CHS0
VAIN
0011
10-Bit
Converter
A/D
AN3
(Input Voltage)
0010
AN2
0001
VCFG0
AN1
0000
AVDD
AN0
0
1
VREF+
Reference
Voltage
AVSS
DS39758B-page 166
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The value in the ADRESH:ADRESL registers is not
modified for a Power-on Reset. The ADRESH:ADRESL
registers will contain unknown data after a Power-on
Reset.
5. Wait for A/D conversion to complete, by either:
• Polling for the GO/DONE bit to be cleared
OR
• Waiting for the A/D interrupt
After the A/D module has been configured as desired,
the selected channel must be acquired before the
conversion is started. The analog input channels must
have their corresponding TRIS bits selected as inputs.
To determine acquisition time, see Section 15.2 “A/D
Acquisition Requirements”. After this acquisition
time has elapsed, the A/D conversion can be started.
An acquisition time can be programmed to occur
between setting the GO/DONE bit and the actual start
of the conversion.
6. Read A/D Result registers (ADRESH:ADRESL);
clear bit ADIF, if required.
7. For next conversion, go to step 1 or step 2, as
required. The A/D conversion time per bit is
defined as TAD. A minimum wait of 2 TAD is
required before the next acquisition starts.
FIGURE 15-2:
A/D TRANSFER FUNCTION
The following steps should be followed to perform an A/D
conversion:
3FFh
3FEh
1. Configure the A/D module:
• Configure analog pins, voltage reference and
digital I/O (ADCON1)
• Select A/D input channel (ADCON0)
• Select A/D acquisition time (ADCON2)
• Select A/D conversion clock (ADCON2)
• Turn on A/D module (ADCON0)
2. Configure A/D interrupt (if desired):
• Clear ADIF bit
003h
002h
001h
000h
• Set ADIE bit
• Set GIE bit
3. Wait the required acquisition time (if required).
4. Start conversion:
Analog Input Voltage
• Set GO/DONE bit (ADCON0 register)
FIGURE 15-3:
ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
Sampling
Switch
VT = 0.6V
ANx
SS
RIC ≤ 1k
RSS
Rs
CPIN
5 pF
VAIN
ILEAKAGE
100 nA
CHOLD = 25 pF
VSS
VT = 0.6V
Legend: CPIN
= Input Capacitance
= Threshold Voltage
VT
6V
5V
4V
3V
2V
ILEAKAGE = Leakage Current at the pin due to
various junctions
VDD
RIC
= Interconnect Resistance
= Sampling Switch
SS
CHOLD
RSS
= Sample/Hold Capacitance (from DAC)
= Sampling Switch Resistance
1
2
3
4
Sampling Switch (kΩ)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 167
PIC18F1230/1330
selected (changed), the channel must be sampled for
at least the minimum acquisition time before starting a
conversion.
15.1 Triggering A/D Conversions
The A/D conversion can be triggered by setting the GO/
DONE bit. This bit can either be set manually by the
programmer or by setting the SEVTEN bit of ADCON0.
When the SEVTEN bit is set, the Special Event Trigger
from the Power Control PWM module triggers the A/D
conversion. For more information, see Section 13.14
“PWM Special Event Trigger”.
Note:
When the conversion is started, the
holding capacitor is disconnected from the
input pin.
To calculate the minimum acquisition time,
Equation 15-1 may be used. This equation assumes
that 1/2 LSb error is used (1024 steps for the A/D). The
1/2 LSb error is the maximum error allowed for the A/D
to meet its specified resolution.
15.2 A/D Acquisition Requirements
For the A/D converter to meet its specified accuracy,
the charge holding capacitor (CHOLD) must be allowed
to fully charge to the input channel voltage level. The
analog input model is shown in Figure 15-3. The
source impedance (RS) and the internal sampling
switch (RSS) impedance directly affect the time
required to charge the capacitor CHOLD. The sampling
switch (RSS) impedance varies over the device voltage
(VDD). The source impedance affects the offset voltage
at the analog input (due to pin leakage current). The
maximum recommended impedance for analog
sources is 2.5 kΩ. After the analog input channel is
Example 15-3 shows the calculation of the minimum
required acquisition time, TACQ. This calculation is
based on the following application system
assumptions:
CHOLD
=
=
≤
=
=
25 pF
Rs
2.5 kΩ
Conversion Error
VDD
Temperature
1/2 LSb
5V → RSS = 2 kΩ
85°C (system max.)
EQUATION 15-1: ACQUISITION TIME
TACQ
=
Amplifier Settling Time + Holding Capacitor Charging Time + Temperature Coefficient
=
TAMP + TC + TCOFF
EQUATION 15-2: A/D MINIMUM CHARGING TIME
VHOLD
or
TC
=
=
(VREF – (VREF/2048)) • (1 – e(-TC/CHOLD(RIC + RSS + RS))
)
-(CHOLD)(RIC + RSS + RS) ln(1/2048)
EQUATION 15-3: CALCULATING THE MINIMUM REQUIRED ACQUISITION TIME
TACQ
TAMP
TCOFF
=
=
=
TAMP + TC + TCOFF
0.2 μs
(Temp – 25°C)(0.02 μs/°C)
(85°C – 25°C)(0.02 μs/°C)
1.2 μs
Temperature coefficient is only required for temperatures > 25°C. Below 25°C, TCOFF = 0 ms.
TC
=
-(CHOLD)(RIC + RSS + RS) ln(1/2047)
-(25 pF) (1 kΩ + 2 kΩ + 2.5 kΩ) ln(0.0004883)
1.05 μs
TACQ
=
0.2 μs + 1 μs + 1.2 μs
2.4 μs
DS39758B-page 168
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
15.3 Selecting and Configuring
Acquisition Time
15.4 Selecting the A/D Conversion
Clock
The ADCON2 register allows the user to select an
acquisition time that occurs each time the GO/DONE
bit is set. It also gives users the option to use an
automatically determined acquisition time.
The A/D conversion time per bit is defined as TAD. The
A/D conversion requires 11 TAD per 10-bit conversion.
The source of the A/D conversion clock is software
selectable. There are seven possible options for TAD:
Acquisition time may be set with the ACQT2:ACQT0 bits
(ADCON2<5:3>), which provide a range of 2 to 20 TAD.
When the GO/DONE bit is set, the A/D module
continues to sample the input for the selected acquisition
time, then automatically begins a conversion. Since the
acquisition time is programmed, there may be no need
to wait for an acquisition time between selecting a
channel and setting the GO/DONE bit.
• 2 TOSC
• 4 TOSC
• 8 TOSC
• 16 TOSC
• 32 TOSC
• 64 TOSC
• Internal RC Oscillator
Manual
acquisition
is
selected
when
For correct A/D conversions, the A/D conversion clock
(TAD) must be as short as possible, but greater than the
minimum TAD (see parameter 130 for more
information).
ACQT2:ACQT0 = 000. When the GO/DONE bit is set,
sampling is stopped and a conversion begins. The user
is responsible for ensuring the required acquisition time
has passed between selecting the desired input
channel and setting the GO/DONE bit. This option is
also the default Reset state of the ACQT2:ACQT0 bits
and is compatible with devices that do not offer
programmable acquisition times.
Table 15-1 shows the resultant TAD times derived from
the device operating frequencies and the A/D clock
source selected.
In either case, when the conversion is completed, the
GO/DONE bit is cleared, the ADIF flag is set and the
A/D begins sampling the currently selected channel
again. If an acquisition time is programmed, there is
nothing to indicate if the acquisition time has ended or
if the conversion has begun.
TABLE 15-1: TAD vs. DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCIES
AD Clock Source (TAD)
Maximum Device Frequency
Operation
ADCS2:ADCS0
PIC18F1230/1330
PIC18LF1230/1330(4)
2 TOSC
4 TOSC
8 TOSC
16 TOSC
32 TOSC
64 TOSC
RC(3)
000
100
001
101
010
110
x11
2.86 MHz
5.71 MHz
11.43 MHz
22.86 MHz
40.0 MHz
40.0 MHz
1.00 MHz(1)
1.43 kHz
2.86 MHz
5.72 MHz
11.43 MHz
22.86 MHz
22.86 MHz
1.00 MHz(2)
Note 1: The RC source has a typical TAD time of 1.2 μs.
2: The RC source has a typical TAD time of 2.5 μs.
3: For device frequencies above 1 MHz, the device must be in Sleep for the entire conversion or the A/D
accuracy may be out of specification.
4: Low-power (PIC18LF1230/1330) devices only.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 169
PIC18F1230/1330
15.5 Operation in Power-Managed
Modes
15.6 Configuring Analog Port Pins
The ADCON1 and TRISA registers configure the A/D
port pins. The port pins needed as analog inputs must
have their corresponding TRIS bits set (input). If the
TRIS bit is cleared (output), the digital output level (VOH
or VOL) will be converted.
The selection of the automatic acquisition time and A/D
conversion clock is determined in part by the clock
source and frequency while in a power-managed mode.
If the A/D is expected to operate while the device is in
a power-managed mode, the ACQT2:ACQT0 and
ADCS2:ADCS0 bits in ADCON2 should be updated in
accordance with the clock source to be used in that
mode. After entering the mode, an A/D acquisition or
conversion may be started. Once started, the device
should continue to be clocked by the same clock
source until the conversion has been completed.
The A/D operation is independent of the state of the
CHS1:CHS0 bits and the TRIS bits.
Note 1: When reading the PORT register, all pins
configured as analog input channels will
read as cleared (a low level). Pins
configured as digital inputs will convert as
analog inputs. Analog levels on a digitally
configured input will be accurately
converted.
If desired, the device may be placed into the
corresponding Idle mode during the conversion. If the
device clock frequency is less than 1 MHz, the A/D RC
clock source should be selected.
2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a
digital input may cause the digital input
buffer to consume current out of the
device’s specification limits.
Operation in Sleep mode requires the A/D FRC clock to
be selected. If bits ACQT2:ACQT0 are set to ‘000’ and
a conversion is started, the conversion will be delayed
one instruction cycle to allow execution of the SLEEP
instruction and entry to Sleep mode. The IDLEN bit
(OSCCON<7>) must have already been cleared prior
to starting the conversion.
DS39758B-page 170
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
After the A/D conversion is completed or aborted, a
2 TAD wait is required before the next acquisition can be
started. After this wait, acquisition on the selected
channel is automatically started.
15.7 A/D Conversions
Figure 15-4 shows the operation of the A/D converter
after the GO/DONE bit has been set and the
ACQT2:ACQT0 bits are cleared. A conversion is
started after the following instruction to allow entry into
Sleep mode before the conversion begins.
Note:
The GO/DONE bit should NOT be set in
the same instruction that turns on the A/D.
Figure 15-5 shows the operation of the A/D converter
after the GO/DONE bit has been set, the ACQT2:ACQT0
bits are set to ‘010’ and a 4 TAD acquisition time is
selected before the conversion starts.
15.8 Discharge
The discharge phase is used to initialize the value of
the capacitor array. The array is discharged before
every sample. This feature helps to optimize the unity-
gain amplifier, as the circuit always needs to charge the
capacitor array, rather than charge/discharge based on
previous measure values.
Clearing the GO/DONE bit during a conversion will abort
the current conversion. The A/D Result register pair will
NOT be updated with the partially completed A/D
conversion
sample.
This
means
that
the
ADRESH:ADRESL registers will continue to contain the
value of the last completed conversion (or the last value
written to the ADRESH:ADRESL registers).
FIGURE 15-4:
A/D CONVERSION TAD CYCLES (ACQT<2:0> = 000, TACQ = 0)
T
CY – TAD
TAD7 TAD8 TAD9 TAD10 TAD11
TAD1
TAD1 TAD2 TAD3 TAD4 TAD5 TAD6
b7
b6
b4
b1
b0
b9
Conversion starts
Holding capacitor is disconnected from analog input (typically 100 ns)
b8
b5
b3
b2
Discharge
Set GO/DONE bit
On the following cycle:
ADRESH:ADRESL are loaded, GO/DONE bit is cleared,
ADIF bit is set, holding capacitor is connected to analog input.
FIGURE 15-5:
A/D CONVERSION TAD CYCLES (ACQT<2:0> = 010, TACQ = 4 TAD)
TAD Cycles
TACQT Cycles
8
9
10
b1
11
b0
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
TAD1
b7
b6
b3
b2
b8
b5
b4
b9
Automatic
Acquisition
Time
Discharge
Conversion starts
(Holding capacitor is disconnected)
Set GO/DONE bit
(Holding capacitor continues
acquiring input)
On the following cycle:
ADRESH:ADRESL are loaded, GO/DONE bit is cleared,
ADIF bit is set, holding capacitor is connected to analog input.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 171
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 15-2: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH A/D OPERATION
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
INTCON
PIR1
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
INT0IE
TXIF
RBIE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
RBIF
41
43
43
43
42
42
42
42
42
44
43
—
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
CMP2IF CMP1IF
CMP0IF
TMR1IF
PIE1
TXIE
TXIP
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
IPR1
ADRESH A/D Result Register High Byte
ADRESL A/D Result Register Low Byte
ADCON0 SEVTEN
—
—
—
—
—
CHS1
PCFG3
ACQT0
RA3
CHS0 GO/DONE ADON
ADCON1
ADCON2
PORTA
TRISA
—
VCFG0
ACQT1
RA4
PCFG2
ADCS2
RA2
PCFG1
ADCS1
RA1
PCFG0
ADCS0
RA0
ADFM
RA7(1)
—
RA6(1)
ACQT2
RA5(2)
TRISA7(1) TRISA6(1) PORTA Data Direction Control Register
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used for A/D conversion.
Note 1: PORTA<7:6> and their direction bits are individually configured as port pins based on various primary
oscillator modes. When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
2: The RA5 bit is only available when Master Clear Reset is disabled (MCLRE Configuration bit = 0);
otherwise, RA5 reads as ‘0’. This bit is read-only.
DS39758B-page 172
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Section 17.0 “Comparator Voltage Reference
Module”). The digital outputs are not available at the
pin level and can only be read through the control
register, CMCON (Register 16-1). CMCON also selects
the comparator input.
16.0 COMPARATOR MODULE
The analog comparator module contains three
comparators. The inputs can be selected from the
analog inputs multiplexed with pins RA0, RB2 and
RB3, as well as the on-chip voltage reference (see
REGISTER 16-1: CMCON: COMPARATOR CONTROL REGISTER
R-0
R-0
R-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
C2OUT
C1OUT
C0OUT
CMEN2
CMEN1
CMEN0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
bit 6
bit 5
C2OUT: Comparator 2 Output bit
1= C2 VIN+ > C2 VIN- (CVREF)
0= C2 VIN+ < C2 VIN- (CVREF)
C1OUT: Comparator 1 Output bit
1= C1 VIN+ > C1 VIN- (CVREF)
0= C1 VIN+ < C1 VIN- (CVREF)-
C0OUT: Comparator 0 Output bit
1= C0 VIN+ > C0 VIN- (CVREF)
0= C0 VIN+ < C0 VIN- (CVREF)
bit 4-3
bit 2
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
CMEN2: Comparator 2 Enable bit
1= Comparator 2 is enabled
0= Comparator 2 is disabled
bit 1
bit 0
CMEN1: Comparator 1 Enable bit
1= Comparator 1 is enabled
0= Comparator 1 is disabled
CMEN0: Comparator 0 Enable bit
1= Comparator 0 is enabled
0= Comparator 0 is disabled
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 173
PIC18F1230/1330
16.1 Comparator Configuration
16.5 Comparator Outputs
For every analog comparator, there is a control bit
called CMENx in the CMCON register. By setting the
CMENx bit, the corresponding comparator can be
enabled. If the Comparator mode is changed, the
comparator output level may not be valid for the
specified mode change delay shown in Section 22.0
“Electrical Characteristics”.
The comparator outputs are read through the CxOUT
bits of the CMCON register. These bits are read-only.
The uncertainty of each of the comparators is related to
the input offset voltage and the response time given in
the specifications.
Note 1: When reading the PORT register, all pins
configured as analog inputs will read as a
‘0’. Pins configured as digital inputs will
convert an analog input according to the
Schmitt Trigger input specification.
Note:
Comparator interrupts should be disabled
during Comparator mode change;
otherwise, a false interrupt may occur.
a
2: Analog levels on any pin defined as a
digital input may cause the input buffer to
consume more current than is specified.
16.2 Comparator Operation
A single comparator is shown in Figure 16-1, along with
the relationship between the analog input levels and
the digital output. When the analog input at VIN+
(CMPx) is less than the analog input VIN- (CVREF), the
output of the comparator is a digital low level. When the
analog input at VIN+ (CMPx) is greater than the analog
input VIN- (CVREF), the output of the comparator is a
digital high level. The shaded areas of the output of the
comparator in Figure 16-1 represent the uncertainty
due to input offsets and response time.
16.6
Comparator Interrupts
The comparator interrupt flag is set whenever there is
a change in the output value of the corresponding
comparator. Software will need to maintain information
about the status of the output bits, as read from
CMCON<7:5>, to determine the actual change that
occurred. The CMPxIF bit (PIR1<3:1>) is the
Comparator Interrupt Flag. The CMPxIF bit must be
reset by clearing it. Since it is also possible to write a ‘1’
to this register, a simulated interrupt may be initiated.
16.3 Comparator Reference
In this comparator module, an internal voltage
reference is used (see Section 17.0 “Comparator
Voltage Reference Module”).
Both the CMPxIE bit (PIE1<3:1>) and the PEIE bit
(INTCON<6>) must be set to enable the interrupt for
the corresponding comparator. In addition, the GIE bit
(INTCON<7>) must also be set. If any of these bits are
clear, the interrupt is not enabled, though the CMPxIF
bit will still be set if an interrupt condition occurs.
FIGURE 16-1:
SINGLE COMPARATOR
VIN+
VIN-
+
Note:
If a change in the CMCON register (C2OUT,
C1OUT or C0OUT) should occur when a
read operation is being executed (start of
the Q2 cycle), then the CMPxIF (PIR1
register) interrupt flag may not get set.
Output
-
The user, in the Interrupt Service Routine, can clear the
interrupt in the following manner:
VIN-
a) Any read or write of CMCON will end the
mismatch condition.
VIN+
b) Clear flag bit CMPxIF.
A mismatch condition will continue to set flag bit
CMPxIF. Reading CMCON will end the mismatch
condition and allow flag bit CMPxIF to be cleared.
Output
16.4 Comparator Response Time
Response time is the minimum time, after selecting a
new reference voltage or input source, before the
comparator output has a valid level. If the internal
reference is changed, the maximum delay of the
internal voltage reference must be considered when
using the comparator outputs. Otherwise, the
maximum delay of the comparators should be used
(see Section 22.0 “Electrical Characteristics”).
DS39758B-page 174
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
16.7 Comparator Operation
During Sleep
16.9 Analog Input Connection
Considerations
When a comparator is active and the device is placed
in Sleep mode, the comparator remains active and the
interrupt is functional if enabled. This interrupt will
wake-up the device from Sleep mode when enabled.
Each operational comparator will consume additional
current, as shown in the comparator specifications. To
minimize power consumption while in Sleep mode, turn
off the comparators (CMEN2:CMEN0 = 000) before
entering Sleep. If the device wakes up from Sleep, the
contents of the CMCON register are not affected.
A simplified circuit for an analog input is shown in
Figure 16-2. Since the analog pins are connected to a
digital output, they have reverse biased diodes to VDD
and VSS. The analog input, therefore, must be between
VSS and VDD. If the input voltage deviates from this
range by more than 0.6V in either direction, one of the
diodes is forward biased and a latch-up condition may
occur. A maximum source impedance of 10 kΩ is
recommended for the analog sources. Any external
component connected to an analog input pin, such as
a capacitor or Zener diode, should have very little
leakage current.
16.8 Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces the CMCON register to its Reset
state, causing the comparator modules to be turned off
(CMEN2:CMEN0 = 000).
FIGURE 16-2:
COMPARATOR ANALOG INPUT MODEL
VDD
VT = 0.6V
RIC
RS < 10k
AIN
Comparator
Input
ILEAKAGE
500 nA
CPIN
5 pF
VA
VT = 0.6V
VSS
Legend: CPIN
=
=
Input Capacitance
Threshold Voltage
VT
ILEAKAGE = Leakage Current at the pin due to various junctions
RIC
RS
VA
=
=
=
Interconnect Resistance
Source Impedance
Analog Voltage
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 175
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 16-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH COMPARATOR MODULE
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
CMCON
CVRCON
INTCON
PIR1
C2OUT
CVREN
C1OUT
—
C0OUT
CVRR
—
—
CMEN2
CVR2
CMEN1
CVR1
CMEN0
CVR0
RBIF
42
42
41
43
43
43
44
43
43
44
43
43
CVRSS
INT0IE
TXIF
CVR3
RBIE
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
TMR0IF
INT0IF
—
—
ADIF
ADIE
ADIP
RA6(1)
RCIF
RCIE
RCIP
RA5(2)
CMP2IF CMP1IF CMP0IF TMR1IF
CMP2IE CMP1IE CMP0IE TMR1IE
CMP2IP CMP1IP CMP0IP TMR1IP
PIE1
TXIE
IPR1
—
RA7(1)
LATA7(1)
TXIP
PORTA
LATA
RA4
RA3
RA2
RA1
RA0
LATA6(1) PORTA Data Latch Register (Read and Write to Data Latch)
TRISA
PORTB
LATB
TRISA7(1) TRISA6(1) PORTA Data Direction Control Register
RB7 RB6 RB5 RB4 RB3 RB2
RB1
RB0
PORTB Data Latch Register (Read and Write to Data Latch)
PORTB Data Direction Control Register
TRISB
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are unused by the comparator module.
Note 1: PORTA<7:6> and their direction and latch bits are individually configured as port pins based on various
primary oscillator modes. When disabled, these bits read as ‘0’.
2: The RA5 bit is only available when Master Clear Reset is disabled (MCLRE Configuration bit = 0);
otherwise, RA5 reads as ‘0’. This bit is read-only.
DS39758B-page 176
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
used is selected by the CVRR bit (CVRCON<5>). The
primary difference between the ranges is the size of the
steps selected by the CVREF selection bits
(CVR3:CVR0), with one range offering finer resolution.
The equations used to calculate the output of the
comparator voltage reference are as follows:
17.0 COMPARATOR VOLTAGE
REFERENCE MODULE
The comparator voltage reference is a 16-tap resistor
ladder network that provides a selectable reference
voltage. Its purpose is to provide a reference for the
analog comparators.
If CVRR = 1:
CVREF = ((CVR3:CVR0)/24) x CVRSRC
A block diagram of the module is shown in Figure 17-1.
The resistor ladder is segmented to provide two ranges
of CVREF values and has a power-down function to
conserve power when the reference is not being used.
The module’s supply reference can be provided from
either device VDD/VSS or an external voltage reference.
If CVRR = 0:
CVREF = (CVRSRC x 1/4) + (((CVR3:CVR0)/32) x
CVRSRC)
The comparator reference supply voltage can come
from either AVDD or AVSS, or the external VREF+ that is
multiplexed with RA4 and AVSS. The voltage source is
selected by the CVRSS bit (CVRCON<4>).
17.1 Configuring the Comparator
Voltage Reference
The settling time of the comparator voltage reference
must be considered when changing the CVREF
output (see Table 22-3 in Section 22.0 “Electrical
Characteristics”).
The voltage reference module is controlled through the
CVRCON register (Register 17-1). The comparator
voltage reference provides two ranges of output
voltage, each with 16 distinct levels. The range to be
REGISTER 17-1: CVRCON: COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE CONTROL REGISTER
R/W-0
U-0
—
R/W-0
CVRR
R/W-0
R/W-0
CVR3
R/W-0
CVR2
R/W-0
CVR1
R/W-0
CVR0
CVREN
CVRSS
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7
CVREN: Comparator Voltage Reference Enable bit
1= CVREF circuit powered on
0= CVREF circuit powered down
bit 6
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
CVRR: Comparator VREF Range Selection bit
1= 0 to 0.667 CVRSRC, with CVRSRC/24 step size (low range)
0= 0.25 CVRSRC to 0.75 CVRSRC, with CVRSRC/32 step size (high range)
bit 4
CVRSS: Comparator VREF Source Selection bit
1= Comparator reference source, CVRSRC = (VREF+) – (AVSS)
0= Comparator reference source, CVRSRC = AVDD – AVSS
bit 3-0
CVR3:CVR0: Comparator VREF Value Selection bits (0 ≤ (CVR3:CVR0) ≤ 15)
When CVRR = 1:
CVREF = ((CVR3:CVR0)/24) • (CVRSRC)
When CVRR = 0:
CVREF = (CVRSRC/4) + ((CVR3:CVR0)/32) • (CVRSRC)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 177
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 17-1:
COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE BLOCK DIAGRAM
CVRSS = 1
CVRSS = 0
VREF+
AVDD
8R
CVR3:CVR0
R
CVREN
R
R
R
16 Steps
CVREF
R
R
R
CVRR
8R
CVRSS = x
AVSS
17.2 Voltage Reference Accuracy/Error
17.3 Operation During Sleep
The full range of voltage reference cannot be realized
due to the construction of the module. The transistors
on the top and bottom of the resistor ladder network
(Figure 17-1) keep CVREF from approaching the
reference source rails. The voltage reference is derived
from the reference source; therefore, the CVREF output
changes with fluctuations in that source. The tested
absolute accuracy of the voltage reference can be
found in Section 22.0 “Electrical Characteristics”.
When the device wakes up from Sleep through an
interrupt or a Watchdog Timer time-out, the contents of
the CVRCON register are not affected. To minimize
current consumption in Sleep mode, the voltage
reference should be disabled.
17.4 Effects of a Reset
A device Reset disables the voltage reference by clearing
bit, CVREN (CVRCON<7>). This Reset selects the high-
voltage range by clearing bit, CVRR (CVRCON<5>). The
CVR value select bits are also cleared.
TABLE 17-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH COMPARATOR VOLTAGE REFERENCE
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
CVRCON
CMCON
CVREN
C2OUT
—
CVRR
CVRSS
—
CVR3
—
CVR2
CVR1
CVR0
42
42
C1OUT
C0OUT
CMEN2
CMEN1
CMEN0
Legend: Shaded cells are not used with the comparator voltage reference.
DS39758B-page 178
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The Low-Voltage Detect Control register (Register 18-1)
completely controls the operation of the LVD module.
This allows the circuitry to be “turned off” by the user
under software control, which minimizes the current
consumption for the device.
18.0 LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT (LVD)
PIC18F1230/1330 devices have a Low-Voltage
Detect module (LVD). This is a programmable circuit
that allows the user to specify the device voltage trip
point. If the device experiences an excursion past the
trip point, an interrupt flag is set. If the interrupt is
enabled, the program execution will branch to the
interrupt vector address and the software can then
respond to the interrupt.
The block diagram for the LVD module is shown in
Figure 18-1.
REGISTER 18-1: LVDCON: LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
R-0
R/W-0
R/W-0
LVDL3(1)
R/W-1
LVDL2(1)
R/W-0
LVDL1(1)
R/W-1
LVDL0(1)
IRVST
LVDEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-6
bit 5
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
IRVST: Internal Reference Voltage Stable Flag bit
1= Indicates that the voltage detect logic will generate the interrupt flag at the specified voltage
trip point
0= Indicates that the voltage detect logic will not generate the interrupt flag at the specified voltage
trip point and the LVD interrupt should not be enabled
bit 4
LVDEN: Low-Voltage Detect Power Enable bit
1= LVD enabled
0= LVD disabled
bit 3-0
LVDL3:LVDL0: Voltage Detection Limit bits(1)
1111= Reserved
1110= Maximum setting
.
.
.
0000= Minimum setting
Note 1: See Table 22-4 in Section 22.0 “Electrical Characteristics” for the specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 179
PIC18F1230/1330
The module is enabled by setting the LVDEN bit. Each
time that the LVD module is enabled, the circuitry
requires some time to stabilize. The IRVST bit is a
read-only bit and is used to indicate when the circuit is
stable. The module can only generate an interrupt after
the circuit is stable and IRVST is set.
trip point voltage. The “trip point” voltage is the voltage
level at which the device detects a low-voltage event
depending on the configuration of the module. When
the supply voltage is equal to the trip point, the voltage
tapped off of the resistor array is equal to the internal
reference voltage generated by the voltage reference
module. The comparator then generates an interrupt
signal by setting the LVDIF bit.
18.1 Operation
The trip point voltage is software programmable to any 1 of
15 values. The trip point is selected by programming the
LVDL3:LVDL0 bits (LVDCON<3:0>).
When the LVD module is enabled, a comparator uses
an internally generated reference voltage as the set
point. The set point is compared with the trip point,
where each node in the resistor divider represents a
FIGURE 18-1:
LVD MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM
VDD
LVDL3:LVDL0
LVDCON
Register
LVDEN
Set
LVDIF
LVDEN
Internal Voltage
Reference
BORENx
DS39758B-page 180
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Depending on the application, the LVD module does
not need to be operating constantly. To decrease the
current requirements, the LVD circuitry may only need
to be enabled for short periods where the voltage is
checked. After doing the check, the LVD module may
be disabled.
18.2 LVD Setup
The following steps are needed to set up the LVD
module:
1. Disable the module by clearing the LVDEN bit
(LVDCON<4>).
2. Write the value to the LVDL3:LVDL0 bits that
selects the desired LVD trip point.
18.4 LVD Start-up Time
3. Enable the LVD module by setting the LVDEN
bit.
The internal reference voltage of the LVD module,
specified in electrical specification parameter D420,
may be used by other internal circuitry, such as the
programmable Brown-out Reset. If the LVD or other
circuits using the voltage reference are disabled to
lower the device’s current consumption, the reference
voltage circuit will require time to become stable before
a low-voltage condition can be reliably detected. This
start-up time, TIRVST, is an interval that is independent
of device clock speed. It is specified in electrical
specification parameter 36.
4. Clear the LVD interrupt flag (PIR2<2>) which
may have been set from a previous interrupt.
5. Enable the LVD interrupt, if interrupts are
desired, by setting the LVDIE and GIE bits
(PIE2<2> and INTCON<7>). An interrupt will not
be generated until the IRVST bit is set.
18.3 Current Consumption
When the module is enabled, the LVD comparator and
voltage divider are enabled and will consume static cur-
rent. The total current consumption, when enabled, is
specified in electrical specification parameter D022B.
The LVD interrupt flag is not enabled until TIRVST has
expired and a stable reference voltage is reached. For
this reason, brief excursions beyond the set point may
not be detected during this interval (refer to Figure 18-2).
FIGURE 18-2:
LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT OPERATION
CASE 1:
LVDIF may not be set
VDD
VLVD
LVDIF
Enable LVD
IRVST
TIRVST
LVDIF cleared in software
Internal reference is stable
CASE 2:
VDD
VLVD
LVDIF
Enable LVD
TIRVST
IRVST
Internal reference is stable
LVDIF cleared in software
LVDIF cleared in software,
LVDIF remains set since LVD condition still exists
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 181
PIC18F1230/1330
18.5 Applications
18.6 Operation During Sleep
In many applications, the ability to detect a drop below
a particular threshold is desirable.
When enabled, the LVD circuitry continues to operate
during Sleep. If the device voltage crosses the trip
point, the LVDIF bit will be set and the device will wake-
up from Sleep. Device execution will continue from the
interrupt vector address if interrupts have been globally
enabled.
For general battery applications, Figure 18-3 shows a
possible voltage curve. Over time, the device voltage
decreases. When the device voltage reaches voltage
VA, the LVD logic generates an interrupt at time TA. The
interrupt could cause the execution of an ISR, which
would allow the application to perform “housekeeping
tasks” and perform a controlled shutdown before the
device voltage exits the valid operating range at TB.
The LVD, thus, would give the application a time win-
dow, represented by the difference between TA and TB,
to safely exit.
18.7 Effects of a Reset
A device Reset forces all registers to their Reset state.
This forces the LVD module to be turned off.
FIGURE 18-3:
TYPICAL LOW-VOLTAGE
DETECT APPLICATION
VA
VB
TA
TB
Time
Legend: VA = LVD trip point
VB = Minimum valid device
operating voltage
TABLE 18-1: REGISTERS ASSOCIATED WITH LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT MODULE
Reset
Values
on Page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
LVDCON
INTCON
PIR2
—
—
IRVST
LVDEN
INT0IE
EEIF
LVDL3
RBIE
—
LVDL2
TMR0IF
LVDIF
LVDL1
INT0IF
—
LVDL0
RBIF
—
42
41
43
43
43
GIE/GIEH PEIE/GIEL TMR0IE
OSCFIF
OSCFIE
OSCFIP
—
—
—
—
—
—
PIE2
EEIE
—
LVDIE
LVDIP
—
—
IPR2
EEIP
—
—
—
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are unused by the LVD module.
DS39758B-page 182
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The inclusion of an internal RC oscillator also provides
the additional benefits of a Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
(FSCM) and Two-Speed Start-up. FSCM provides for
background monitoring of the peripheral clock and
automatic switchover in the event of its failure. Two-
Speed Start-up enables code to be executed almost
immediately on start-up while the primary clock source
completes its start-up delays.
19.0 SPECIAL FEATURES OF
THE CPU
PIC18F1230/1330 devices include several features
intended to maximize reliability and minimize cost
through elimination of external components. These are:
• Oscillator Selection
• Resets:
All of these features are enabled and configured by
setting the appropriate Configuration register bits.
- Power-on Reset (POR)
- Power-up Timer (PWRT)
- Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST)
- Brown-out Reset (BOR)
• Interrupts
19.1 Configuration Bits
The Configuration bits can be programmed (read as
‘0’) or left unprogrammed (read as ‘1’) to select various
device configurations. These bits are mapped starting
at program memory location 300000h.
• Watchdog Timer (WDT)
• Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
• Two-Speed Start-up
• Code Protection
The user will note that address 300000h is beyond the
user program memory space. In fact, it belongs to the
configuration memory space (300000h-3FFFFFh) which
can only be accessed using table reads and table writes.
• ID Locations
• In-Circuit Serial Programming
Programming the Configuration registers is done in a
manner similar to programming the Flash memory. The
WR bit in the EECON1 register starts a self-timed write
to the Configuration register. In normal operation mode,
a TBLWT instruction with the TBLPTR pointing to the
Configuration register sets up the address and data for
the Configuration register write. Setting the WR bit
starts a long write to the Configuration register. The
Configuration registers are written a byte at a time. To
write or erase a configuration cell, a TBLWTinstruction
can write a ‘1’ or a ‘0’ into the cell. For additional details
on Flash programming, refer to Section 6.5 “Writing
to Flash Program Memory”.
The oscillator can be configured for the application
depending on frequency, power, accuracy and cost. All
of the options are discussed in detail in Section 2.0
“Oscillator Configurations”.
A complete discussion of device Resets and interrupts
is available in previous sections of this data sheet.
In addition to their Power-up and Oscillator Start-up
Timers provided for Resets, PIC18F1230/1330 devices
have a Watchdog Timer, which is either permanently
enabled via the Configuration bits or software
controlled (if configured as disabled).
TABLE 19-1: CONFIGURATION BITS AND DEVICE IDs
Default/
Unprogrammed
Value
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
300001h CONFIG1H IESO
FCMEN
—
—
—
—
—
—
FOSC3
BORV0
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
00-- 0111
---1 1111
---1 1111
---- 111-
1--- 0--1
1000 ---1
---- --11
11-- ----
---- --11
111- ----
---- --11
-1-- ----
See Table 19-2
See Table 19-2
300002h CONFIG2L
300003h CONFIG2H
300004h CONFIG3L
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
BORV1
BOREN1 BOREN0 PWRTEN
WDTPS3 WDTPS2 WDTPS1 WDTPS0 WDTEN
—
—
HPOL
LPOL
—
PWMPIN
—
—
FLTAMX
STVREN
CP0
300005h CONFIG3H MCLRE
T1OSCMX
300006h CONFIG4L BKBUG XINST BBSIZ1 BBSIZ0
—
—
—
—
300008h CONFIG5L
300009h CONFIG5H CPD
30000Ah CONFIG6L
30000Bh CONFIG6H WRTD
—
—
CPB
—
—
—
—
—
—
CP1
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
WRT1
—
WRT0
—
WRTB
—
WRTC
—
—
—
—
30000Ch CONFIG7L
30000Dh CONFIG7H
—
—
—
—
—
EBTR1
—
EBTR0
—
EBTRB
DEV1
DEV9
—
—
—
—
(1)
3FFFFEh DEVID1
DEV2
DEV10
DEV0
DEV8
REV4
DEV7
REV3
DEEV6
REV2
DEV5
REV1
DEV4
REV0
DEV3
(1)
3FFFFFh DEVID2
Legend:
-= unimplemented, read as ‘0’.Shaded cells are unimplemented, read as ‘0’.
Note 1: DEVID registers are read-only and cannot be programmed by the user.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 183
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-1: CONFIG1H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 1 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300001h)
R/P-0
IESO
R/P-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-0
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
FCMEN
FOSC3
FOSC2
FOSC1
FOSC0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7
bit 6
IESO: Internal/External Oscillator Switchover bit
1= Oscillator Switchover mode enabled
0= Oscillator Switchover mode disabled
FCMEN: Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Enable bit
1= Fail-Safe Clock Monitor enabled
0= Fail-Safe Clock Monitor disabled
bit 5-4
bit 3-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
FOSC3:FOSC0: Oscillator Selection bits
11xx= External RC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
101x= External RC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
1001= Internal oscillator block, CLKO function on RA6, port function on RA7
1000= Internal oscillator block, port function on RA6 and RA7
0111= External RC oscillator, port function on RA6
0110= HS oscillator, PLL enabled (Clock Frequency = 4 x FOSC1)
0101= EC oscillator, port function on RA6
0100= EC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
0011= External RC oscillator, CLKO function on RA6
0010= HS oscillator
0001= XT oscillator
0000= LP oscillator
DS39758B-page 184
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-2: CONFIG2L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 2 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300002h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
BORV1(1)
R/P-1
BORV0(1)
R/P-1
BOREN1(2)
R/P-1
R/P-1
BOREN0(2) PWRTEN(2)
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-5
bit 4-3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
BORV1:BORV0: Brown-out Reset Voltage bits(1)
11= Minimum setting
•
•
•
00= Maximum setting
bit 2-1
bit 0
BOREN1:BOREN0: Brown-out Reset Enable bits(2)
11= Brown-out Reset enabled in hardware only (SBOREN is disabled)
10= Brown-out Reset enabled in hardware only and disabled in Sleep mode (SBOREN is disabled)
01= Brown-out Reset enabled and controlled by software (SBOREN is enabled)
00= Brown-out Reset disabled in hardware and software
PWRTEN: Power-up Timer Enable bit(2)
1= PWRT disabled
0= PWRT enabled
Note 1: See Section 22.1 “DC Characteristics” for the specifications.
2: The Power-up Timer is decoupled from Brown-out Reset, allowing these features to be independently
controlled.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 185
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-3: CONFIG2H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 2 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300003h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
R/P-1
WDTPS3
WDTPS2
WDTPS1
WDTPS0
WDTEN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-5
bit 4-1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
WDTPS3:WDTPS0: Watchdog Timer Postscale Select bits
1111= 1:32,768
1110= 1:16,384
1101= 1:8,192
1100= 1:4,096
1011= 1:2,048
1010= 1:1,024
1001= 1:512
1000= 1:256
0111= 1:128
0110= 1:64
0101= 1:32
0100= 1:16
0011= 1:8
0010= 1:4
0001= 1:2
0000= 1:1
bit 0
WDTEN: Watchdog Timer Enable bit
1= WDT enabled
0= WDT disabled (control is placed on the SWDTEN bit)
DS39758B-page 186
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-4: CONFIG3L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 3 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300005h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
HPOL(1)
R/P-1
LPOL(1)
R/P-1
U-0
—
PWMPIN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-4
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
HPOL: High Side Transistors Polarity bit (Odd PWM Output Polarity Control bit)(1)
1= PWM1, PWM3 and PWM5 are active-high (default)
0= PWM1, PWM3 and PWM5 are active-low
bit 2
bit 2
bit 0
LPOL: Low Side Transistors Polarity bit (Even PWM Output Polarity Control bit)(1)
1= PWM0, PWM2 and PWM4 are active-high (default)
0= PWM0, PWM2 and PWM4 are active-low
PWMPIN: PWM Output Pins Reset State Control bit
1= PWM outputs disabled upon Reset
0= PWM outputs drive active states upon Reset(2)
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1: Polarity control bits, HPOL and LPOL, define PWM signal output active and inactive states, PWM states
generated by the Fault inputs or PWM manual override.
2: When PWMPIN = 0, PWMEN<2:0> = 100. PWM output polarity is defined by HPOL and LPOL.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 187
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-5: CONFIG3H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 3 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300005h)
R/P-1
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
MCLRE
T1OSCMX
FLTAMX
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7
MCLRE: MCLR Pin Enable bit
1= MCLR pin enabled, RA5 input pin disabled
0= RA5 input pin enabled, MCLR pin disabled
bit 6-4
bit 3
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
T1OSCMX: T1OSO/T1CKI MUX bit
1= T1OSO/T1CKI pin resides on RA6
0= T1OSO/T1CKI pin resides on RB2
bit 2-1
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
FLTAMX: FLTA MUX bit
1= FLTA is muxed onto RA5
0= FLTA is muxed onto RA7
DS39758B-page 188
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-6: CONFIG4L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 4 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300006h)
R/P-1
R/P-0
R/P-0
R/P-0
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/P-1
BKBUG
XINST
BBSIZ1
BBSIZ0
STVREN
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7
BKBUG: Background Debugger Enable bit
1= Background debugger disabled, RB6 and RB7 configured as general purpose I/O pins
0= Background debugger enabled, RB6 and RB7 are dedicated to In-Circuit Debug
bit 6
XINST: Extended Instruction Set Enable bit
1= Instruction set extension and Indexed Addressing mode enabled
0= Instruction set extension and Indexed Addressing mode disabled
bit 5-4
BBSIZ<1:0>: Boot Block Size Select bits
For PIC18F1330 device:
11= 1 kW Boot Block size
10= 1 kW Boot Block size
01= 512W Boot Block size
00= 256W Boot Block size
For PIC18F1230 device:
11= 512W Boot Block size
10= 512W Boot Block size
01= 512W Boot Block size
00= 256W Boot Block size
bit 3-1
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
STVREN: Stack Overflow/Underflow Reset Enable bit
1= Reset on stack overflow/underflow enabled
0= Reset on stack overflow/underflow disabled
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 189
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-7: CONFIG5L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 5 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 300008h)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/C-1
CP1
R/C-1
CP0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-2
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
CP1: Code Protection bit (Block 1 Code Memory Area)
1= Block 1 is not code-protected
0= Block 1 is code-protected
bit 0
CP0: Code Protection bit (Block 0 Code Memory Area)
1= Block 0 is not code-protected
0= Block 0 is code-protected
REGISTER 19-8: CONFIG5H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 5 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 300009h)
R/C-1
CPD
R/C-1
CPB
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7
CPD: Code Protection bit (Data EEPROM)
1= Data EEPROM is not code-protected
0= Data EEPROM is code-protected
bit 6
CPB: Code Protection bit (Boot Block Memory Area)
1= Boot Block is not code-protected
0= Boot Block is code-protected
bit 5-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
DS39758B-page 190
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-9: CONFIG6L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 6 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 30000Ah)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/C-1
WRT1
R/C-1
WRT0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-2
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
WRT1: Write Protection bit (Block 1 Code Memory Area)
1= Block 1 is not write-protected
0= Block 1 is write-protected
bit 0
WRT0: Write Protection bit (Block 0 Code Memory Area)
1= Block 0 is not write-protected
0= Block 0 is write-protected
REGISTER 19-10: CONFIG6H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 6 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 30000Bh)
R/C-1
R/C-1
R-1
WRTC(1)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
WRTD
WRTB
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7
WRTD: Write Protection bit (Data EEPROM)
1= Data EEPROM is not write-protected
0= Data EEPROM is write-protected
bit 6
WRTB: Write Protection bit (Boot Block Memory Area)
1= Boot Block is not write-protected
0= Boot Block is write-protected
bit 5
WRTC: Write Protection bit (Configuration Registers)(1)
1= Configuration registers are not write-protected
0= Configuration registers are write-protected
bit 4-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
Note 1: This bit is read-only in normal execution mode; it can be written only in Program mode.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 191
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-11: CONFIG7L: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 7 LOW (BYTE ADDRESS 30000Ch)
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/C-1
R/C-1
EBTR1
EBTR0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-2
bit 1
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
EBTR1: Table Read Protection bit (Block 1 Code Memory Area)
1= Block 1 is not protected from table reads executed in other blocks
0= Block 1 is protected from table reads executed in other blocks
bit 0
EBTR0: Table Read Protection bit (Block 0 Code Memory Area)
1= Block 0 is not protected from table reads executed in other blocks
0= Block 0 is protected from table reads executed in other blocks
REGISTER 19-12: CONFIG7H: CONFIGURATION REGISTER 7 HIGH (BYTE ADDRESS 30000Dh)
U-0
—
R/C-1
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
EBTRB
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Readable bit
C = Clearable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7
bit 6
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
EBTRB: Table Read Protection bit (Boot Block Memory Area)
1= Boot Block is not protected from table reads executed in other blocks
0= Boot Block is protected from table reads executed in other blocks
bit 5-0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
DS39758B-page 192
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-13: DEVID1: DEVICE ID REGISTER 1 FOR PIC18F1230/1330 DEVICES
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
DEV2
DEV1
DEV0
REV4
REV3
REV2
REV1
REV0
bit 7
bit 0
Legend:
R = Read-only bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-5
bit 4-0
DEV2:DEV0: Device ID bits
These bits are used with the DEV10:DEV3 bits in the DEVID2 register to identify part number.
REV3:REV0: Revision ID bits
These bits are used to indicate the device revision.
REGISTER 19-14: DEVID2: DEVICE ID REGISTER 2 FOR PIC18F1230/1330 DEVICES
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
DEV10
DEV9
DEV8
DEV7
DEV6
DEV5
DEV4
DEV3
bit 0
bit 7
Legend:
R = Read-only bit
P = Programmable bit
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
-n = Value when device is unprogrammed
u = Unchanged from programmed state
bit 7-0
DEV10:DEV3: Device ID bits
These bits are used with the DEV2:DEV0 bits in the DEVID1 register to identify part number.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 193
PIC18F1230/1330
19.2 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Note 1: The CLRWDT and SLEEP instructions
clear the WDT and postscaler counts
when executed.
For PIC18F1230/1330 devices, the WDT is driven by
the INTRC source. When the WDT is enabled, the
clock source is also enabled. The nominal WDT period
is 4 ms and has the same stability as the INTRC
oscillator.
2: Changing the setting of the IRCF bits
(OSCCON<6:4>) clears the WDT and
postscaler counts.
The 4 ms period of the WDT is multiplied by a 16-bit
postscaler. Any output of the WDT postscaler is
selected by a multiplexer, controlled by bits in Configu-
ration Register 2H. Available periods range from 4 ms
to 131.072 seconds (2.18 minutes). The WDT and
postscaler are cleared when any of the following events
occur: a SLEEPor CLRWDTinstruction is executed, the
IRCF bits (OSCCON<6:4>) are changed or a clock
failure has occurred.
3: When a CLRWDTinstruction is executed,
the postscaler count will be cleared.
19.2.1
CONTROL REGISTER
Register 19-15 shows the WDTCON register. This is a
readable and writable register which contains a control
bit that allows software to override the WDT enable
Configuration bit, but only if the Configuration bit has
disabled the WDT.
FIGURE 19-1:
WDT BLOCK DIAGRAM
Enable WDT
SWDTEN
WDTEN
WDT Counter
Wake-up from
Power-Managed
Modes
÷128
INTRC Source
Change on IRCF bits
CLRWDT
WDT
Reset
Reset
Programmable Postscaler
1:1 to 1:32,768
All Device Resets
4
WDTPS<3:0>
Sleep
DS39758B-page 194
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
REGISTER 19-15: WDTCON: WATCHDOG TIMER CONTROL REGISTER
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
U-0
—
R/W-0
SWDTEN(1)
bit 0
bit 7
Legend:
R = Readable bit
-n = Value at POR
W = Writable bit
‘1’ = Bit is set
U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’
‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown
bit 7-1
bit 0
Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’
SWDTEN: Software Controlled Watchdog Timer Enable bit(1)
1= Watchdog Timer is on
0= Watchdog Timer is off
Note 1: This bit has no effect if the Configuration bit, WDTEN, is enabled.
TABLE 19-2: SUMMARY OF WATCHDOG TIMER REGISTERS
Reset
Values
on page
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
RCON
WDTCON
IPEN
—
SBOREN(1)
—
—
—
RI
—
TO
—
PD
—
POR
—
BOR
SWDTEN(2)
42
42
Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Shaded cells are not used by the Watchdog Timer.
Note 1: The SBOREN bit is only available when the BOREN1:BOREN0 Configuration bits = 01; otherwise, it is
disabled and reads as ‘0’. See Section 4.4 “Brown-out Reset (BOR)”.
2: This bit has no effect if the Configuration bit, WDTEN, is enabled.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 195
PIC18F1230/1330
In all other power-managed modes, Two-Speed Start-up
is not used. The device will be clocked by the currently
selected clock source until the primary clock source
becomes available. The setting of the IESO bit is
ignored.
19.3 Two-Speed Start-up
The Two-Speed Start-up feature helps to minimize the
latency period from oscillator start-up to code execution
by allowing the microcontroller to use the INTOSC
oscillator as a clock source until the primary clock
source is available. It is enabled by setting the IESO
Configuration bit.
19.3.1
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS FOR
USING TWO-SPEED START-UP
Two-Speed Start-up should be enabled only if the
primary oscillator mode is LP, XT, HS or HSPLL
(crystal-based modes). Other sources do not require
an OST start-up delay; for these, Two-Speed Start-up
should be disabled.
While using the INTOSC oscillator in Two-Speed
Start-up, the device still obeys the normal command
sequences for entering power-managed modes,
including multiple SLEEP instructions (refer to
Section 3.1.4 “Multiple Sleep Commands”). In
practice, this means that user code can change the
SCS1:SCS0 bit settings or issue SLEEP instructions
before the OST times out. This would allow an applica-
tion to briefly wake-up, perform routine “housekeeping”
tasks and return to Sleep before the device starts to
operate from the primary oscillator.
When enabled, Resets and wake-ups from Sleep mode
cause the device to configure itself to run from the
internal oscillator block as the clock source, following
the time-out of the Power-up Timer, after a Power-on
Reset is enabled. This allows almost immediate code
execution while the primary oscillator starts and the
OST is running. Once the OST times out, the device
automatically switches to PRI_RUN mode.
User code can also check if the primary clock source is
currently providing the device clocking by checking the
status of the OSTS bit (OSCCON<3>). If the bit is set,
the primary oscillator is providing the clock. Otherwise,
the internal oscillator block is providing the clock during
wake-up from Reset or Sleep mode.
To use a higher clock speed on wake-up, the INTOSC
or postscaler clock sources can be selected to provide
a higher clock speed by setting bits, IRCF2:IRCF0,
immediately after Reset. For wake-ups from Sleep, the
INTOSC or postscaler clock sources can be selected
by setting the IRCF2:IRCF0 bits prior to entering Sleep
mode.
FIGURE 19-2:
TIMING TRANSITION FOR TWO-SPEED START-UP (INTOSC TO HSPLL)
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 Q3
Q1
Q2
INTOSC
Multiplexer
OSC1
(1)
(1)
TPLL
TOST
1
2
n-1
n
PLL Clock
Output
Clock
Transition(2)
CPU Clock
Peripheral
Clock
Program
Counter
PC + 2
PC + 4
PC + 6
PC
Wake from Interrupt Event
OSTS bit Set
Note 1: TOST = 1024 TOSC; TPLL = 2 ms (approx). These intervals are not shown to scale.
2: Clock transition typically occurs within 2-4 TOSC.
DS39758B-page 196
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
To use a higher clock speed on wake-up, the INTOSC
or postscaler clock sources can be selected to provide
a higher clock speed by setting bits, IRCF2:IRCF0,
immediately after Reset. For wake-ups from Sleep, the
INTOSC or postscaler clock sources can be selected
by setting the IRCF2:IRCF0 bits prior to entering Sleep
mode.
19.4 Fail-Safe Clock Monitor
The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) allows the
microcontroller to continue operation in the event of an
external oscillator failure by automatically switching the
device clock to the internal oscillator block. The FSCM
function is enabled by setting the FCMEN Configuration
bit.
The FSCM will detect failures of the primary or
secondary clock sources only. If the internal oscillator
block fails, no failure would be detected, nor would any
action be possible.
When FSCM is enabled, the INTRC oscillator runs at
all times to monitor clocks to peripherals and provide a
backup clock in the event of a clock failure. Clock
monitoring (shown in Figure 19-3) is accomplished by
creating a sample clock signal, which is the INTRC
output divided by 64. This allows ample time between
FSCM sample clocks for a peripheral clock edge to
occur. The peripheral device clock and the sample
clock are presented as inputs to the Clock Monitor latch
(CM). The CM is set on the falling edge of the device
clock source, but cleared on the rising edge of the
sample clock.
19.4.1
FSCM AND THE WATCHDOG TIMER
Both the FSCM and the WDT are clocked by the
INTRC oscillator. Since the WDT operates with a
separate divider and counter, disabling the WDT has
no effect on the operation of the INTRC oscillator when
the FSCM is enabled.
As already noted, the clock source is switched to the
INTOSC clock when a clock failure is detected.
Depending on the frequency selected by the
IRCF2:IRCF0 bits, this may mean a substantial change
in the speed of code execution. If the WDT is enabled
with a small prescale value, a decrease in clock speed
allows a WDT time-out to occur and a subsequent
device Reset. For this reason, fail-safe clock events
also reset the WDT and postscaler, allowing it to start
timing from when execution speed was changed and
decreasing the likelihood of an erroneous time-out.
FIGURE 19-3:
FSCM BLOCK DIAGRAM
Clock Monitor
Latch (CM)
(edge-triggered)
Peripheral
Clock
S
Q
INTRC
Source
C
Q
÷ 64
19.4.2
EXITING FAIL-SAFE OPERATION
(32 μs)
488 Hz
(2.048 ms)
The fail-safe condition is terminated by either a device
Reset or by entering a power-managed mode. On
Reset, the controller starts the primary clock source
specified in Configuration Register 1H (with any
required start-up delays that are required for the
oscillator mode, such as the OST or PLL timer). The
INTOSC multiplexer provides the device clock until the
primary clock source becomes ready (similar to a Two-
Speed Start-up). The clock source is then switched to
the primary clock (indicated by the OSTS bit in the
OSCCON register becoming set). The Fail-Safe Clock
Monitor then resumes monitoring the peripheral clock.
Clock
Failure
Detected
Clock failure is tested for on the falling edge of the
sample clock. If a sample clock falling edge occurs
while CM is still set, a clock failure has been detected
(Figure 19-4). This causes the following:
• The FSCM generates an oscillator fail interrupt by
setting bit, OSCFIF (PIR2<7>).
• The device clock source is switched to the internal
oscillator block (OSCCON is not updated to show
the current clock source – this is the fail-safe
condition).
The primary clock source may never become ready
during start-up. In this case, operation is clocked by the
INTOSC multiplexer. The OSCCON register will remain
in its Reset state until a power-managed mode is
entered.
• The WDT is reset.
During switchover, the postscaler frequency from the
internal oscillator block may not be sufficiently stable for
timing sensitive applications. In these cases, it may be
desirable to select another clock configuration and enter
an alternate power-managed mode. This can be done to
attempt a partial recovery or execute a controlled shut-
down. See Section 3.1.4 “Multiple Sleep Commands”
and Section 19.3.1 “Special Considerations for
Using Two-Speed Start-up” for more details.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 197
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 19-4:
FSCM TIMING DIAGRAM
Sample Clock
Oscillator
Failure
Device
Clock
Output
CM Output
(Q)
Failure
Detected
OSCFIF
CM Test
CM Test
CM Test
Note:
The device clock is normally at a much higher frequency than the sample clock. The relative frequencies in
this example have been chosen for clarity.
time considerably longer than the FCSM sample clock
time, a false clock failure may be detected. To prevent
this, the internal oscillator block is automatically
configured as the device clock and functions until the
primary clock is stable (the OST and PLL timers have
timed out). This is identical to Two-Speed Start-up
mode. Once the primary clock is stable, the INTRC
returns to its role as the FSCM source.
19.4.3
FSCM INTERRUPTS IN
POWER-MANAGED MODES
By entering a power-managed mode, the clock multi-
plexer selects the clock source selected by the OSCCON
register. Fail-Safe Clock Monitoring of the power-
managed clock source resumes in the power-managed
mode.
If an oscillator failure occurs during power-managed
operation, the subsequent events depend on whether
or not the oscillator failure interrupt is enabled. If
enabled (OSCFIF = 1), code execution will be clocked
by the INTOSC multiplexer. An automatic transition
back to the failed clock source will not occur.
Note:
The same logic that prevents false oscilla-
tor failure interrupts on POR, or wake from
Sleep, will also prevent the detection of
the oscillator’s failure to start at all follow-
ing these events. This can be avoided by
monitoring the OSTS bit and using a
timing routine to determine if the oscillator
is taking too long to start. Even so, no
oscillator failure interrupt will be flagged.
If the interrupt is disabled, subsequent interrupts while
in Idle mode will cause the CPU to begin executing
instructions while being clocked by the INTOSC
source.
As noted in Section 19.3.1 “Special Considerations
for Using Two-Speed Start-up”, it is also possible to
select another clock configuration and enter an
alternate power-managed mode while waiting for the
primary clock to become stable. When the new power-
managed mode is selected, the primary clock is
disabled.
19.4.4
POR OR WAKE FROM SLEEP
The FSCM is designed to detect oscillator failure at any
point after the device has exited Power-on Reset
(POR) or low-power Sleep mode. When the primary
device clock is EC, RC or INTRC modes, monitoring
can begin immediately following these events.
For oscillator modes involving a crystal or resonator
(HS, HSPLL, LP or XT), the situation is somewhat
different. Since the oscillator may require a start-up
DS39758B-page 198
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
Each of the three blocks has three code protection bits
associated with them. They are:
19.5 Program Verification and
Code Protection
• Code-Protect bit (CPx)
The overall structure of the code protection on the
PIC18 Flash devices differs significantly from other
PICmicro® devices.
• Write-Protect bit (WRTx)
• External Block Table Read bit (EBTRx)
Figure 19-5 shows the program memory organization
for 4 and 8-Kbyte devices and the specific code
protection bit associated with each block. The actual
locations of the bits are summarized in Table 19-3.
The user program memory is divided into three blocks.
One of these is a Boot Block of variable size (maximum
2 Kbytes). The remainder of the memory is divided into
two blocks on binary boundaries.
FIGURE 19-5:
CODE-PROTECTED PROGRAM MEMORY FOR PIC18F1230/1330
MEMORY SIZE/DEVICE
Block Code Protection
4 Kbytes
8 Kbytes
Address
Range
Controlled By:
CPB, WRTB, EBTRB
CP0, WRT0, EBTR0
(PIC18F1230)
(PIC18F1330)
000000h
0003FFh
Boot Block
Boot Block
000400h
Block 0
Block 1
0007FFh
000800h
Block 0
Block 1
CP1, WRT1, EBTR1
CP2, WRT2, EBTR2
000FFFh
001000h
Unimplemented
Read ‘0’s
001FFFh
002000h
Unimplemented
Unimplemented
Read ‘0’s
Read ‘0’s
(Unimplemented Memory Space)
1FFFFFh
TABLE 19-3: SUMMARY OF CODE PROTECTION REGISTERS
File Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
300008h CONFIG5L
300009h CONFIG5H
30000Ah CONFIG6L
—
CPD
—
—
CPB
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
CP1
—
CP0
—
—
WRT1
—
WRT0
—
30000Bh CONFIG6H WRTD
WRTB
—
WRTC
—
30000Ch CONFIG7L
30000Dh CONFIG7H
—
—
EBTR1
—
EBTR0
—
EBTRB
—
Legend: Shaded cells are unimplemented.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 199
PIC18F1230/1330
A table read instruction that executes from a location
outside of that block is not allowed to read and will result
in reading ‘0’s. Figures 19-6 through 19-8 illustrate table
write and table read protection.
19.5.1
PROGRAM MEMORY
CODE PROTECTION
The program memory may be read to or written from
any location using the table read and table write
instructions. The Device ID may be read with table
reads. The Configuration registers may be read and
written with the table read and table write instructions.
Note:
Code protection bits may only be written to
a ‘0’ from a ‘1’ state. It is not possible to
write a ‘1’ to a bit in the ‘0’ state. Code
protection bits are only set to ‘1’ by a full
chip erase or block erase function. The full
chip erase and block erase functions can
only be initiated via ICSP operation or an
external programmer.
In normal execution mode, the CPx bits have no direct
effect. CPx bits inhibit external reads and writes. A
block of user memory may be protected from table
writes if the WRTx Configuration bit is ‘0’. The EBTRx
bits control table reads. For a block of user memory
with the EBTRx bit set to ‘0’, a table read instruction
that executes from within that block is allowed to read.
FIGURE 19-6:
TABLE WRITE (WRTx) DISALLOWED
Register Values
Program Memory
Configuration Bit Settings
000000h
0007FFh
WRTB, EBTRB = 11
000800h
TBLPTR = 0008FFh
PC = 000FFEh
WRT0, EBTR0 = 01
TBLWT*
TBLWT*
000FFFh
001000h
PC = 001800h
WRT1, EBTR1 = 11
001FFFh
Results: All table writes disabled to Blockn whenever WRTx = 0.
DS39758B-page 200
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 19-7:
EXTERNAL BLOCK TABLE READ (EBTRx) DISALLOWED
Register Values
Program Memory
Configuration Bit Settings
000000h
WRTB, EBTRB = 11
0007FFh
000800h
TBLPTR = 0008FFh
PC = 001100h
WRT0, EBTR0 = 10
WRT1, EBTR1 = 11
000FFFh
001000h
TBLRD*
001FFFh
Results: All table reads from external blocks to Blockn are disabled whenever EBTRx = 0.
TABLAT register returns a value of ‘0’.
FIGURE 19-8:
EXTERNAL BLOCK TABLE READ (EBTRx) ALLOWED
Register Values
Program Memory
Configuration Bit Settings
000000h
WRTB, EBTRB = 11
WRT0, EBTR0 = 10
0007FFh
000800h
TBLPTR = 0008FFh
PC = 000FFEh
TBLRD*
000FFFh
001000h
WRT1, EBTR1 = 11
001FFFh
Results: Table reads permitted within Blockn, even when EBTRBx = 0.
TABLAT register returns the value of the data at the location TBLPTR.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 201
PIC18F1230/1330
19.5.2
DATA EEPROM
CODE PROTECTION
19.8 In-Circuit Debugger
When the BKBUG Configuration bit is programmed to
a ‘0’, the In-Circuit Debugger functionality is enabled.
This function allows simple debugging functions when
used with MPLAB® IDE. When the microcontroller has
this feature enabled, some resources are not available
for general use. Table 19-4 shows which resources are
required by the background debugger.
The entire data EEPROM is protected from external
reads and writes by two bits: CPD and WRTD. CPD
inhibits external reads and writes of data EEPROM.
WRTD inhibits internal and external writes to data
EEPROM. The CPU can always read data EEPROM
under normal operation, regardless of the protection bit
settings.
TABLE 19-4: DEBUGGER RESOURCES
19.5.3
CONFIGURATION REGISTER
PROTECTION
I/O pins:
RB6, RB7
2 levels
Stack:
The Configuration registers can be write-protected.
The WRTC bit controls protection of the Configuration
registers. In normal execution mode, the WRTC bit is
read-only. WRTC can only be written via ICSP
operation or an external programmer.
Program Memory:
Data Memory:
512 bytes
10 bytes
To use the In-Circuit Debugger function of the microcon-
troller, the design must implement In-Circuit Serial
Programming connections to MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA,
VDD, VSS, RB7/PWM5/PGD and RB6/PWM4/PGC. This
will interface to the In-Circuit Debugger module available
from Microchip or one of the third party development tool
companies.
19.6 ID Locations
Eight memory locations (200000h-200007h) are
designated as ID locations, where the user can store
checksum or other code identification numbers. These
locations are both readable and writable during normal
execution through the TBLRD and TBLWT instructions
or during program/verify. The ID locations can be read
when the device is code-protected.
19.9 Single-Supply ICSP Programming
The PIC18F1230/1330 device family does not support
Low-Voltage ICSP Programming or LVP. This device
family can only be programmed using high-voltage ICSP
programming. For more details, refer to the
“PIC18F1230/1330 Flash Microcontroller Programming
Specification” (DS39752).
19.7
In-Circuit Serial Programming
PIC18F1230/1330 microcontrollers can be serially
programmed while in the end application circuit. This is
simply done with two lines for clock and data and three
other lines for power, ground and the programming
voltage. This allows customers to manufacture boards
with unprogrammed devices and then program the
microcontroller just before shipping the product. This
also allows the most recent firmware or a custom
firmware to be programmed.
Memory that is not code-protected can be erased using
either a block erase, or erased row by row, then written
at any specified VDD. If code-protected memory is to be
erased, a block erase is required.
DS39758B-page 202
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
20.1 MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software
20.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT
The PICmicro® microcontrollers are supported with a
full range of hardware and software development tools:
The MPLAB IDE software brings an ease of software
development previously unseen in the 8/16-bit micro-
controller market. The MPLAB IDE is a Windows®
operating system-based application that contains:
• Integrated Development Environment
- MPLAB® IDE Software
• Assemblers/Compilers/Linkers
- MPASMTM Assembler
• A single graphical interface to all debugging tools
- Simulator
- MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 C Compilers
- MPLINKTM Object Linker/
MPLIBTM Object Librarian
- Programmer (sold separately)
- Emulator (sold separately)
- In-Circuit Debugger (sold separately)
• A full-featured editor with color-coded context
• A multiple project manager
- MPLAB ASM30 Assembler/Linker/Library
• Simulators
- MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
• Emulators
• Customizable data windows with direct edit of
contents
- MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator
- MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator
• In-Circuit Debugger
• High-level source code debugging
• Visual device initializer for easy register
initialization
- MPLAB ICD 2
• Mouse over variable inspection
• Device Programmers
- PICSTART® Plus Development Programmer
• Drag and drop variables from source to watch
windows
- MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
• Extensive on-line help
• Low-Cost Demonstration and Development
Boards and Evaluation Kits
• Integration of select third party tools, such as
HI-TECH Software C Compilers and IAR
C Compilers
The MPLAB IDE allows you to:
• Edit your source files (either assembly or C)
• One touch assemble (or compile) and download
to PICmicro MCU emulator and simulator tools
(automatically updates all project information)
• Debug using:
- Source files (assembly or C)
- Mixed assembly and C
- Machine code
MPLAB IDE supports multiple debugging tools in a
single development paradigm, from the cost-effective
simulators, through low-cost in-circuit debuggers, to
full-featured emulators. This eliminates the learning
curve when upgrading to tools with increased flexibility
and power.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 203
PIC18F1230/1330
20.2 MPASM Assembler
20.5 MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker
and Librarian
The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal
macro assembler for all PICmicro MCUs.
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler produces relocatable
machine code from symbolic assembly language for
dsPIC30F devices. MPLAB C30 C Compiler uses the
assembler to produce its object file. The assembler
generates relocatable object files that can then be
archived or linked with other relocatable object files and
archives to create an executable file. Notable features
of the assembler include:
The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object
files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX
files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol
reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines
and generated machine code and COFF files for
debugging.
The MPASM Assembler features include:
• Integration into MPLAB IDE projects
• Support for the entire dsPIC30F instruction set
• Support for fixed-point and floating-point data
• Command line interface
• User-defined macros to streamline
assembly code
• Rich directive set
• Conditional assembly for multi-purpose
source files
• Flexible macro language
• MPLAB IDE compatibility
• Directives that allow complete control over the
assembly process
20.6 MPLAB SIM Software Simulator
20.3 MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30
C Compilers
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator allows code
development in a PC-hosted environment by simulat-
ing the PICmicro MCUs and dsPIC® DSCs on an
instruction level. On any given instruction, the data
areas can be examined or modified and stimuli can be
applied from a comprehensive stimulus controller.
Registers can be logged to files for further run-time
analysis. The trace buffer and logic analyzer display
extend the power of the simulator to record and track
program execution, actions on I/O, as well as internal
registers.
The MPLAB C18 and MPLAB C30 Code Development
Systems are complete ANSI
C
compilers for
Microchip’s PIC18 family of microcontrollers and
dsPIC30F family of digital signal controllers. These
compilers provide powerful integration capabilities,
superior code optimization and ease of use not found
with other compilers.
For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide
symbol information that is optimized to the MPLAB IDE
debugger.
The MPLAB SIM Software Simulator fully supports
symbolic debugging using the MPLAB C18 and
MPLAB C30 C Compilers, and the MPASM and
MPLAB ASM30 Assemblers. The software simulator
offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside
of the laboratory environment, making it an excellent,
economical software development tool.
20.4 MPLINK Object Linker/
MPLIB Object Librarian
The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable
objects created by the MPASM Assembler and the
MPLAB C18 C Compiler. It can link relocatable objects
from precompiled libraries, using directives from a
linker script.
The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and
modification of library files of precompiled code. When
a routine from a library is called from a source file, only
the modules that contain that routine will be linked in
with the application. This allows large libraries to be
used efficiently in many different applications.
The object linker/library features include:
• Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many
smaller files
• Enhanced code maintainability by grouping
related modules together
• Flexible creation of libraries with easy module
listing, replacement, deletion and extraction
DS39758B-page 204
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
20.7 MPLAB ICE 2000
High-Performance
20.9 MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger
Microchip’s In-Circuit Debugger, MPLAB ICD 2, is a
powerful, low-cost, run-time development tool,
connecting to the host PC via an RS-232 or high-speed
USB interface. This tool is based on the Flash PICmicro
MCUs and can be used to develop for these and other
PICmicro MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. The MPLAB ICD 2
utilizes the in-circuit debugging capability built into
the Flash devices. This feature, along with Microchip’s
In-Circuit Serial ProgrammingTM (ICSPTM) protocol,
offers cost-effective, in-circuit Flash debugging from the
graphical user interface of the MPLAB Integrated
Development Environment. This enables a designer to
develop and debug source code by setting breakpoints,
single stepping and watching variables, and CPU
status and peripheral registers. Running at full speed
enables testing hardware and applications in real
time. MPLAB ICD 2 also serves as a development
programmer for selected PICmicro devices.
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended
to provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for PICmicro
microcontrollers. Software control of the MPLAB ICE
2000 In-Circuit Emulator is advanced by the MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment, which allows
editing, building, downloading and source debugging
from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 is a full-featured emulator
system with enhanced trace, trigger and data monitor-
ing features. Interchangeable processor modules allow
the system to be easily reconfigured for emulation of
different processors. The architecture of the MPLAB
ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator allows expansion to
support new PICmicro microcontrollers.
The MPLAB ICE 2000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft® Windows® 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
20.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer
The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal,
CE compliant device programmer with programmable
voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for
maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display
(128 x 64) for menus and error messages and a modu-
lar, detachable socket assembly to support various
package types. The ICSP™ cable assembly is included
as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB
PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program
PICmicro devices without a PC connection. It can also
set code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3
connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable.
The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and
optimized algorithms for quick programming of large
memory devices and incorporates an SD/MMC card for
file storage and secure data applications.
20.8 MPLAB ICE 4000
High-Performance
In-Circuit Emulator
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is intended to
provide the product development engineer with a
complete microcontroller design tool set for high-end
PICmicro MCUs and dsPIC DSCs. Software control of
the MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator is provided by
the MPLAB Integrated Development Environment,
which allows editing, building, downloading and source
debugging from a single environment.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 is a premium emulator system,
providing the features of MPLAB ICE 2000, but with
increased emulation memory and high-speed perfor-
mance for dsPIC30F and PIC18XXXX devices. Its
advanced emulator features include complex triggering
and timing, and up to 2 Mb of emulation memory.
The MPLAB ICE 4000 In-Circuit Emulator system has
been designed as a real-time emulation system with
advanced features that are typically found on more
expensive development tools. The PC platform and
Microsoft Windows 32-bit operating system were
chosen to best make these features available in a
simple, unified application.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 205
PIC18F1230/1330
20.11 PICSTART Plus Development
Programmer
20.12 Demonstration, Development and
Evaluation Boards
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is an
easy-to-use, low-cost, prototype programmer. It
connects to the PC via a COM (RS-232) port. MPLAB
Integrated Development Environment software makes
using the programmer simple and efficient. The
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer supports
most PICmicro devices in DIP packages up to 40 pins.
Larger pin count devices, such as the PIC16C92X and
PIC17C76X, may be supported with an adapter socket.
The PICSTART Plus Development Programmer is CE
compliant.
A wide variety of demonstration, development and
evaluation boards for various PICmicro MCUs and dsPIC
DSCs allows quick application development on fully func-
tional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for
adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware
and source code for examination and modification.
The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs,
temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232
interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional
EEPROM memory.
The demonstration and development boards can be
used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom
circuits and for learning about various microcontroller
applications.
In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demon-
stration/development board series of circuits, Microchip
has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software
®
for analog filter design, KEELOQ security ICs, CAN,
IrDA®, PowerSmart® battery management, SEEVAL®
evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate
sensing, plus many more.
Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com)
and the latest “Product Selector Guide” (DS00148) for
the complete list of demonstration, development and
evaluation kits.
DS39758B-page 206
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
The literal instructions may use some of the following
operands:
21.0 INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY
PIC18F1230/1330 devices incorporate the standard set
of 75 PIC18 core instructions, as well as an extended set
of 8 new instructions for the optimization of code that is
recursive or that utilizes a software stack. The extended
set is discussed later in this section.
• A literal value to be loaded into a file register
(specified by ‘k’)
• The desired FSR register to load the literal value
into (specified by ‘f’)
• No operand required
(specified by ‘—’)
21.1 Standard Instruction Set
The control instructions may use some of the following
operands:
The standard PIC18 instruction set adds many
enhancements to the previous PICmicro® MCU instruc-
tion sets, while maintaining an easy migration from
these PICmicro MCU instruction sets. Most instructions
are a single program memory word (16 bits), but there
are four instructions that require two program memory
locations.
• A program memory address (specified by ‘n’)
• The mode of the CALLor RETURNinstructions
(specified by ‘s’)
• The mode of the table read and table write
instructions (specified by ‘m’)
Each single-word instruction is a 16-bit word divided
into an opcode, which specifies the instruction type and
one or more operands, which further specify the
operation of the instruction.
• No operand required
(specified by ‘—’)
All instructions are a single word, except for four
double-word instructions. These instructions were
made double-word to contain the required information
in 32 bits. In the second word, the 4 MSbs are ‘1’s. If
this second word is executed as an instruction (by
itself), it will execute as a NOP.
The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped
into four basic categories:
• Byte-oriented operations
• Bit-oriented operations
• Literal operations
All single-word instructions are executed in a single
instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the
program counter is changed as a result of the
instruction. In these cases, the execution takes two
instruction cycles, with the additional instruction
cycle(s) executed as a NOP.
• Control operations
The PIC18 instruction set summary in Table 21-2 lists
byte-oriented, bit-oriented, literal and control
operations. Table 21-1 shows the opcode field
descriptions.
The double-word instructions execute in two instruction
cycles.
Most byte-oriented instructions have three operands:
1. The file register (specified by ‘f’)
One instruction cycle consists of four oscillator periods.
Thus, for an oscillator frequency of 4 MHz, the normal
instruction execution time is 1 μs. If a conditional test is
true, or the program counter is changed as a result of
an instruction, the instruction execution time is 2 μs.
Two-word branch instructions (if true) would take 3 μs.
2. The destination of the result (specified by ‘d’)
3. The accessed memory (specified by ‘a’)
The file register designator ‘f’ specifies which file
register is to be used by the instruction. The destination
designator ‘d’ specifies where the result of the
operation is to be placed. If ‘d’ is zero, the result is
placed in the WREG register. If ‘d’ is one, the result is
placed in the file register specified in the instruction.
Figure 21-1 shows the general formats that the
instructions can have. All examples use the convention
‘nnh’ to represent a hexadecimal number.
The Instruction Set Summary, shown in Table 21-2,
lists the standard instructions recognized by the
Microchip MPASM™ Assembler.
All bit-oriented instructions have three operands:
1. The file register (specified by ‘f’)
2. The bit in the file register (specified by ‘b’)
3. The accessed memory (specified by ‘a’)
Section 21.1.1 “Standard Instruction Set” provides
a description of each instruction.
The bit field designator ‘b’ selects the number of the bit
affected by the operation, while the file register
designator ‘f’ represents the number of the file in which
the bit is located.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 207
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 21-1: OPCODE FIELD DESCRIPTIONS
Field
Description
a
RAM access bit
a = 0: RAM location in Access RAM (BSR register is ignored)
a = 1: RAM bank is specified by BSR register
bbb
Bit address within an 8-bit file register (0 to 7).
BSR
Bank Select Register. Used to select the current RAM bank.
ALU Status bits: Carry, Digit Carry, Zero, Overflow, Negative.
C, DC, Z, OV, N
d
Destination select bit
d = 0: store result in WREG
d = 1: store result in file register f
dest
f
Destination: either the WREG register or the specified register file location.
8-bit Register file address (00h to FFh) or 2-bit FSR designator (0h to 3h).
12-bit Register file address (000h to FFFh). This is the source address.
12-bit Register file address (000h to FFFh). This is the destination address.
Global Interrupt Enable bit.
f
s
f
d
GIE
k
Literal field, constant data or label (may be either an 8-bit, 12-bit or a 20-bit value).
Label name.
label
mm
The mode of the TBLPTR register for the table read and table write instructions.
Only used with table read and table write instructions:
*
No change to register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes)
Post-Increment register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes)
Post-Decrement register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes)
Pre-Increment register (such as TBLPTR with table reads and writes)
*+
*-
+*
n
The relative address (2’s complement number) for relative branch instructions or the direct address for
Call/Branch and Return instructions.
PC
Program Counter.
PCL
Program Counter Low Byte.
Program Counter High Byte.
Program Counter High Byte Latch.
Program Counter Upper Byte Latch.
Power-Down bit.
PCH
PCLATH
PCLATU
PD
PRODH
PRODL
s
Product of Multiply High Byte.
Product of Multiply Low Byte.
Fast Call/Return mode select bit
s = 0: do not update into/from shadow registers
s = 1: certain registers loaded into/from shadow registers (Fast mode)
TBLPTR
TABLAT
TO
21-bit Table Pointer (points to a program memory location).
8-bit Table Latch.
Time-out bit.
TOS
u
Top-of-Stack.
Unused or unchanged.
Watchdog Timer.
WDT
WREG
x
Working register (accumulator).
Don’t care (‘0’ or ‘1’). The assembler will generate code with x = 0. It is the recommended form of use for
compatibility with all Microchip software tools.
z
7-bit offset value for indirect addressing of register files (source).
7-bit offset value for indirect addressing of register files (destination).
Optional argument.
s
z
d
{
}
[text]
(text)
[expr]<n>
→
Indicates an indexed address.
The contents of text.
Specifies bit nof the register indicated by the pointer expr.
Assigned to.
< >
Register bit field.
∈
In the set of.
italics
User-defined term (font is Courier New).
DS39758B-page 208
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 21-1:
GENERAL FORMAT FOR INSTRUCTIONS
Byte-oriented file register operations
Example Instruction
15
10
OPCODE
9
8
7
0
ADDWF MYREG, W, B
d
a
f (FILE #)
d = 0for result destination to be WREG register
d = 1for result destination to be file register (f)
a = 0to force Access Bank
a = 1for BSR to select bank
f = 8-bit file register address
Byte to Byte move operations (2-word)
15
12 11
0
0
MOVFF MYREG1, MYREG2
OPCODE
f (Source FILE #)
15
12 11
1111
f (Destination FILE #)
f = 12-bit file register address
Bit-oriented file register operations
15 12 11 9 8
OPCODE b (BIT #)
7
0
BSF MYREG, bit, B
a
f (FILE #)
b = 3-bit position of bit in file register (f)
a = 0to force Access Bank
a = 1for BSR to select bank
f = 8-bit file register address
Literal operations
15
8
7
0
MOVLW 7Fh
OPCODE
k (literal)
k = 8-bit immediate value
Control operations
CALL, GOTO and Branch operations
15
8 7
0
GOTO Label
OPCODE
12 11
n<7:0> (literal)
15
0
1111
n<19:8> (literal)
n = 20-bit immediate value
15
15
8
7
0
CALL MYFUNC
OPCODE
12 11
S
n<7:0> (literal)
0
1111
n<19:8> (literal)
S = Fast bit
15
15
11 10
0
0
BRA MYFUNC
BC MYFUNC
OPCODE
n<10:0> (literal)
8 7
OPCODE
n<7:0> (literal)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 209
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 21-2: PIC18FXXXX INSTRUCTION SET
16-Bit Instruction Word
MSb LSb
Mnemonic,
Operands
Status
Affected
Description
Cycles
Notes
BYTE-ORIENTED OPERATIONS
ADDWF f, d, a Add WREG and f
ADDWFC f, d, a Add WREG and Carry bit to f
1
1
1
1
1
0010 01da0 ffff
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
ffff Z, N
1, 2
1, 2
1,2
2
1, 2
4
4
1, 2
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2, 3, 4
1, 2
1, 2, 3, 4
4
1, 2
1, 2
1
0010 0da
0001 01da
0110 101a
0001 11da
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ANDWF
CLRF
COMF
f, d, a AND WREG with f
f, a Clear f
f, d, a Complement f
ffff
Z
ffff Z, N
ffff None
ffff None
ffff None
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
ffff None
ffff None
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
ffff None
ffff None
ffff Z, N
ffff Z, N
ffff None
ffff
ffff None
ffff None
CPFSEQ
CPFSGT
CPFSLT
DECF
f, a
f, a
f, a
Compare f with WREG, skip =
Compare f with WREG, skip >
Compare f with WREG, skip <
1 (2 or 3) 0110 001a
1 (2 or 3) 0110 010a
1 (2 or 3) 0110 000a
f, d, a Decrement f
1
0000 01da
DECFSZ
DCFSNZ
INCF
f, d, a Decrement f, Skip if 0
f, d, a Decrement f, Skip if Not 0
f, d, a Increment f
1 (2 or 3) 0010 11da
1 (2 or 3) 0100 11da
1
1 (2 or 3) 0011 11da
1 (2 or 3) 0100 10da
1
1
2
0010 10da
INCFSZ
INFSNZ
IORWF
MOVF
f, d, a Increment f, Skip if 0
f, d, a Increment f, Skip if Not 0
f, d, a Inclusive OR WREG with f
f, d, a Move f
0001 00da
0101 00da
1100 ffff
1111 ffff
0110 111a
0000 001a
0110 110a
0011 01da
0100 01da
0011 00da
0100 00da
0110 100a
0101 01da
MOVFF
f , f
Move f (source) to 1st word
s
d
s
f (destination) 2nd word
d
MOVWF
MULWF
NEGF
f, a
f, a
f, a
Move WREG to f
Multiply WREG with f
Negate f
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1, 2
1, 2
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
ffff C, Z, N
ffff Z, N
ffff C, Z, N
ffff Z, N
RLCF
RLNCF
RRCF
RRNCF
SETF
f, d, a Rotate Left f through Carry
f, d, a Rotate Left f (No Carry)
f, d, a Rotate Right f through Carry
f, d, a Rotate Right f (No Carry)
f, a
Set f
ffff None
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
1, 2
1, 2
SUBFWB f, d, a Subtract f from WREG with
borrow
SUBWF
f, d, a Subtract WREG from f
1
1
0101 11da
0101 10da
ffff
ffff
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
ffff C, DC, Z, OV, N
SUBWFB f, d, a Subtract WREG from f with
borrow
SWAPF
TSTFSZ
XORWF
f, d, a Swap nibbles in f
f, a Test f, skip if 0
f, d, a Exclusive OR WREG with f
1
0011 10da
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff None
ffff None
ffff Z, N
4
1, 2
1 (2 or 3) 0110 011a
0001 10da
1
Note 1: When a PORT register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1, 0), the value used will be that value
present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an
external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
2: If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, ‘d’ = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned.
3: If the Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
4: Some instructions are two-word instructions. The second word of these instructions will be executed as a NOPunless the
first word of the instruction retrieves the information embedded in these 16 bits. This ensures that all program memory
locations have a valid instruction.
DS39758B-page 210
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 21-2: PIC18FXXXX INSTRUCTION SET (CONTINUED)
16-Bit Instruction Word
Mnemonic,
Operands
Status
Affected
Description
Cycles
Notes
MSb
LSb
BIT-ORIENTED OPERATIONS
BCF
BSF
BTFSC
BTFSS
BTG
f, b, a Bit Clear f
f, b, a Bit Set f
f, b, a Bit Test f, Skip if Clear
f, b, a Bit Test f, Skip if Set
f, d, a Bit Toggle f
1
1
1001 bbba
1000 bbba
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff None
ffff None
ffff None
ffff None
ffff None
1, 2
1, 2
3, 4
3, 4
1, 2
1 (2 or 3) 1011 bbba
1 (2 or 3) 1010 bbba
1
0111 bbba
CONTROL OPERATIONS
BC
BN
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
n
Branch if Carry
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
1 (2)
2
1110 0010
1110 0110
1110 0011
1110 0111
1110 0101
1110 0001
1110 0100
1101 0nnn
1110 0000
1110 110s
1111 kkkk
0000 0000
0000 0000
1110 1111
1111 kkkk
0000 0000
1111 xxxx
0000 0000
0000 0000
1101 1nnn
0000 0000
0000 0000
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
nnnn
kkkk
kkkk
0000
0000
kkkk
kkkk
0000
xxxx
0000
0000
nnnn
1111
0001
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
nnnn None
kkkk None
kkkk
Branch if Negative
Branch if Not Carry
Branch if Not Negative
Branch if Not Overflow
Branch if Not Zero
Branch if Overflow
Branch Unconditionally
Branch if Zero
Call subroutine 1st word
2nd word
Clear Watchdog Timer
Decimal Adjust WREG
Go to address 1st word
2nd word
BNC
BNN
BNOV
BNZ
BOV
BRA
BZ
n
n, s
1 (2)
2
CALL
CLRWDT
DAW
GOTO
—
—
n
1
1
2
0100 TO, PD
0111
C
kkkk None
kkkk
NOP
NOP
POP
PUSH
RCALL
RESET
RETFIE
—
—
—
—
n
No Operation
No Operation
1
1
1
1
2
1
2
0000 None
xxxx None
0110 None
0101 None
nnnn None
1111 All
4
Pop top of return stack (TOS)
Push top of return stack (TOS)
Relative Call
Software device Reset
Return from interrupt enable
s
000s GIE/GIEH,
PEIE/GIEL
RETLW
RETURN
SLEEP
k
s
—
Return with literal in WREG
Return from Subroutine
Go into Standby mode
2
2
1
0000 1100
0000 0000
0000 0000
kkkk
0001
0000
kkkk None
001s None
0011 TO, PD
Note 1: When a PORT register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1, 0), the value used will be that value
present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an
external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
2: If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, ‘d’ = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned.
3: If the Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
4: Some instructions are two-word instructions. The second word of these instructions will be executed as a NOPunless the
first word of the instruction retrieves the information embedded in these 16 bits. This ensures that all program memory
locations have a valid instruction.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 211
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 21-2: PIC18FXXXX INSTRUCTION SET (CONTINUED)
16-Bit Instruction Word
Mnemonic,
Operands
Status
Affected
Description
Cycles
Notes
MSb
LSb
LITERAL OPERATIONS
ADDLW
ANDLW
IORLW
LFSR
k
k
k
f, k
Add literal and WREG
AND literal with WREG
Inclusive OR literal with WREG
Move literal (12-bit) 2nd word
1
1
1
2
0000 1111 kkkk
0000 1011 kkkk
0000 1001 kkkk
1110 1110 00ff
1111 0000 kkkk
0000 0001 0000
0000 1110 kkkk
0000 1101 kkkk
0000 1100 kkkk
0000 1000 kkkk
0000 1010 kkkk
kkkk C, DC, Z, OV, N
kkkk Z, N
kkkk Z, N
kkkk None
kkkk
kkkk None
kkkk None
kkkk None
kkkk None
kkkk C, DC, Z, OV, N
kkkk Z, N
to FSR(f)
1st word
MOVLB
MOVLW
MULLW
RETLW
SUBLW
XORLW
k
k
k
k
k
k
Move literal to BSR<3:0>
Move literal to WREG
Multiply literal with WREG
Return with literal in WREG
Subtract WREG from literal
Exclusive OR literal with WREG
1
1
1
2
1
1
DATA MEMORY ↔ PROGRAM MEMORY OPERATIONS
TBLRD*
Table Read
2
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
0000 0000 0000
1000 None
1001 None
1010 None
1011 None
1100 None
1101 None
1110 None
1111 None
TBLRD*+
TBLRD*-
TBLRD+*
TBLWT*
TBLWT*+
TBLWT*-
TBLWT+*
Table Read with post-increment
Table Read with post-decrement
Table Read with pre-increment
Table Write
Table Write with post-increment
Table Write with post-decrement
Table Write with pre-increment
2
Note 1: When a PORT register is modified as a function of itself (e.g., MOVF PORTB, 1, 0), the value used will be that value
present on the pins themselves. For example, if the data latch is ‘1’ for a pin configured as input and is driven low by an
external device, the data will be written back with a ‘0’.
2: If this instruction is executed on the TMR0 register (and where applicable, ‘d’ = 1), the prescaler will be cleared if
assigned.
3: If the Program Counter (PC) is modified or a conditional test is true, the instruction requires two cycles. The second
cycle is executed as a NOP.
4: Some instructions are two-word instructions. The second word of these instructions will be executed as a NOPunless the
first word of the instruction retrieves the information embedded in these 16 bits. This ensures that all program memory
locations have a valid instruction.
DS39758B-page 212
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
21.1.1
STANDARD INSTRUCTION SET
ADDLW
ADD Literal to W
ADDWF
ADD W to f
Syntax:
ADDLW
k
Syntax:
ADDWF
f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
(W) + k → W
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Operation:
(W) + (f) → dest
0000
1111
kkkk
kkkk
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
The contents of W are added to the
8-bit literal ‘k’ and the result is placed in
W.
0010
01da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Add W to register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’
(default).
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
ADDLW
15h
Before Instruction
10h
After Instruction
25h
W
=
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
W
=
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
ADDWF
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
W
=
17h
REG
=
0C2h
After Instruction
W
REG
=
=
0D9h
0C2h
Note:
All PIC18 instructions may take an optional label argument preceding the instruction mnemonic for use in
symbolic addressing. If a label is used, the instruction format then becomes: {label} instruction argument(s).
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 213
PIC18F1230/1330
ADDWFC
ADD W and Carry bit to f
ANDLW
AND Literal with W
Syntax:
ADDWFC
f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
ANDLW
k
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
(W) .AND. k → W
N, Z
Operation:
(W) + (f) + (C) → dest
0000
1011
kkkk
kkkk
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N,OV, C, DC, Z
The contents of W are ANDed with the
8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in W.
0010
00da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Add W, the Carry flag and data memory
location ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in data memory location ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
ANDLW
05Fh
Before Instruction
W
=
A3h
03h
After Instruction
W
=
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
ADDWFC
REG, 0, 1
Before Instruction
Carry bit
REG
W
=
=
=
1
02h
4Dh
After Instruction
Carry bit
REG
W
=
=
=
0
02h
50h
DS39758B-page 214
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
ANDWF
AND W with f
BC
Branch if Carry
Syntax:
ANDWF
f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
BC
n
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
if Carry bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
(W) .AND. (f) → dest
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
1110
0010
nnnn
nnnn
0001
01da
ffff
ffff
Description:
If the Carry bit is ‘1’, then the program
will branch.
Description:
The contents of W are ANDed with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Example:
ANDWF
REG, 0, 0
Example:
HERE
BC
5
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
W
REG
=
=
17h
C2h
PC
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
After Instruction
If Carry
PC
If Carry
PC
=
=
=
=
1;
address (HERE + 12)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
W
REG
=
=
02h
C2h
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 215
PIC18F1230/1330
BCF
Bit Clear f
BN
Branch if Negative
Syntax:
BCF f, b {,a}
Syntax:
BN
n
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
if Negative bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
0 → f<b>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1110
0110
nnnn
nnnn
1001
bbba
ffff
ffff
Description:
If the Negative bit is ‘1’, then the
Description:
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is cleared.
program will branch.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
operation
operation
operation
operation
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Example:
BCF
FLAG_REG, 7, 0
C7h
47h
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG
After Instruction
FLAG_REG
=
=
Example:
HERE
BN Jump
Before Instruction
PC
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
If Negative
PC
If Negative
PC
=
=
=
=
1;
address (Jump)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
DS39758B-page 216
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
BNC
Branch if Not Carry
BNN
Branch if Not Negative
Syntax:
BNC
n
Syntax:
BNN
n
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
if Carry bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
if Negative bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1110
0011
nnnn
nnnn
1110
0111
nnnn
nnnn
Description:
If the Carry bit is ‘0’, then the program
will branch.
Description:
If the Negative bit is ‘0’, then the
program will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
Cycles:
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
If No Jump:
Q1
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Example:
HERE
BNC Jump
Example:
HERE
BNN Jump
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
PC
=
address (HERE)
PC
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
After Instruction
If Carry
PC
If Carry
PC
=
=
=
=
0;
If Negative
PC
If Negative
PC
=
=
=
=
0;
address (Jump)
address (Jump)
1;
1;
address (HERE + 2)
address (HERE + 2)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 217
PIC18F1230/1330
BNOV
Branch if Not Overflow
BNZ
Branch if Not Zero
Syntax:
BNOV
n
Syntax:
BNZ
n
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
if Overflow bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
if Zero bit is ‘0’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1110
0101
nnnn
nnnn
1110
0001
nnnn
nnnn
Description:
If the Overflow bit is ‘0’, then the
program will branch.
Description:
If the Zero bit is ‘0’, then the program
will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
Cycles:
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
If No Jump:
Q1
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Example:
HERE
BNOV Jump
Example:
HERE
BNZ Jump
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
PC
=
address (HERE)
PC
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
After Instruction
If Overflow
PC
If Overflow
PC
=
=
=
=
0;
If Zero
PC
If Zero
PC
=
=
=
=
0;
address (Jump)
address (Jump)
1;
1;
address (HERE + 2)
address (HERE + 2)
DS39758B-page 218
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
BRA
Unconditional Branch
BSF
Bit Set f
Syntax:
BRA
n
Syntax:
BSF f, b {,a}
Operands:
Operation:
-1024 ≤ n ≤ 1023
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
a ∈ [0,1]
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Status Affected: None
Operation:
1 → f<b>
Encoding:
1101
0nnn
nnnn
nnnn
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1000
Bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is set.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Description:
Add the 2’s complement number ‘2n’ to
the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next instruction,
the new address will be PC + 2 + 2n. This
instruction is a two-cycle instruction.
bbba
ffff
ffff
Description:
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Example:
HERE
BRA Jump
Q2
Q3
Q4
Before Instruction
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
PC
=
=
address (HERE)
address (Jump)
After Instruction
PC
Example:
BSF
FLAG_REG, 7, 1
0Ah
8Ah
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG
After Instruction
FLAG_REG
=
=
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 219
PIC18F1230/1330
BTFSC
Bit Test File, Skip if Clear
BTFSS
Bit Test File, Skip if Set
Syntax:
BTFSC f, b {,a}
Syntax:
BTFSS f, b {,a}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0 ≤ b < 7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 0
Operation:
skip if (f<b>) = 1
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1011
bbba
ffff
ffff
1010
bbba
ffff
ffff
Description:
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘0’, then the next
instruction is skipped. If bit ‘b’ is ‘0’, then
the next instruction fetched during the
current instruction execution is discarded
and a NOPis executed instead, making
this a two-cycle instruction.
Description:
If bit ‘b’ in register ‘f’ is ‘1’, then the next
instruction is skipped. If bit ‘b’ is ‘1’, then
the next instruction fetched during the
current instruction execution is discarded
and a NOPis executed instead, making
this a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected. If
‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected. If
‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates in
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh).
See Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh).
See Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
If skip:
Q1
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
Example:
HERE
FALSE
TRUE
BTFSC
:
:
FLAG, 1, 0
Example:
HERE
FALSE
TRUE
BTFSS
:
:
FLAG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
PC
Before Instruction
PC
=
address (HERE)
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
After Instruction
If FLAG<1>
PC
If FLAG<1>
PC
=
=
=
=
0;
If FLAG<1>
PC
If FLAG<1>
PC
=
=
=
=
0;
address (TRUE)
1;
address (FALSE)
1;
address (FALSE)
address (TRUE)
DS39758B-page 220
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
BTG
Bit Toggle f
BOV
Branch if Overflow
Syntax:
BTG f, b {,a}
Syntax:
BOV
n
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
0 ≤ b < 7
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
if Overflow bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
(f<b>) → f<b>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1110
0100
nnnn
nnnn
0111
bbba
ffff
ffff
Description:
If the Overflow bit is ‘1’, then the
Description:
Bit ‘b’ in data memory location ‘f’ is
inverted.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
program will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will have
incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Example:
BTG
PORTC, 4, 0
Before Instruction:
PORTC
After Instruction:
PORTC
=
0111 0101 [75h]
0110 0101 [65h]
Example:
HERE
BOV Jump
Before Instruction
=
PC
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
If Overflow
PC
If Overflow
PC
=
=
=
=
1;
address (Jump)
0;
address (HERE + 2)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 221
PIC18F1230/1330
BZ
Branch if Zero
CALL
Subroutine Call
Syntax:
BZ
n
Syntax:
CALL k {,s}
Operands:
Operation:
-128 ≤ n ≤ 127
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 1048575
s ∈ [0,1]
if Zero bit is ‘1’
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Operation:
(PC) + 4 → TOS,
k → PC<20:1>
if s = 1
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1110
0000
nnnn
nnnn
(W) → WS,
(STATUS) → STATUSS,
(BSR) → BSRS
Description:
If the Zero bit is ‘1’, then the program
will branch.
The 2’s complement number ‘2n’ is
added to the PC. Since the PC will
have incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is then a
two-cycle instruction.
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1st word (k<7:0>)
2nd word(k<19:8>)
1110
1111
110s
k kkk
kkkk
kkkk
7
0
8
k
kkk kkkk
19
Description:
Subroutine call of entire 2-Mbyte
memory range. First, return address
(PC + 4) is pushed onto the return
stack. If ‘s’ = 1, the W, STATUS and
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
BSR registers are also pushed into their
respective shadow registers, WS,
STATUSS and BSRS. If ‘s’ = 0, no
update occurs (default). Then, the
20-bit value ‘k’ is loaded into PC<20:1>.
CALLis a two-cycle instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
If Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Words:
Cycles:
2
2
If No Jump:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
No
operation
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal PUSH PC to Read literal
‘k’<7:0>,
stack
‘k’<19:8>,
Write to PC
Example:
HERE
BZ Jump
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Before Instruction
PC
=
address (HERE)
After Instruction
If Zero
PC
If Zero
PC
=
=
=
=
1;
Example:
HERE
CALL THERE, 1
address (Jump)
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
0;
address (HERE + 2)
=
address (HERE)
PC
=
address (THERE)
TOS
WS
=
=
=
address (HERE + 4)
W
BSRS
STATUSS =
BSR
STATUS
DS39758B-page 222
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
CLRF
Clear f
CLRWDT
Clear Watchdog Timer
Syntax:
CLRF f {,a}
Syntax:
CLRWDT
None
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
000h → WDT,
000h → WDT postscaler,
1 → TO,
Operation:
000h → f,
1 → Z
1 → PD
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
TO, PD
0110
101a
ffff
ffff
0000
0000
0000
0100
Description:
Clears the contents of the specified
register.
Description:
CLRWDTinstruction resets the
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
Watchdog Timer. It also resets the
postscaler of the WDT. Status bits, TO
and PD, are set.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
Process
Data
No
operation
operation
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Example:
CLRWDT
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Before Instruction
Q2
Q3
Q4
WDT Counter
After Instruction
WDT Counter
WDT Postscaler
TO
=
?
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
=
=
=
=
00h
0
1
Example:
CLRF
FLAG_REG, 1
PD
1
Before Instruction
FLAG_REG
After Instruction
FLAG_REG
=
=
5Ah
00h
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 223
PIC18F1230/1330
CPFSEQ
Compare f with W, Skip if f = W
COMF
Complement f
Syntax:
CPFSEQ f {,a}
Syntax:
COMF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W),
skip if (f) = (W)
(unsigned comparison)
Operation:
(f) → dest
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0001
11da
ffff
ffff
0110
001a
ffff
ffff
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
Description:
Compares the contents of data memory
location ‘f’ to the contents of W by
performing an unsigned subtraction.
If ‘f’ = W, then the fetched instruction is
discarded and a NOPis executed
instead, making this a two-cycle
instruction.
complemented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Words:
Cycles:
1
Q2
Q3
Q4
1(2)
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Example:
COMF
REG, 0, 0
Q2
Q3
Q4
Before Instruction
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
REG
=
13h
After Instruction
If skip:
REG
W
=
=
13h
ECh
Q1
No
Q2
No
Q3
No
Q4
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
No
Q2
No
Q3
No
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
Example:
HERE
CPFSEQ REG, 0
NEQUAL
EQUAL
:
:
Before Instruction
PC Address
=
HERE
W
REG
=
=
?
?
After Instruction
If REG
PC
=
=
W;
Address (EQUAL)
If REG
PC
≠
=
W;
Address (NEQUAL)
DS39758B-page 224
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
CPFSGT
Compare f with W, Skip if f > W
CPFSLT
Compare f with W, Skip if f < W
Syntax:
CPFSGT f {,a}
Syntax:
CPFSLT f {,a}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W),
skip if (f) > (W)
(unsigned comparison)
Operation:
(f) – (W),
skip if (f) < (W)
(unsigned comparison)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0110
0110
010a
ffff
ffff
000a
ffff
ffff
Description:
Compares the contents of data memory
location ‘f’ to the contents of the W by
performing an unsigned subtraction.
If the contents of ‘f’ are greater than the
contents of WREG, then the fetched
instruction is discarded and a NOPis
executed instead, making this a
Description:
Compares the contents of data memory
location ‘f’ to the contents of W by
performing an unsigned subtraction.
If the contents of ‘f’ are less than the
contents of W, then the fetched
instruction is discarded and a NOPis
executed instead, making this a
two-cycle instruction.
two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Words:
Cycles:
1
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Q2
Read
register ‘f’
Q3
Process
Data
Q4
No
operation
Decode
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
No
Q2
No
Q3
No
Q4
No
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
operation
operation
operation
operation
Q1
No
operation
No
operation
Q2
No
operation
No
operation
Q3
No
operation
No
operation
Q4
No
operation
No
operation
Example:
HERE
NLESS
LESS
CPFSLT REG, 1
:
:
Before Instruction
PC
W
=
=
Address (HERE)
Example:
HERE
NGREATER
GREATER
CPFSGT REG, 0
:
:
?
After Instruction
If REG
PC
If REG
PC
<
=
≥
=
W;
Before Instruction
Address (LESS)
W;
Address (NLESS)
PC
W
=
=
Address (HERE)
?
After Instruction
If REG
PC
>
=
W;
Address (GREATER)
If REG
PC
≤
=
W;
Address (NGREATER)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 225
PIC18F1230/1330
DAW
Decimal Adjust W Register
DECF
Decrement f
Syntax:
DAW
None
Syntax:
DECF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
If [W<3:0> > 9] or [DC = 1] then
(W<3:0>) + 6 → W<3:0>;
else
Operation:
(f) – 1 → dest
(W<3:0>) → W<3:0>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
C, DC, N, OV, Z
0000
01da
ffff
ffff
If [W<7:4> + DC > 9] or [C = 1] then
(W<7:4>) + 6 + DC → W<7:4> ;
else
Description:
Decrement register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’
(default).
(W<7:4>) + DC → W<7:4>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
C
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
0000
0000
0000
0111
Description:
DAW adjusts the eight-bit value in W
resulting from the earlier addition of two
variables (each in packed BCD format)
and produces a correct packed BCD
result.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register W
Process
Data
Write
W
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Example 1:
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
DAW
Before Instruction
W
C
DC
=
=
=
A5h
0
0
Example:
DECF
CNT,
1, 0
Before Instruction
After Instruction
CNT
Z
After Instruction
=
01h
0
=
W
=
05h
1
0
C
DC
=
=
CNT
Z
=
=
00h
1
Example 2:
Before Instruction
W
=
CEh
C
DC
=
=
0
0
After Instruction
W
=
34h
C
DC
=
=
1
0
DS39758B-page 226
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
DECFSZ
Decrement f, Skip if 0
DCFSNZ
Decrement f, Skip if Not 0
Syntax:
DECFSZ f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
DCFSNZ f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – 1 → dest,
Operation:
(f) – 1 → dest,
skip if result = 0
skip if result ≠ 0
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0100
The contents of register ‘f’ are
0010
11da
ffff
ffff
11da
ffff
ffff
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
Description:
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is ‘0’, the next instruction,
which is already fetched, is discarded
and a NOPis executed instead, making
it a two-cycle instruction.
decremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is not ‘0’, the next
instruction, which is already fetched, is
discarded and a NOPis executed
instead, making it a two-cycle
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read
Process
Data
Write to
destination
register ‘f’
If skip:
Q1
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
Example:
HERE
DECFSZ
GOTO
CNT, 1, 1
LOOP
Example:
HERE
ZERO
NZERO
DCFSNZ TEMP, 1, 0
:
:
CONTINUE
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
Before Instruction
TEMP
After Instruction
=
Address (HERE)
=
?
CNT
=
CNT – 1
0;
If CNT
=
=
≠
=
TEMP
If TEMP
PC
If TEMP
PC
=
=
=
≠
=
TEMP – 1
0;
PC
Address (CONTINUE)
0;
If CNT
PC
Address (ZERO)
0;
Address (HERE + 2)
Address (NZERO)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 227
PIC18F1230/1330
GOTO
Unconditional Branch
INCF
Increment f
Syntax:
GOTO
k
Syntax:
INCF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
0 ≤ k ≤ 1048575
k → PC<20:1>
None
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 → dest
Encoding:
1st word (k<7:0>)
2nd word(k<19:8>)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
C, DC, N, OV, Z
1110
1111
1111
kkk
k kkk
kkkk
kkkk
kkkk
7
0
8
k
0010
10da
ffff
ffff
19
Description:
GOTOallows an unconditional branch
anywhere within entire
2-Mbyte memory range. The 20-bit
value ‘k’ is loaded into PC<20:1>.
GOTOis always a two-cycle
instruction.
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
2
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘k’<7:0>,
No
operation
Read literal
‘k’<19:8>,
Write to PC
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
No
operation
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Example:
GOTO THERE
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
After Instruction
PC
=
Address (THERE)
Example:
INCF
CNT, 1, 0
Before Instruction
CNT
Z
=
FFh
0
=
=
=
C
?
DC
?
After Instruction
CNT
Z
=
00h
1
=
=
=
C
1
DC
1
DS39758B-page 228
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
INFSNZ
Increment f, Skip if Not 0
INCFSZ
Increment f, Skip if 0
Syntax:
INFSNZ f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
INCFSZ f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) + 1 → dest,
skip if result ≠ 0
Operation:
(f) + 1 → dest,
skip if result = 0
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0100
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is not ‘0’, the next
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
10da
ffff
ffff
0011
11da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are
incremented. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If the result is ‘0’, the next instruction,
which is already fetched, is discarded
and a NOPis executed instead, making
it a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
instruction, which is already fetched, is
discarded and a NOPis executed
instead, making it a two-cycle
instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1(2)
1(2)
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
If skip:
Q1
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
operation
Example:
HERE
NZERO
ZERO
INCFSZ
:
:
CNT, 1, 0
Example:
HERE
ZERO
NZERO
INFSNZ REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
=
Address (HERE)
=
Address (HERE)
REG
If REG
PC
If REG
PC
=
REG + 1
CNT
If CNT
PC
If CNT
PC
=
CNT + 1
≠
=
=
=
0;
=
=
≠
=
0;
Address (ZERO)
0;
Address (NZERO)
Address (NZERO)
0;
Address (ZERO)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 229
PIC18F1230/1330
IORLW
Inclusive OR Literal with W
IORWF
Inclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
IORLW
k
Syntax:
IORWF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
(W) .OR. k → W
N, Z
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .OR. (f) → dest
0000
1001
kkkk
kkkk
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
The contents of W are ORed with the
eight-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed in
W.
0001
00da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Inclusive OR W with register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is
‘0’, the result is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’,
the result is placed back in register ‘f’
(default).
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
IORLW
35h
Before Instruction
W
=
9Ah
BFh
After Instruction
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
W
=
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
IORWF RESULT, 0, 1
Before Instruction
RESULT =
13h
91h
W
=
After Instruction
RESULT =
13h
93h
W
=
DS39758B-page 230
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
LFSR
Load FSR
MOVF
Move f
Syntax:
LFSR f, k
Syntax:
MOVF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 2
0 ≤ k ≤ 4095
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
k → FSRf
Operation:
f → dest
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
0101
1110
1111
1110
0000
00ff
k kkk
11
kkkk
k kkk
00da
ffff
ffff
7
Description:
The 12-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into the
File Select Register pointed to by ‘f’.
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are moved to
a destination dependent upon the
status of ‘d’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is
placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
Location ‘f’ can be anywhere in the
256-byte bank.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
2
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read literal
‘k’ MSB
Process
Data
Write
literal ‘k’
MSB to
FSRfH
Decode
Read literal
‘k’ LSB
Process
Data
Write literal
‘k’ to FSRfL
Example:
LFSR 2, 3ABh
After Instruction
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
FSR2H
FSR2L
=
=
03h
ABh
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write W
Example:
MOVF
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
22h
FFh
After Instruction
REG
W
=
=
22h
22h
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 231
PIC18F1230/1330
MOVFF
Move f to f
MOVLB
Move Literal to Low Nibble in BSR
Syntax:
MOVFF f ,f
Syntax:
MOVLW k
s
d
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 4095
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
k → BSR
None
s
0 ≤ f ≤ 4095
d
Operation:
(f ) → f
s
d
Status Affected:
None
0000
0001
kkkk
kkkk
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (destin.)
The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into the
Bank Select Register (BSR). The value of
BSR<7:4> always remains ‘0’, regardless
1100
1111
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffff
ffffs
ffffd
Description:
The contents of source register ‘f ’ are
of the value of k :k .
s
7 4
moved to destination register ‘f ’.
d
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Location of source ‘f ’ can be anywhere
s
in the 4096-byte data space (000h to
FFFh) and location of destination ‘f ’
can also be anywhere from 000h to
FFFh.
Either source or destination can be W
(a useful special situation).
d
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write literal
‘k’ to BSR
MOVFFis particularly useful for
transferring a data memory location to a
peripheral register (such as the transmit
buffer or an I/O port).
The MOVFFinstruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
Example:
MOVLB
5
Before Instruction
BSR Register =
After Instruction
BSR Register =
02h
05h
Words:
Cycles:
2
2 (3)
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
(src)
Process
Data
No
operation
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
Write
register ‘f’
(dest)
No dummy
read
Example:
MOVFF
REG1, REG2
Before Instruction
REG1
REG2
=
=
33h
11h
After Instruction
REG1
REG2
=
=
33h
33h
DS39758B-page 232
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
MOVLW
Move Literal to W
MOVWF
Move W to f
Syntax:
MOVLW
k
Syntax:
MOVWF f {,a}
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
Words:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
k → W
None
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) → f
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0110
Move data from W to register ‘f’.
Location ‘f’ can be anywhere in the
256-byte bank.
0000
1110
kkkk
kkkk
111a
ffff
ffff
The eight-bit literal ‘k’ is loaded into W.
Description:
1
1
Cycles:
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
MOVLW
5Ah
After Instruction
W
=
5Ah
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
MOVWF
REG, 0
Before Instruction
W
REG
=
=
4Fh
FFh
After Instruction
W
REG
=
=
4Fh
4Fh
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 233
PIC18F1230/1330
MULLW
Multiply Literal with W
MULWF
Multiply W with f
Syntax:
MULLW
k
Syntax:
MULWF f {,a}
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
(W) x k → PRODH:PRODL
Operation:
(W) x (f) → PRODH:PRODL
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0000
1101
kkkk
kkkk
0000
001a
ffff
ffff
An unsigned multiplication is carried
out between the contents of W and the
8-bit literal ‘k’. The 16-bit result is
placed in the PRODH:PRODL register
pair. PRODH contains the high byte.
W is unchanged.
None of the Status flags are affected.
Note that neither Overflow nor Carry is
possible in this operation. A Zero result
is possible but not detected.
Description:
An unsigned multiplication is carried
out between the contents of W and the
register file location ‘f’. The 16-bit
result is stored in the PRODH:PRODL
register pair. PRODH contains the
high byte. Both W and ‘f’ are
unchanged.
None of the Status flags are affected.
Note that neither Overflow nor Carry is
possible in this operation. A Zero
result is possible but not detected.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used
to select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write
registers
PRODH:
PRODL
f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See Section 21.2.3
“Byte-Oriented and Bit-Oriented
Instructions in Indexed Literal Offset
Mode” for details.
Example:
MULLW
0C4h
Before Instruction
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
W
PRODH
PRODL
=
=
=
E2h
?
?
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
After Instruction
W
Q2
Q3
Q4
=
=
=
E2h
ADh
08h
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
PRODH
PRODL
registers
PRODH:
PRODL
Example:
MULWF
REG, 1
Before Instruction
W
=
C4h
REG
PRODH
PRODL
=
=
=
B5h
?
?
After Instruction
W
=
C4h
REG
PRODH
PRODL
=
=
=
B5h
8Ah
94h
DS39758B-page 234
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
NEGF
Negate f
NOP
No Operation
Syntax:
NEGF f {,a}
Syntax:
NOP
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
None
No operation
Operation:
(f) + 1 → f
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0000
1111
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
0000
xxxx
0000
xxxx
0000
xxxx
0110
110a
ffff
ffff
Description:
Location ‘f’ is negated using two’s
complement. The result is placed in the
data memory location ‘f’.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Description:
Words:
No operation.
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
No
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
operation
Example:
None.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Example:
NEGF
REG, 1
Before Instruction
REG
After Instruction
REG
=
0011 1010 [3Ah]
1100 0110 [C6h]
=
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 235
PIC18F1230/1330
POP
Pop Top of Return Stack
PUSH
Push Top of Return Stack
Syntax:
POP
Syntax:
PUSH
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
None
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
None
(TOS) → bit bucket
(PC + 2) → TOS
None
None
0000
0000
0000
0110
0000
0000
0000
0101
The TOS value is pulled off the return
stack and is discarded. The TOS value
then becomes the previous value that
was pushed onto the return stack.
This instruction is provided to enable
the user to properly manage the return
stack to incorporate a software stack.
The PC + 2 is pushed onto the top of
the return stack. The previous TOS
value is pushed down on the stack.
This instruction allows implementing a
software stack by modifying TOS and
then pushing it onto the return stack.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
PUSH
No
No
Decode
No
operation
POP TOS
value
No
operation
PC + 2 onto
return stack
operation
operation
Example:
POP
Example:
PUSH
GOTO
NEW
Before Instruction
Before Instruction
TOS
Stack (1 level down)
TOS
PC
=
=
345Ah
0124h
=
=
0031A2h
014332h
After Instruction
After Instruction
PC
=
=
=
0126h
0126h
345Ah
TOS
TOS
PC
=
=
014332h
NEW
Stack (1 level down)
DS39758B-page 236
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
RCALL
Relative Call
RESET
Reset
Syntax:
RCALL
n
Syntax:
RESET
None
Operands:
Operation:
-1024 ≤ n ≤ 1023
Operands:
Operation:
(PC) + 2 → TOS,
(PC) + 2 + 2n → PC
Reset all registers and flags that are
affected by a MCLR Reset.
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected:
Encoding:
All
0000
1101
1nnn
nnnn
nnnn
0000
1111
1111
Description:
Subroutine call with a jump up to 1K
from the current location. First, return
address (PC + 2) is pushed onto the
stack. Then, add the 2’s complement
number ‘2n’ to the PC. Since the PC will
have incremented to fetch the next
instruction, the new address will be
PC + 2 + 2n. This instruction is a
two-cycle instruction.
Description:
This instruction provides a way to
execute a MCLR Reset in software.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Start
No
No
Reset
operation
operation
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
Example:
RESET
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
After Instruction
Registers =
Q2
Q3
Q4
Reset Value
Reset Value
Flags*
=
Decode
Read literal
‘n’
Process
Data
Write to
PC
PUSH PC
to stack
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
Example:
HERE
RCALL Jump
Before Instruction
PC
After Instruction
PC
TOS =
=
Address (HERE)
=
Address (Jump)
Address (HERE + 2)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 237
PIC18F1230/1330
RETFIE
Return from Interrupt
RETLW
Return Literal to W
Syntax:
RETFIE {s}
Syntax:
RETLW k
Operands:
Operation:
s ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
(TOS) → PC,
k → W,
1 → GIE/GIEH or PEIE/GIEL
if s = 1
(TOS) → PC,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
(WS) → W,
(STATUSS) → STATUS,
(BSRS) → BSR,
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0000
1100
kkkk
kkkk
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
Description:
W is loaded with the eight-bit literal ‘k’.
The program counter is loaded from the
top of the stack (the return address).
The high address latch (PCLATH)
remains unchanged.
Status Affected:
Encoding:
GIE/GIEH, PEIE/GIEL
0000
0000
0001
000s
Description:
Return from interrupt. Stack is popped
and Top-of-Stack (TOS) is loaded into
the PC. Interrupts are enabled by
setting either the high or low priority
global interrupt enable bit. If ‘s’ = 1, the
contents of the shadow registers, WS,
STATUSS and BSRS, are loaded into
their corresponding registers, W,
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
POP PC
from stack,
Write to W
STATUS and BSR. If ‘s’ = 0, no update
of these registers occurs (default).
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Example:
Q2
Q3
Q4
CALL TABLE ; W contains table
; offset value
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
POP PC
from stack
; W now has
; table value
Set GIEH or
GIEL
:
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
TABLE
ADDWF PCL ; W = offset
RETLW k0
RETLW k1
; Begin table
;
Example:
RETFIE
1
:
:
After Interrupt
PC
W
BSR
STATUS
=
=
=
=
=
TOS
WS
RETLW kn
; End of table
BSRS
STATUSS
1
Before Instruction
GIE/GIEH, PEIE/GIEL
W
=
07h
After Instruction
W
=
value of kn
DS39758B-page 238
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
RETURN
Return from Subroutine
RLCF
Rotate Left f through Carry
Syntax:
RETURN {s}
Syntax:
RLCF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
s ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
(TOS) → PC
if s = 1
(WS) → W,
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n + 1>,
(f<7>) → C,
(C) → dest<0>
(STATUSS) → STATUS,
(BSRS) → BSR,
PCLATU, PCLATH are unchanged
Status Affected:
Encoding:
C, N, Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0011
01da
ffff
ffff
0000
0000
0001
001s
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the left through the Carry
flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in
W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to
select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever
Description:
Return from subroutine. The stack is
popped and the top of the stack (TOS)
is loaded into the program counter. If
‘s’= 1, the contents of the shadow
registers, WS, STATUSS and BSRS,
are loaded into their corresponding
registers, W, STATUS and BSR. If
‘s’ = 0, no update of these registers
occurs (default).
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See Section 21.2.3
“Byte-Oriented and Bit-Oriented
Instructions in Indexed Literal Offset
Mode” for details.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
Process
Data
POP PC
from stack
register f
C
No
No
No
No
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
operation
operation
operation
operation
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Example:
RETURN
Q2
Q3
Q4
After Instruction:
PC = TOS
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
RLCF
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
C
=
=
1110 0110
0
After Instruction
REG
=
1110 0110
W
C
=
=
1100 1100
1
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 239
PIC18F1230/1330
RLNCF
Rotate Left f (No Carry)
RRCF
Rotate Right f through Carry
Syntax:
RLNCF f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
RRCF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n + 1>,
(f<7>) → dest<0>
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n – 1>,
(f<0>) → C,
(C) → dest<7>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
C, N, Z
0100
01da
ffff
ffff
0011
00da
ffff
ffff
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the left. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
stored back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the right through the Carry
flag. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is placed in W.
If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is placed back in
register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
register f
register f
C
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
RLNCF
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
After Instruction
Example:
RRCF
REG, 0, 0
=
1010 1011
0101 0111
Before Instruction
REG
=
REG
C
=
=
1110 0110
0
After Instruction
REG
=
1110 0110
W
C
=
=
0111 0011
0
DS39758B-page 240
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
RRNCF
Rotate Right f (No Carry)
SETF
Set f
Syntax:
RRNCF f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
SETF f {,a}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
FFh → f
Operation:
(f<n>) → dest<n – 1>,
(f<0>) → dest<7>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0110
100a
ffff
ffff
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
Description:
The contents of the specified register
are set to FFh.
0100
00da
ffff
ffff
Description:
The contents of register ‘f’ are rotated
one bit to the right. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed back in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank will be
selected, overriding the BSR value. If ‘a’
is ‘1’, then the bank will be selected as
per the BSR value (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
register f
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write
register ‘f’
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Example:
SETF
REG, 1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Before Instruction
REG
After Instruction
REG
=
=
5Ah
FFh
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
RRNCF
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
After Instruction
REG
=
1101 0111
1110 1011
RRNCF REG, 0, 0
=
Example 2:
Before Instruction
W
REG
=
=
?
1101 0111
After Instruction
W
REG
=
=
1110 1011
1101 0111
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 241
PIC18F1230/1330
SLEEP
Enter Sleep mode
SUBFWB
Subtract f from W with Borrow
Syntax:
SLEEP
None
Syntax:
SUBFWB f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
00h → WDT,
0 → WDT postscaler,
1 → TO,
Operation:
(W) – (f) – (C) → dest
0 → PD
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
TO, PD
0101
01da
ffff
ffff
0000
0000
0000
0011
Description:
Subtract register ‘f’ and Carry flag
(borrow) from W (2’s complement
method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored in
register ‘f’ (default).
Description:
The Power-Down status bit (PD) is
cleared. The Time-out status bit (TO)
is set. Watchdog Timer and its
postscaler are cleared.
The processor is put into Sleep mode
with the oscillator stopped.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
Process
Data
Go to
Sleep
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Example:
SLEEP
Before Instruction
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
TO
PD
=
=
?
?
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
After Instruction
TO
PD
=
=
1†
0
Example 1:
SUBFWB
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
†
If WDT causes wake-up, this bit is cleared.
REG
W
=
3
2
1
=
=
C
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
FF
2
=
=
=
=
0
Z
0
1
N
; result is negative
Example 2:
SUBFWB
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
2
5
1
C
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
2
3
1
0
=
=
=
=
Z
N
0
; result is positive
Example 3:
SUBFWB
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
1
2
0
C
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
0
2
1
1
0
=
=
=
=
Z
; result is zero
N
DS39758B-page 242
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
SUBLW
Subtract W from Literal
SUBWF
Subtract W from f
Syntax:
SUBLW
k
Syntax:
SUBWF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
k – (W) → W
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Operation:
(f) – (W) → dest
0000
1000
kkkk
kkkk
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
0101 11da
W is subtracted from the eight-bit
literal ‘k’. The result is placed in W.
ffff
ffff
Description:
Subtract W from register ‘f’ (2’s
complement method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the
result is stored in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the
result is stored back in register ‘f’
(default).
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is
selected. If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used
to select the GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction
operates in Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode whenever
f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See Section 21.2.3
“Byte-Oriented and Bit-Oriented
Instructions in Indexed Literal Offset
Mode” for details.
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example 1:
SUBLW 02h
Before Instruction
W
C
=
=
01h
?
After Instruction
W
C
Z
=
01h
=
=
=
1
0
0
; result is positive
N
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Example 2:
SUBLW 02h
Before Instruction
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
W
C
=
=
02h
?
Q2
Q3
Q4
After Instruction
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
W
C
Z
=
00h
=
=
=
1
1
0
; result is zero
N
Example 1:
SUBWF
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
Example 3:
SUBLW 02h
REG
W
=
3
2
?
Before Instruction
=
=
W
C
=
=
03h
?
C
After Instruction
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
1
2
1
0
0
W
C
Z
=
FFh ; (2’s complement)
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
0
0
1
; result is negative
; result is positive
Z
N
N
Example 2:
SUBWF
REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
2
2
?
C
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
2
0
1
1
0
=
=
=
=
; result is zero
Z
N
Example 3:
SUBWF
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
1
2
?
C
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
FFh ;(2’s complement)
2
0
0
1
=
=
=
=
; result is negative
Z
N
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 243
PIC18F1230/1330
SUBWFB
Subtract W from f with Borrow
SWAPF
Swap f
SUBWFB f {,d {,a}}
Syntax:
Syntax:
SWAPF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(f) – (W) – (C) → dest
Operation:
(f<3:0>) → dest<7:4>,
(f<7:4>) → dest<3:0>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
0101
10da
ffff
ffff
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Description:
Subtract W and the Carry flag (borrow)
from register ‘f’ (2’s complement
method). If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
0011
10da
ffff
ffff
Description:
The upper and lower nibbles of register
‘f’ are exchanged. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result
is placed in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is
placed in register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Write to
destination
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example 1:
SUBWFB REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
19h
0Dh
1
(0001 1001)
(0000 1101)
Example:
SWAPF
REG, 1, 0
C
Before Instruction
After Instruction
REG
=
53h
35h
REG
W
C
=
0Ch
0Dh
1
(0000 1011)
(0000 1101)
After Instruction
=
=
=
=
REG
=
Z
0
N
0
; result is positive
Example 2:
SUBWFB REG, 0, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
1Bh
1Ah
0
(0001 1011)
(0001 1010)
C
After Instruction
REG
W
C
=
1Bh
00h
1
(0001 1011)
=
=
=
=
Z
1
; result is zero
N
0
Example 3:
SUBWFB REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
=
03h
0Eh
1
(0000 0011)
(0000 1101)
C
After Instruction
REG
=
F5h
(1111 0100)
; [2’s comp]
W
C
Z
=
=
=
=
0Eh
0
0
1
(0000 1101)
N
; result is negative
DS39758B-page 244
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TBLRD
Table Read
TBLRD
Table Read (Continued)
Syntax:
TBLRD ( *; *+; *-; +*)
None
Example 1:
TBLRD *+ ;
Operands:
Operation:
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
MEMORY (00A356h)
=
=
=
55h
00A356h
34h
if TBLRD *
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
TBLPTR – No Change;
if TBLRD *+
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLRD *-
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT;
(TBLPTR) – 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLRD +*
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
(Prog Mem (TBLPTR)) → TABLAT
After Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
=
=
34h
00A357h
Example 2:
TBLRD +* ;
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
MEMORY (01A357h)
=
=
=
=
AAh
01A357h
12h
MEMORY (01A358h)
After Instruction
34h
TABLAT
TBLPTR
=
=
34h
01A358h
Status Affected: None
Encoding:
0000
0000
0000
10nn
nn=0 *
=1 *+
=2 *-
=3 +*
Description:
This instruction is used to read the contents
of Program Memory (P.M.). To address the
program memory, a pointer called Table
Pointer (TBLPTR) is used.
The TBLPTR (a 21-bit pointer) points to
each byte in the program memory. TBLPTR
has a 2-Mbyte address range.
TBLPTR[0] = 0: Least Significant Byte of
Program Memory Word
TBLPTR[0] = 1: Most Significant Byte of
Program Memory Word
The TBLRDinstruction can modify the value
of TBLPTR as follows:
•
•
•
•
no change
post-increment
post-decrement
pre-increment
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
No operation
No
No operation
(Write
TABLAT)
operation (Read Program operation
Memory)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 245
PIC18F1230/1330
TBLWT
Table Write
TBLWT
Table Write (Continued)
Syntax:
TBLWT ( *; *+; *-; +*)
None
Example 1:
TBLWT *+;
Operands:
Operation:
Before Instruction
if TBLWT*
TABLAT
TBLPTR
HOLDING REGISTER
(00A356h)
=
=
55h
00A356h
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
TBLPTR – No Change;
if TBLWT*+
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLWT*-
(TABLAT) → Holding Register;
(TBLPTR) – 1 → TBLPTR;
if TBLWT+*
(TBLPTR) + 1 → TBLPTR;
(TABLAT) → Holding Register
=
FFh
After Instructions (table write completion)
TABLAT
TBLPTR
HOLDING REGISTER
(00A356h)
=
=
55h
00A357h
=
55h
Example 2:
TBLWT +*;
Before Instruction
TABLAT
TBLPTR
=
=
34h
01389Ah
Status Affected: None
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Ah)
=
FFh
Encoding:
0000
0000
0000
11nn
nn=0 *
=1 *+
=2 *-
=3 +*
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Bh)
=
FFh
After Instruction (table write completion)
TABLAT
TBLPTR
=
=
34h
01389Bh
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Ah)
Description:
This instruction uses the 3 LSBs of
TBLPTR to determine which of the
8 holding registers the TABLAT is written
to. The holding registers are used to
program the contents of Program
Memory (P.M.). (Refer to Section 6.0
“Flash Program Memory” for additional
details on programming Flash memory.)
The TBLPTR (a 21-bit pointer) points to
each byte in the program memory.
TBLPTR has a 2-Mbyte address range.
The LSb of the TBLPTR selects which
byte of the program memory location to
access.
=
=
FFh
34h
HOLDING REGISTER
(01389Bh)
TBLPTR[0] = 0: Least Significant Byte
of Program Memory
Word
TBLPTR[0] = 1: Most Significant Byte
of Program Memory
Word
The TBLWT instruction can modify the
value of TBLPTR as follows:
•
•
•
•
no change
post-increment
post-decrement
pre-increment
Words:
1
2
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
No
Q3
No
Q4
No
Decode
operation operation operation
No
No No No
operation operation operation operation
(Read
TABLAT)
(Write to
Holding
Register )
DS39758B-page 246
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TSTFSZ
Test f, Skip if 0
XORLW
Exclusive OR Literal with W
Syntax:
TSTFSZ f {,a}
Syntax:
XORLW k
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
a ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
(W) .XOR. k → W
N, Z
Operation:
skip if f = 0
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
0000
1010
kkkk
kkkk
0110
011a
ffff
ffff
The contents of W are XORed with
the 8-bit literal ‘k’. The result is placed
in W.
Description:
If ‘f’ = 0, the next instruction fetched
during the current instruction execution
is discarded and a NOPis executed,
making this a two-cycle instruction.
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to W
Example:
XORLW
0AFh
Before Instruction
W
=
B5h
1Ah
Words:
Cycles:
1
After Instruction
1(2)
W
=
Note: 3 cycles if skip and followed
by a 2-word instruction.
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
No
operation
If skip:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
If skip and followed by 2-word instruction:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
No
No
No
No
operation
operation
operation
operation
Example:
HERE
NZERO
ZERO
TSTFSZ CNT, 1
:
:
Before Instruction
PC
=
Address (HERE)
After Instruction
If CNT
PC
If CNT
PC
=
=
≠
=
00h,
Address (ZERO)
00h,
Address (NZERO)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 247
PIC18F1230/1330
XORWF
Exclusive OR W with f
Syntax:
XORWF f {,d {,a}}
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 255
d ∈ [0,1]
a ∈ [0,1]
Operation:
(W) .XOR. (f) → dest
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, Z
0001
10da
ffff
ffff
Description:
Exclusive OR the contents of W with
register ‘f’. If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored
in W. If ‘d’ is ‘1’, the result is stored back
in the register ‘f’ (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’, the Access Bank is selected.
If ‘a’ is ‘1’, the BSR is used to select the
GPR bank (default).
If ‘a’ is ‘0’ and the extended instruction
set is enabled, this instruction operates
in Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode whenever f ≤ 95 (5Fh). See
Section 21.2.3 “Byte-Oriented and
Bit-Oriented Instructions in Indexed
Literal Offset Mode” for details.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Example:
XORWF
REG, 1, 0
Before Instruction
REG
W
=
=
AFh
B5h
After Instruction
REG
W
=
=
1Ah
B5h
DS39758B-page 248
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
A summary of the instructions in the extended instruction
set is provided in Table 21-3. Detailed descriptions are
provided in Section 21.2.2 “Extended Instruction
Set”. The opcode field descriptions in Table 21-1
(page 208) apply to both the standard and extended
PIC18 instruction sets.
21.2 Extended Instruction Set
In addition to the standard 75 instructions of the PIC18
instruction set, PIC18F1230/1330 devices also provide
an optional extension to the core CPU functionality.
The added features include eight additional instruc-
tions that augment indirect and indexed addressing
operations and the implementation of Indexed Literal
Offset Addressing mode for many of the standard
PIC18 instructions.
Note:
The instruction set extension and the
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
were designed for optimizing applications
written in C; the user may likely never use
these instructions directly in the assem-
bler. The syntax for these commands is
provided as a reference for users who may
be reviewing code that has been
generated by a compiler.
The additional features of the extended instruction set
are disabled by default. To enable them, users must set
the XINST Configuration bit.
The instructions in the extended set (with the exception
of CALLW, MOVSFand MOVSS) can all be classified as
literal operations, which either manipulate the File
Select Registers, or use them for indexed addressing.
Two of the instructions, ADDFSR and SUBFSR, each
have an additional special instantiation for using FSR2.
These versions (ADDULNK and SUBULNK) allow for
automatic return after execution.
21.2.1
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SYNTAX
Most of the extended instructions use indexed
arguments, using one of the File Select Registers and
some offset to specify a source or destination register.
When an argument for an instruction serves as part of
indexed addressing, it is enclosed in square brackets
(“[ ]”). This is done to indicate that the argument is used
as an index or offset. The MPASM™ Assembler will
flag an error if it determines that an index or offset value
is not bracketed.
The extended instructions are specifically implemented
to optimize re-entrant program code (that is, code that
is recursive or that uses a software stack) written in
high-level languages, particularly C. Among other
things, they allow users working in high-level
languages to perform certain operations on data
structures more efficiently. These include:
When the extended instruction set is enabled, brackets
are also used to indicate index arguments in byte-
oriented and bit-oriented instructions. This is in addition
to other changes in their syntax. For more details, see
Section 21.2.3.1 “Extended Instruction Syntax with
Standard PIC18 Commands”.
• Dynamic allocation and deallocation of software
stack space when entering and leaving
subroutines
• Function Pointer invocation
• Software Stack Pointer manipulation
Note:
In the past, square brackets have been
used to denote optional arguments in the
PIC18 and earlier instruction sets. In this
text and going forward, optional
arguments are denoted by braces (“{ }”).
• Manipulation of variables located in a software
stack
TABLE 21-3: EXTENSIONS TO THE PIC18 INSTRUCTION SET
16-Bit Instruction Word
MSb LSb
Mnemonic,
Operands
Status
Affected
Description
Cycles
ADDFSR
ADDULNK
CALLW
f, k
k
Add literal to FSR
Add literal to FSR2 and return
Call subroutine using WREG
1
2
2
2
1110 1000 ffkk kkkk
1110 1000 11kk kkkk
0000 0000 0001 0100
1110 1011 0zzz zzzz
1111 ffff ffff ffff
1110 1011 1zzz zzzz
1111 xxxx xzzz zzzz
1110 1010 kkkk kkkk
None
None
None
None
MOVSF
zs, fd Move zs (source) to 1st word
fd (destination) 2nd word
zs, zd Move zs (source) to 1st word
zd (destination) 2nd word
MOVSS
PUSHL
2
1
None
None
k
Store literal at FSR2,
decrement FSR2
SUBFSR
SUBULNK
f, k
k
Subtract literal from FSR
Subtract literal from FSR2 and
return
1
2
1110 1001 ffkk kkkk
1110 1001 11kk kkkk
None
None
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 249
PIC18F1230/1330
21.2.2
EXTENDED INSTRUCTION SET
ADDFSR
Add Literal to FSR
ADDULNK
Add Literal to FSR2 and Return
Syntax:
ADDFSR f, k
Syntax:
ADDULNK k
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
f ∈ [ 0, 1, 2 ]
FSR(f) + k → FSR(f)
Operands:
Operation:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
FSR2 + k → FSR2,
(TOS) → PC
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
Status Affected: None
1110
1000
ffkk
kkkk
Encoding:
1110 1000
11kk
kkkk
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is added to the
contents of the FSR specified by ‘f’.
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is added to the
contents of FSR2. A RETURNis then
executed by loading the PC with the
TOS.
The instruction takes two cycles to
execute; a NOPis performed during the
second cycle.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
FSR
This may be thought of as a special
case of the ADDFSRinstruction, where
f = 3 (binary ‘11’); it operates only on
FSR2.
Example:
ADDFSR 2, 23h
Words:
1
2
Before Instruction
FSR2
After Instruction
FSR2
=
03FFh
0422h
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
=
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
literal ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
FSR
No
No
No
No
Operation
Operation
Operation Operation
Example:
ADDULNK 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
PC
=
=
03FFh
0100h
After Instruction
FSR2
PC
=
=
0422h
(TOS)
Note:
All PIC18 instructions may take an optional label argument preceding the instruction mnemonic for use in
symbolic addressing. If a label is used, the instruction syntax then becomes: {label} instruction argument(s).
DS39758B-page 250
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
CALLW
Subroutine Call Using WREG
MOVSF
Move Indexed to f
Syntax:
CALLW
None
Syntax:
MOVSF [z ], f
s
d
Operands:
Operation:
Operands:
0 ≤ z ≤ 127
s
0 ≤ f ≤ 4095
d
(PC + 2) → TOS,
(W) → PCL,
Operation:
((FSR2) + z ) → f
s
d
(PCLATH) → PCH,
(PCLATU) → PCU
Status Affected:
None
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (destin.)
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1110
1111
1011
ffff
0zzz
ffff
zzzz
ffff
s
d
0000
0000
0001
0100
Description
First, the return address (PC + 2) is
pushed onto the return stack. Next, the
contents of W are written to PCL; the
existing value is discarded. Then, the
contents of PCLATH and PCLATU are
latched into PCH and PCU,
respectively. The second cycle is
executed as a NOPinstruction while the
new next instruction is fetched.
Description:
The contents of the source register are
moved to destination register ‘f ’. The
d
actual address of the source register is
determined by adding the 7-bit literal
offset ‘z ’ in the first word to the value of
s
FSR2. The address of the destination
register is specified by the 12-bit literal
‘f ’ in the second word. Both addresses
d
can be anywhere in the 4096-byte data
space (000h to FFFh).
The MOVSFinstruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
If the resultant source address points to
an indirect addressing register, the
value returned will be 00h.
Unlike CALL, there is no option to
update W, STATUS or BSR.
Words:
Cycles:
1
2
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Words:
Cycles:
2
2
Decode
Read
WREG
PUSH PC to
stack
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
No
operation
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Determine
Determine
Read
source addr source addr source reg
Example:
HERE
CALLW
Decode
No
operation
No
operation
Write
register ‘f’
(dest)
Before Instruction
PC
=
address (HERE)
PCLATH =
PCLATU =
10h
00h
06h
No dummy
read
W
=
After Instruction
PC
=
001006h
Example:
MOVSF
[05h], REG2
TOS
=
address (HERE + 2)
PCLATH =
PCLATU =
W
10h
00h
06h
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
80h
33h
=
Contents
of 85h
REG2
=
=
11h
After Instruction
FSR2
=
80h
Contents
of 85h
REG2
=
=
33h
33h
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 251
PIC18F1230/1330
MOVSS
Move Indexed to Indexed
PUSHL
Store Literal at FSR2, Decrement FSR2
Syntax:
MOVSS [z ], [z ]
Syntax:
PUSHL k
s
d
Operands:
0 ≤ z ≤ 127
s
Operands:
Operation:
0 ≤ k ≤ 255
0 ≤ z ≤ 127
d
k → (FSR2),
FSR2 – 1 → FSR2
Operation:
((FSR2) + z ) → ((FSR2) + z )
s d
Status Affected:
None
Status Affected: None
Encoding:
1st word (source)
2nd word (dest.)
Encoding:
1111
1010
kkkk
kkkk
1110
1111
1011
xxxx
1zzz
xzzz
zzzz
zzzz
s
d
Description:
The 8-bit literal ‘k’ is written to the data
memory address specified by FSR2. FSR2
is decremented by 1 after the operation.
This instruction allows users to push values
onto a software stack.
Description
The contents of the source register are
moved to the destination register. The
addresses of the source and destination
registers are determined by adding the
7-bit literal offsets ‘z ’ or ‘z ’,
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
s
d
respectively, to the value of FSR2. Both
registers can be located anywhere in
the 4096-byte data memory space
(000h to FFFh).
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
The MOVSSinstruction cannot use the
PCL, TOSU, TOSH or TOSL as the
destination register.
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
data
Write to
destination
If the resultant source address points to
an indirect addressing register, the
value returned will be 00h. If the
resultant destination address points to
an indirect addressing register, the
instruction will execute as a NOP.
Example:
PUSHL 08h
Before Instruction
FSR2H:FSR2L
Memory (01ECh)
=
=
01ECh
00h
Words:
2
2
After Instruction
FSR2H:FSR2L
Memory (01ECh)
=
=
01EBh
08h
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Determine
Determine
Read
source addr source addr source reg
Decode
Determine
dest addr
Determine
dest addr
Write
to dest reg
Example:
MOVSS [05h], [06h]
Before Instruction
FSR2
=
=
=
80h
33h
11h
Contents
of 85h
Contents
of 86h
After Instruction
FSR2
=
=
=
80h
33h
33h
Contents
of 85h
Contents
of 86h
DS39758B-page 252
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
SUBFSR
Subtract Literal from FSR
SUBULNK
Subtract Literal from FSR2 and Return
Syntax:
SUBFSR f, k
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
f ∈ [ 0, 1, 2 ]
FSR(f – k) → FSR(f)
None
Syntax:
SUBULNK k
Operands:
Operands:
Operation:
0 ≤ k ≤ 63
FSR2 – k → FSR2
(TOS) → PC
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Status Affected: None
1110
1001
ffkk
kkkk
Encoding:
1110
1001
11kk
kkkk
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is subtracted from
the contents of the FSR specified
by ‘f’.
Description:
The 6-bit literal ‘k’ is subtracted from the
contents of the FSR2. A RETURNis then
executed by loading the PC with the TOS.
The instruction takes two cycles to
execute; a NOPis performed during the
second cycle.
This may be thought of as a special case of
the SUBFSRinstruction, where f = 3 (binary
‘11’); it operates only on FSR2.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Words:
1
2
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Example:
SUBFSR 2, 23h
03FFh
Q2
Q3
Q4
Before Instruction
FSR2
After Instruction
FSR2
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
=
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
No
Operation
=
03DCh
Example:
SUBULNK 23h
Before Instruction
FSR2
PC
=
=
03FFh
0100h
After Instruction
FSR2
PC
=
=
03DCh
(TOS)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 253
PIC18F1230/1330
21.2.3
BYTE-ORIENTED AND
BIT-ORIENTED INSTRUCTIONS IN
INDEXED LITERAL OFFSET MODE
21.2.3.1
Extended Instruction Syntax with
Standard PIC18 Commands
When the extended instruction set is enabled, the file
register argument, ‘f’, in the standard byte-oriented and
bit-oriented commands is replaced with the literal offset
value, ‘k’. As already noted, this occurs only when ‘f’ is
less than or equal to 5Fh. When an offset value is used,
it must be indicated by square brackets (“[ ]”). As with
the extended instructions, the use of brackets indicates
to the compiler that the value is to be interpreted as an
index or an offset. Omitting the brackets, or using a
value greater than 5Fh within brackets, will generate an
error in the MPASM Assembler.
Note: Enabling the PIC18 instruction set
extension may cause legacy applications
to behave erratically or fail entirely.
In addition to eight new commands in the extended set,
enabling the extended instruction set also enables
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode (Section 5.5.1
“Indexed Addressing with Literal Offset”). This has
a significant impact on the way that many commands of
the standard PIC18 instruction set are interpreted.
When the extended set is disabled, addresses embed-
ded in opcodes are treated as literal memory locations:
either as a location in the Access Bank (‘a’ = 0) or in a
GPR bank designated by the BSR (‘a’ = 1). When the
extended instruction set is enabled and ‘a’ = 0,
however, a file register argument of 5Fh or less is
interpreted as an offset from the pointer value in FSR2
and not as a literal address. For practical purposes, this
means that all instructions that use the Access RAM bit
as an argument – that is, all byte-oriented and bit-
oriented instructions, or almost half of the core PIC18
instructions – may behave differently when the
extended instruction set is enabled.
If the index argument is properly bracketed for Indexed
Literal Offset Addressing mode, the Access RAM
argument is never specified; it will automatically be
assumed to be ‘0’. This is in contrast to standard
operation (extended instruction set disabled) when ‘a’
is set on the basis of the target address. Declaring the
Access RAM bit in this mode will also generate an error
in the MPASM Assembler.
The destination argument, ‘d’, functions as before.
In the latest versions of the MPASM Assembler,
language support for the extended instruction set must
be explicitly invoked. This is done with either the
command line option, /y, or the PE directive in the
source listing.
When the content of FSR2 is 00h, the boundaries of the
Access RAM are essentially remapped to their original
values. This may be useful in creating backward
compatible code. If this technique is used, it may be
necessary to save the value of FSR2 and restore it
when moving back and forth between C and assembly
routines in order to preserve the Stack Pointer. Users
must also keep in mind the syntax requirements of the
extended instruction set (see Section 21.2.3.1
“Extended Instruction Syntax with Standard PIC18
Commands”).
21.2.4
CONSIDERATIONS WHEN
ENABLING THE EXTENDED
INSTRUCTION SET
It is important to note that the extensions to the instruc-
tion set may not be beneficial to all users. In particular,
users who are not writing code that uses a software
stack may not benefit from using the extensions to the
instruction set.
Although the Indexed Literal Offset Addressing mode
can be very useful for dynamic stack and pointer
manipulation, it can also be very annoying if a simple
arithmetic operation is carried out on the wrong
register. Users who are accustomed to the PIC18
programming must keep in mind that, when the
extended instruction set is enabled, register addresses
of 5Fh or less are used for Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode.
Additionally, the Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
mode may create issues with legacy applications
written to the PIC18 assembler. This is because
instructions in the legacy code may attempt to address
registers in the Access Bank below 5Fh. Since these
addresses are interpreted as literal offsets to FSR2
when the instruction set extension is enabled, the
application may read or write to the wrong data
addresses.
Representative examples of typical byte-oriented and
bit-oriented instructions in the Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode are provided on the following page to
show how execution is affected. The operand
conditions shown in the examples are applicable to all
instructions of these types.
When porting an application to the PIC18F1230/1330,
it is very important to consider the type of code. A large,
re-entrant application that is written in ‘C’ and would
benefit from efficient compilation will do well when
using the instruction set extensions. Legacy
applications that heavily use the Access Bank will most
likely not benefit from using the extended instruction
set.
DS39758B-page 254
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
ADD W to Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
Bit Set Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
ADDWF
BSF
Syntax:
ADDWF
[k] {,d}
Syntax:
BSF [k], b
Operands:
0 ≤ k ≤ 95
d ∈ [0,1]
Operands:
0 ≤ f ≤ 95
0 ≤ b ≤ 7
Operation:
(W) + ((FSR2) + k) → dest
Operation:
1 → ((FSR2) + k)<b>
Status Affected:
Encoding:
N, OV, C, DC, Z
Status Affected:
Encoding:
None
1000
0010
01d0
kkkk
kkkk
bbb0
kkkk
kkkk
Description:
The contents of W are added to the
contents of the register indicated by
FSR2, offset by the value ‘k’.
If ‘d’ is ‘0’, the result is stored in W. If ‘d’
is ‘1’, the result is stored back in
register ‘f’ (default).
Description:
Bit ‘b’ of the register indicated by FSR2,
offset by the value ‘k’, is set.
Words:
1
1
Cycles:
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read
register ‘f’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Example:
BSF
[FLAG_OFST], 7
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
Data
Write to
destination
Before Instruction
FLAG_OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A0Ah
=
=
0Ah
0A00h
Example:
ADDWF
[OFST], 0
=
55h
D5h
Before Instruction
After Instruction
W
OFST
FSR2
Contents
of 0A2Ch
=
=
=
17h
2Ch
0A00h
Contents
of 0A0Ah
=
=
20h
After Instruction
W
=
=
37h
20h
Set Indexed
(Indexed Literal Offset mode)
Contents
of 0A2Ch
SETF
Syntax:
SETF [k]
Operands:
Operation:
Status Affected:
Encoding:
Description:
0 ≤ k ≤ 95
FFh → ((FSR2) + k)
None
0110
1000
kkkk
kkkk
The contents of the register indicated by
FSR2, offset by ‘k’, are set to FFh.
Words:
Cycles:
1
1
Q Cycle Activity:
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Decode
Read ‘k’
Process
Data
Write
register
Example:
SETF
[OFST]
2Ch
Before Instruction
OFST
=
=
FSR2
0A00h
Contents
of 0A2Ch
=
00h
After Instruction
Contents
of 0A2Ch
=
FFh
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 255
PIC18F1230/1330
To develop software for the extended instruction set,
the user must enable support for the instructions and
the Indexed Addressing mode in their language tool(s).
Depending on the environment being used, this may be
done in several ways:
21.2.5
SPECIAL CONSIDERATIONS WITH
MICROCHIP MPLAB® IDE TOOLS
The latest versions of Microchip’s software tools have
been designed to fully support the extended instruction
set of the PIC18F1230/1330 family of devices. This
includes the MPLAB C18 C Compiler, MPASM Assem-
bly language and MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment (IDE).
• A menu option, or dialog box within the
environment, that allows the user to configure the
language tool and its settings for the project
• A command line option
When selecting
a
target device for software
• A directive in the source code
development, MPLAB IDE will automatically set default
Configuration bits for that device. The default setting for
the XINST Configuration bit is ‘0’, disabling the
extended instruction set and Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing mode. For proper execution of applications
developed to take advantage of the extended
instruction set, XINST must be set during
programming.
These options vary between different compilers,
assemblers and development environments. Users are
encouraged to review the documentation accompany-
ing their development systems for the appropriate
information.
DS39758B-page 256
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.0 ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
(†)
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +125°C
Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on any pin with respect to VSS (except VDD and MCLR) ................................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V)
Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS ......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +7.5V
Voltage on MCLR with respect to VSS (Note 2) ......................................................................................... 0V to +13.25V
Total power dissipation (Note 1) ...............................................................................................................................1.0W
Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA
Maximum current into VDD pin ..............................................................................................................................250 mA
Input clamp current, IIK (VI < 0 or VI > VDD)...................................................................................................................... 20 mA
Output clamp current, IOK (VO < 0 or VO > VDD) .............................................................................................................. 20 mA
Maximum output current sunk by any I/O pin..........................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum output current sourced by any I/O pin ....................................................................................................25 mA
Maximum current sunk by all ports .......................................................................................................................200 mA
Maximum current sourced by all ports ..................................................................................................................200 mA
Note 1: Power dissipation is calculated as follows:
Pdis = VDD x {IDD – ∑ IOH} + ∑ {(VDD – VOH) x IOH} + ∑(VOL x IOL)
2: Voltage spikes below VSS at the MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA pin, inducing currents greater than 80 mA, may
cause latch-up. Thus, a series resistor of 50-100Ω should be used when applying a “low” level to the MCLR/
VPP/RA5/FLTA pin, rather than pulling this pin directly to VSS.
† NOTICE: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the
device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those or any other conditions above those
indicated in the operation listings of this specification is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for
extended periods may affect device reliability.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 257
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-1:
PIC18F1230/1330 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH (INDUSTRIAL)
6.0V
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
PIC18F1230/1330
4.2V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
2.0V
40 MHz
Frequency
FIGURE 22-2:
PIC18F1230/1330 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH (EXTENDED)
6.0V
5.5V
PIC18F1230/1330
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
4.2V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
2.0V
25 MHz
Frequency
DS39758B-page 258
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-3:
PIC18LF1230/1330 VOLTAGE-FREQUENCY GRAPH (INDUSTRIAL)
6.0V
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
PIC18LF1230/1330
4.2V
3.5V
3.0V
2.5V
2.0V
40 MHz
4 MHz
Frequency
FMAX = (16.36 MHz/V) (VDDAPPMIN – 2.0V) + 4 MHz
Note: VDDAPPMIN is the minimum voltage of the PICmicro® device in the application.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 259
PIC18F1230/1330
22.1 DC Characteristics: Supply Voltage
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
(Industrial)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Supply Voltage
Min
Typ Max Units
Conditions
D001
VDD
PIC18LF1230/1330 2.0
PIC18F1230/1330 4.2
—
—
—
5.5
5.5
—
V
V
V
HS, XT, RC and LP Oscillator modes
D002
D003
VDR
RAM Data Retention
1.5
(1)
Voltage
VPOR
VDD Start Voltage
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
—
—
—
0.7
—
V
See section on Power-on Reset for details
D004
SVDD
VBOR
VDD Rise Rate
to ensure internal
Power-on Reset signal
0.05
V/ms See section on Power-on Reset for details
Brown-out Reset Voltage
PIC18LF1230/1330
BORV1:BORV0 = 11
BORV1:BORV0 = 10
All devices
D005
D005
2.00 2.05 2.16
2.65 2.79 2.93
V
V
BORV1:BORV0 = 01
BORV1:BORV0 = 00
4.11 4.33 4.55
4.36 4.59 4.82
V
V
Legend: Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: This is the limit to which VDD can be lowered in Sleep mode, or during a device Reset, without losing RAM data.
DS39758B-page 260
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
(Industrial)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Power-Down Current (IPD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(1)
PIC18LF1230/1330 100
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
nA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
(Sleep mode)
0.1
0.2
PIC18LF1230/1330 0.1
VDD = 3.0V
(Sleep mode)
0.1
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
0.3
All devices 0.1
0.1
0.4
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
VDD = 5.0V
(Sleep mode)
Extended devices only 10
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 261
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
PIC18LF1230/1330 15
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
-40°C
15
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
15
μA
PIC18LF1230/1330 40
μA
FOSC = 31 kHz
(RC_RUN mode,
INTRC source)
35
μA
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
30
μA
All devices 105
μA
90
80
μA
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
-40°C
VDD = 5.0V
μA
Extended devices only 80
μA
PIC18LF1230/1330 0.32 TBD
0.33 TBD
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
0.33 TBD
PIC18LF1230/1330 0.6
TBD
FOSC = 1 MHz
(RC_RUN mode,
INTOSC source)
0.55 TBD
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
0.6
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
All devices 1.1
1.1
1.0
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
VDD = 5.0V
Extended devices only
1
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
DS39758B-page 262
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
(Industrial)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
PIC18LF1230/1330 0.8
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
μA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
-40°C
0.8
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
0.8
PIC18LF1230/1330 1.3
FOSC = 4 MHz
(RC_RUN mode,
INTOSC source)
1.3
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
1.3
All devices 2.5
2.5
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
-40°C
VDD = 5.0V
2.5
Extended devices only 2.5
PIC18LF1230/1330 2.9
3.1
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
3.6
PIC18LF1230/1330 4.5
FOSC = 31 kHz
(RC_IDLE mode,
INTRC source)
4.8
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
5.8
All devices 9.2
9.8
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
VDD = 5.0V
11.4 TBD
Extended devices only 21 TBD
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 263
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
PIC18LF1230/1330 165
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
mA
mA
mA
mA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
mA
mA
mA
mA
-40°C
175
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
190
PIC18LF1230/1330 250
FOSC = 1 MHz
(RC_IDLE mode,
INTOSC source)
270
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
290
All devices 500
520
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
-40°C
VDD = 5.0V
550
Extended devices only 0.6
PIC18LF1230/1330 340
350
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
360
PIC18LF1230/1330 520
FOSC = 4 MHz
(RC_IDLE mode,
INTOSC source)
540
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
580
All devices 1.0
1.1
1.1
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
VDD = 5.0V
Extended devices only 1.1
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
DS39758B-page 264
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
(Industrial)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
PIC18LF1230/1330 250
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
-40°C
260
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
250
μA
PIC18LF1230/1330 550
μA
FOSC = 1 MHz
(PRI_RUN,
480
μA
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
460
μA
EC oscillator)
All devices 1.2
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
1.1
1.0
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
-40°C
VDD = 5.0V
Extended devices only 1.0
PIC18LF1230/1330 0.72 TBD
0.74 TBD
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
0.74 TBD
PIC18LF1230/1330 1.3
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
FOSC = 4 MHz
(PRI_RUN,
1.3
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
1.3
EC oscillator)
All devices 2.7
2.6
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
+125°C
+125°C
VDD = 5.0V
2.5
Extended devices only 2.6
Extended devices only 8.4
11
VDD = 4.2V
VDD = 5.0V
FOSC = 25 MHz
(PRI_RUN,
EC oscillator)
All devices 15
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
16
VDD = 4.2V
VDD = 5.0V
FOSC = 40 MHz
(PRI_RUN,
EC oscillator)
16
All devices 21
21
21
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 265
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
All devices 7.5
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
-40°C
FOSC = 4 MHz,
16 MHz internal
(PRI_RUN HS+PLL)
7.4
+25°C
VDD = 4.2V
+85°C
7.3
Extended devices only 8.0
+125°C
-40°C
All devices 10
FOSC = 4 MHz,
16 MHz internal
(PRI_RUN HS+PLL)
10
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
-40°C
VDD = 5.0V
9.7
Extended devices only 10
All devices 17
FOSC = 10 MHz,
40 MHz internal
(PRI_RUN HS+PLL)
17
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 4.2V
VDD = 5.0V
17
All devices 23
FOSC = 10 MHz,
40 MHz internal
(PRI_RUN HS+PLL)
23
23
+25°C
+85°C
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
DS39758B-page 266
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
(Industrial)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
PIC18LF1230/1330 65
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
-40°C
65
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
70
PIC18LF1230/1330 120
FOSC = 1 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
120
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
130
All devices 300
240
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
-40°C
VDD = 5.0V
300
Extended devices only 320
PIC18LF1230/1330 260
255
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
270
PIC18LF1230/1330 420
FOSC = 4 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
430
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
450
All devices 0.9
0.9
0.9
+25°C
+85°C
+125°C
+125°C
+125°C
VDD = 5.0V
Extended devices only
1
Extended devices only 2.8
4.3
VDD = 4.2V
VDD = 5.0V
FOSC = 25 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
All devices 6.0
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
6.2
VDD = 4.2V
VDD = 5.0V
FOSC = 40 MHz
(PRI_IDLE mode,
EC oscillator)
6.6
All devices 8.1
9.1
8.3
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 267
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Supply Current (IDD)
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
(2)
PIC18LF1230/1330 14
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
-40°C
15
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 5.0V
16
(4)
PIC18LF1230/1330 40
FOSC = 32 kHz
35
(SEC_RUN mode,
Timer1 as clock)
31
All devices 99
81
75
PIC18LF1230/1330 2.5
3.7
4.5
(4)
PIC18LF1230/1330 5.0
FOSC = 32 kHz
5.4
(SEC_IDLE mode,
Timer1 as clock)
6.3
All devices 8.5
9.0
10.5 TBD
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
DS39758B-page 268
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
(Industrial)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
Module Differential Currents (ΔIWDT, ΔIBOR, ΔILVD, ΔIOSCB, ΔIAD)
D022
(ΔIWDT)
Watchdog Timer 1.3
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
-40°C
+25°C
1.4
2.0
1.9
2.0
2.8
4.0
5.5
5.6
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
VDD = 5.0V
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 5.0V
+85°C
13
+125°C
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
(4)
D022A
(ΔIBOR)
Brown-out Reset
35
40
55
0
μA -40°C to +125°C
μA -40°C to +85°C
μA -40°C to +125°C
Sleep mode,
BOREN1:BOREN0 = 10
0
(4)
D022B
(ΔILVD)
Low-Voltage Detect
22
25
29
30
μA
μA
μA
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 5.0V
μA -40°C to +125°C
D025
(ΔIOSCB)
Timer1 Oscillator 2.1
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
μA
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
-40°C
+25°C
+85°C
(3)
1.8
2.1
2.2
2.6
2.9
3.0
3.2
3.4
VDD = 2.0V
32 kHz on Timer1
(3)
VDD = 3.0V
VDD = 5.0V
32 kHz on Timer1
(3)
32 kHz on Timer1
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 269
PIC18F1230/1330
22.2 DC Characteristics: Power-Down and Supply Current
PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
PIC18F1230/1330
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +125°C for extended
(Industrial, Extended)
Param
No.
Device
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
Module Differential Currents (ΔIWDT, ΔIBOR, ΔILVD, ΔIOSCB, ΔIAD)
D026
(ΔIAD)
A/D Converter 1.0
TBD
TBD
TBD
TBD
μA
μA
μA
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 3.0V
1.0
1.0
2.0
A/D on, not converting
VDD = 5.0V
μA -40°C to +125°C
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined. Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: The power-down current in Sleep mode does not depend on the oscillator type. Power-down current is measured
with the part in Sleep mode, with all I/O pins in high-impedance state and tied to VDD or VSS and all features that
add delta current disabled (such as WDT, Timer1 oscillator, BOR, etc.).
2: The supply current is mainly a function of operating voltage, frequency and mode. Other factors, such as I/O pin
loading and switching rate, oscillator type and circuit, internal code execution pattern and temperature, also have
an impact on the current consumption.
The test conditions for all IDD measurements in active operation mode are:
OSC1 = external square wave, from rail-to-rail; all I/O pins tri-stated, pulled to VDD or VSS;
MCLR = VDD; WDT enabled/disabled as specified.
3: Low-power Timer1 oscillator selected.
4: BOR and LVD enable internal band gap reference. With both modules enabled, current consumption will be less
than the sum of both specifications.
DS39758B-page 270
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.3 DC Characteristics: PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
VIL
Input Low Voltage
I/O ports:
with TTL buffer
D030
D030A
D031
D032
D033
VSS
—
0.15 VDD
0.8
V
V
V
V
V
VDD < 4.5V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
MCLR
VSS
VSS
VSS
0.2 VDD
0.2 VDD
0.3 VDD
OSC1
HS, HSPLL modes
RC, EC modes(1)
XT, LP modes
D033A
D033B
D034
OSC1
OSC1
T1CKI
VSS
VSS
VSS
0.2 VDD
0.3
0.3
V
V
V
VIH
Input High Voltage
I/O ports:
D040
D040A
D041
D042
D043
with TTL buffer
0.25 VDD + 0.8V
2.0
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
V
V
V
V
V
VDD < 4.5V
4.5V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5V
with Schmitt Trigger buffer
0.8 VDD
0.8 VDD
0.7 VDD
MCLR
OSC1
HS, HSPLL modes
D043A
D043B
D043C
D044
OSC1
OSC1
OSC1
T1CKI
0.8 VDD
0.9 VDD
1.6
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
V
V
V
V
EC mode
RC mode(1)
XT, LP modes
1.6
IIL
Input Leakage Current(2,3)
D060
I/O ports
—
1
μA VSS ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD,
Pin at high-impedance
D061
D063
MCLR
—
—
5
5
μA Vss ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
μA Vss ≤ VPIN ≤ VDD
OSC1
IPU
Weak Pull-up Current
PORTB weak pull-up current
D070
IPURB
50
400
μA VDD = 5V, VPIN = VSS
Note 1: In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the
PICmicro® device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
2: The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified
levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input
voltages.
3: Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
4: Parameter is characterized but not tested.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 271
PIC18F1230/1330
22.3 DC Characteristics: PIC18F1230/1330 (Industrial)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (Industrial) (Continued)
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Symbol
No.
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
VOL
Output Low Voltage
I/O ports
D080
D083
—
—
0.6
0.6
V
V
IOL = 8.5 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
-40°C to +85°C
OSC2/CLKO
IOL = 1.6 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
(RC, RCIO, EC, ECIO modes)
Output High Voltage(3)
-40°C to +85°C
VOH
D090
D092
I/O ports
VDD – 0.7
VDD – 0.7
—
—
V
V
IOH = -3.0 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
-40°C to +85°C
OSC2/CLKO
IOH = -1.3 mA, VDD = 4.5V,
(RC, RCIO, EC, ECIO modes)
-40°C to +85°C
Capacitive Loading Specs
on Output Pins
D100(4)
D101
COSC2 OSC2 pin
—
—
15
50
pF In XT, HS and LP modes
when external clock is
used to drive OSC1
CIO
All I/O pins and OSC2
(in RC mode)
pF To meet the AC Timing
Specifications
Note 1: In RC oscillator configuration, the OSC1/CLKI pin is a Schmitt Trigger input. It is not recommended that the
PICmicro® device be driven with an external clock while in RC mode.
2: The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified
levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current may be measured at different input
voltages.
3: Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin.
4: Parameter is characterized but not tested.
DS39758B-page 272
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 22-1: MEMORY PROGRAMMING REQUIREMENTS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
DC CHARACTERISTICS
Param
Sym
No.
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
Data EEPROM Memory
D120
ED
Byte Endurance
100K
VMIN
1M
—
—
E/W -40°C to +85°C
D121 VDRW VDD for Read/Write
5.5
V
Using EECON to read/write
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D122 TDEW Erase/Write Cycle Time
D123 TRETD Characteristic Retention
—
4
—
—
ms
40
—
Year Provided no other
specifications are violated
D124
D125
TREF
IDDP
Number of Total Erase/Write
Cycles before Refresh(1)
1M
—
10M
10
—
—
E/W -40°C to +85°C
Supply Current during
Programming
mA
Program Flash Memory
Cell Endurance
D130
D131
EP
10K
100K
—
—
E/W -40°C to +85°C
VPR
VDD for Read
VMIN
5.5
V
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D132B VPEW VDD for Self-Timed Write
VMIN
—
5.5
V
VMIN = Minimum operating
voltage
D133A TIW
Self-Timed Write Cycle Time
—
2
—
—
ms
D134 TRETD Characteristic Retention
40
100
Year Provided no other
specifications are violated
D135
IDDP
Supply Current during
Programming
—
10
—
mA
†
Data in “Typ” column is at 5.0V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
Note 1: Refer to Section 7.8 “Using the Data EEPROM” for a more detailed discussion on data EEPROM
endurance.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 273
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 22-2: COMPARATOR SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: 3.0V < VDD < 5.5V, -40°C < TA < +85°C (unless otherwise stated).
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristics
Input Offset Voltage
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Comments
D300
VIOFF
—
0
5.0
—
10
VDD – 1.5
—
mV
V
D301
D302
300
VICM
Input Common Mode Voltage
Common Mode Rejection Ratio
Response Time(1)
CMRR
TRESP
55
—
—
—
dB
ns
ns
150
150
400
PIC18FXXXX
300A
600
PIC18LFXXXX,
VDD = 2.0V
301
TMC2OV Comparator Mode Change to
Output Valid
—
—
10
μs
Note 1: Response time measured with one comparator input at (VDD – 1.5)/2, while the other input transitions
from VSS to VDD.
TABLE 22-3: VOLTAGE REFERENCE SPECIFICATIONS
Operating Conditions: 3.0V < VDD < 5.5V, -40°C < TA < +85°C (unless otherwise stated).
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristics
Resolution
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Comments
D310
VRES
VDD/24
—
—
—
2k
—
VDD/32
1/2
LSb
LSb
Ω
D311
D312
310
VRAA
VRUR
TSET
Absolute Accuracy
Unit Resistor Value (R)
Settling Time(1)
—
—
—
10
μs
Note 1: Settling time measured while CVRR = 1and CVR3:CVR0 transitions from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’.
DS39758B-page 274
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-4:
LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CHARACTERISTICS
VDD
(LVDIF can be
cleared in software)
VLVD
(LVDIF set by hardware)
LVDIF
TABLE 22-4: LOW-VOLTAGE DETECT CHARACTERISTICS
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max Units
Conditions
D420
LVD Voltage on VDD
Transition High-to-Low
LVDL<3:0> = 0000 2.06
LVDL<3:0> = 0001 2.12
LVDL<3:0> = 0010 2.24
LVDL<3:0> = 0011 2.32
LVDL<3:0> = 0100 2.47
LVDL<3:0> = 0101 2.65
LVDL<3:0> = 0110 2.74
LVDL<3:0> = 0111 2.96
LVDL<3:0> = 1000 3.22
LVDL<3:0> = 1001 3.37
LVDL<3:0> = 1010 3.52
LVDL<3:0> = 1011 3.70
LVDL<3:0> = 1100 3.90
LVDL<3:0> = 1101 4.11
LVDL<3:0> = 1110 4.36
2.17
2.23
2.36
2.44
2.60
2.79
2.89
3.12
3.39
3.55
3.71
3.90
4.11
4.33
4.59
2.28
2.34
2.48
2.56
2.73
2.93
3.04
3.28
3.56
3.73
3.90
4.10
4.32
4.55
4.82
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 275
PIC18F1230/1330
22.4 AC (Timing) Characteristics
22.4.1
TIMING PARAMETER SYMBOLOGY
The timing parameter symbols have been created
using one of the following formats:
1. TppS2ppS
2. TppS
T
3. TCC:ST
4. Ts
(I2C specifications only)
(I2C specifications only)
F
Frequency
T
Time
Lowercase letters (pp) and their meanings:
pp
cc
ck
cs
di
CCP1
CLKO
CS
osc
rd
OSC1
RD
rw
sc
ss
t0
RD or WR
SCK
SDI
do
dt
SDO
SS
Data in
I/O port
MCLR
T0CKI
T13CKI
WR
io
t1
mc
wr
Uppercase letters and their meanings:
S
F
Fall
P
R
V
Z
Period
H
High
Rise
I
L
Invalid (High-impedance)
Low
Valid
High-impedance
I2C only
AA
output access
Bus free
High
Low
High
Low
BUF
TCC:ST (I2C specifications only)
CC
HD
Hold
SU
Setup
ST
DAT
STA
DATA input hold
Start condition
STO
Stop condition
DS39758B-page 276
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
22.4.2
TIMING CONDITIONS
Note:
Because of space limitations, the generic
terms “PIC18FXXXX” and “PIC18LFXXXX”
are used throughout this section to refer to
the PIC18F1230/1330 and PIC18LF1230/
1330 families of devices specifically and
only those devices.
The temperature and voltages specified in Table 22-5
apply to all timing specifications unless otherwise
noted. Figure 22-5 specifies the load conditions for the
timing specifications.
TABLE 22-5: TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS – AC
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature
-40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
AC CHARACTERISTICS
Operating voltage VDD range as described in DC spec Section 22.1 and
Section 22.3.
LF parts operate for industrial temperatures only.
FIGURE 22-5:
LOAD CONDITIONS FOR DEVICE TIMING SPECIFICATIONS
Load Condition 1
VDD/2
Load Condition 2
CL
Pin
RL
CL
VSS
Pin
VSS
RL = 464Ω
CL = 50 pF for all pins except OSC2/CLKO and including D and E outputs as ports
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 277
PIC18F1230/1330
22.4.3
TIMING DIAGRAMS AND SPECIFICATIONS
FIGURE 22-6:
EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING (ALL MODES EXCEPT PLL)
Q4
Q1
1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Q1
OSC1
CLKO
3
3
4
4
2
TABLE 22-6: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Param.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
No.
1A
FOSC
External CLKI Frequency(1)
DC
DC
DC
DC
0.1
4
1
20
31.25
4
MHz XT, RC Oscillator modes
MHz HS Oscillator mode
kHz LP Oscillator mode
MHz RC Oscillator mode
MHz XT Oscillator mode
MHz HS Oscillator mode
kHz LP Oscillator mode
Oscillator Frequency(1)
4
20
200
—
5
1
TOSC
External CLKI Period(1)
Oscillator Period(1)
1000
50
ns
ns
μs
ns
μs
ns
ns
μs
ns
ns
ns
μs
ns
ns
ns
ns
XT, RC Oscillator modes
HS Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
RC Oscillator mode
XT Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
TCY = 4/FOSC, Industrial
TCY = 4/FOSC, Extended
XT Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
XT Oscillator mode
LP Oscillator mode
HS Oscillator mode
—
32
—
250
250
100
50
—
1
250
250
—
5
2
3
TCY
Instruction Cycle Time(1)
100
160
30
—
—
TOSL,
TOSH
External Clock in (OSC1)
High or Low Time
—
2.5
10
—
—
4
TOSR,
TOSF
External Clock in (OSC1)
Rise or Fall Time
—
20
50
7.5
—
—
Note 1: Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals four times the input oscillator time base period for all configurations
except PLL. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type under
standard operating conditions with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result
in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested
to operate at “min.” values with an external clock applied to the OSC1/CLKI pin. When an external clock
input is used, the “max.” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices.
DS39758B-page 278
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 22-7: PLL CLOCK TIMING SPECIFICATIONS (VDD = 4.2V TO 5.5V)
Param
No.
Sym
Characteristic
Min
Typ†
Max
Units
Conditions
F10
F11
F12
F13
FOSC Oscillator Frequency Range
4
—
—
—
—
10
40
2
MHz HS mode only
FSYS On-Chip VCO System Frequency
16
—
-2
MHz HS mode only
trc
PLL Start-up Time (Lock Time)
ms
%
ΔCLK CLKO Stability (Jitter)
+2
†
Data in “Typ” column is at 5V, 25°C unless otherwise stated. These parameters are for design guidance
only and are not tested.
TABLE 22-8: AC CHARACTERISTICS: INTERNAL RC ACCURACY
PIC18F1230/1330 (INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18LF1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
PIC18F1230/1330
Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated)
Operating temperature -40°C ≤ TA ≤ +85°C for industrial
(Industrial)
Param
No.
Device
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
(1)
INTOSC Accuracy @ Freq = 8 MHz, 4 MHz, 2 MHz, 1 MHz, 500 kHz, 250 kHz, 125 kHz, 31 kHz
PIC18LF1230/1330
-2
-5
+/-1
—
2
5
%
%
%
%
%
%
+25°C
VDD = 2.7-3.3V
VDD = 2.7-3.3V
VDD = 2.7-3.3V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
-10°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
+25°C
-10
-2
+/-1
+/-1
—
10
2
PIC18F1230/1330
-5
5
-10°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
-10
+/-1
10
(2,3)
INTRC Accuracy @ Freq = 31 kHz
PIC18LF1230/1330 26.562
PIC18F1230/1330 26.562
—
—
35.938
35.938
kHz
kHz
-40°C to +85°C
-40°C to +85°C
VDD = 2.7-3.3V
VDD = 4.5-5.5V
Legend: Shading of rows is to assist in readability of the table.
Note 1: Frequency calibrated at 25°C. OSCTUNE register can be used to compensate for temperature drift.
2: INTRC frequency after calibration.
3: Change of INTRC frequency as VDD changes.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 279
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-7:
CLKO AND I/O TIMING
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
OSC1
11
10
CLKO
13
14
12
18
19
16
I/O pin
(Input)
15
17
I/O pin
(Output)
New Value
Old Value
20, 21
Refer to Figure 22-5 for load conditions.
Note:
TABLE 22-9: CLKO AND I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units Conditions
10
TosH2ckL OSC1 ↑ to CLKO ↓
TosH2ckH OSC1 ↑ to CLKO ↑
—
—
—
—
—
75
75
35
35
—
—
—
50
—
—
—
10
—
10
—
—
—
200
ns (Note 1)
ns (Note 1)
ns (Note 1)
ns (Note 1)
ns (Note 1)
ns (Note 1)
ns (Note 1)
ns
11
200
12
TckR
TckF
CLKO Rise Time
CLKO Fall Time
100
13
100
14
TckL2ioV CLKO ↓ to Port Out Valid
TioV2ckH Port In Valid before CLKO ↑
0.5 TCY + 20
15
0.25 TCY + 25
—
—
16
TckH2ioI
Port In Hold after CLKO ↑
0
—
17
TosH2ioV OSC1 ↑ (Q1 cycle) to Port Out Valid
150
—
18
TosH2ioI
OSC1 ↑ (Q2 cycle) to Port
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
100
200
0
ns
Input Invalid (I/O in hold time)
18A
19
—
ns VDD = 2.0V
ns
TioV2osH Port Input Valid to OSC1 ↑ (I/O in setup time)
—
20
TioR
Port Output Rise Time
Port Output Fall Time
INTx Pin High or Low Time
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
—
25
60
25
60
—
ns
20A
21
—
ns VDD = 2.0V
ns
TioF
—
21A
22†
23†
—
ns VDD = 2.0V
ns
TINP
TCY
TCY
TRBP
RB7:RB4 Change INTx High or Low Time
—
ns
†
These parameters are asynchronous events not related to any internal clock edges.
Note 1: Measurements are taken in RC mode, where CLKO output is 4 x TOSC.
DS39758B-page 280
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-8:
RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER AND
POWER-UP TIMER TIMING
VDD
MCLR
30
Internal
POR
33
PWRT
Time-out
32
Oscillator
Time-out
Internal
Reset
Watchdog
Timer
Reset
31
34
34
I/O pins
Note:
Refer to Figure 22-5 for load conditions.
FIGURE 22-9:
BROWN-OUT RESET TIMING
BVDD
VDD
35
VIRVST
Enable Internal
Reference Voltage
Internal Reference
Voltage Stable
36
TABLE 22-10: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER
AND BROWN-OUT RESET REQUIREMENTS
Param.
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
30
TmcL
TWDT
MCLR Pulse Width (low)
2
—
—
μs
31
Watchdog Timer Time-out Period
(no postscaler)
3.4
4.0
4.6
ms
32
33
34
TOST
Oscillation Start-up Timer Period
1024 TOSC
55.6
—
65.5
2
1024 TOSC
—
ms
μs
TOSC = OSC1 period
TPWRT Power-up Timer Period
75
—
TIOZ
I/O High-Impedance from MCLR
Low or Watchdog Timer Reset
—
35
36
TBOR
Brown-out Reset Pulse Width
200
—
—
—
μs VDD ≤ BVDD (see D005)
μs
TIRVST Time for Internal Reference
Voltage to become Stable
20
50
37
38
39
TLVD
TCSD
Low-Voltage Detect Pulse Width
CPU Start-up Time
200
—
—
10
1
—
—
—
μs
μs
μs
VDD ≤ VLVD
TIOBST Time for INTOSC to Stabilize
—
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 281
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-10:
TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMINGS
T0CKI
41
40
42
T1OSO/T1CKI
46
45
47
48
TMR0 or TMR1
Note: Refer to Figure 22-5 for load conditions.
TABLE 22-11: TIMER0 AND TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK REQUIREMENTS
Param
No.
Symbol
Tt0H
Characteristic
T0CKI High Pulse Width
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
40
No prescaler
With prescaler
No prescaler
With prescaler
No prescaler
With prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
10
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
41
42
Tt0L
Tt0P
T0CKI Low Pulse Width
T0CKI Period
0.5 TCY + 20
10
TCY + 10
Greater of:
20 ns or
ns N = prescale
value
(TCY + 40)/N
(1, 2, 4,..., 256)
45
46
Tt1H
Tt1L
T1CKI High
Time
Synchronous, no prescaler
0.5 TCY + 20
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
ns
ns
Synchronous, PIC18FXXXX
10
with prescaler
PIC18LFXXXX
25
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
Asynchronous PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
30
50
T1CKI Low
Time
Synchronous, no prescaler
Synchronous, PIC18FXXXX
0.5 TCY + 5
10
25
30
50
with prescaler
PIC18LFXXXX
VDD = 2.0V
VDD = 2.0V
Asynchronous PIC18FXXXX
PIC18LFXXXX
47
48
Tt1P
Ft1
T1CKI Input
Period
Synchronous
Greater of:
20 ns or
(TCY + 40)/N
ns N = prescale
value (1, 2, 4, 8)
Asynchronous
60
DC
—
50
ns
kHz
—
T1CKI Oscillator Input Frequency Range
Tcke2tmrI Delay from External T1CKI Clock Edge to Timer
Increment
2 TOSC
7 TOSC
DS39758B-page 282
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-11:
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION (MASTER/SLAVE) TIMING
RA2/TX/CK
pin
121
121
RA3/RX/DT
pin
120
Note: Refer to Figure 22-5 for load conditions.
122
TABLE 22-12: EUSART SYNCHRONOUS TRANSMISSION REQUIREMENTS
Param
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units Conditions
No.
120
TckH2dtV SYNC XMIT (MASTER & SLAVE)
Clock High to Data Out Valid
PIC18FXXXX
—
—
—
—
—
—
40
100
20
ns
PIC18LFXXXX
ns VDD = 2.0V
ns
121
122
Tckrf
Tdtrf
Clock Out Rise Time and Fall Time PIC18FXXXX
(Master mode)
PIC18LFXXXX
50
ns VDD = 2.0V
ns
Data Out Rise Time and Fall Time
PIC18FXXXX
20
PIC18LFXXXX
50
ns VDD = 2.0V
FIGURE 22-12:
EUSART SYNCHRONOUS RECEIVE (MASTER/SLAVE) TIMING
RA2/TX/CK
pin
125
RA3/RX/DT
pin
126
Note: Refer to Figure 22-5 for load conditions.
TABLE 22-13: EUSART SYNCHRONOUS RECEIVE REQUIREMENTS
Param.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
No.
125
TdtV2ckl SYNC RCV (MASTER & SLAVE)
Data Hold before CK ↓ (DT hold time)
10
15
—
—
ns
ns
126
TckL2dtl
Data Hold after CK ↓ (DT hold time)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 283
PIC18F1230/1330
TABLE 22-14: A/D CONVERTER CHARACTERISTICS: PIC18F1230/1330 (INDUSTRIAL)
PIC18LF1230/1330 (INDUSTRIAL)
Param
No.
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Conditions
A01
NR
Resolution
—
—
—
—
—
—
10
< 1
< 1
< 1.5
< 1
bit ΔVREF ≥ 3.0V
A03
A04
A06
A07
A10
A20
EIL
Integral Linearity Error
Differential Linearity Error
Offset Error
—
LSb ΔVREF ≥ 3.0V
LSb ΔVREF ≥ 3.0V
LSb ΔVREF ≥ 3.0V
LSb ΔVREF ≥ 3.0V
EDL
EOFF
EGN
—
—
—
Gain Error
—
Monotonicity
Guaranteed(1)
—
VSS ≤ VAIN ≤ VREF
ΔVREF Reference Voltage Range
1.8
3
—
—
—
—
V
V
VDD < 3.0V
VDD ≥ 3.0V
(VREF+ – VSS)
A21
A25
A30
VREF+ Positive Reference Voltage
VSS
VSS
—
—
—
—
VREF+
VREF+
2.5
V
V
VAIN
ZAIN
Analog Input Voltage
Recommended Impedance of
Analog Voltage Source
kΩ
A50
IREF
VREF+ Input Current(2)
—
—
—
—
5
150
μA During VAIN acquisition.
μA During A/D conversion
cycle.
Note 1: The A/D conversion result never decreases with an increase in the input voltage and has no missing codes.
2: VREF+ current is from RA4/T0CKI/AN2/VREF+ pin or VDD, whichever is selected as the VREF+ source.
DS39758B-page 284
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
FIGURE 22-13:
A/D CONVERSION TIMING
BSF ADCON0, GO
(Note 2)
131
130
Q4
A/D CLK(1)
132
. . .
. . .
9
8
7
2
1
0
A/D DATA
ADRES
NEW_DATA
TCY
OLD_DATA
ADIF
GO
DONE
SAMPLING STOPPED
SAMPLE
Note 1: If the A/D clock source is selected as RC, a time of TCY is added before the A/D clock starts. This allows the SLEEPinstruction
to be executed.
2: This is a minimal RC delay (typically 100 ns), which also disconnects the holding capacitor from the analog input.
TABLE 22-15: A/D CONVERSION REQUIREMENTS
Param
Symbol
Characteristic
Min
Max
Units
Conditions
No.
130
TAD
A/D Clock Period
PIC18FXXXX
0.7
1.4
25.0(1)
25.0(1)
μs TOSC based, VREF ≥ 3.0V
PIC18LFXXXX
μs VDD = 2.0V,
TOSC based, VREF full range
PIC18FXXXX
TBD
TBD
11
1
3
μs A/D RC mode
μs VDD = 2.0V, A/D RC mode
TAD
PIC18LFXXXX
131
132
TCNV
TACQ
Conversion Time
12
(not including acquisition time)(2)
Acquisition Time(3)
1.4
TBD
—
—
μs -40°C to +85°C
μs
0°C ≤ to ≤ +85°C
135
TSWC
TDIS
Switching Time from Convert → Sample
—
(Note 4)
TBD
Discharge Time
0.2
—
μs
Legend: TBD = To Be Determined
Note 1: The time of the A/D clock period is dependent on the device frequency and the TAD clock divider.
2: ADRES register may be read on the following TCY cycle.
3: The time for the holding capacitor to acquire the “New” input voltage when the voltage changes full scale
after the conversion (VDD to VSS or VSS to VDD). The source impedance (RS) on the input channels is 50Ω.
4: On the following cycle of the device clock.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 285
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 286
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
23.0 DC AND AC
CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS
AND TABLES
Graphs and tables are not available at this time.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 287
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 288
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
24.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION
24.1 Package Marking Information
18-Lead PDIP
Example
e
3
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
PIC18F1330-I/P
0510017
18-Lead SOIC
Example
XXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXXX
PIC18F1230-
E/SO
e
3
0510017
YYWWNNN
20-Lead SSOP
Example
XXXXXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXXXXX
PIC18F1230-
e
3
E/SS
0510017
YYWWNNN
28-Lead QFN
Example
XXXXXXXX
XXXXXXXX
YYWWNNN
18F1330
-I/ML
0510017
e
3
Legend: XX...X Customer-specific information
Y
Year code (last digit of calendar year)
YY
Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year)
WW
NNN
e
Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’)
Alphanumeric traceability code
Pb-free JEDEC designator for Matte Tin (Sn)
This package is Pb-free. The Pb-free JEDEC designator (
can be found on the outer packaging for this package.
3
*
)
3
e
Note: In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will
be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available
characters for customer-specific information.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 289
PIC18F1230/1330
24.2 Package Details
The following sections give the technical details of the
packages.
18-Lead Plastic Dual In-line (P) – 300 mil Body (PDIP)
E1
D
2
α
n
1
E
A2
L
A
c
A1
B1
β
p
B
eB
Units
Dimension Limits
INCHES*
NOM
18
MILLIMETERS
MIN
MAX
MIN
NOM
18
MAX
n
p
Number of Pins
Pitch
.100
.155
.130
2.54
Top to Seating Plane
A
.140
.170
3.56
2.92
3.94
3.30
4.32
Molded Package Thickness
Base to Seating Plane
Shoulder to Shoulder Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
A2
A1
E
.115
.015
.300
.240
.890
.125
.008
.045
.014
.310
5
.145
3.68
0.38
7.62
6.10
22.61
3.18
0.20
1.14
0.36
7.87
5
.313
.250
.898
.130
.012
.058
.018
.370
10
.325
.260
.905
.135
.015
.070
.022
.430
15
7.94
6.35
22.80
3.30
0.29
1.46
0.46
9.40
10
8.26
6.60
22.99
3.43
0.38
1.78
0.56
10.92
15
E1
D
Tip to Seating Plane
Lead Thickness
L
c
Upper Lead Width
Lower Lead Width
B1
B
Overall Row Spacing
Mold Draft Angle Top
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
§
eB
α
β
5
10
15
5
10
15
* Controlling Parameter
§ Significant Characteristic
Notes:
Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed .010” (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-001
Drawing No. C04-007
DS39758B-page 290
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
18-Lead Plastic Small Outline (SO) – Wide, 300 mil Body (SOIC)
E
p
E1
D
2
1
B
n
h
α
45°
c
A2
A
φ
β
L
A1
Units
Dimension Limits
INCHES*
NOM
18
MILLIMETERS
MIN
MAX
MIN
NOM
18
MAX
n
p
Number of Pins
Pitch
Overall Height
.050
.099
.091
.008
.407
.295
.454
.020
.033
4
1.27
A
.093
.104
2.36
2.24
2.50
2.31
0.20
10.34
7.49
11.53
0.50
0.84
4
2.64
2.39
0.30
10.67
7.59
11.73
0.74
1.27
8
Molded Package Thickness
Standoff
A2
A1
E
.088
.004
.394
.291
.446
.010
.016
0
.094
.012
.420
.299
.462
.029
.050
8
§
0.10
10.01
7.39
11.33
0.25
0.41
0
Overall Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
Chamfer Distance
Foot Length
E1
D
h
L
φ
Foot Angle
c
Lead Thickness
Lead Width
.009
.014
0
.011
.017
12
.012
.020
15
0.23
0.36
0
0.27
0.42
12
0.30
0.51
15
B
α
β
Mold Draft Angle Top
Mold Draft Angle Bottom
0
12
15
0
12
15
* Controlling Parameter
§ Significant Characteristic
Notes:
Dimensions D and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 010” (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MS-013
Drawing No. C04-051
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 291
PIC18F1230/1330
20-Lead Plastic Shrink Small Outline (SS) – 209 mil Body, 5.30 mm (SSOP)
E
E1
p
D
B
2
1
n
c
A
A2
φ
A1
L
MILLIMETERS*
Units
Dimension Limits
n
INCHES
NOM
20
MIN
MAX
MIN
NOM
20
.065
MAX
Number of Pins
Pitch
p
.026
A
–
Overall Height
Molded Package Thickness
Standoff
–
.079
–
2.00
1.85
–
–
A2
A1
E
.069
–
1.65
0.05
7.40
5.00
6.90
0.55
0.09
0°
.065
.002
.291
.197
.073
–
1.75
–
.323
.220
.295
0.37
.010
8°
Overall Width
Molded Package Width
Overall Length
Foot Length
7.80
5.30
8.20
5.60
7.50
0.95
0.25
8°
.307
.209
.283
0.30
–
E1
D
7.20
0.75
–
.272
0.22
.004
0°
L
Lead Thickness
Foot Angle
c
φ
4°
–
4°
–
0.38
.015
.009
0.22
Lead Width
B
* Controlling Parameter
Notes:
Dimensions D and E1 do no include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 010" (0.254mm) per side.
JEDEC Equivalent: MO-150
Drawing No. C04-072
Revised 8-27-04
DS39758B-page 292
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
28-Lead Plastic Quad Flat No Lead Package (ML) 6x6 mm Body (QFN) –
With 0.55 mm Contact Length (Saw Singulated)
E
E2
EXPOSED
METAL
PAD
(NOTE 2)
e
b
D
D2
2
1
K
n
OPTIONAL
INDEX
AREA
ALTERNATE
INDEX
INDICATORS
SEE DETAIL
L
TOP VIEW
BOTTOM VIEW
(NOTE 1)
A1
A
DETAIL
ALTERNATE
PAD OUTLINE
Units
INCHES
NOM
MILLIMETERS
NOM
28
*
Dimension Limits
MIN
MAX
MIN
MAX
n
e
Number of Pins
Pitch
28
.026 BSC
0.65 BSC
0.90
Overall Height
Standoff
A
A1
A3
E
.031
.035
.001
.039
0.80
1.00
.000
.002
0.00
0.02
0.05
Contact Thickness
Overall Width
Exposed Pad Width
Overall Length
Exposed Pad Length
Contact Width
Contact Length §
.008 REF
0.20 REF
6.00
.232
.153
.232
.153
.009
.018
.008
.236
.167
.236
.167
.011
.022
–
.240
.169
.240
.169
.013
.024
–
5.90
3.89
5.90
3.89
0.23
0.45
0.20
6.10
4.29
6.10
4.29
0.33
0.65
–
E2
D
4.24
6.00
D2
β
4.24
0.28
L
0.55
Contact-to-Exposed Pad
§
K
–
*
Controlling Parameter
§
Significant Characteristic
Notes:
1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area.
2. Exposed pad varies according to die attach paddle size.
BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances.
See ASME Y14.5M
REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only.
See ASME Y14.5M
JEDEC equivalent: MO-220
Drawing No. C04-105
Revised 09-12-05
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 293
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 294
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
APPENDIX A: REVISION HISTORY
APPENDIX B: DEVICE
DIFFERENCES
Revision A (November 2005)
The differences between the devices listed in this data
sheet are shown in Table B-1.
Original data sheet for PIC18F1230/1330 devices.
Revision B (February 2006)
Data bank information was updated and a note was
added for calculating the PCPWM duty cycle.
TABLE B-1:
DEVICE DIFFERENCES
Features
PIC18F1230
PIC18F1330
Program Memory (Bytes)
Program Memory (Instructions)
Packages
4096
2048
8192
4096
18-pin PDIP
18-pin SOIC
20-pin SSOP
28-pin QFN
18-pin PDIP
18-pin SOIC
20-pin SSOP
28-pin QFN
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 295
PIC18F1230/1330
APPENDIX C: CONVERSION
CONSIDERATIONS
APPENDIX D: MIGRATION FROM
BASELINE TO
ENHANCED DEVICES
This appendix discusses the considerations for
converting from previous versions of a device to the
ones listed in this data sheet. Typically, these changes
are due to the differences in the process technology
used. An example of this type of conversion is from a
PIC16C74A to a PIC16C74B.
This section discusses how to migrate from a Baseline
device (i.e., PIC16C5X) to an Enhanced MCU device
(i.e., PIC18FXXX).
The following are the list of modifications over the
PIC16C5X microcontroller family:
Not Applicable
Not Currently Available
DS39758B-page 296
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
APPENDIX E: MIGRATION FROM
MID-RANGE TO
APPENDIX F: MIGRATION FROM
HIGH-END TO
ENHANCED DEVICES
ENHANCED DEVICES
A detailed discussion of the differences between the
mid-range MCU devices (i.e., PIC16CXXX) and the
Enhanced devices (i.e., PIC18FXXX) is provided in
AN716, “Migrating Designs from PIC16C74A/74B to
PIC18C442”. The changes discussed, while device
specific, are generally applicable to all mid-range to
Enhanced device migrations.
A detailed discussion of the migration pathway and
differences between the high-end MCU devices (i.e.,
PIC17CXXX) and the Enhanced devices (i.e.,
PIC18FXXX) is provided in AN726, “PIC17CXXX to
PIC18CXXX Migration”.
This Application Note is available as Literature Number
DS00726.
This Application Note is available as Literature Number
DS00716.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 297
PIC18F1230/1330
NOTES:
DS39758B-page 298
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
INDEX
Device Clock .............................................................. 20
EUSART Receive .................................................... 154
EUSART Transmit ................................................... 152
External Power-on Reset Circuit
A
A/D ................................................................................... 164
A/D Converter Interrupt, Configuring ....................... 168
Acquisition Requirements ........................................ 169
ADCON0 Register .................................................... 164
ADCON1 Register .................................................... 164
ADCON2 Register .................................................... 164
ADRESH Register ............................................ 164, 167
ADRESL Register .................................................... 164
Analog Port Pins, Configuring .................................. 171
Associated Registers ............................................... 173
Configuring the Module ............................................ 168
Conversion Clock (TAD) ........................................... 170
Conversion Requirements ....................................... 286
Conversion Status (GO/DONE Bit) .......................... 167
Conversions ............................................................. 172
Converter Characteristics ........................................ 285
Discharge ................................................................. 172
Operation in Power-Managed Modes ...................... 171
Selecting and Configuring Acquisition Time ............ 170
Triggering Conversions ............................................ 169
Absolute Maximum Ratings ............................................. 258
AC (Timing) Characteristics ............................................. 277
Conditions ................................................................ 278
Load Conditions for Device
(Slow VDD Power-up) ........................................ 35
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ........................................... 198
Generic I/O Port ......................................................... 81
Interrupt Logic ............................................................ 88
Low-Voltage Detect ................................................. 181
On-Chip Reset Circuit ................................................ 33
PIC18F1230/1330 ..................................................... 10
PLL (HS Mode) .......................................................... 17
Power Control PWM ................................................ 112
PWM (One Output Pair,
Complementary Mode) .................................... 113
PWM (One Output Pair,
Independent Mode) ......................................... 113
PWM I/O Pin ............................................................ 136
PWM Time Base ...................................................... 115
Reads from Flash Program Memory ......................... 69
Single Comparator ................................................... 175
Table Read Operation ............................................... 65
Table Write Operation ............................................... 66
Table Writes to Flash Program Memory .................... 71
Timer0 in 16-Bit Mode ............................................. 102
Timer0 in 8-Bit Mode ............................................... 102
Timer1 ..................................................................... 106
Timer1 (16-Bit Read/Write Mode) ............................ 106
Watchdog Timer ...................................................... 195
BN .................................................................................... 217
BNC ................................................................................. 218
BNN ................................................................................. 218
BNOV .............................................................................. 219
BNZ ................................................................................. 219
BOR. See Brown-out Reset.
Timing Specifications ....................................... 278
Parameter Symbology ............................................. 277
Temperature and Voltage Specifications ................. 278
AC Characteristics
Internal RC Accuracy ............................................... 280
Access Bank
Mapping with Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing Mode ............................................... 63
Remapping with Indexed Literal Offset
Addressing Mode ............................................... 63
ADCON0 Register ............................................................ 164
GO/DONE Bit ........................................................... 167
ADCON1 Register ............................................................ 164
ADCON2 Register ............................................................ 164
ADDFSR .......................................................................... 251
ADDLW ............................................................................ 214
ADDULNK ........................................................................ 251
ADDWF ............................................................................ 214
ADDWFC ......................................................................... 215
ADRESH Register ............................................................ 164
ADRESL Register .................................................... 164, 167
Analog-to-Digital Converter. See A/D.
BOV ................................................................................. 222
BRA ................................................................................. 220
Brown-out Reset (BOR) ..................................................... 36
Detecting ................................................................... 36
Disabling in Sleep Mode ............................................ 36
Software Enabled ...................................................... 36
BSF .................................................................................. 220
BTFSC ............................................................................. 221
BTFSS ............................................................................. 221
BTG ................................................................................. 222
BZ .................................................................................... 223
C
ANDLW ............................................................................ 215
ANDWF ............................................................................ 216
Assembler
C Compilers
MPLAB C18 ............................................................. 205
MPLAB C30 ............................................................. 205
CALL ................................................................................ 223
CALLW ............................................................................ 252
Clock Sources .................................................................... 20
Selecting the 31 kHz Source ..................................... 21
Selection Using OSCCON Register .......................... 21
CLRF ............................................................................... 224
CLRWDT ......................................................................... 224
MPASM Assembler .................................................. 205
B
BC .................................................................................... 216
BCF .................................................................................. 217
Block Diagrams
A/D ........................................................................... 167
Analog Input Model .................................................. 168
Comparator Analog Input Model .............................. 176
Comparator Voltage Reference ............................... 179
Dead-Time Control Unit for
One PWM Output Pair ..................................... 129
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 299
PIC18F1230/1330
Code Examples
Data EEPROM Memory ..................................................... 75
Associated Registers ................................................. 78
EEADR Register ........................................................ 75
EECON1 and EECON2 Registers ............................. 75
Operation During Code-Protect ................................. 78
Protection Against Spurious Write ............................. 77
Reading ..................................................................... 77
Using ......................................................................... 78
Write Verify ................................................................ 77
Writing ....................................................................... 77
Data Memory ..................................................................... 51
Access Bank .............................................................. 53
and the Extended Instruction Set .............................. 61
Bank Select Register (BSR) ...................................... 51
General Purpose Registers ....................................... 53
Map for PIC18F1230/1330 ........................................ 52
Special Function Registers ........................................ 54
DAW ................................................................................ 227
DC and AC Characteristics
16 x 16 Signed Multiply Routine ................................80
16 x 16 Unsigned Multiply Routine ............................80
8 x 8 Signed Multiply Routine ....................................79
8 x 8 Unsigned Multiply Routine ................................79
Computed GOTO Using an Offset Value ...................48
Data EEPROM Read .................................................77
Data EEPROM Refresh Routine ................................78
Data EEPROM Write .................................................77
Erasing a Flash Program Memory Row .....................70
Fast Register Stack ....................................................48
How to Clear RAM (Bank 0) Using
Indirect Addressing ............................................59
Implementing a Real-Time Clock Using
a Timer1 Interrupt Service ...............................109
Initializing PORTA ......................................................81
Initializing PORTB ......................................................84
Reading a Flash Program Memory Word ..................69
Saving STATUS, WREG and
BSR Registers in RAM .......................................99
Writing to Flash Program Memory ....................... 72–73
Code Protection ....................................................... 184, 200
Associated Registers ...............................................200
Configuration Register Protection ............................203
Data EEPROM .........................................................203
Program Memory .....................................................201
COMF ...............................................................................225
Comparator ......................................................................174
Analog Input Connection Considerations .................176
Associated Registers ...............................................177
Configuration ............................................................175
Effects of a Reset .....................................................176
Interrupts ..................................................................175
Operation .................................................................175
Operation During Sleep ...........................................176
Outputs ....................................................................175
Reference ................................................................175
Response Time ........................................................175
Comparator Specifications ...............................................275
Comparator Voltage Reference .......................................178
Accuracy and Error ..................................................179
Associated Registers ...............................................179
Configuring ...............................................................178
Effects of a Reset .....................................................179
Operation During Sleep ...........................................179
Computed GOTO ...............................................................48
Configuration Bits .............................................................184
Context Saving During Interrupts .......................................99
Conversion Considerations ..............................................297
CPFSEQ ..........................................................................225
CPFSGT ...........................................................................226
CPFSLT ...........................................................................226
Crystal Oscillator/Ceramic Resonator ................................15
Customer Change Notification Service ............................307
Customer Notification Service ..........................................307
Customer Support ............................................................307
Graphs and Tables .................................................. 288
DC Characteristics ........................................................... 272
Power-Down and Supply Current ............................ 262
Supply Voltage ........................................................ 261
DCFSNZ .......................................................................... 228
DECF ............................................................................... 227
DECFSZ .......................................................................... 228
Development Support ...................................................... 204
Device Differences ........................................................... 296
Device Overview .................................................................. 7
Details on Individual
Family Members .................................................. 8
Features (table) ........................................................... 9
New Core Features ...................................................... 7
Other Special Features ................................................ 8
Device Reset Timers ......................................................... 37
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ................................. 37
PLL Lock Time-out ..................................................... 37
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ........................................... 37
Time-out Sequence ................................................... 37
Direct Addressing .............................................................. 60
E
Effect on Standard PIC MCU Instructions ....................... 255
Effects of Power-Managed Modes on
Various Clock Sources .............................................. 23
Electrical Characteristics ................................................. 258
Enhanced Universal Synchronous Asynchronous
Receiver Transmitter (EUSART). See EUSART.
Equations
A/D Acquisition Time ............................................... 169
A/D Minimum Charging Time ................................... 169
Calculating the Minimum Required
Acquisition Time .............................................. 169
PWM Frequency ...................................................... 123
PWM Period for Continuous
Up/Down Count Mode ..................................... 123
PWM Period for Free-Running Mode ...................... 123
PWM Resolution ...................................................... 123
Errata ................................................................................... 5
D
Data Addressing Modes .....................................................59
Comparing Options with the
Extended Instruction Set Enabled ......................62
Direct ..........................................................................59
Indexed Literal Offset .................................................61
Instructions Affected ..........................................61
Indirect .......................................................................59
Inherent and Literal ....................................................59
DS39758B-page 300
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
EUSART
Asynchronous Mode ................................................ 151
Table Pointer Boundaries .......................................... 68
Table Reads and Table Writes .................................. 65
Write Sequence ......................................................... 71
Writing ....................................................................... 71
Protection Against Spurious Writes ................... 73
Unexpected Termination ................................... 73
Write Verify ........................................................ 73
FSCM. See Fail-Safe Clock Monitor.
12-Bit Break Character Sequence ................... 157
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 155
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 153
Auto-Wake-up on Sync Break Character ......... 155
Receiver ........................................................... 154
Receiving a Break Character ........................... 157
Setting Up 9-Bit Mode with
G
Address Detect ........................................ 154
GOTO .............................................................................. 229
Transmitter ....................................................... 151
Baud Rate Generator
H
Operation in Power-Managed Modes .............. 145
Baud Rate Generator (BRG) .................................... 145
Associated Registers ....................................... 146
Auto-Baud Rate Detect .................................... 149
Baud Rate Error, Calculating ........................... 146
Baud Rates, Asynchronous Modes ................. 147
High Baud Rate Select (BRGH Bit) ................. 145
Sampling .......................................................... 145
Synchronous Master Mode ...................................... 158
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 160
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 159
Reception ......................................................... 160
Transmission ................................................... 158
Synchronous Slave Mode ........................................ 161
Associated Registers, Receive ........................ 162
Associated Registers, Transmit ....................... 161
Reception ......................................................... 162
Transmission ................................................... 161
Extended Instruction Set
ADDFSR .................................................................. 251
ADDULNK ................................................................ 251
and Using MPLAB Tools .......................................... 257
CALLW ..................................................................... 252
Considerations for Use ............................................ 255
MOVSF .................................................................... 252
MOVSS .................................................................... 253
PUSHL ..................................................................... 253
SUBFSR .................................................................. 254
SUBULNK ................................................................ 254
Syntax ...................................................................... 250
External Clock Input ........................................................... 16
Hardware Multiplier ............................................................ 79
Introduction ................................................................ 79
Operation ................................................................... 79
Performance Comparison .......................................... 79
I
I/O Ports ............................................................................ 81
ID Locations ............................................................. 184, 203
INCF ................................................................................ 229
INCFSZ ............................................................................ 230
In-Circuit Debugger .......................................................... 203
In-Circuit Serial Programming (ICSP) ...................... 184, 203
Independent PWM Mode
Duty Cycle Assignment ........................................... 131
Output ...................................................................... 131
Output, Channel Override ........................................ 132
Indexed Literal Offset Addressing
and Standard PIC18 Instructions ............................. 255
Indexed Literal Offset Mode ............................................. 255
Indirect Addressing ............................................................ 60
INFSNZ ............................................................................ 230
Initialization Conditions for all Registers ...................... 41–44
Instruction Cycle ................................................................ 49
Clocking Scheme ....................................................... 49
Flow/Pipelining .......................................................... 49
Instruction Set .................................................................. 208
ADDLW .................................................................... 214
ADDWF ................................................................... 214
ADDWF (Indexed Literal Offset Mode) .................... 256
ADDWFC ................................................................. 215
ANDLW .................................................................... 215
ANDWF ................................................................... 216
BC ............................................................................ 216
BCF ......................................................................... 217
BN ............................................................................ 217
BNC ......................................................................... 218
BNN ......................................................................... 218
BNOV ...................................................................... 219
BNZ ......................................................................... 219
BOV ......................................................................... 222
BRA ......................................................................... 220
BSF .......................................................................... 220
BSF (Indexed Literal Offset Mode) .......................... 256
BTFSC ..................................................................... 221
BTFSS ..................................................................... 221
BTG ......................................................................... 222
BZ ............................................................................ 223
CALL ........................................................................ 223
CLRF ....................................................................... 224
CLRWDT ................................................................. 224
COMF ...................................................................... 225
CPFSEQ .................................................................. 225
CPFSGT .................................................................. 226
F
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ............................................ 184, 198
Exiting Operation ..................................................... 198
Interrupts in Power-Managed Modes ....................... 199
POR or Wake from Sleep ........................................ 199
WDT During Oscillator Failure ................................. 198
Fast Register Stack ............................................................ 48
Firmware Instructions ....................................................... 208
Flash Program Memory ..................................................... 65
Associated Registers ................................................. 73
Control Registers ....................................................... 66
EECON1 and EECON2 ..................................... 66
TABLAT (Table Latch) Register ......................... 68
TBLPTR (Table Pointer) Register ...................... 68
Erase Sequence ........................................................ 70
Erasing ....................................................................... 70
Operation During Code-Protect ................................. 73
Reading ...................................................................... 69
Table Pointer
Boundaries Based on Operation ........................ 68
Operations with TBLRD
and TBLWT (table) .................................... 68
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 301
PIC18F1230/1330
CPFSLT ...................................................................226
DAW .........................................................................227
DCFSNZ ..................................................................228
DECF .......................................................................227
DECFSZ ...................................................................228
Extended Instruction Set ..........................................250
General Format ........................................................210
GOTO ......................................................................229
INCF .........................................................................229
INCFSZ ....................................................................230
INFSNZ ....................................................................230
IORLW .....................................................................231
IORWF .....................................................................231
LFSR ........................................................................232
MOVF .......................................................................232
MOVFF ....................................................................233
MOVLB ....................................................................233
MOVLW ...................................................................234
MOVWF ...................................................................234
MULLW ....................................................................235
MULWF ....................................................................235
NEGF .......................................................................236
NOP .........................................................................236
Opcode Field Descriptions .......................................209
POP .........................................................................237
PUSH .......................................................................237
RCALL .....................................................................238
RESET .....................................................................238
RETFIE ....................................................................239
RETLW ....................................................................239
RETURN ..................................................................240
RLCF ........................................................................240
RLNCF .....................................................................241
RRCF .......................................................................241
RRNCF ....................................................................242
SETF ........................................................................242
SETF (Indexed Literal Offset Mode) ........................256
SLEEP .....................................................................243
Standard Instructions ...............................................208
SUBFWB ..................................................................243
SUBLW ....................................................................244
SUBWF ....................................................................244
SUBWFB ..................................................................245
SWAPF ....................................................................245
TBLRD .....................................................................246
TBLWT .....................................................................247
TSTFSZ ...................................................................248
XORLW ....................................................................248
XORWF ....................................................................249
INTCON Registers ....................................................... 89–91
Internal Oscillator Block .....................................................18
Adjustment .................................................................18
INTIO Modes ..............................................................18
INTOSC Frequency Drift ............................................18
INTOSC Output Frequency ........................................18
OSCTUNE Register ...................................................18
PLL in INTOSC Modes ..............................................18
Internal RC Oscillator
Interrupt Sources ............................................................. 184
A/D Conversion Complete ....................................... 168
INTn Pin ..................................................................... 99
PORTB, Interrupt-on-Change .................................... 99
TMR0 ......................................................................... 99
TMR1 Overflow ........................................................ 105
Interrupts ............................................................................ 87
Interrupts, Flag Bits
Interrupt-on-Change Flag (RBIF Bit) .......................... 84
INTOSC, INTRC. See Internal Oscillator Block.
IORLW ............................................................................. 231
IORWF ............................................................................. 231
IPR Registers ..................................................................... 96
L
LFSR ................................................................................ 232
Low-Voltage Detect ......................................................... 180
Applications ............................................................. 183
Associated Registers ............................................... 183
Characteristics ......................................................... 276
Current Consumption ............................................... 182
Effects of a Reset .................................................... 183
Operation ................................................................. 181
During Sleep .................................................... 183
Setup ....................................................................... 182
Start-up Time ........................................................... 182
Typical Application ................................................... 183
Low-Voltage ICSP Programming.
See Single-Supply ICSP Programming.
LVD. See Low-Voltage Detect.
M
Master Clear (MCLR) ......................................................... 35
Memory Organization ........................................................ 45
Data Memory ............................................................. 51
Program Memory ....................................................... 45
Memory Programming Requirements .............................. 274
Microchip Internet Web Site ............................................. 307
Migration from Baseline to Enhanced Devices ................ 297
Migration from High-End to Enhanced Devices ............... 298
Migration from Mid-Range to Enhanced Devices ............ 298
MOVF .............................................................................. 232
MOVFF ............................................................................ 233
MOVLB ............................................................................ 233
MOVLW ........................................................................... 234
MOVSF ............................................................................ 252
MOVSS ............................................................................ 253
MOVWF ........................................................................... 234
MPLAB ASM30 Assembler, Linker, Librarian .................. 205
MPLAB ICD 2 In-Circuit Debugger .................................. 206
MPLAB ICE 2000 High-Performance
Universal In-Circuit Emulator ................................... 206
MPLAB ICE 4000 High-Performance
Universal In-Circuit Emulator ................................... 206
MPLAB Integrated Development
Environment Software ............................................. 204
MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer ................................... 206
MPLINK Object Linker/MPLIB Object Librarian ............... 205
MULLW ............................................................................ 235
MULWF ............................................................................ 235
Use with WDT ..........................................................195
Internet Address ...............................................................307
DS39758B-page 302
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
PORTB
N
Associated Registers ................................................. 86
Interrupt-on-Change Flag (RBIF Bit) ......................... 84
LATB Register ........................................................... 84
PORTB Register ........................................................ 84
TRISB Register .......................................................... 84
Power Control PWM ........................................................ 111
Associated Registers ............................................... 139
Control Registers ..................................................... 114
Functionality ............................................................ 114
Power-Managed Modes ..................................................... 25
and A/D Operation ................................................... 171
Clock Sources ........................................................... 25
Clock Transitions and Status Indicators .................... 26
Effects on Clock Sources .......................................... 23
Entering ..................................................................... 25
Exiting Idle and Sleep Modes .................................... 31
By Interrupt ........................................................ 31
By Reset ............................................................ 31
By WDT Time-out .............................................. 31
Without an Oscillator Start-up Delay ................. 32
Idle Modes ................................................................. 29
PRI_IDLE .......................................................... 30
RC_IDLE ........................................................... 31
SEC_IDLE ......................................................... 30
Multiple Sleep Commands ......................................... 26
Run Modes ................................................................ 26
PRI_RUN ........................................................... 26
RC_RUN ............................................................ 27
SEC_RUN ......................................................... 26
Selecting .................................................................... 25
Sleep Mode ............................................................... 29
Summary (table) ........................................................ 25
Power-on Reset (POR) ...................................................... 35
Time-out Sequence ................................................... 37
Power-up Delays ............................................................... 23
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ................................................... 23
Prescaler, Timer0 ............................................................ 103
PRI_IDLE Mode ................................................................. 30
PRI_RUN Mode ................................................................. 26
Program Counter ............................................................... 46
PCL, PCH and PCU Registers .................................. 46
PCLATH and PCLATU Registers .............................. 46
Program Memory
NEGF ............................................................................... 236
NOP ................................................................................. 236
O
Oscillator Configuration ...................................................... 15
EC .............................................................................. 15
ECIO .......................................................................... 15
HS .............................................................................. 15
HSPLL ........................................................................ 15
Internal Oscillator Block ............................................. 18
INTIO1 ....................................................................... 15
INTIO2 ....................................................................... 15
LP ............................................................................... 15
RC .............................................................................. 15
RCIO .......................................................................... 15
XT .............................................................................. 15
Oscillator Selection .......................................................... 184
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ................................... 23, 37
Oscillator Switching ............................................................ 20
Oscillator Transitions ......................................................... 21
Oscillator, Timer1 ............................................................. 105
P
Packaging ........................................................................ 290
Details ...................................................................... 291
Marking Information ................................................. 290
PICSTART Plus Development Programmer .................... 207
PIE Registers ..................................................................... 94
Pin Functions
AVDD .......................................................................... 14
AVSS .......................................................................... 14
MCLR/VPP/RA5/FLTA ................................................ 11
NC .............................................................................. 14
RA0/AN0/INT0/KBI0/CMP0 ....................................... 12
RA1/AN1/INT1/KBI1 .................................................. 12
RA2/TX/CK ................................................................ 12
RA3/RX/DT ................................................................ 12
RA4/T0CKI/AN2//VREF+ ............................................. 12
RA6/OSC2/CLKO/T1OSO/T1CKI/AN3 ...................... 11
RA7/OSC1/CLKI/T1OSI/FLTA ................................... 11
RB0/PWM0 ................................................................ 13
RB1/PWM1 ................................................................ 13
RB2/INT2/KBI2/CMP2/T1OSO/T1CKI ....................... 13
RB3/INT3/KBI3/CMP1/T1OSI .................................... 13
RB4/PWM2 ................................................................ 13
RB5/PWM3 ................................................................ 13
RB6/PWM4/PGC ....................................................... 13
RB7/PWM5/PGD ....................................................... 13
VDD ............................................................................ 14
VSS ............................................................................. 14
Pinout I/O Descriptions
and Extended Instruction Set .................................... 63
Instructions ................................................................ 50
Two-Word .......................................................... 50
Interrupt Vector .......................................................... 45
Look-up Tables .......................................................... 48
Map and Stack (diagram) .......................................... 45
Reset Vector .............................................................. 45
Program Verification ........................................................ 200
Programming, Device Instructions ................................... 208
PUSH ............................................................................... 237
PUSH and POP Instructions .............................................. 47
PUSHL ............................................................................. 253
PWM
PIC18F1230/1330 ...................................................... 11
PIR Registers ..................................................................... 92
PLL Frequency Multiplier ................................................... 17
HSPLL Oscillator Mode .............................................. 17
Use with INTOSC ....................................................... 17
POP ................................................................................. 237
POR. See Power-on Reset.
Fault Input ................................................................ 136
Output and Polarity Control ..................................... 135
Single-Pulse Operation ............................................ 132
Special Event Trigger .............................................. 138
Update Lockout ....................................................... 138
PORTA
Associated Registers ................................................. 83
LATA Register ............................................................ 81
PORTA Register ........................................................ 81
TRISA Register .......................................................... 81
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 303
PIC18F1230/1330
PWM Dead Time
EECON1 (EEPROM Control 1) ........................... 67, 76
FLTCONFIG (Fault Configuration) ........................... 137
INTCON (Interrupt Control) ........................................ 89
INTCON2 (Interrupt Control 2) ................................... 90
INTCON3 (Interrupt Control 3) ................................... 91
IPR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Priority 1) ......................... 96
IPR2 (Peripheral Interrupt Priority 2) ......................... 97
IPR3 (Peripheral Interrupt Priority 3) ......................... 97
LVDCON (Low-Voltage Detect Control) .................. 180
OSCCON (Oscillator Control) .................................... 22
OSCTUNE (Oscillator Tuning) ................................... 19
OVDCOND (Output Override Control) ..................... 134
OVDCONS (Output State) ....................................... 134
PIE1 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 1) .......................... 94
PIE2 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 2) .......................... 95
PIE3 (Peripheral Interrupt Enable 3) .......................... 95
PIR1 (Peripheral Interrupt Request (Flag) 1) ............. 92
PIR2 (Peripheral Interrupt Request (Flag) 2) ............. 93
PIR3 (Peripheral Interrupt Request (Flag) 3) ............. 93
PTCON0 (PWM Timer Control 0) ............................ 116
PTCON1 (PWM Timer Control 1) ............................ 116
PWMCON0 (PWM Control 0) .................................. 117
PWMCON1 (PWM Control 1) .................................. 118
RCON (Reset Control) ......................................... 34, 98
RCSTA (Receive Status and Control) ..................... 143
STATUS .................................................................... 58
STKPTR (Stack Pointer) ............................................ 47
T0CON (Timer0 Control) ......................................... 101
T1CON (Timer1 Control) ......................................... 105
TXSTA (Transmit Status and Control) ..................... 142
WDTCON (Watchdog Timer Control) ...................... 196
RESET ............................................................................. 238
Reset State of Registers .................................................... 40
Resets ........................................................................ 33, 184
Brown-out Reset (BOR) ........................................... 184
Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST) ............................... 184
Power-on Reset (POR) ............................................ 184
Power-up Timer (PWRT) ......................................... 184
RETFIE ............................................................................ 239
RETLW ............................................................................ 239
RETURN .......................................................................... 240
Return Address Stack ........................................................ 46
Associated Registers ................................................. 46
Return Stack Pointer (STKPTR) ........................................ 47
Revision History ............................................................... 296
RLCF ............................................................................... 240
RLNCF ............................................................................. 241
RRCF ............................................................................... 241
RRNCF ............................................................................ 242
Decrementing the Counter .......................................130
Distortion ..................................................................131
Generators ...............................................................129
Insertion ...................................................................129
Ranges .....................................................................130
PWM Duty Cycle ..............................................................125
Center-Aligned .........................................................127
Complementary Operation .......................................128
Edge-Aligned ...........................................................126
Register Buffers .......................................................126
Registers ..................................................................125
PWM Output Override ......................................................132
Complementary Mode ..............................................132
Examples .................................................................134
Synchronization .......................................................132
PWM Period .....................................................................123
PWM Time Base ..............................................................114
Continuous Up/Down Count Modes .........................119
Free-Running Mode .................................................119
Interrupts ..................................................................119
In Continuous Up/Down Count Mode ..............120
In Double Update Mode ...................................122
In Free-Running Mode .....................................119
In Single-Shot Mode ........................................120
Postscaler ................................................................119
Prescaler ..................................................................119
Single-Shot Mode ....................................................119
R
RAM. See Data Memory.
RBIF Bit ..............................................................................84
RC Oscillator ......................................................................17
RCIO Oscillator Mode ................................................17
RC_IDLE Mode ..................................................................31
RC_RUN Mode ..................................................................27
RCALL ..............................................................................238
RCON Register
Bit Status During Initialization ....................................40
Reader Response ............................................................308
Register File Summary ................................................. 55–57
Registers
ADCON0 (A/D Control 0) .........................................164
ADCON1 (A/D Control 1) .........................................165
ADCON2 (A/D Control 2) .........................................166
BAUDCON (Baud Rate Control) ..............................144
CMCON (Comparator Control) ................................174
CONFIG1H (Configuration 1 High) ..........................185
CONFIG2H (Configuration 2 High) ..........................187
CONFIG2L (Configuration 2 Low) ............................186
CONFIG3H (Configuration 3 High) ..........................189
CONFIG3L (Configuration 3 Low) ............................188
CONFIG4L (Configuration 4 Low) ............................190
CONFIG5H (Configuration 5 High) ..........................191
CONFIG5L (Configuration 5 Low) ............................191
CONFIG6H (Configuration 6 High) ..........................192
CONFIG6L (Configuration 6 Low) ............................192
CONFIG7H (Configuration 7 High) ..........................193
CONFIG7L (Configuration 7 Low) ............................193
CVRCON (Comparator Voltage
S
SEC_IDLE Mode ............................................................... 30
SEC_RUN Mode ................................................................ 26
SETF ................................................................................ 242
Single-Supply ICSP Programming ................................... 203
SLEEP ............................................................................. 243
Sleep
OSC1 and OSC2 Pin States ...................................... 23
Software Simulator (MPLAB SIM) ................................... 205
Special Features of the CPU ........................................... 184
Special Function Registers
Reference Control) ...........................................178
DEVID1 (Device ID 1) ..............................................194
DEVID2 (Device ID 2) ..............................................194
DTCON (Dead-Time Control) ..................................130
Map ............................................................................ 54
Stack Full/Underflow Resets .............................................. 48
SUBFSR .......................................................................... 254
DS39758B-page 304
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
SUBFWB .......................................................................... 243
SUBLW ............................................................................ 244
SUBULNK ........................................................................ 254
SUBWF ............................................................................ 244
SUBWFB .......................................................................... 245
SWAPF ............................................................................ 245
PWM Period Buffer Updates in Continuous
Up/Down Count Modes ................................... 124
PWM Period Buffer Updates in
Free-Running Mode ......................................... 124
PWM Time Base Interrupt
(Free-Running Mode) ...................................... 120
PWM Time Base Interrupt (Single-Shot Mode) ....... 121
PWM Time Base Interrupts (Continuous Up/Down
Count Mode with Double Updates) .................. 122
PWM Time Base Interrupts (Continuous
T
Table Reads/Table Writes ................................................. 48
TBLRD ............................................................................. 246
TBLWT ............................................................................. 247
Time-out in Various Situations (table) ................................ 37
Timer0 .............................................................................. 101
16-Bit Mode Timer Reads and Writes ...................... 103
Associated Registers ............................................... 103
Clock Source Edge Select (T0SE Bit) ...................... 103
Clock Source Select (T0CS Bit) ............................... 103
Interrupt .................................................................... 103
Operation ................................................................. 103
Prescaler .................................................................. 103
Switching the Assignment ................................ 103
Prescaler Assignment (PSA Bit) .............................. 103
Prescaler Select (T0PS2:T0PS0 Bits) ..................... 103
Prescaler. See Prescaler, Timer0.
Timer1 .............................................................................. 105
16-Bit Read/Write Mode ........................................... 108
Associated Registers ............................................... 109
Interrupt .................................................................... 108
Operation ................................................................. 106
Oscillator .......................................................... 105, 107
Oscillator Layout Considerations ............................. 107
Overflow Interrupt .................................................... 105
TMR1H Register ...................................................... 105
TMR1L Register ....................................................... 105
Use as a Clock Source ............................................ 107
Use as a Real-Time Clock ....................................... 108
Timing Diagrams
Up/Down Count Mode) .................................... 121
Reset, Watchdog Timer (WDT), Oscillator
Start-up Timer (OST), Power-up
Timer (PWRT) ................................................. 282
Send Break Character Sequence ............................ 157
Slow Rise Time (MCLR Tied to VDD,
VDD Rise > TPWRT) ............................................ 39
Start of Center-Aligned PWM .................................. 127
Synchronous Reception
(Master Mode, SREN) ..................................... 160
Synchronous Transmission ..................................... 158
Synchronous Transmission (Through TXEN) .......... 159
Time-out Sequence on POR w/PLL Enabled
(MCLR Tied to VDD) .......................................... 39
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied to VDD, Case 1) ...................... 38
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Not Tied to VDD, Case 2) ...................... 38
Time-out Sequence on Power-up
(MCLR Tied to VDD, VDD Rise < TPWRT) ........... 38
Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock .......................... 283
Transition for Entry to Idle Mode ............................... 30
Transition for Entry to SEC_RUN Mode .................... 27
Transition for Entry to Sleep Mode ............................ 29
Transition for Two-Speed Start-up
(INTOSC to HSPLL) ........................................ 197
Transition for Wake from Idle to Run Mode ............... 30
Transition for Wake from Sleep (HSPLL) .................. 29
Transition from RC_RUN Mode to
A/D Conversion ........................................................ 286
Asynchronous Reception ......................................... 155
Asynchronous Transmission .................................... 152
Asynchronous Transmission (Back to Back) ........... 152
Automatic Baud Rate Calculation ............................ 150
Auto-Wake-up Bit (WUE) During
Normal Operation ............................................ 156
Auto-Wake-up Bit (WUE) During Sleep ................... 156
BRG Overflow Sequence ......................................... 150
Brown-out Reset (BOR) ........................................... 282
CLKO and I/O .......................................................... 281
Clock/Instruction Cycle .............................................. 49
Dead-Time Insertion for Complementary PWM ....... 129
Duty Cycle Update Times in Continuous
PRI_RUN Mode ................................................. 28
Transition from SEC_RUN Mode to
PRI_RUN Mode (HSPLL) .................................. 27
Transition to RC_RUN Mode ..................................... 28
Timing Diagrams and Specifications ............................... 279
CLKO and I/O Requirements ................................... 281
EUSART Synchronous Receive
Requirements .................................................. 284
EUSART Synchronous Transmission
Requirements .................................................. 284
External Clock Requirements .................................. 279
PLL Clock ................................................................ 280
Reset, Watchdog Timer, Oscillator Start-up
Timer, Power-up Timer and Brown-out
Up/Down Count Mode ..................................... 126
Duty Cycle Update Times in Continuous
Up/Down Count Mode with Double Updates ... 127
Edge-Aligned PWM .................................................. 126
EUSART Synchronous Receive
(Master/Slave) ................................................. 284
EUSART Synchronous Transmission
(Master/Slave) ................................................. 284
External Clock (All Modes Except PLL) ................... 279
Fail-Safe Clock Monitor ............................................ 199
Low-Voltage Detect Characteristics ......................... 276
Low-Voltage Detect Operation ................................. 182
Override Bits in Complementary Mode .................... 133
PWM Output Override Example #1 .......................... 135
PWM Output Override Example #2 .......................... 135
Reset Requirements ........................................ 282
Timer0 and Timer1 External Clock
Requirements .................................................. 283
Top-of-Stack Access .......................................................... 46
TSTFSZ ........................................................................... 248
Two-Speed Start-up ................................................. 184, 197
Two-Word Instructions
Example Cases ......................................................... 50
TXSTA Register
BRGH Bit ................................................................. 145
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 305
PIC18F1230/1330
V
Voltage Reference Specifications ....................................275
W
Watchdog Timer (WDT) ...........................................184, 195
Associated Registers ...............................................196
Control Register .......................................................195
During Oscillator Failure ..........................................198
Programming Considerations ..................................195
WWW Address .................................................................307
WWW, On-Line Support .......................................................5
X
XORLW ............................................................................248
XORWF ............................................................................249
DS39758B-page 306
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
THE MICROCHIP WEB SITE
CUSTOMER SUPPORT
Microchip provides online support via our WWW site at
www.microchip.com. This web site is used as a means
to make files and information easily available to
customers. Accessible by using your favorite Internet
browser, the web site contains the following
information:
Users of Microchip products can receive assistance
through several channels:
• Distributor or Representative
• Local Sales Office
• Field Application Engineer (FAE)
• Technical Support
• Product Support – Data sheets and errata,
application notes and sample programs, design
resources, user’s guides and hardware support
documents, latest software releases and archived
software
• Development Systems Information Line
Customers
should
contact
their
distributor,
representative or field application engineer (FAE) for
support. Local sales offices are also available to help
customers. A listing of sales offices and locations is
included in the back of this document.
• General Technical Support – Frequently Asked
Questions (FAQ), technical support requests,
online discussion groups, Microchip consultant
program member listing
Technical support is available through the web site
at: http://support.microchip.com
• Business of Microchip – Product selector and
ordering guides, latest Microchip press releases,
listing of seminars and events, listings of
Microchip sales offices, distributors and factory
representatives
CUSTOMER CHANGE NOTIFICATION
SERVICE
Microchip’s customer notification service helps keep
customers current on Microchip products. Subscribers
will receive e-mail notification whenever there are
changes, updates, revisions or errata related to a
specified product family or development tool of interest.
To register, access the Microchip web site at
www.microchip.com, click on Customer Change
Notification and follow the registration instructions.
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 307
PIC18F1230/1330
READER RESPONSE
It is our intention to provide you with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip prod-
uct. If you wish to provide your comments on organization, clarity, subject matter, and ways in which our documentation
can better serve you, please FAX your comments to the Technical Publications Manager at (480) 792-4150.
Please list the following information, and use this outline to provide us with your comments about this document.
To:
Technical Publications Manager
Reader Response
Total Pages Sent ________
RE:
From:
Name
Company
Address
City / State / ZIP / Country
Telephone: (_______) _________ - _________
FAX: (______) _________ - _________
Application (optional):
Would you like a reply?
Y
N
PIC18F1230/1330
DS39758B
Literature Number:
Device:
Questions:
1. What are the best features of this document?
2. How does this document meet your hardware and software development needs?
3. Do you find the organization of this document easy to follow? If not, why?
4. What additions to the document do you think would enhance the structure and subject?
5. What deletions from the document could be made without affecting the overall usefulness?
6. Is there any incorrect or misleading information (what and where)?
7. How would you improve this document?
DS39758B-page 308
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
PIC18F1230/1330
PIC18F1230/1330 PRODUCT IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM
To order or obtain information, e.g., on pricing or delivery, refer to the factory or the listed sales office.
PART NO.
Device
X
/XX
XXX
Examples:
Temperature
Range
Package
Pattern
a)
PIC18LF1330-I/P 301 = Industrial temp.,
PDIP package, Extended VDD limits,
QTP pattern #301.
b)
PIC18LF1230-I/SO = Industrial temp., SOIC
package, Extended VDD limits.
Device
PIC18F1230/1330(1)
PIC18F1230/1330T(2)
VDD range 4.2V to 5.5V
PIC18LF1230/1330(1)
PIC18LF1230/1330T(2)
VDD range 2.0V to 5.5V
Temperature Range
Package(3)
I
E
=
=
-40°C to +85°C (Industrial)
-40°C to +125°C (Extended)
SO
SS
P
=
=
=
=
Plastic Small Outline (SOIC)
Plastic Shrink Small Outline (SSOP)
Plastic Dual In-line (PDIP)
Note 1:
2:
F
LF
T
=
=
=
Standard Voltage Range
Wide Voltage Range
in tape and reel QFN packages only
ML
Plastic Quad Flat No Lead (QFN)
Pattern
QTP, SQTP, Code or Special Requirements
(blank otherwise)
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
Advance Information
DS39758B-page 309
WORLDWIDE SALES AND SERVICE
AMERICAS
Corporate Office
2355 West Chandler Blvd.
Chandler, AZ 85224-6199
Tel: 480-792-7200
Fax: 480-792-7277
Technical Support:
http://support.microchip.com
Web Address:
www.microchip.com
ASIA/PACIFIC
Australia - Sydney
Tel: 61-2-9868-6733
Fax: 61-2-9868-6755
ASIA/PACIFIC
India - Bangalore
Tel: 91-80-4182-8400
Fax: 91-80-4182-8422
EUROPE
Austria - Wels
Tel: 43-7242-2244-399
Fax: 43-7242-2244-393
Denmark - Copenhagen
Tel: 45-4450-2828
China - Beijing
Tel: 86-10-8528-2100
Fax: 86-10-8528-2104
India - New Delhi
Tel: 91-11-5160-8631
Fax: 91-11-5160-8632
Fax: 45-4485-2829
China - Chengdu
Tel: 86-28-8676-6200
Fax: 86-28-8676-6599
France - Paris
Tel: 33-1-69-53-63-20
Fax: 33-1-69-30-90-79
India - Pune
Tel: 91-20-2566-1512
Fax: 91-20-2566-1513
Atlanta
China - Fuzhou
Tel: 86-591-8750-3506
Fax: 86-591-8750-3521
Germany - Munich
Tel: 49-89-627-144-0
Fax: 49-89-627-144-44
Japan - Yokohama
Tel: 81-45-471- 6166
Fax: 81-45-471-6122
Alpharetta, GA
Tel: 770-640-0034
Fax: 770-640-0307
Italy - Milan
Tel: 39-0331-742611
Fax: 39-0331-466781
China - Hong Kong SAR
Tel: 852-2401-1200
Fax: 852-2401-3431
Korea - Gumi
Tel: 82-54-473-4301
Fax: 82-54-473-4302
Boston
Westborough, MA
Tel: 774-760-0087
Fax: 774-760-0088
Netherlands - Drunen
Tel: 31-416-690399
Fax: 31-416-690340
China - Qingdao
Tel: 86-532-8502-7355
Fax: 86-532-8502-7205
Korea - Seoul
Tel: 82-2-554-7200
Fax: 82-2-558-5932 or
82-2-558-5934
Chicago
Itasca, IL
Tel: 630-285-0071
Fax: 630-285-0075
Spain - Madrid
Tel: 34-91-708-08-90
Fax: 34-91-708-08-91
China - Shanghai
Tel: 86-21-5407-5533
Fax: 86-21-5407-5066
Malaysia - Penang
Tel: 60-4-646-8870
Fax: 60-4-646-5086
Dallas
Addison, TX
Tel: 972-818-7423
Fax: 972-818-2924
UK - Wokingham
Tel: 44-118-921-5869
Fax: 44-118-921-5820
China - Shenyang
Tel: 86-24-2334-2829
Fax: 86-24-2334-2393
Philippines - Manila
Tel: 63-2-634-9065
Fax: 63-2-634-9069
Detroit
China - Shenzhen
Tel: 86-755-8203-2660
Fax: 86-755-8203-1760
Farmington Hills, MI
Tel: 248-538-2250
Fax: 248-538-2260
Singapore
Tel: 65-6334-8870
Fax: 65-6334-8850
China - Shunde
Tel: 86-757-2839-5507
Fax: 86-757-2839-5571
Kokomo
Kokomo, IN
Tel: 765-864-8360
Fax: 765-864-8387
Taiwan - Hsin Chu
Tel: 886-3-572-9526
Fax: 886-3-572-6459
China - Wuhan
Tel: 86-27-5980-5300
Fax: 86-27-5980-5118
Taiwan - Kaohsiung
Tel: 886-7-536-4818
Fax: 886-7-536-4803
Los Angeles
Mission Viejo, CA
Tel: 949-462-9523
Fax: 949-462-9608
China - Xian
Tel: 86-29-8833-7250
Fax: 86-29-8833-7256
Taiwan - Taipei
Tel: 886-2-2500-6610
Fax: 886-2-2508-0102
San Jose
Mountain View, CA
Tel: 650-215-1444
Fax: 650-961-0286
Thailand - Bangkok
Tel: 66-2-694-1351
Fax: 66-2-694-1350
Toronto
Mississauga, Ontario,
Canada
Tel: 905-673-0699
Fax: 905-673-6509
02/16/06
DS39758B-page 310
Advance Information
© 2006 Microchip Technology Inc.
相关型号:
PIC18F1230-E/PSQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-E/SO
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-E/SOQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-E/SOSQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-E/SS
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-E/SSQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-E/SSSQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-I/ML
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-I/MLQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-I/MLSQTP
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
PIC18F1230-I/P
18/20/28-Pin, Enhanced Flash Microcontrollers with nanoWatt Technology, High-Performance PWM and A/D
MICROCHIP
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明